Digitized by the Internet Arciiive

in 2011 witii funding from

LYRASIS IVIembers and Sloan Foundation

http://www.archive.org/details/ohiouniversitybu1958ohio

Ohio University

A GATEWAY TO OPPORTUNITY

1804 OHIO'S OLDEST UNIVERSITY *

One Hundred Fifty-Four Years of Distinguished Educational Service to the State and Nation

1958

See inside of map folder for identification of pictures in Bulletin

^l-SiL- l"" "==" *" AlRPOilT

INOUSTBIAL ARTS HEATING PLAMT LAUNDRY

ENGINEERING BUILDINfi SCIENCE HALL CHEMISTRY CbPELAND HALL SUPER HALL MEN'S 8YM(CAP.t300) LINDLEY ANNEX LINDLEY HALL CHUGS LIBRARY UEMORIAL AUDITORIUM GALBREATH CHAPEL ELLIS HALL WILSON HALL MCSUFFET HALL CUTL£R HALL riNE ARTS HALL EWINC HALL CARNEGIE HALL WOMEf/S GYM ROYD HALL

S9 PARK PLACE (PRES.RES.) MUSIC HALL

NATnORIUM (SEAHNG CAP 850) SCOTT QUADRANGLE (STOWOUENI AGRICULTURE BUILDING BRYAN HALL UNIVERSITY ELEM.SCHQOL JOHNSON HALL (IIS) 8USH HALL(I4S) BIDBLC HALL (133) PEItKINS HALL042) BEAD HAL^l 142) WASHINGTON HALL ( 260) TIFFIN HALL 11 96) I SHIVELY HALLIieS) DORMITORY

6AHERTSFELDER HALL(3I01 JEFFERSON HALL(309) HEALTH CENTER VOICT HALL SPEECH BTJILDINO VETERANS AFFAIRS 29,31 S.COLLEGE ST OHIO UNIVERSITY CENTER HOWARD HALL PHYSICAL EDUCATION INDOOR PRACTICE BUILDING LIFE SCIENCE BUILDING

S.W.TM.ON as.

BO TO 0.a3S3A. EXPRMNTU FARM <H£BBAflO$VILLE)

53 ANIN

54 EDGE

55 ENSI

: e BUS 97 BALI I SB STAI

59 STAF

60 GAR

61 351

62 SB 6 3 56 1 64 60E

es SHE'

66 WEL: 6T 4B

68 34

69 PUT

70 IIS.

71 SER

72 EWI

PICTURES IN THE BULLETIN

"An Act, establishing an

University . . . " Frontispiece

Edwin Watts Chubb Library Frontispiece

Opposite page:

Voigt Hall A Residence Hall for Women 32

Bryan Hall A Residence Hall for Women 33

East Green Residence Halls for Men 64

Helen Mauck Galbreath Memorial Chapel 65

Commencement on the Green 96

Freshmen Learn About the University's

Traditions (top) 97

A Dean Counsels with a Student (bottom) 97

One of the Home Economics Laboratories (top)_128

A Student Teacher and Children (bottom) 128

A Modern Classroom (top) 129

A Journalism Laboratory (bottom) 129

University Women's Glee Club (top) 160

University Symphony Orchestra (Center) 160

University Men's Glee Club (bottom) 160

Bobcats Meet Foe on Gridiron (top) 161

A Meet in the Natatorium (bottom) 161

The Study of History (top) 192

Research in Chemistry (bottom) 192

Summer Session Students enjoy "Under the

Elms" Concert (top) 193

Students Enjoy the Advantages of Study at an

Ohio University Branch (bottom) 193

A Corner of the Ceramics Laboratory (top) 224

Scene from a Theatre Production (bottom) 224

R.O.T.C. Review (top) 225

A Chemical Engineering Laboratory (bottom) 225

Jo the #/^ ^^ -

rospectlve student

p.

Ohio University, established by an act of the Legislature of the State of Ohio in 1804, is but a year younger than the state itself. Those who planned its founding were members of the original Ohio Company of Associates who came from New England and understood well the supreme importance of higher education. Through more than a century and a half the University has grown into a complex organization of seven colleges, five schools, a number of Branches, and other major divisions. Year-round study opportunities are provided, and programs leading to undergraduate and graduate degrees, includ- ing the doctorate, are available.

The University is coeducational. It is fully accredited, and is con- stantly improving its facilities and its instructional services to afford the best possible educational opportunities. Because it is supported by the state, the costs of attendance are lower than at most universi- ties of similar high standards.

Ohio University offers an extensive program of recreational activi- ties and intramural sports for all students. In inter-collegiate com- petition its varsity teams consistently rank high in the Mid-American Conference.

There are on the campus over 150 student organizations in which participation is encouraged as a valuable aid in developing leadership and civic responsibility. Students sit as active members on several committees concerned with the government of the university and the regulation of campus life.

The university and the Athens community present many cultural advantages. There are frequent and varied professional and student concerts, plays in the fine University Theatre, art exhibits, lectures, and other programs of general or special interest.

Qualified men have the opportunity for military training in Army and Air Force Tactics, Organization, and Administration. Upon comple- tion of the university and the Reserve Officers Training Corps re- quirements they may be offered commissions as second lieutenants in the U. S. Army Reserve or the U. S. Air Force Reserve.

Ohio University is a friendly university. The faculty and adminis- tration strive to give students an education and to make life as pleas- ant for them as possible while they are doing it. With more than 7000 students on its compact, residential campus, Ohio University is large enough to sustain a true university atmosphere but not so large as to endanger the personal relationship that should exist between every student and his University.

The University welcomes the serious consideration of all who are giving thought to the preparation they need to live a rich and effec- tive life.

CHAPTER ^^^^"^

in the towu oi i^"' . ^ . n- *:^n^ for the liberal

WHEREAS infiitutKins lo

education ot joaui^.te ^ ^^^^^^^^ ^^^^ ^^^^^^

grefs of arts and .- ] .,. ,^.^ ^1^^

rality, virtue and v. = -- -^^^ ^ ^_^^^^ '

peace, order ana proii^ - ; ^. ^_^^^^ t-n-vj-ra- honor^blti ' ' ' ' ^^v.ibie,

-:sai;d patiouuL^v.' .- - ^

a

.-. 0/ the stvif fj '-'^-'^ iadt..Aic jj^,jj,,a.

hall b- ^.u timvt)iit> i~^^^^-_ , ,. . ,

.1

1 1 1 <*. i »• i.V >- * * - " - , , ,

blH^-"^ III the town '■

fl,u^ in th^ilrnVr

%! bv tbc O'hio 1. y •'• ;;-'■

Umvcriityrturthcn.uu ., -^ .,..Uns and

" vuM" rcli-'on and moralUy, and calKjn, Mia.., rcno.-.. V.t^rirv

,-. ,,,1, an the dcgvcfs and literary

.^ - dl be and lor.'- .u nn m the laid ^^^.^^,.;,,,.

nmvcuuy, a body politic and corporate, by

A ti

iiiii Ill iiiiiiiMiiiiiiiiiiif

%>{^

\

V

/

\"-

%.!

■r]

Pi

'"\.

\\'

mm

4^4.; «

#^

^/■t..;<-

<" /

Pifc.

ikj >,

-#:•

'^rh

fit

?»*'^.

\hy^d'

^J-

A":

OHIO

UNIVERSITY BULLETIN

For The Biennium

1958 1960

ATHENS. OHIO

TABLE OF CONTENTS

(See Index for more detailed listings)

University Calendar 4

University History 12

Curricula and Degrees 12

Accreditation 14

Buildings and Grounds 14

Housing and Food Service 17

Other University Services 19

Scholarships 24

Loan Funds 29

Prizes and Awards 32

Cultural Opportunities 36

Recreational Opportunities 39

Student Activities and Organizations 44

Admissions 52

Fees 58

Expense Estimate 59

Registration 60

Graduation 68

The University College 76

The College of Applied Science 82

The College of Arts and Sciences 98

The College of Commerce 116

The College of Education 128

The College of Fine Arts 144

The Graduate College 160

The Branches 166

The Division of Physical Education and Athletics 166

The Reserve Officers' Training Corps Division 171

The University Extension Division 174

The Summer Session 175

Courses of Instruction 178

General Officers of the University 304

Administrative Officers 305

Administrative Officers in the Colleges 307

Officers of Instruction 310

Index 327

OHIO UNIVERSITY BULLETIN

Vol. LV JANUARY, 1958 Number 1

Published at Athens', Ohio, by Ohio University in January (twice), March, April, August, and November. Entered at the Post Office at Athens, Ohio, as Second-class Matter under act of August 24, 1912.

1958-1959

1959-1960

JUNE '58 S M T W T F S

15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30

JULY '58

1 2 S 4 5

6 7 8 9 10 11 12

13 14 15 16 17 18 19

20 21 22 23 24 25 26

27 28 29 30 31

AUGUST '58

1 2

3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 SI

SEPTEMBER '58

1 2 S 4 5 6

7 8 9 10 11 12 IS

14 15 16 17 18 19 20

21 22 23 24 25 26 27

28 29 30

OCTOBEK '58

12 8 4

6 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 SO 31

JANUARY '59 S M T W T F S

J^ 2 3

4 5 6 7 8 9 10

11 12 13 14 15 16 17

18 19 20 21 22 23 24

25 26 27 28 29 30 31

FEBRUARY '59

12 3 4 5 6 7

8 9 10 11 12 13 14

15 16 17 18 19 20 21

22 23 24 25 26 27 28

MARCH '59

12 3 4 5 6 7

8 9 10 11 12 13 14

15 16 17 18 19 20 21

22 23 24 25 26 27 28

29 30 31

APRIL '59

12 3 4

i 6 7 8 9 10 11

12 13 14 15 16 17 18

19 20 21 22 23 24 25

28 27 28 29 30

MAY '59

1 2

8 4 5 G 7 8 9

10 11 12 13 14 15 16

17 18 19 20 21 22 23

24 25 26 27 28 29 30

JUNE '59 S M T W T F S

14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30

JULY '59

1 2 3 J_

5 6 7 8 9 10 11

12 13 14 15 16 17 18

19 20 21 22 23 24 25

26 27 28 29 30 31

AUGUST '59

1

2 3 4 5 6 7 8

9 10 11 12 13 14 15

16 17 18 19 20 21 22

23 24 25 26 27 28 29

30 31

SEPTEMBER '59

12 3 4 5

6 _7^ 8 9 10 11 12

13 14 15 16 17 18 19

20 21 22 23 24 25 26

27 28 29 30

OCTOBER '59

12 3

4 5 6 7 8 9 10

11 12 13 14 15 16 17

18 19 20 21 22 23 24

25 26 27 28 29 30 31

JANUARY '60

S M T W T F S

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 81

FEBRUARY '60

12 3 4 5 6

7 8 9 10 11 12 13

14 15 16 17 18 19 20

21 22 23 24 25 26 27

28 29

MARCH '60

12 3 4 5

6 7 8 9 10 11 12

13 14 15 16 17 18 19

20 21 22 23 24 25 26

27 28 29 30 31

APRIL '60

1 2

3 4 5 6 7 8 9

10 11 12 13 14 15 16

r7 18 19 20 21 22 23

24 25 26 27 28 29 30

MAY '60

12 3 4 5 6 7

8 9 10 11 12 13 14

15 16 17 18 19 20 21

22 23 24 25 26 27 28

29 30 31

NOVEMBER '58

1

2 3 4 5 6 7 8

9 10 11 12 13 14 15

16 17 18 19 20 21 22

23 24 25 26 27 28 29

30

DECEMBER '58

12 3 4 5 6

7 8 9 10 11 12 13

14 15 16 17 18 19 20

21 22 23 24 25 26 27

28 29 30 31

JUNE '59

12 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13

Inclusive Vacation Dates : Thanksgiving,

Noon Nov. 26 to Noon Dec. 1 Christmas,

Dec. 17 to Jan. 5

at noon.

Spring, Noon

Mar. 25 to Noon

April 1.

NOVEMBER '59

12 3 4 5 6 7

8 9 10 11 12 13 14

15 16 17 18 19 20 21

22 23 24 25 26 27 28

29 30

DECEMBER '59

12 3 4 5

6 7 8 9 10 11 12

13 14 15 16 17 18 19

20 21 22 23 24_25 26

27 28 29 30 31

JUNE '60

12 3 4

5 6 7 8 9 10 11

Inclusive Vacation Dates : Thanksgiving, Noon Nov. 25 to Noon Nov. 30 Christmas, Dec. 17 to Jan. 4 at noon. Spring, Noon April 13 to Noon April 20.

THE UNIVERSITY CALENDAR FOR 1958-1959

THE 1958 SUMMER SESSION

First term June 16 to July 18; second term July 21 to August 22. For complete announcements see the Summer Session Bulletin.

PRECOLLEGE COUNSELING

A one-day testing and counseling program recommended for all new freshmen. Freshmen come to the campus for one day in July.

FIRST SEMESTER 1958-1959

1958

Sept. 13 Sat. Opening of Freshman Week.

Sept. 17 Wed. Registration for all students at time specified on

registration time card.

Sept. 18 Thur. Classes begin.

Sept. 29 Mon. Last day for registering for the semester.

Last day for graduate student to apply for admis- sion to candidacy.

Oct. 4 Sat. Last day for adding course by change order.

Last day for degree college student to withdraw from a course.

Oct. 6 Mon. Last day for filing application for graduation on

January 31.

Oct. 11 Sat. Last day for partial refund of fees to students

who withdraw.

Oct. 16 Thur. English proficiency test in evening.

Oct. 25 Sat. Last day for removing incomplete grades incurred

during last session in residence.

Oct. 30 Thur. University College seven-weeks' grades due in

Registrar's office by 4:00 p.m.

Nov. 4 Tues.

to Nov. 8 Sat. Counseling period for University College students.

Nov. 8 Sat. Last day for University College student to with-

draw from a course.

Nov. 26 Wed. Thanksgiving recess begins at 12:00 noon.

4

Dec. 1 Mon, Classes resume at 12:00 noon,

Dec. 4 Thur. University College twelve-weeks' grades due in

Registrar's office by 4:00 p.m.

Dec. 5 Fri Advising of degree college students for second

semester; classes dismissed.

Dec. 9 Tues.

to Dec. 13 Sat. Counseling period for University College students;

second semester schedules are prepared.

Dec. 12 Fri. Last day for all master's degree candidates to

take comprehensive examination on major course work. Last day for master's degree candidates to present thesis in form for final typing to Thesis Director for approval.

Dec. 16 Tues. Christmas recess begins after last class.

1959

Jan. 5 Mon. Classes resume at 12:00 noon.

Jan. 21 Wed. Last day of classes.

Jan. 22 Thur. Reading and review day.

Last day for master's degree candidates to take oral examination on thesis.

Jan. 23 Fri. Examinations begin.

Jan. 26 Mon. Theses due in library and abstracts due in

Graduate College office.

Jan. 28 Wed. Candidates' grades due in Registrar's office,

4:00 p.m.

Jan. 29 Thur. Examinations end.

Jan. 31 Sat. Semester closes; commencement; activities for

new second semester students begin.

SECOND SEMESTER 1958-1959

Semester opens; counseling and advising.

Registration.

Classes begin.

Last day for registering for the semester. Last day for graduate student to apply for admission to candidacy.

Feb. 21 Sat. Last day for adding course by change order.

Last day for degree college student to withdraw from a course.

Feb.

2

Mon.

Feb.

3

Tues.

Feb.

4

Wed.

Feb.

16

Mon.

Feb. 23 Mon.

Feb. 28 Sat.

Mar. 12 Thur.

Mar. 14 Sat.

Mar. 17 Tues.

to

Mar. 21 Sat.

Mar. 19 Thur,

Mar. 25 Wed.

Mar. 28 Sat.

Apr. 1 Wed.

Apr. 28 Tues.

Apr. 30 Thur,

May 5 Tues.

to

May 9 Sat.

May 7 Thur.

May 26 Tues.

May 27 Wed.

May 28 Thur.

May 30 Sat.

June 1 Mon.

June 3 Wed.

June 5 Fri.

June 7 Sun.

Last day for filing application for graduation on June 7.

Last day for partial refund of fees to students who withdraw.

University College six-weeks' grades due in Registrar's office by 4:00 p.m.

Last day for removing incomplete grades in- curred during last session in residence.

Counseling period for University College students.

English proficiency test in evening.

Spring recess begins at 12:00 noon.

Last day for University College student to with- draw from a course.

Classes resume at 12:00 noon.

Last day for master's degree candidates to present thesis in form for final typing to Thesis Director for approval.

University College thirteen-weeks' grades due in Registrar's office by 4:00 p.m.

Counseling period for University College students.

Last day for all master's degree candidates to take comprehensive examination on major course work.

Last day for master's degree candidates to take oral examination on thesis.

Reading and review day; counseling and advising for September.

Examinations begin.

Memorial Day holiday.

Theses due in library and abstracts due in Graduate College office.

Candidates' grades due in Registrar's office, 4:00 p.m.

Examinations end.

Commencement.

6

THE UNIVERSITY CALENDAR FOR ] 959-1 960

THE 1959 SUMMER SESSION

First term June 15 to July 17; second term July 20 to August 21. For complete announcements see the Summer Session Bulletin.

PRECOLLEGE COUNSELING

A one-day testing and counseling program recommended for all new freshmen. Freshmen come to the campus for one day in July.

1959

Sept. 12 Sat.

Sept. 16 Wed.

Sept. 17 Thur.

Sept. 28 Mon.

Oct.

3 Sat.

Oct. 5 Mon.

Oct. 10 Sat.

Oct. 15 Thur.

Oct. 24 Sat.

Oct. 29 Thur.

Nov. 3 Tues.

to

Nov. 7 Sat.

Nov. 7 Sat.

Nov. 25 Wed. Nov. 30 Mon.

FIRST SEMESTER 1959-1960

Opening of Freshman Week.

Registration for all students at time specified on registration time card.

Classes begin.

Last day for registering for the semester. Last day for graduate student to apply for admis- sion to candidacy.

Last day for adding course by change order. Last day for degree college student to withdraw from a course.

Last day for filing application for graduation on January 30.

Last day for partial refund to fees to students who withdraw.

English proficiency test in evening.

Last day for removing incomplete grades incurred during last session in residence.

University College seven-weeks' grades due in Registrar's office by 4:00 p.m.

Counseling period for University College students.

Last day for University College student to with- draw from a course.

Thanksgiving recess begins at 12:00 noon.

Classes resume at 12:00 noon.

7

Dec. 3 Thur. University College twelve-weeks' grades due in

Registrar's office by 4:00 p.m.

Dec. 4 Fri. Advising of degree college students for second

semester; classes dismissed.

Dec. 8 Tues.

to Dec. 12 Sat. Counseling period for University College students;

second semester schedules are prepared.

Dec. 11 Fri. Last day for all master's degree candidates to

take comprehensive examination on major course work.

Dec. 14 Mon. Last day for master's degree candidates to present

thesis in form for final typing to Thesis Director for approval,

Dec. 16 Wed. Christmas recess begins after last class.

1960

Jan. 4 Mon. Classes resume at 12:00 noon.

Jan. 20 Wed. Last day of classes.

Jan. 21 Thur. Reading and review day.

Last day for master's degree candidates to take oral examination on thesis.

Jan. 22 Fri. Examinations begin.

Jan. 25 Mon. Theses due in library and abstracts due in

Graduate College office.

Jan. 27 Wed. Candidates' grades due in Registrar's office,

4:00 p.m.

Jan. 28 Thur. Examinations end.

Jan. 30 Sat. Semester closes; commencement; activities for

new second semester students begin.

SECOND SEMESTER 1959-1960

Semester opens; counseling and advising.

Registration.

Classes begin.

Last day for registering for the semester. Last day for graduate student to apply for admission to candidacy.

Feb. 20 Sat. Last day for adding course by change order .

Last day for degree college student to withdraw from a course.

8

Feb.

1

Mon.

Feb.

2

Tues.

Feb.

3

Wed.

Feb.

15

Mon.

Feb. 22 Mon.

Feb. 27 Sat.

Mar. 12 Sat.

Mar. 17 Thur.

Mar. 17 Thur.

Mar. 22 Tues.

to

Mar. 26 Sat.

Mar. 26 Sat.

Apr. 13 Wed.

Apr. 20 Wed.

Apr. 27 Wed.

Apr. 28 Thur.

May 3 Tues.

to

May 7 Sat.

May 5 Thur.

May 24 Tues.

May 25 Wed.

May 26 Thur.

May 30 Mon.

May 31 Tues.

June 1 Wed.

June 3 Fri.

June 5 Sun.

Last day for filing application for graduation on June 5.

Last day for partial refund of fees to students who withdraw.

Last day for removing incomplete grades in- curred during last session in residence.

English proficiency test in evening.

University College seven-weeks' grades due in Registrar's office by 4:00 p.m.

Counseling period for University College students.

Last day for University College student to with- draw from a course.

Spring recess begins at 12:00 noon.

Classes resume at 12:00 noon.

Last day for master's degree candidates to present thesis in form for final typing to Thesis Director for approval.

University College thirteen-week's grades due in Registrar's office by 4:00 p.m.

Counseling period for University College students.

Last day for all master's degree candidates to take comprehensive examination on major course work.

Last day for master's degree candidates to take oral examination on thesis.

Reading and review day; counseling and advising for September.

Examinations begin.

Memorial Day holiday.

Theses due in library and abstracts due in Graduate College office.

Candidates' grades due in Registrar's office, 4:00 p.m.

Examinations end. Commencement. 9

GENERAL INFORMATION

Historical Background Organization of the University;

Curricula and Degrees Buildings and Grounds Housing and Food Service

Other University Services

Student Health Service

Counseling

Clinics

Veterans

Students fronn Other Countries

Bureau of Appointnnents

Student Financial Aids

Scholarships Loan Funds Student Ennployment

Prizes and Awards

Cultural and Recreational Opportunities

Student Activities and Organizations

Student Government

Publications

Dramatics

Music

Religious

Scholastic and Social

OHIO UNIVERSITY

HISTORICAL BACKGROUND

Ohio University has a rich heritage. Considered its co-founders are Dr. Manasseh Cutler of Ipswich, Massachusetts, and General Rufus Putnam of Rutland, Massachusetts. It was Cutler who in 1787 signed the Ohio Company's contract with Congress for the purchase of land in the Northwest Territory. The contract set aside two townships of land in the center of the purchase tract as the gift of the United States Government for the founding of a University. It was adding reality to Cutler's words which had been incorporated in the Ordinance of 1787 for the government of the Northwest Territory: "Religion, morality, and knowledge being necessary to good government and the happiness of mankind, schools, and the means of education shall for- ever be encouraged." It was Putnam who in 1799, after delay caused by the Indian Wars, laid out the town of Athens and the College Green. On March 1, 1803, Ohio, the first of five states to be formed from the Northwest Territory, entered the Union, and on February 18, 1804 its Legislature provided for the establishment of "an University . . . in the town of Athens ... by the name and style of the Ohio University." Thus Ohio University became the first institution of higher learning in the Northwest Territory and the vast region beyond. It has grown with the Nation and the State into a diversified and effective institution of higher education.

ORGANIZATION OF THE UNIVERSITY

CURRICULA AND DEGREES

The University College

Basic preparation for admission to each of the degree-granting

colleges Two-year terminal programs leading to the Associate in Arts diploma

The College of Applied Science

Engineering Curricula leading to the degrees Bachelor of Science

in Architectural Engineering, Bachelor of Science in Chemical

Engineering, Bachelor of Science in Civil Engineering, Bachelor

of Science in Electrical Engineering, and Bachelor of Science in

Mechanical Engineering Curriculum leading to the degree Bachelor of Science in Industrial

Technology The School of Home Economics

Curricula leading to the degree Bachelor of Science in Home Economics The Department of Industrial Arts The College of Arts and Sciences

Curricula leading to the degrees Bachelor of Arts and Bachelor of

Science Preprofessional curricula

12

Organization of the University 13

The College of Commerce

Curricula leading to the degrees Bachelor of Science (major in Agriculture), Bachelor of Science in Commerce, and Bachelor of Science in Secretarial Studies The School of Journalism

Curricula leading to the degree Bachelor of Science in Journalism

The College of Education

Teacher-training curricula leading to the degree Bachelor of Science in Education

The College of Fine Arts

Curricula in three schools leading to the degree Bachelor of Fine

Arts The School of Dramatic Art and Speech The School of Music The School of Painting and Allied Arts

The Graduate College

Programs leading to the degrees Master of Arts, Master of Business Administration, Master of Education, Master of Fine Arts, Master of Science, and Doctor of Philosophy

The Branches Chillicothe Ironton Lancaster Martins Ferry Portsmouth Zanesville

The Division of Physical Education and Athletics

The Reserve Officers' Training Corps

Air Science

Military Science and Tactics

The University Extension Division Extension Classes Correspondence Courses

CLASSIFICATION AND LOCATION

Ohio University is a coeducational, state-supported university. The city of Athens, home of the University, is located in scenic South- eastern Ohio and has a population of 10,000.

Free from the distractions of a metropolitan center, Athens offers many advantages to the person who desires to pursue university work in an atmosphere of culture and relative quiet.

14 Ohio University

Athens is conveniently accessible by automobile on U. S. Routes 33 and 50 and State Route 56. The city is on the main New York-St. Louis route of the Baltimore and Ohio Railroad. Bus service from the north is provided by the Lake Shore System and the Zane Transit Lines, from the south by Lake Shore, and from the east and west by Grey- hound Lines.

THE SESSIONS

The sessions of the University consist, annually, of two eighteen- week semesters and a summer session of two five-week terms. Sequences of courses are planned to permit students to begin degree programs in any of these sessions. The plan provides year-round study opportunities for students at both the undergraduate and graduate levels.

ACCREDITATION

Ohio University is accredited by the North Central Association of Colleges and Secondary Schools, and by the recognized professional accrediting associations identified with its major academic divisions. It holds membership in the leading state and national educational and professional associations in its major areas of interest. Specific references to accreditation are contained in the respective college sections of the catalog. A selected list of memberships and approvals appears on the inside back cover.

BUILDINGS AND GROUNDS

Ohio University's physical plant consists of 53 principal build- ings, 47 auxiliary buildings, and 332 acres of land. There is in ad- dition the Ohio University Airport of 100 acres and the University Farm of 391 acres.

ON THE GREEN

The "College Green" was laid out from time to time between 1799 and 1804 in compliance with the terms of a Resolution of the General Assembly of the Territory of Ohio passed in 1799. Its pres- ent boundaries were fixed in 1844.

The Green now comprises a small part of the land holdings of the University, and a majority of the university buildings are to be found off The Green, although near it.

On The Green are located 12 buildings and two memorial gate- ways.

Manasseh Cutler Hall (18*), the oldest building in the North- west Territory erected for the purposes of higher education, was known in its early days as "The College Edifice" and later as the Center Build- ing. It was given its present name for one of the founders of the Uni- versity. Its construction was begun in 1816 and completed in 1818. Cutler Hall and the nearby "Wings," of similar style, comprise an in- teresting unit of early American architecture.

•See map and key in front of catalog.

Buildings and Grounds 15

Wilson Hall (16) was erected in 1837 and for more than a century was known as East Wing.

McGuFFEY Hall (17), originally known as West Wing, was erected in 1839. This building was named for William Holmes McGuffey, author of the famous "Readers" and a onetime president of Ohio University. It is identical with Wilson Hall in the unit of three old buildings, which today house administrative offices.

Other buildings on The Green are the Edwin Watts Chubb Library (12), the Alumni Memorial Auditorium (13), the Galbreath MEM0RLA.L Chapel (14), Ewing Hall (Social Sciences) (20), Hall of Fine Arts (Architecture, Photography) (19), Ellis Hall (Art, Eng- lish, Languages) (15), Carnegie Hall (Mathematics, R.O.T.C.) (21), the Women's Gymnasium (22), and Boyd Hall (residence for women) (23).

Most of the other university buildings are located on streets adjacent to or leading from The Green.

OFF THE GREEN

ON EAST UNION STREET, north boundary of The Green, are the University Center (46), the University Guest House (67), the Home Economics Management House (68), the University Elemen- tary School (30), and the Education Building (51).

The Student Health Center (42) is located off East Union Street.

ON UNIVERSITY TERRACE, immediately east of The Green, is Bryan Hall (residence for women) (29) and the Agriculture and House- hold Arts Building (28).

Also on University Terrace, southeast of The Green, is Scott Quadrangle (27) and the Natatorium (26). Scott Quadrangle, a resi- dence for women, is composed of eight units Atkinson, Bentley, Copeland, Dana, Dunkle, Evans, Gordy, and Hoover halls.

ON PARK PLACE, south boundary of The Green, is Music Hall (25) and the President's Home (24).

ON COLLEGE STREET, a street running north and south from The Green, will be found the Speech Building (44), Voigt Hall (43), and Howard Hall (47). The latter two halls are residences for women.

ON SOUTH COURT STREET, west boundary of The Green are Lindley Hall (residence for women) (11) and Copeland Hall (Commerce, Journalism) (7).

ON PRESIDENT STREET, west of The Green, are to be found the Men's Gymnasium (9), Super Hall (Physics) (8), the Chemistry Building (6), Science Hall (Zoology) (5), and the Engineering Building (4).

Located on top of the Engineering Building is the nine-inch refract- or telescope of the Department of Astronomy.

16 Ohio University

ON RICHLAND AVENUE, across the South Bridge, are the Life Sci- ence Building (50), the Engineering Laboratory (55), and the Animal Building (53).

The Industrial Arts Building (1) and the Heating Plant (2) are located on West Union Street.

EAST GREEN

ON THE EAST GREEN, an area immediately east of the main campus, is an 11-unit housing area for men. The entire project, when the final dormitory (39) is completed, will house 2,200 men students, will have cost approximately seven and one-half million dollars, and will be one of the finest dormitory systems in the Midwest,

Occupied are the following: Johnson Hall (31), Bush Hall (32), Biddle Hall (33), Perkins Hall (34), Read Hall (35), Washington Hall (36), Tiffin Hall (37), Shively Hall (38), Gamertsfelder Hall (40), and Jefferson Hall (41).

ATHLETIC FIELDS

The Athletic Fields, comprising 200 acres, are located across the Hocking River on the east side of Richland Avenue. There is an excellent baseball field (57); Indoor practice building and Ice Rink (49), the first unit of a new Physical Education Plant (48); Ohio Stadium (58), seating 14,000 persons, with a football gridiron and running track; intramural fields; tennis courts and practice fields. Additional recrea- tional areas total 206 acres.

UNIVERSITY GOLF COURSE

The nine-hole University Golf Course is located on the east side of the Hocking River across from Ohio Stadium and the other athletic fields. The two areas are connected by an iron footbridge.

UNIVERSITY AIRPORT

The Ohio University Airport of 100 acres is located approximately two miles from the campus on U.S. Route 50, east of Athens. The field has a runway 4,000 feet in length, four hangars, and an administration building. The hangars provide space for plane storage, a repair station, a Link Trainer room, and a pilots' ready room. The field is equippe ^ with runway lights for night flying.

UNIVERSITY FARM

The University Farm of 391 acres is located nine miles southwest of Athens. Laboratory work and demonstrations are carried on with crops (primarily grain and feed) and with livestock (dairy and beef cattle, hogs, and poultry). On the farm are two homes, four barns, poultry houses, and numerous small buildings.

HOUSING AND FOOD SERVICE

LIVING ACCOMMODATIONS. Ohio University provides attractive residence halls for the health and well-being of its students. All of the men's and women's facilities are adjacent to the campus, easily and conveniently accessible to other University buildings and to the business section of the city of Athens. Each residence hall has its own dining hall, with the exception of Voigt Hall and the dormitories on the East Green which are served by central dining halls. Management of the dining halls is under competent dietitians, who serve as members of the staff of the Director of Residence Services. Each residence hall is under the supervision of a resident manager or resident head. In addition, a number of graduate assistants and upperclass student counselors are assigned to the halls to aid in the over-all counseling program.

APPLICATIONS. Applications for rooms in either the women's or men's residence halls should be made to the Director of Housing, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio. HOUSING CONTRACTS ARE MADE FOR THE FULL ACADEMIC YEAR. An application is considered only if accompanied by a $5.00 retaining fee made payable to Ohio Uni- versity. (Applicants for mid-year entrance or the summer session remit $2.50). The retaining fee is not refundable. All Freshmen, Except Those Twenty-one Years of Age and Over, Must Live in University Housing During Their First Year. Exceptions are made for commuters and residents of Athens.

BOARD. The cost of board in University dining halls is $216.00 a semester for 21 meals a week. Meals are served throughout the academic year except during the Thanksgiving, Christmas, and Spring recesses. Board rates are subject to revision, upward or downward, in accord- ance with prevailing economic conditions. Residents in all University housing accommodations are required to eat in University dining halls.

ROOMS. In the residence halls for men or women, two or more students are assigned to each room. Semester room rates in the perm- anent dormitories for each student range from $117.00 to $144.00. All room rates include telephone, mail, and linen services. Rooms are furnished with dresser, study desks, chairs, beds, and bed linen which is laundered by the University. Items such as blankets, bed spread, dresser scarf, towels, toilet articles, and such accessories as draperies and desk lamp, must be provided by the student.

The University reserves the right to use rooms in any of the resi- dence halls during the Christmas recess.

RESIDENCE HALLS. There are eight residence halls and three Uni- versity-owned cottages for women. The residence units are Boyd, Bryan, Howard, Jefferson, Lindley, and Voigt halls, Scott Quadrangle, and Ohio University Center Dormitory.

The present facilities for men include nine residence halls. They are Biddle, Bush, Gamertsfelder, Johnson, Perkins, Read, Shively, Tiffin,

17

18 Ohio University

and Washington halls. Married students are permitted to live in Uni- versity residence halls provided their husband or wife is not on campus or in the vicinity of Athens.

PAYMENTS. Following the assignment of a student to a place in a residence hall, an advance payment is required. The amount of the advance deposit, together with a deadline for its receipt, will be indi- cated in the assignment letter. The advance deposit is applied to the student's room account. An initial board payment will be due the first week of each term. A schedule of payment and dates, determined by the Office of the Treasurer, will be forwarded with the assignment letter.

CANCELLATIONS AND REFUNDS. Full refund of the advance room payment will be made to a student requesting cancellation by September 1 for the fall semester and by January 15 for the spring semester. After those dates, refunds will be made on the basis of 80% of the advance room payment if application for refund is made before the second week of the semester and 50% if it is made before the end of the fourth week. A week is interpreted to mean a calendar week ending on Saturday. A student withdrawing during the semester will be re- funded the unused portion of the board payment. Further information about housing may be obtained from the Director of Housing, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio.

ROOMS IN PRIVATE HOMES

Rooms in private homes are listed in the Office of the Director of Housing. Rooms are not listed until they have been inspected and approved by a member of the staff of the Director of Housing or of the Dean of Women. All undergraduate students, except those 25 years of age or over, are required to reside in approved housing. This rule applies to married students whose husbands or wives do not accompany them to Athens on the same basis as to single students.

FRATERNITIES AND SORORITIES

Eighteen of the twenty social fraternities and eleven social soi'ori- ties maintain houses near the campus in which residence and dining facilities are available to members.

HOUSING FOR MARRIED STUDENTS

NOTE: The apartment and trailer park facilities are provided only for married students and their families.

APARTMENTS. The University has 112 apartment units located on East State Street, approximately two miles from The Green. Each of these apartments consists of a living room, bedroom, kitchen, and bath- room. Each has an abundance of closet space, and is equipped with a gas cooking range and a gas heating unit. Tenants must arrange to supply the additional needed articles. The rent is $39.00 a month, payable in advance. The rental charge includes all utilities.

Housing and Food Service 19

In addition, there are seventeen furnished (except refrigerator) two-room prefabricated units which accommodate a like number of families. The rent for each unit is $30.00 a month, payable in advance. The rental charge includes gas and water. Each family unit is compact, efficient, and quite livable.

Veterans are given preference in the assignment of these facilities.

TRAILER PARK. The University Trailer Park, which will accommo- date 36 privately-owned trailers, is located on East State Street, ad- jacent to the University Airport. Space rental for a trailer is $10.00 a month, which includes water and sewerage. Excellent toilet, bathing, and laundry facilities are provided for all trailer occupants. The rental charge does not cover electricity.

TRANSPORTATION. Convenient bus service is maintained by the University, on an hourly schedule when classes are in session, at no cost to the occupants of the East State Street area.

Further information about quarters for married students may be obtained from the Director of Housing, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio.

OTHER UNIVERSITY SERVICES

STUDENT HEALTH SERVICE

The Student Health Service facilities are to be found in the Health Center Building, which can be reached from East Union Street.

The Health Center includes a complete clinic with X-ray and minor surgery, an infirmary of forty beds with an isolation wing, a physio- therapy department and nurses' quarters. There is an auditorium where, by means of health films and lectures, an accent is placed upon preven- tive medicine and health education.

The Health Service maintains a continuous record of each student's health, beginning with the family physician's report which is required on admission. A tuberculin skin test is given each new student on ad- mission. All positive skin reactors are given a chest X-ray each year. All negative reactors are urged to be re-tested each year. This pro\ides a means of early detection and protection for the college community. The Director of the Health Service in this, as in all other respects, has authority to take steps to prevent the spread of communicable diseases and to maintain standards of sanitation on the campus.

The Health Service staff comprises four full-time doctors and nine registered nurses.

Students are entitled to the following:

1. Clinic. This ambulant or outpatient service is open from 8 a.m. to 5 p.m., except Saturdays when the hours are 10 a.m. to 12 noon. The Clinic is closed on Sundays and holidays.

20 Ohio University

2. Infirmary. This is the bed, or inpatient, service. Each student is entitled to infirmary care, subject to the judgment of the doctors. The daily visiting hour is from 2:30 to 3:30 p.m., and the number of visitors at any one time is limited to two per patient. During epidemics the visiting hour may be suspended.

3. Emergency Service. When the Clinic closes at 5 p.m. the main door is locked. Throughout the evening and night a nurse remains on duty, and a doctor is on call to care for emergencies. Admission can be gained by ambulance or car at the east entrance to the Health Center, or on foot at the west entrance where there is an illuminated night bell. This service is for emergencies only, and is not intended to be an ex- tension of the daytime Clinic.

The university physicians do not make outside calls except in ex- treme emergency, and then only when called by a housemother, student dean, or other responsible person. The accessibility of the Health Center to all parts of the campus is one of its conspicious features.

4. Consultations. Specialists in eye, ear, nose, throat, major sur- gery, and psychiatry are available in Athens, and consultations, obtained at the discretion of the Director, are at the expense of the Health Ser- vice. The student is responsible for any expense beyond first consul- tation. The Health Service does not assume any of the cost of glasses or dental care; students are expected to have these matters attended to at home. Likewise, major surgery is not provided for or paid for by the Health Service. The Health Center is not equipped to care for such cases, and they are therefore transferred to their homes or to the local (Athens) hospital. Students' families should carry hospital and medical insurance.

5. Diagnosis and Medicines. The Health Center is equipped with full diagnostic service, such as clinical laboratory, metabolism tester, and X-ray. No charge is made for any of these tests. Medicines are also dispensed without extra charge, except in certain chronic cases. Needless to say, the doctor must be the judge as to what tests and what medications are required in any given case.

ABSENCE CERTIFICATES, A student who has been treated in the clinic or infirmary will be given a signed statement to be presented to his individual professors. The Health Service has no responsibility to the student who absents himself from class on his own initiative. A student, therefore, who feels unwell is wise to report to the Health Center at the earliest opportunity.

VACCINATION. New students, whether freshmen or transfers, must present evidence of vaccination against smallpox within the past five years, before being admitted to Ohio University. A blank certificate giving detailed instruction is sent to each applicant for admission and must be returned to the Director of Admissions properly completed and signed. Tetanus toxoid is given to all entering students unless they have been previously immunized-

Other University Services 21

COUNSELING

EDUCATIONAL COUNSELING. Each student is assigned to a faculty counselor who is primarily concerned with the educational guidance of the student throughout his freshman year. The counselor assists with the selection of courses and follows the progress of each student in his studies. Because the faculty counselor is selected from the student's major field of interest, many students choose to continue with the same adviser for four yeai-s. In the degree college the student is assigned to or selects his adviser on the basis of his field of specialization or con- centration. Students are encouraged to consult freely with faculty ad-

GENERAL COUNSELING. General counseling is a special concern of the Dean of Men and the Dean of Women and their associates in their offices in McGuffey Hall. Through student activities and organizations and the housing program these persons are in close touch with student life. Problems as a normal part of educational development are often personal in nature; e.g., meeting financial needs, getting along with people, making vocational choices. The offices of the Dean of Men and Dean of Women provide students with resources for helping themselves when confronted with perplexities beyond their own immediate resources. The Dean of Men and the Dean of Women work in close relationship with all other services in the University which are concerned with the welfare of students.

TESTING AND VOCATIONAL COUNSELING. Tests for all new students are administered, scored and reported to the administrative officers and faculty counselors. Students, counselors, and advisers may secure the results of such tests by inquiring at the University Testing and Voca- tional Counseling Service.

Complete vocational counseling is available to interested students. Educational and vocational plans are developed on the basis of a survey of the abilities, interests, aptitudes and achievements, and also on the basis of the requirements for the occupations and their training pro- grams. A fee of $5 is charged to cover the costs of tests and test scoring. Application for this service may be made by contacting the staff of the Testing and Counseling Service.

SPEECH AND HEARING CLINIC

The School of Dramatic Art and Speech offers clinical services with- out charge to students with special problems in speech or hearing. Stu- dents wishing counseling or training should inquire at the office of the Speech and Hearing Clinic, Room 204, Speech Building.

VETERANS

Veterans who enter Ohio University should report to the Office of the Coordinator of Veterans Affairs, 29 South College Street. Stu- dents who expect to be enrolled under Public Law 634 (orphans of

22 Ohio University

deceased veterans) should also report to the Veterans Office as soon as possible after their arrival on campus. It is the desire of that office to be of all possible service to veterans and students enrolled in the University.

STUDENTS FROM FOREIGN COUNTRIES

Ohio University welcomes students from other countries who show promise of profiting from educational opportunities in this country, and it has prepared special information for the benefit of prospective stu- dents from outside the continental limits of the United States. This in- formation may be obtained by writing to the Director of Admissions, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio.

There is, furthermore, an Adviser to Foreign Students, whose in- terest in the problems of the foreign student is not limited to official matters. All such students are invited to consult him at the beginning of their period of residence and to call upon him at any time during their stay at the University. His office is located at 29 South College Street.

BUREAU OF APPOINTMENTS

The Bureau of Appointments, located in Cutler Hall, affords stu- dents, former students, and graduates of the University assistance in securing positions in such fields as teaching, business, and industry. There is no registration fee or charge for service while an applicant is enrolled as a student in the University or during his first year out of school. After the one-year period, a charge of $.2 a year is made for each year in which assistance is requested.

The Director of the Bureau of Appointments and the office personnel are available to counsel students relative to their vocational plans.

The Bureau maintains and promotes all possible connections with prospective employers for the benefit of persons seeking initial place- ment and for those looking toward advancement to better positions.

PUBLIC RELATIONS OFFICE

The University's Public Eelations Office, located in Cutler Hall, provides interesting and reliable information to prospective students and public school officers through personal interviews, literature, and correspondence; and arranges for the availability of university talent and services to high schools, civic groups and other organizations in order that good will toward the University may be furthered.

NEWS BUREAU

Supervised by the Director of Press Relations, the Ohio University News Bureau prepares stories, features, and pictures concerning all branches of the University, including intercollegiate athletics, and the activities and accomplishments of students and student groups, for publication in newspapers and magazines and for radio broadcasts. As-

Other University Services 23

sistance is given in writing material for various university publications and bulletins. Liaison is mantaned with other university and college publicity departments. Visiting members of the press and radio are in vited to make the News Bureau, located in Cutler Hall, their head- quarters when visiting Ohio University, and every aid is given in secur- ing data requested personally or by letter.

ALUMNI OFFICE

The Alumni Office, a central records office and service agency, lo- cated in Cutler Hall, is maintained jointly by Ohio University and the Ohio University Alumni Association. The work of the office is super- vised by the Alumni Secretary, who is the executive secretary of the alumni association.

The maintenance of biographical and address records of graduates and former students is a primary function of the office. The Ohio Alumnus, published monthly from October to June, is the official mag'a- zine of the alumni association and is mailed to all members paying the annual membership fee.

The Ohio University Alumni Association was organized June 22, 1859, to serve the mutual interests of the alumni and the University. Any person who has attended the University for at least one year is eligible for membership in it. The Association is governed by a Board of Directors representing the various geographic areas in the United States, the Alumni Clubs, the Alumni Council, the Class Secretaries Council, the Varsity Board Council, the University, and the Ohio Uni- versity Fund, Inc. The local groups, knovm as clubs, have been organized in cities, counties, and other geographical areas throughout the United States, where the number of graduates and former students is large enough to warrant or support a club.

OHIO UNIVERSITY FUND, INCORPORATED

The Ohio University Fund, Incorporated, a non-profit organization, was incorporated October 11, 1945, under the laws of the State of Ohio for the support of the educational undertakings of Ohio University. The corporation receives and holds in trust any property, real and personal, that is given, devised, bequeathed, given in trust or in any other way made over to the Corporation for the use or benefit of Ohio University, or of any student or professor, or any dependent thereof, for the purpose of carrying on at the university any line of work, teaching or investigation, which the donor, grantor, or testator may designate. The corporation invests and disburses all monies received, and manages, administers, and controls all property received according to the specifications established by the donors. General gifts are used for projects that cannot be financed by state appropriations, such as student aid, research, scholarships and awards, travel, library needs, intellectual and cultural life, special equipment, general needs, and the president's fund, and other uses as determined by the Board of Trustees.

The Fund is governed by a board of trustees of five members, chosen to give balanced representation from the Board of Trustees

24 Ohio University

of Ohio University, from the Administration of the University, and from the Ohio University Alumni Association.

Contributions should be made payable to the Ohio University Fund, Inc., and sent to the Director, Ohio University Fund, Inc., Cutler Hall, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio. The Director will be happy to answer inquiries relating to the purposes and management of the Fund.

STUDENT FINANCIAL AIDS

Ohio University attempts to assist students in furthering their edu- cation on the college level by providing three types of financial aid: scholarships, loans, and employment.

Unless otherwise indicated, persons desiring information concern- ing any of these types of aid or who submit applications for them should direct their communications to the Director of Student Financial Aids, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio.

SCHOLARSHIPS

ALUMNAE, ALUMNI AND MOTHERS CLUB SCHOLARSHIPS. Scholarships in varying amounts are awarded annually by Ohio University women's clubs in Akron, Dayton, and Youngstown, by Ohio University mother's clubs in Lakewood and Youngstown, and by various chapters of the Ohio University Alumni Association, to seniors graduating from high schools in the immediate areas of the organizations, or to students already en- rolled in the University from these areas.

A.A.U.W. SCHOLARSHIP. Through the generosity of the Athens Branch of the American Association of University Women an annual scholarship has been established that provides for the remission of the general registration fee for each semester and is available to a girl graduate from an Athens County high school on the basis of citizen- ship, leadership, and scholastic aptitude and promise.

ANCHOR HOCKING SCHOLARSHIPS. The Anchor Hocking Scholar- ships at Ohio University have been established by the directors of the Anchor Hocking Glass Corporation, Lancaster, Ohio, for the purpose of providing financial assistance to worthy young men and women who seek a college education. Those eligible to apply for these scholarships are seniors or graduates of all high schools in the communities and counties in which the corporation's plants and off'ices are located. These include Lancaster and Fairfield County, Ohio; Connellsville and Fayette County, Pennsylvania; Salem and Salem County, New Jersey; Winchester and Randolph County, Indiana, and Sales Offices of the Company. Gradua- tion from an accredited high school and a scholastic standing in the upper third of the graduating class are basic requirements.

Each scholarship has an annual monetary value of $250, with the possibility of annual renewals for a four-year period. The money is to be applied to registration fees and books. Renewals are based upon a thorough review of the recipient's scholastic accomplishments at the University.

Student Financial Aids 25

Candidates for the Anchor Hocking Scholarships submit applica- tions directly to the Scholarship Committee, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio, and the selection of candidates rests entirely with that body. Ap- plicants must meet established standards which include scholastic achievement, leadership, high moral character, financial need, and other qualifications which point to success in college and post-college life.

BEASLEY SCHOLARSHIPS. A grant of $1,000 from Mr. F. R. Beasley, Athens, Ohio, provides cash awards each semester to outstanding fresh- men on the basis of academic promise, citizenship, and personal qualities.

CHILLICOTHE EDUCATIONAL FOUNDATION. Six business establish- ments and industries, a fraternal organization, and an individual have made available eight endowed scholarships of $200 each for Chillicothe Branch students.

CLINTON POSTON BIDDLE MEMORIAL SCHOLARSHIPS. In 1939, Dr. T. R. Biddle, '91, and Mrs. Biddle, Athens, Ohio, gave $5,000 to the University for the purpose of establishing a loan fund in memory of their son, Clinton Poston Biddle, '17. This fund is now available for scholarships, without limitations as to academic class or scholastic standing.

COLUMBIA DOWNING SCHOLARSHIPS. Madeleine Downing Knight, Glynlea, South Jacksonville, Florida, has established a scholarship fund of $10,000 as a memorial to her father, Columbia Downing, who in the early sixties was a student at Ohio University. The income from the fund, $600 annually, is normally divided among several qualified stu- dents.

ROSE MARIE DARST SCHOLARSHIP. A bequest of $3,000 has been re- ceived from the estate of the late Mrs. Mary E. Darst to establish a memorial to her daughter. Rose Marie Darst, '26, a former assistant professor of art at Kansas State College. Income from the memorial fund is used to provide scholarships for "worthy students of high stand- ing in the Art Department."

RUTH AND ORAL DAUGHERTY SCHOLARSHIP. An endowment estab- lished through the generosity of Mr. and Mrs. Oral Daugherty of Nelson- ville, provides an annual income of $150 to be awarded a graduate of Nelsonville High School each year on the basis of scholastic aptitude and promise, qualities of citizenship, leadership, participation in school acti- vities and evidences of good character.

FORBES FUND SCHOLARSHIP GRANTS-IN-AID. An endowment of $8,000 provides $480 cash each year to assist with the cost of housing for girls who are working to help pay college expenses. Awards are based upon scholastic standing and need.

GALBREATH SCHOLARSHIPS. A grant of $1,000 from Mr. John W. Galbreath, '20, a member of the Board of Trustees of Ohio University, provides cash awards each semester to outstanding freshmen on the basis of academic promise, citizenship, and personal qualities.

26 Ohio University

GRADUATE SCHOLARSHIPS. Several University Scholarships are available to college graduates who have maintained a high scholastic average. These awards pay the basic registration (resident or non- resident) fee. Applications should be filed with the Director of Student Financial Aids by July 1.

McLaughlin scholarship, a scholarship has been established in memory of George E. McLaughlin, '14, former professor of industrial arts, by his daughter, Mrs. Helen McLaughlin Gray, '32. Income from a memorial fund of $1,500 is awarded annually to an outstanding stu- dent who is majoring in industrial arts and who is in need of financial asistance.

albert F. MARTING scholarships. One two-year scholarship is available each year to high school graduates who enroll in the Ports- mouth Branch of Ohio University. The value of the scholarship is $100 for each semester the student is enrolled up to a maximum of four se- mesters.

Final awards are made by an impartial committee of five members. Awards are based upon the following: (a) high school scholastic rec- ord; (b) score on a college ability test; (c) qualities of citizenship, leadership, and participation in school activities.

Applications, in writing, should be made not later than July 1 to The Marting Bros. Co., Portsmouth, Ohio.

OHIO ACADEMY OF SCIENCE SCHOLARSHIPS. Scholarships are available to winners in the Ohio Academy of Science Competition for high school seniors. Awards are based upon: (a) high school scholastic record, (b) superior academy exhibit rating, and (c) approved rating in the National Science Talent Search Test or in a science test given by the Ohio Academy of Science. These scholarships provide for remission of the general registration fee each semester.

OHIO UNIVERSITY SCHOLARSHIPS. A limited number of scholarships are awarded annually to a selected group of high school graduates and college students. Each scholarship is awarded for the academic year of two semesters, and provides for the remission of the general registration fee each semester. A faculty committee appointed by the president of the University awards all scholarships on or before July 1.

Freshman Scholarships are awarded to high school graduates who rank high in their graduating classes. Awards are also based upon need, character, recommendations, high school activities and results of the Ohio State Psychological Test.

Upper-Class Scholarships are available to students who have com- pleted at least two semesters in residence at Ohio University, and who are carrying a full academic load. Any student having a point-hour ratio of 3.0 (B) or who expects to attain it by the close of the second semester, may apply for a scholarship at any time after April 1 and prior to June 1. Awards are based upon scholastic achievement, need, and col- lege activities.

Student Financial Aids 27

H. WESTCOn ROACH SCHOLARSHIP. A scholarship has been estab- lished in the memory of H. Westcott Roach, '23, by his widow, Mrs. Helen Hedden Roach, '36. Income from a memorial fund of $2,500 is used to provide an annual scholarship for a student of outstanding ability who is majoring in music and who is in need of financial assistance.

SESQUICENTENNIAL SCHOLARSHIPS. As their contribution to the ob- servance of Ohio University's 150 years of educational leadership, the alumni and friends of the University have pledged in excess of $400,000 toward a Sesquicentennial Scholarship Fund. The money has been in- vested in the Irreducible Debt Fund of the State of Ohio. At least 80 annual scholarships, with a value of $150 each, have been established in perpetuity through these contributions. The names of the donors are being inscribed in a book appropriate for the purpose.

The Sesquicentennial Scholarships are awarded on the basis of scho- lastic achievement, character, need, and recommendations. It is hoped that the recipients of these awards may someday contribute to similar funds to help students who follow them in years to come.

SPECIAL MUSIC SCHOLARSHIPS. A limited number of scholarships are available to students having special ability and promise in applied music. These scholarships provide for remission of the general registra- tion fee each semester and for remission of the applied music fees.

PAUL AND BETH STOCKER SCHOLARSHIP. Through the generosity of Paul Stocker, '26, and Mrs. Beth Kilpatrick Stocker, '28, Lorain, Ohio, an endowment has been established which provides an annual income of $150 to be awarded a son or daughter of an employee of the Lorain Products Corporation. Applicants must meet the standard requirements established by the University Scholarships Committee.

HARRIET E. TENAN SCHOLARSHIP. The Harriet E. Tenan Scholar- ship is awarded to an entering freshman boy or girl from McConnels- ville, Ohio, who is recommended by the pastor of the McConnelsville Trinity Methodist Church and the editor of the Morgan County Herald. The annual award is made from the income from a gift to the University by the founder of the fund.

HENRY ZENNER SCHOLARSHIPS. The Henry Zenner Scholarships were established by the directors of The McBee Company, Athens, Ohio, for sons and daughters of persons in the employ of the company. How- ever, if eligible candidates are not found among sons and daughters, the scholarships will be made available to any qualified scholarship applicant at Ohio University selected by the Scholarships Committee.

High school graduates and upperclass students are eligible to apply for the Henry Zenner Scholarships provided they meet the University's established standards, which include scholastic achievement, leadership qualities, high moral character, seriousness of purpose, and financial need. Applications are submitted directly to the Scholarship Committee, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio, which has sole jurisdication in the award- ing of the scholarships.

28 Ohio University

Each scholarship provides for the payment of all fees, room rent, and an allowance of not to exceed $75 for books and supplies. It is awarded for one year, but is renewed automatically from year to year, provided the recipient continues to meet the University's standards for gradua- tion. The Henry Zenner alternate scholarships provide for the payment of all fees.

JAMES W. FAULKNER MEMORIAL FUND SCHOLARSHIP. An annual $250 scholarship for a worthy and needy student of journalism who is a resident of Ohio. Renewable year to year if a point-hour ratio of 2.5 is maintained. Established by the trustees of the Fund which was raised by friends of Mr. Faulkner, a pioneer among Ohio political writers and state house correspondents, after his death in 1923.

GENERAL SCHOLARSHIPS

AMERICAN BANKER'S ASSOCIATION SCHOLARSHIP. The American Banker's Association Foundation for Education in Economics allocates annually a $250 loan scholarship to the College of Commerce. This loan scholarship is awarded to a deserving student of senior rank or above whose major course is in banking, economics, or related subjects.

FULBRIGHT OR MARSHALL SCHOLARSHIPS. Students who are inter- ested in applying for Fulbright or Marshall Scholarships should consult Dr. B. A. Renkenberger, Chairman, Foreign Study Committee, Ohio Uni- versity, Athens, Ohio. Application blanks are available at the opening of the academic year each September. Only graduate students are eligible for these awards.

RHODES SCHOLARSHIPS. Men who have completed their sophomore year at Ohio University are eligible to compete for the Cecil Rhodes Scholarship, tenable for three years at Oxford University, England, with a stipend of $2,000 each year. These scholarships are awarded on the combined bases of character, scholarship, athletics, and leadership in collegiate activities. Persons desiring information or application blanks should direct their communications to Dr. Paul G. Krauss, Ohio Univer- sity, Athens, Ohio.

GRANTS-IN-AID

LIGHTER GRANTS-IN-AID. Through a gift of the Lichter Foundation of Cincinnati, ten grants-in-aid of $200 each are available each year to high school graduates in modest circumstances who desire an opportunity of working their way through college. Awarding of the grants will be based upon character, superior scholastic standing, recom- mendations, definite need, and personal interviews.

Applicants for these grants must be prepared to demonstrate their willingness to take employment as a means of helping to defray their expenses. The University will make available employment on the campus, or will give assistance in obtaining employment elsewhere.

Student Financial Aids 29

Should a successful applicant find that the grant-in-aid, his own earnings, and supplementary help from home sources are not sufficient to cover school expenses, he will have the privilege of borrowing from the Lichter-provided loan fund (see Loan Funds).

LOAN FUNDS

Certain general provisions apply to all loan funds unless otherwise noted. These provisions include the following:

1. Applicants must have a point-hour ratio of at least 2.0 (C).

2. Long-term loans bear an interest rate of four (4) per cent per annum.

3. For the most part, long-term loans are available only to upper- class students (juniors and seniors).

4. Inquiries and applications should be directed to the Director of Student Financial Aids, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio.

ALUMNI LOAN FUND. A number of alumni and friends of Ohio University have contributed over $8,000 for the purpose of furnishing loans to students pursuing four-year courses in the University. Loans may not exceed $200.

KELLOGG FOUNDATION LOAN FUND. The W. K. Kellogg Foundation of Battle Creek, Michigan, has granted the University the sum of $2,000 to be used as a loan fund for medical technology students during their year at Mount Carmel Hospital in Columbus. See "Medical Technology" under ZOOLOGY.

LIGHTER FOUNDATION LOAN FUND. In considering applications for assistance, primary consideration will be given to the student's scholastic record. However, account will also be taken of the applicant's evidences of need for financial assistance, of his good character, and of his gen- eral worthiness and professional promise.

To receive favorable consideration, an applicant must:

1. Be endorsed as to character and personality by (a) two per- sons of some standing in the community in which he has re- sided who have known the applicant at least five years, one of whom preferably should be an alumnus of the University; (b) the principal or headmaster of the high school or preparatory school, or the president or dean of the college or university pre- viously attended; (c) the registration officer or head of the college in which he is enrolled.

2. Be in good health, and furnish upon request a certificate from a physician to that effect.

3. Submit a statement of his financial needs and such other in- formation as the Foundation may deem necessary, on the appli- cation form of the Foundation, such application to have the approval of his parent or guardian.

30 Ohio University

4. Be prepared upon request to furnish such life insurance as collateral as may be required by the Foundation.

A recipient of a loan will be required to sign a promisory note for each sum received. The notes will begin to bear interest at the rate of 3% per annum, payable semi-annually, one year after graduation, or after leaving the University for other reasons. Should the applicant, for reasons satisfactory to the Foundation, postpone entering upon his earning career, he may apply for deferment of the date of the begin- ning of interest until one year after entering upon his earning career.

One year after leaving the University, and annually thereafter, the recipient of a loan will be required to consult with the Lichter Founda- tion for the purpose of establishing a program of payment of the notes commensurate with his earning capacity. He will be required, on these occasions, to inform the Foundation of his whereabouts, the character of the work in which he is engaged, and the remuneration he is receiving.

In general it will be the policy of the Foundation to make loans to students who have completed at least one year of residence in college with a good academic record. In exceptional cases, applications will be considered from a student after one semester of residence. Applications will be considered from students entering college in special cases, in which the applicant shall have met, with high standing, all entrance re- quirements and shall present references and records of previous attain- ments of the highest order.

HENRY STRONG EDUCATIONAL FOUNDATION LOAN FUND. Scholar- ship loans are granted to qualified upperclassmen under twenty-five years of age. Interest at 3% per annum begins to accrue at graduation or upon withdrawal from college, and repayment of the principal and interest is made during the four year period after graduation or with- drawal. Loans up to $600 for an academic year may be obtained by students who are superior risks as evidenced by scholarship, character, and future financial ability.

MEL WEINBERG MEMORIAL LOAN FUND. In memory of their son, Mr. and Mrs. Jerome M. Weinberg of New York City have contributed $500 for the establishment of this fund. Its purpose is to make available to juniors or seniors of demonstrable need small loans to be repaid within two years after graduation. The maximum sum to be loaned is $250.

G. FRANKLIN WHITE STUDENT LOAN FUND. This fund, of $2000, was provided by the will of the late Dr. G. Franklin White, '01. Preference is given to students preparing to teach and to pre-medical students. Preference, under the terms of the grant, is also given to residents of Ohio, although non-residents are not barred from applying for loans.

WOMEN'S LEAGUE LOAN AND SERVICE FUND. The Women's League of Ohio University maintains a loan and service fund for women stu- dents. A sum not to exceed $200 may be borrowed by a student who has spent at least one year on the campus. Collateral, or payment guaran- teed by a parent, is required.

Student Financial Aids 31

EMERGENCY LOAN FUNDS

ALPHA PHI OMEGA LOAN FUND. Delta Gamma Chapter of Alpha Phi Omega, national scouting service fraternity, has established a loan fund of $50. Scouts or former scouts may borrow up to $15 from this fund to meet financial emergencies. A service charge of 25 cents is made for a 30-day loan.

LAKEWOOD MOTHERS' CLUB LOAN FUND. The Ohio University Mothers' Club of Lakewood, Ohio, has given $100 to be used as an emer- gency loan fund for the benefit of students whose homes are in Lake- wood, Rocky River, Bay Village, or Fairview. Any amount up to $10 may be borrowed for one month's time without qualification except as to residence. A fee of 25 cents is charged for each loan.

MEN'S UNION EMERGENCY LOAN FUND. The Men's Union, which is the governing organization representing all men on the Ohio Uni- versity campus, has set up a loan fund with a principal amount of $1,200. Loans not exceeding $35 are made to men students to meet fi- nancial emergencies. Loans are not made for expenses which might reasonably be anticipated. A service charge of 40 cents is made for a 30-day loan.

WOMEN'S LEAGUE LOAN AND SERVICE FUND. The Women's League, in addition to their long-term loan, has set up a loan fund for women on the short-term basis. A maximum amount of $35 may be borrowed for 30 days with a service charge of 40 cents.

HEALTH SERVICE FUND

DELLA HIXSON HEALTH SERVICE FUND. Prompted by a deep interest in physical welfare, the late Mrs. Delia Connett Hixson, '97, Cambridge, Ohio, bequeathed a sum of money to the University, the annual interest on which, approximately $700, is to be used for the treatment and hos- pitalization of students who are financially unable to provide such service for themselves or whose families cannot defray these expenses. The fund, known as the Delia Hixson Health Service Fund, is administered by a committee composed of the Dean of Women (chairman), the Dean of Men, and the Director of the University Health Service.

PART-TIME EMPLOYMENT

Every effort is made to secure employment for those students whose resources are not adequate for entire self support and who request aid. The placements are both on and off campus, and fall into three general categories: (1) board jobs in various university dining halls; (2) part-time work as student assistants in university departments and offices; (3) part-time employment in Athens business establishments and homes. The job referrals are based upon: (1) cumulative grade aver- age, (2) need, (3) personal qualifications, (4) past experience, and (5) free time. For freshmen, high school records and recommendations are considered. All board job recipients must have a lung x-ray.

32 Ohio University

Provision is made for special class schedules in order to permit stu- dents to meet employers' needs. Adjustment of academic programs for employment will not be made for students having a point-hour ratio less than 2,0 (C), for students on academic warning, or for working beyond, a distance of 75 miles from Athens. Freshman students, in cases of es- sential need, are given every consideration for permits for schedule adjustment. Students applying for permits must present a letter from the employer, stating working hours, to the office of the Dean of Men or Dean of Women before consulting their adviser prior to registration for the semester.

Anyone wishing to apply for part-time employement may do so by writing directly to the Director of Student Financial Aids, Ohio Univer- sity, Athens, Ohio, or by contacting the director personally in McGuffey Hall.

PRIZES AND AWARDS

Announcement of the winners and presentation of the following prizes and awards are made at the Honors Day Convocation, usually held in April. The awards have been established, primarily, for the recognition of high scholastic achievement. Complete descriptions and other information relating to them may be obtained from the Chair- man, Committee on Scholarship Encouragement.

In the listing below, the name of the prize or award is followed, in parentheses, by the field in which it is given; a designation of those eligible for it; and by the name of the donor, if the latter is not in- dicated by the name of the award.

A. A. ATKINSON AWARDS. (Physics and electrical engineering.) Seniors. Established by the late Dean A. A. Atkinson, '91, of the College of Applied Science.

ALPHA DELTA PI SCHOLARSHIP PRIZE. (General scholarship.) Sopho- more girl.

ALPHA GAMMA DELTA SPEECH CORRECTION AWARD. (Speech cor- rection.) Senior major man or woman expecting to continue graduate work in the field.

ALPHA LAMBDA DELTA SENIOR AWARD AND HONOR CERTIFICATES. (General scholarship.) Senior rank and membership in awarding or- ganization.

ALPHA LAMBDA DELTA JUNIOR AWARD. (General scholarship.) Junior rank and membership in awarding organization.

AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF CHEMISTS SENIOR AWARD. (Chemistry.) Senior.

BORDEN FRESHMAN PRIZE. (General Scholarship.) Student with the highest scholastic average during his freshman year.

CHI OMEGA ECONOMICS PRIZE. (Economics.) All women.

:^ % %

^^jTi

m^^

A^

ILira jin

*■?«'

:i:^tete. ""''''^Ipji^

mmmir':^ f

<#^-<-

il T'K is SI

Tt

ir f 'if

<*i*'

^■''.

miJ

lir"' %■«§-¥

Prizes and Awards 33

CLEVELAND BOBCAT CLUB AWARD. (General scholarship.) Freshman boy.

DELTA PHI DELTA AWARDS. (Space arts and fine arts.) To a freshman in the former; to a senior in the latter.

DELTA SIGMA PI AWARD. (Commerce.) Male student who upon graduation ranks highest for entire course in commerce and business administration.

DICK DE LA HAVE HUGHES BAND AWARD. (Band.) Junior. Establish- ed by Mr. M. D. Hughes, '12, and Mrs. Hughes as a memorial to their son.

DOUGAN VARSITY BASEBALL AWARD. (Baseball.) Varsity player. Established by Dr. Stanley Dougan, '14, and Mrs. Nelle Stokes Dougan, '16.

EMERSON POEM PRIZE. (Original poetry.) Students or graduates of Ohio University. Established by Mr. W. D. Emerson, of the Class of 1833. Awarded biennially. Entries for the next competition must be in the hands of the President of the University before the opening of the second semester of 1958-59.

EVANS LATIN PRIZES. (Latin.) Students in the classical languages. Established by the Ohio University Alumni Association as a memorial to Dr. Dafydd J. Evans, '71, for many years professor of classical languages at Ohio University.

FRANCES McVICKER MAXWELL DEBATE AWARD. (Intercollegiate de- bate.) Junior or senior man or woman.

FRANK B. GULLUM AV/ARD. (General scholarship.) Male student with highest scholastic record during first two semesters at Ohio University. Established by Delta Tau Delta fraternity in honor of Frank B. Gullum, '07, associate professor emeritus of chemistry.

GEORGE LaVALLEE AWARD IN CHEMISTRY. (Chemistry.) Senior. Established by the Upper Ohio Valley Section of the American Chemical Society.

HORN SENIOR COMMERCE PRIZE. (Commerce.) Senior in Commerce with highest scholastic average in commerce subjects. Established by the late Mr. Clarence H. Horn, '01, former lecturer in commerce, and aug- mented as a memorial by his widow and son, Mrs. Sarah Murphy Horn, '00, and Robert H. Horn, '25.

INTER-DORMITORY COUNCIL AWARD. (General scholarship.) Sopho- more or junior woman residing in a university dormitory.

IRMA E. VOIGT MEMORIAL AWARD OF SIGMA KAPPA. (Dramatic art and speech.) Senior girl participating in dramatic productions or in a related technical field. Established by Sigma Kappa sorority as a me- morial to Dr. Irma E. Voigt, dean of women at Ohio University, 1913- 1953.

34 Ohio University

J-CLUB AWARD. (General scholarship.) Junior man.

JOHN BAYARD THOMAS PREMEDIC PRIZE. (Zoology.) Junior or senior premedical student who has gained admission to a medical school. Estab- lished by Dr. Josephus Tucker Ullum, '98, as a memorial to his nephew, and augmented in 1954 by three of Dr. Ullum's sisters, Mrs. Mary Ullum Thomas, '96, Mrs. Margaret Uilum Stalder, '05, and Mrs. Charlotte Ullum Coultrap, '08.

JOSHUA R. MORTON AWARD IN CHEMISTRY. (Chemistry.) Major in chemistry. Established by the Ohio University Chemistry Club in honor of J. R. Morton, '05, professor emeritus of chemistry.

JULIA J. NEHLS HOME ECONOMICS AWARD. (Home economics.) Junior girl majoring in home economics. Established by Kappa Delta sorority in honor of its adviser, Miss Nehls.

MEN'S UNION SCHOLARSHIP PRIZES. (General scholarship.) All men achieving a 4.0 scholastic standing in either of the two semesters pre- ceding the award; the fraternity pledge class and the East Green dormitory with highest scholastic averages for the Fall semester.

MERRILL PALMER SCHOLARSHIP AWARD. (Home Economics.) Pro- vides the privilege of studying for one semester at the Merrill Palmer School in Detroit, Michigan. Awarded to students who have shown high scholarship and aptitude and interest in Family Life Education.

OHIO UNIVERSITY FUND, INC., AWARDS. (Scholarship.) Seniors who show outstanding ability and willingness to undertake scholarly work independently and on own initiative.

PANHELLENIC SCHOLARSHIP AWARDS. (General scholarship.) So- rority with highest scholastic average for the preceding two semesters. Established by the Panhellenic Association.

PANHELLENIC FOREIGN STUDENT AWARD. (Scholarship and need.) Foreign woman student. Established by the Panhellenic Association.

PEARL HEHN GAMERTSFELDER PHILOSOPHY PRIZE. (Philosophy.) Junior who through high scholarship and campus citizenship shows promise for a career in philosophy or a closely related field.

PHI BETA KAPPA HUMANITIES AWARDS. (Classical languages and other humanities.) Juniors and seniors. Established by Dr. Anna Pearl McVay, '92.

PHI MU PLEDGE CLASS AWARD. (General scholarship.) Sorority pledge class having highest scholastic average for first semester of the year.

PHI UPSILON OMICRON AWARDS. (Home economics.) Sophomore woman and senior woman.

Prizes and Awards 35

SIGMA ALPHA IOTA MUSIC PRIZE. (General scholarship.) Sophomore woman with a major in music.

SIGMA ALPHA IOTA NATIONAL HONOR CERTIFICATE. ( General scholar- ship.) Senior woman, member of awarding organization, with the highest scholastic average.

SIGMA DELTA CHI SCHOLARSHIP AWARDS. (General scholarship and achievement.) Highest five per cent of seniors in journalism, and most outstanding senior man in journalism.

SINA SIDWELL ROGERS PRIZE IN FINE ARTS. (Art.) Junior or senior, member of De'^^a Phi Delta, national art fraternity. Established by Mrs. Elizabeth Sidwell Wagner as a memorial to her sister, Miss Sina Sidwell, '25.

SUPER GREEK PRIZES. (Greek language and classical culture.) Juniors and seniors. Established by friends and former students of Dr. Charles W. Super, fonner president of Ohio University and classical scholar.

THETA SIGMA PHI AWARDS. (Journalism.) Two most outstanding senior women in journalism.

THOMAS COOKE McCRACKEN KAPPA DELTA PI SCHOLARSHIP AWARD.

(Education.) Senior in Omega Chapter of Kappa Delta Pi or an alum- nus of the Chapter, or a Senior in the College of Education, expecting to pursue graduate study in teacher preparation. Recipient selected on bases of scholarship, personality and leadership qualities, and promise of high attainment in educational service. Established in honor of Dr. T. C. McCracken, dean emeritus of the College of Education, and for many years national president of Kappa Delta Pi.

VARSITY "O" SCHOLARSHIP AWARD. (Scholarship and citizenship.) Member of a varsity sports squad.

WOMAN'S MUSIC CLUB PRIZE. (Music.) A music major enrolled in the College of Education, the College of Fine Arts, or the College of Arts and Sciences. Established by the Woman's Music Club of Athens.

WOMEN'S INDEPENDENT ASSOCIATION AWARD. (General scholar- ship.) Upperclass woman.

WOMEN'S LEAGUE SCHOLARSHIP AWARDS. (General scholarship and need.) (1) Sophomore girl with highest two-consecutive-semester record, (2) women students with 4.0 scholastic average for second semester of year preceding the awarding or first semester of year in which award is made, (3) residence cottage for women with highest scholastic average.

ZETA TAU ALPHA PRIZE IN FINE ARTS. (General scholarship and mer- it.) Sophomore in College of Fine Arts.

36 Ohio University

CULTURAL OPPORTUNITIES

FOREIGN STUDY PROGRAMS

EXCHANGE PROGRAMS IN FRANCE AND SPAIN. Students interested in spending a year in France or Spain may have the opportunity to do so under the Exchange Program sponsored by the University and super- vised by the Department of Romance Languages. These students will follow an academic program in Paris or Madrid under the guidance of the French Ministry of Education or the Institute de Cultural Hispan- ica, and, upon presentation of a diploma granted for the work done, will receive credit for a year of work at Ohio University.

Any student may participate in this program who has the prepara- tion in language necessary to pursue the course work. However, lan- guage majors (particularly those who are preparing to teach) will be given preference where a choice is necessary. It is highly desirable that the student be in his junior year during his study abroad, although exceptions may be made in deserving cases.

Each student pays to the Office of the Treasurer the same fees that he would pay were he to be on the campus. The French or Spanish student pays the same fees (board, room, and tuition) in his own school. The two then exchange places.

Ordinarily the student will sail for Europe in mid-September. This will give him time to adapt himself to his surroundings and to become more fluent in the language before the opening of classes in early October. Classwork usually ends about the first of July. All arrange- ments for this program are made through the Director of Foreign Study, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio.

TRAVEL— STUDY PROGRAMS IN FRANCE AND SPAIN. Each summer Ohio University sponsors a program of travel and study in France and Spain. These projects are primarily intended for teachers of French and Spanish in high schools and colleges, but other interested persons may be accepted. Language qualifications must be met only where credit is desired.

The program consists of five weeks in and about Paris or Madrid, with the time divided between classwork and educational and recreational activities. The dates of the program are approximately the same as those of the Ohio University Summer Session.

Up to four hours of graduate or undergraduate credit may be earned in French or Spanish in two two-hour courses. The classwork is held in the mornings, leaving afternoons, evenings and weekends free for sightseeing, travel, and the theatre. The last week is free of classwork and students are at liberty to travel.

The groups will be under the guidance of one of the regular mem- bers of the Ohio University staff, and instruction will be given by native French or Spanish teachers. Those not wishing to earn credit will register as auditors.

Persons interested in this program should communicate with the Director of Foreign Study, Ohio University, for further details.

Cultural Opportunities 37

UNIVERSITY LIBRARY

Books are an important part of an educational experience at Ohio University. Tlie University Library is organized to provide books for study and research and to promote an appreciation for reading as one of the cultural assets of later life.

The collections are housed in the Edwin Watts Chubb Library, erected in 1930 and named in honor of a former dean of the College of Arts and Sciences. The main collection of more than 275,000 volumes, including periodical sets, documents, and pamphlets, is shelved chiefly in the stacks to which all students have direct access. A reference collection of several thousand volumes is in the Reading Room and current issues of more than 1,200 periodicals are in the adjoining Periodical Room. Newspapers from the principal cities of Ohio and elsewhere are available in the Philomathean Room nearby, which also contains a selection of standard literature.

Books reserved in courses at faculty request are on the ground floor. The Athenian Room serves as a history reading room; selected documents and maps are on display illustrating the history of the University and the state. Other special subject reading rooms will be developed as facilities permit. A browsing room contains books of general interest for pleasure reading. A collection of sound recordings is available for use in the Irvine Room and here is kept the library's collection of microfilm which includes files of newspapers printed in Athens from 1825. A microcard reader is also available here.

In the Children's and Young People's Room an extensive collection of books for younger readers provides service to the children of Athens and is used as a laboratory by students in education. Small collections of specialized material are administered by the College of Commerce, School of Music, Department of Chemistry, Department of Physics, and the University Health Center.

During regular sessions the Library is open daily and throughout the evenings; on weekends and during vacations shorter hours are ob- served.

GUEST ARTISTS AND SPEAKERS

In addition to bringing many distinguished persons to the campus for limited engagements, the University each year invites one or more guest artists to spend periods of time during which they not only lecture or appear in recitals but counsel informally with interested students.

Among the visitors who have recently been in residence for con- sultation and instruction are Dr. Ernst von Dohnanyi, composer, con- ductor, and pianist; Maurice Eisenberg, cellist; Charles Burchfield and Ben Shahn, artists; Marc Connelly, playwright; Charles Laughton and Blanche Yurka, of stage and screen; Jean Renoir, motion picture director; Clare Leighton, printmaker; and Charles Allen Smart, author of a best seller, "R.F.D.," and other novels.

Guest speakers have included men and women eminent in such fields as business, education, the fine arts, science, government, and foreign affairs.

38 Ohio University

SPECIAL CONCERT SERIES

The Athens Community Concert Association and the Athens Cham- ber Music Society each sponsor a concert series, bringing to the campus internationally-famous instrumentalists and vocalists, symphony orches- tras, opera and ballet companies, and chamber music groups. Special arrangements are made for the admission of students.

FINE ARTS PROJECTS

The College of Fine Arts plans many events of a cultural nature each year. In addition to the numerous concerts and plays which are presented by the students and faculties of the School of Dramatic Art and Speech and the School of Music, the two schools have cooperated in campus-wide production of "Roberta," "Girl Crazy," "Song of Norway," "No, No, Nanette," "Brigadoon," "Fledermaus," "Finian's Rainbow," "Kiss Me, Kate," "Knickerbocker Holiday," and "Oklahoma."

Since 1943, the School of Painting and Allied Arts has sponsored the Ohio Valley Oil and Water Color Show, a competition open to artists of Ohio, Illinois, Indiana, Kentucky, West Virginia and Pennsylvania. The University is building a permanent collection of paintings, many of which are purchased from this show.

The Ohio Valley Summer Theatre, sponsored by the School of Dra- matic Art and Speech, produces annually a series of six outstanding plays.

ART EXHIBITS

The School of Painting and Allied Arts maintains an art gallery in the Edwin Watts Chubb Library in which a program of exhibitions is conducted throughout the year. Other exhibitions are scheduled from time to time in other parts of the library and in the University Center.

UNIVERSITY MUSEUM

The University Museum of Natural History, oldest of its kind west of the Allegheny Mountains, houses more than 80,000 specimens, in- cluding specimens from Dr. S. P. Hildreth's famous collection of rocks and minerals dated 1815 and 1825.

Many science collections have gravitated to the museum through the efforts of local groups, societies and individuals. These have yielded series of fossils, rocks, minerals, plants and animals. In addition, there are on display many items of archaeological, ethnological, economic and historic interest.

The museum is housed in the basement of Alumni Memorial Audi- torium and is open to the general public Monday through Friday, 9 to 11 a.m.; Monday and Tuesday, 3 to 5 p.m.; Friday 1 to 3 p.m.; Sat- urday, 9 a.m. to 12 noon; and Sunday by special group request.

RECREATIONAL OPPORTUNITIES

THE UNIVERSITY CENTER

The University Center provides facilities for the cultural, social, and recreational benefit of students. The Center, located opposite the north gateway to the campus, contains three beautiful lounges, a large ballroom, dining rooms, cafeteria, snack bar, library and record listening room, television, conference rooms, student government and publications offices, and recreational areas for bowling, billiards, table tennis, and cards.

Club rooms for both men and women members of the university faculty are also located in this building.

The University Center is not only a place for fun and relaxation, but is also an educational workshop, where students can develop cultural interest, skills in human relations, and organizational efficiency during their out-of-class hours.

A faculty-student policy board controls the operation of the build- ing, and an all student board directs the large and varied program pro- vided by the Center for the benefit of the entire student body.

THE NATATORIUM

The Natatorium is one of the largest and most modern of such structures on any college campus. Conveniently located adjacent to the main campus, the building is featured by a pool, 42 feet wide by 75 feet long, with six standard 7 foot racing lanes and a rated capacity of 116 persons. The pool is equipped with submerged lighting, Olympic-style starting blocks, diving boards, and safety equipment.

The building contains locker rooms, dressing rooms, and spectator accommodations for about 1,000 persons.

The facilities of the Natatorium are available to students for both credit and recreational swimming.

GENERAL RECREATION

The Division of Physical Education and Athletics directs the intra- mural athletic program at Ohio University. This program includes com- petitive and physical recreational activities that are sponsored for men and women students.

Facilities at Ohio University for intramural athletics include a gymnasium for men, a gymasium for women, a natatorium, an ice skating rink, a game room in the University Center, and extensive outdoor recreational areas. The men's athletic fields are equipped to

39

40 Ohio University

handle ten softball games or seven touch-pass football games at one time. Women's athletic fields are available for intramural softball, hockey, archery, and soccer. Thirty-seven tennis courts are used inter- changeably for men's and women's programs. Outdoor areas for basket- ball, horseshoe pitching, bowling on the green, and volleyball are also available to men and women.

The indoor practice building houses an ice skating rink, 85 feet by 190 feet, the first such college facility in the state. From October to April there are classes in beginning and advanced skating skills, in ad- dition to recreational skating. Ice hockey is an intramural and inter- collegiate sport.

Plans are being completed for a $2,000,000 Physical Education and Athletic Plant, which will accommodate a diversified sports and activity program for men and women.

Intramural activities for men include touch football, basketball, track, golf, volleyball, handball, softball, tennis, badminton, bowling, horseshoes, wrestling, field days, soccer, hockey, swimming, and table tennis.

Intramural activities sponsored by the Women's Recreation Associa- tion include hockey, archery, tennis, bowling, basketball, soccer, softball, golf, and swimming.

The Division of Physical Education and Athletics directs the varsity sports program which consists of football, baseball, basketball, track, soccer, wrestling, cross country, tennis, swimming, golf, ice hockey, and riflery.

The Women's Recreation Association has a cabin in the wooded hills outside of Athens that is available to groups for outing activities.

A nine-hole, university-owned golf course, located adjacent to the campus, is available to the university community.

The University Center is, as its name suggests, truly a center of recreational, social, and educational activities within most attractive surroundings.

Dramatic productions by the University Theatre and the University Playshop are scheduled at frequent intervals for the enjoyment of stu- dents and members of the local community.

Numerous dances, both formal and informal, are held during the year.

The Dance Club, sponsored by the women's department of the Di- vision of Physical Education and Athletics, gives an annual dance con- cert which is a production of compositions in dance form.

The Dolphin Club, a women's aquatic group, presents an annual water show.

Student Activities and Organizations 41

Under the sponsorship of the Men's Independent Association, fea- ture movie productions are shown three nights each week in Memorial Auditorium.

Several of the local churches have social-religious programs that are designed for and enjoyed by large numbers of students.

Not many miles distant from Athens, and suitable as weekend diversions, are the attractions of four of the state's most scenic areas Dow Lake, just east of Athens; Lake Hope, in the heart of the Zaleski State Forest; the caves and gorges of the Hocking Park area; and Burr Oak Lake near Glouster, Ohio.

The 160 acre Dow Lake, within a 2,000 acre state park, will be used extensively by the university for outdoor education, group camping, aquatics, boating, and for research projects in conservation and natural resources.

STUDENT ACTIVITIES AND ORGANIZATIONS

SOCIAL POLICY

The students, faculty, and administrative officers of Ohio University and the community of Athens are united in their interest in maintaining a moral tone and a social pattern that is in keeping with good taste and acceptable social practice anywhere among educated people.

Ohio University has a long and interesting history. Succeeding generations of students who come to the University with varying back- grounds and social interests should enrich the traditions, social stand- ards, prestige, and reputation of the University. The University expects students to exercise discerning judgment and to be personally respon- sible for absorbing and complying with the social patterns of the uni- versity community.

The student body, faculty, and administrative officers, therefore, will employ any reasonable means to control moral indiscretions and social behavior which is in bad taste.

CAMPUS AFFAIRS COMMIHEE

The Campus Affairs Committee is the official executive committee of extracuri'icular life, recognized and authorized by the President. It corresponds to the academic executive board of which the President is chairman. The two personnel deans. Dean of Men and Dean of Women, are the administration's permanent representatives on the committee and serve as co-chairmen, alternating annually as presiding officer. In addi-

42 Ohio University

tion to the two personnel deans, four faculty members, two men and two women, are appointed for three-year terms by the President. The five student members are elected each year. All of the Campus Affairs Committee student members are on the committee by virtue of their positions; namely, the president and two vice presidents of the Student Council elected by the campus at large, and the presidents of the Women's League and the Men's Union.

The Campus Affairs Committee is held responsible by the President for extracurricular policies, for allocation of the non-athletic portion of the student activity fee, for final decisions relative to new organiza- tions on campus, for those activities growing out of student life which affect campus and public relationships, for the jurisdiction over rules and regulations in which both men and women are involved, and for any other matters which the President may refer to it.

STUDENT GOVERNMENT ASSOCIATIONS

THE STUDENT COUNCIL. The Student Council is an organization that includes among its purposes the fostering of a spirit of unity and loyalty to Ohio University and the coordination of all campus social and extra- curricular activities.

The Council is composed of the indicated officers or elected represen- tatives of the following organizations:

President of Student Council Interfraternity Council

Women's Vice President of East Green Council

Student Council Interdorm Council

Men's Vice President of Panhellenic Association

Student Council President of the Senior Class

Men's Union Governing Board President of the Junior Class

Women's League President of the Sophomore Class

Campus Religious Council President of the Freshman Class

The council operates under a constitution of its own which has been approved by the Campus Affairs Committee. It has the delegated authority, with the approval of the Campus Affairs Committee, to con- sider, promote, and put into effect projects which pertain to student activities and, particularly, to promote a balanced campus-wide social program.

THE WOMEN'S LEAGUE. The Women's League, the all-women's or- ganization, has an active membership of every regularly-enrolled woman student. The Women's League shares the Student Government Room in the Ohio University Center. The activities sponsored by the League consist of a Freshman Women's Party, receptions, teas. Co-ed Prom, and Leadership Conference. Each year the League awards a $25 cash

Student Activities and Organizations 43

prize to the woman with the highest scholastic average extending over two semesters. In addition, it grants a resident scholarship to one foreign student.

THE MEN'S UNION. The Men's Union is an organization to which every regularly-enrolled male student automatically belongs. The Men's Union sponsors the Registration Hop in September, the annual Men's Leaders' Banquet, and many other projects. Throughout the year the Men's Union also sponsors activities designed to be broad enough in scope to include the interests of every man on the campus. Each semester the Men's Union makes an award of a gold medal to the man with the highest scholastic standing as well as five cups for group achievement.

PUBLICATIONS

The Ohio University Post, the student newspaper, is published four times a week. The Athena, a yearbook published under student editor- ship, appears toward the latter part of the spring semester. The editorial and business offices for both publications are located in the Otiio Univer- sity Center.

Opportunities are provided for practical work in copy writing and editing, photography, salesmanship, accounting, and business, and edi- torial management. Students are encouraged to make application for the various positions on the publications staffs through the respective edi- tors and business managers.

There are also a number of salaried positions on both publications for qualified individuals. Applications for these positions are filed with the Dean of Men or the Dean of Women at certain announced times. The Campus Affairs Committee, in consultation with the faculty advisers, is responsible for the selection of salaried staff members and for the over- all management of the publications.

Sphere is the Ohio University literai-y magazine. Issued annually or semi-annually, it publishes student poetry, fiction, essays, and photog- raphy. It has a considerable campus circulation and is widely exchanged with student literary magazines from other schools. The magazine is managed by students and cooperating faculty members.

DRAMATIC AND FORENSIC ORGANIZATIONS

THE UNIVERSITY THEATRE. The University Theatre serves both the University and the community by promoting the cultural and entertain- ment values which the legitimate theatre provides through participation of audience and performers. Production details of the presentation of four plays annually are managed, under faculty supervision, by students enrolled in courses in the School of Dramatic Art and Speech. Casts are chosen at public tryouts open to all students. In addition to the regu- lar program of plays, a musical comedy is produced each year in cooper- ation with the School of Music and the Fine Arts Council.

44 Ohio University

THE UNIVERSITY PLAYSHOP. The University Playshop is a producing group comprised principally of student directors, actors, and technicians, who are enrolled in courses in the School of Dramatic Art and Speech. However, roles in Playship productions are open to all students in the University. Playshop produces the "Great Play" series. Each year two full-length plays are given as a part of a four-year cycle designed to be representative of each of eight periods in the history of drama from the classical Greek and Roman to the American Theatre of the early nineteen hundreds.

THEATRE WORKSHOP. The workshop is a producing organization de- signed especially for freshmen and sophomores who have an interest in theatre and a desire to participate actively in plays. It is open to all students. Bills of one-act plays and new scripts are presented from time to time during the academic year.

THE OHIO VALLEY SUMMER THEATRE. The summer theatre, a joint project of the University and the Community of Athens, produces six plays each season and provides an opportunity for some 20 to 30 selected students to work and study full time in the theatre. Faculty members and townspepole work together with students in all phases of production.

VARSITY INTERCOLLEGIATE DEBATE. Ohio University is an active member of the Ohio Intercollegiate Debate Association for men and for women. Numerous opportunities for participation are provided by an extensive program of local practice debates, together with frequent intercollegiate debates both in tournaments and before audiences.

FIRST-YEAR DEBATE. First-year debate is open to freshmen and to upperclassmen who have not had previous experience in intercollegiate debate. Discussion meetings and practice debates are held on the ques- tion and selected teams take part in an intercollegiate first-year debate tournament.

ORATORY CONTEST. Ohio University is an active member of three state oratory associations. In February the State Oratorical Contest for Men is held, followed in March by the State Oratorical Contest for Women, and in May by the State Peace Contest in v/hich men partici- pate.

INTERPRETATION CONTEST. Each year an average of four inter- pretation contests in poetry and prose are held for men and women. The State Interpretation Contest for women is held in connection with the State Oratorical Contest.

TELEVISION. Closed circuit television equipment is available for lab- oratory and experimental work. Students enrolled in television courses are given practical experience in camera operation and the techniques of direction and production.

Student Activities and Organizations 45

RADIO STATIONS WOUB-AM and WOUI-FM. Ohio University main- tains laboratory stations WOUB and WOUI. WOUB, the 100 watt AM station, broadcasts on 1340 kc and has a range of approximately 30 miles. It broadcasts 16 hours a day, every day of the year. The Uni- versity stations are non-commercial and educational. They provide radio students with practical experience in all aspects of broadcasting. Most of the responsibility for the operation of the stations and the preparation and production of the progi'ams is in the hands of advanced students who work under close faculty supervision. In addition to the regular schedule, special events such as football games, lectures, and musical programs are broadcast through remote facilities of the stations. Many of the programs are beamed specifically to the citizens of Athens and the county, and are designed to acquaint them with the activities carried on in the entire University.

MUSIC ORGANIZATIONS

Membership, with or without academic credit, is open to all qualified men and women of the various schools and colleges of the University.

THE UNIVERSITY CHORUS. A large chorus of mixed voices which performs works from the standard choral repertoire. The Concert Choir, an organization of 30 singers, is selected from the membership of the University Chorus.

THE UNIVERSITY MEN'S GLEE CLUB. Among the activities of the club are several concerts each year on the campus and participation in vari- ous traditional events. Occasional tours and radio broadcasts are sched- uled.

THE UNIVERSITY WOMEN'S GLEE CLUB. The club is well known for the quality of its work and its activities on the campus. It gives several programs on the campus and occasional trips are taken in the spring.

THE UNIVERSITY BANDS. The University Bands are composed of three musical organizations the Symphonic Band, which maintains a well- balanced instrumentation of selected musicians; the Varsity Band, which serves as a recreational-laboratory group; and the football Marching Band, which is composed of all members of the Symphonic Band in addi- tion to selected players from the Varsity Band.

THE UNIVERSITY SYMPHONY ORCHESTRA. At present the orchestra has a complete, well-balanced instrumentation of seventy. Several con- certs, using the standard symphonic repertoire, are given on the campus during the year and trips to near-by cities are occasionally made. Mem- bership, either with credit or as an extracurricular activity, is open to all qualified men and women of the various schools and colleges of the University.

46 Ohio IjNrv'ERSiTY

RELIGIOUS ORGANIZATIONS

YWCA. The Y.W.C.A. is the campus religious organization for women. Its program includes social service activities in the Children's Home, State Hospital for the Insane, mining centers in Athens County, and with children at the Salvation Army. A Newcomers Party for Freshmen women, regular monthly meetings and social functions are also a part of the program.

Under the direction of the Y.W.C.A. the pledges of the Greek-letter sororities participate in an annual original theatrical production which is known as "The Prep Follies." The income from the production is used in support of the Y.W.C.A. program.

YMCA. The Y.M.C.A. provides an all-campus religious activity for men. It includes a broad program of religious, social, and service functions. Discussion sessions, personal counseling, and worship services are integral parts of the Y.M.C.A. schedule.

The religious welfare and interests of students are fostered by various organizations sponsored by the churches of Athens or church- affiliated groups. See "Religious Societies" below.

CAMPUS RELIGIOUS COUNCIL. Representatives of the religious or- ganizations constitute the Campus Religious Council. This council serves as a coordinating agency for the programs of the various groups listed, and initiates programs of an interfaith nature upon the campus. The council is composed of the adult advisers and two student representa- tives from each group.

RELIGIOUS SOCIETIES

These organizations are sponsored by Athens churches or church- affiliated groups. All are social as well as religious in character and activities. Baptist-Disciple Student Fellowship (Northern Baptist-Disciple men

and women) Baptist Student Union (men and women) Canterbury Club (Episcopal men and women) Christian Science Club (men and women) Hillel Foundation (Jewish men and women) .

Intervarsity Christian Fellowship (non-sectarian, men and women) Kappa Phi (Methodist women) Lutheran Student Association (men and women) Newman Club (Catholic men and women)

Orthodox Christian Fellowship (Orthodox Christian men and women) Phi Chi Delta (Presbyterian women) Sigma Theta Epsilon (Methodist men) Wesley Foundation (Methodist men and women) Wesley Pla^yers (Methodist men and women) Westminster Foundation (Presbyterian men and women)

SCHOLASTIC AND SOCIAL ORGANIZATIONS

HONOR SOCIETIES

These organizations confer metuhersliij) in recognition of high scholastic attainment and the fulfillment of other constitutional re- quirements. Sovie of the societies recognize and encourage the develop- ment of a ivell-rounded personality and leadership and service qualities in addition to academic achievement.

The first date is the founding date; the second the do.te the Ohio University chapter was established. Organizations are listed in the order of establishment at Ohio University.

Tau Kappa Alpha. 1908; 1916. Forensics (men and women). Phi Upsilon Omicron. 1909; 1921. Home Economics (women). Kappa Delta Pl 1911; 1923. Education (men and women). Phi Beta Kappa. 1776; 1929. Liberal Arts (men and women). Kappa Tau Alpha. 1910; 1929. Journalism (men and women). Epsilon Pi Tau. 1929; 1934. Industrial Arts Education. Phi Eta Sigma. 1923; 1936. Freshman Scholarship (men). MoPvTAR Board. 1918; 1938. Student Leadership and Service (senior

women). Alpha Lambda Delta. 1924; 1941. Freshman Scholarship (women). Beta Gamma Sigma. 1913; 1951. Commerce (men and women). Omicron Delta Kappa. 1914; 1951. Student Leadership and Service

(men). Tau Beta Pi. 1885; 1953. Engineering (men).

Phi Kappa Phl 1897; 1956. All Academic Fields (men and women). Pi Gamma Mu. 1924; 1956. Social Science (men and women).

NATIONAL PROFESSIONAL, RECOGNITION, OR DEPARTMENT SOCIETIES

These organizations confer membership in recognition of achieve- ments in specific fields of education or service.

Accounting (men and women) Beta Alpha Psi

Art (men and women) Delta Phi Delta

Band (men and women) Kappa Kappa Psi

Band (women) Tau Beta Sigma

Campus Service (men) Alpha Phi Omega

Campus Service (men) Circle K

Campus Leadership (women) Chimes

Campus Leadership (men) J Club

Classical Languages (men and women) Eta Sigma Phi

Commerce (men) Delta Sigma Pi

Dramatics (men and women) National Collegiate Players

Education Ohio Student Education Assoclation

47

48

Ohio University

Education (graduate men) Phi Delta Kappa

Engineering (men) American Society of Civil Engineers

Engineering (men) American Institute of Electrical Engineers

Engineering (men) American Society of Mechanical Engineers

Engineering (men) Ohio Society of Professional Engineers

History (men and women) Phi Alpha Theta

Journalism (women) Theta Sigma Phi

Journalism (men) Sigma Delta Chi

Management Society for the Advancement of Management

Military (men) Arnold Air Society

Military (men) Pershing Rifles

Military (men) Scabbard and Blade

Music (v/omen) Sigma Alpha Iota

Music (men) Phi Mu Alpha

Music (men and women) Music Education Conference

Photography (men and women) Kappa Alpha Mu

Physics (men) American Institute of Physics

Psychology (men and women) Psi Chi

Radio American Institute of Radio Engineers

Sociology (men and women) Alpha Kappa Delta

Speech (men and women) Speech Correction Club

Student Activities (men) Blue Key

SPECIAL INTEREST SOCIETIES

Departmental and other organizations that are not affiliated with national groups.

Alliance Franciase (French) Alpha Omega Upsilon Architectural Society Camera Club Chemical Society Childhood Education Club Chi Psi Omega (Botany-Zoology) Chi Rho Beta (Radio) Der Deutsche Verein (German) Dolphin Club (Swimming) Earth Science Club Finnettes (Swimming) Flying "O" (Sports) FooTLiGHTERS (Dramatics) Graduate Club Green and White Chess Club Home Economics Club Industrial Arts Club International Club International Forum Judo Club

Klub Siella (Medical Technology)

La Tertulia

Metropolitan Club of Ohio U.

O. U. Band

0. U. Radio Club

O. U. Republican Club

O. U. Table Tennis Club

Orchesis (Dance)

Rifle Club

Russian Language Club

Sabre Air Command

Secretarial Club

Sociology Club

Spanish Club

Student Press Club

Symphony Orchestra

Varsity "0" (Sports)

Veterans Club of Ohio U.

Women's Recreation Association

Women's Tennis Club

Young Democratic Club

Scholastic and Social Organizations 49

SOCIAL FRATERNITIES

These self -perpetuating groups organize the social life of their members as a contributing factor to their educational program,. Member- ship is upon invitation only.

INTERFRATERNITY COUNCIL (MEN)*

Beta Theta Pi (1839) f— Beta Kappa Chapter, 1841 Delta Tau Delta (1859)— Beta Chapter, 1862 Phi Delta Theta (1848)— Ohio Gamma Chapter, 1868 Phi Kappa Tau (1906)— Beta Chapter, 1909

Lambda Chi Alpha (1909) Alpha Omega Chapter, 1918 (inactive 1937-1950)

Theta Chi (1856)— Alpha Tau Chapter, 1925

Tau Kappa Epsilon (1899)— Alpha Beta Chapter, 1927

Phi Kappa (1889)— Psi Chapter, 1929

Pi Kappa Alpha (1868) Gamma Omicron Chapter, 1930

Phi Epsilon Pi (1904)— Alpha Rho Chapter, 1933

Phi Sigma Delta (1910)— Alpha Delta Chapter, 1948

Acacia (1904)— Ohio Trowel Chapter, 1949

Sigma Chi (1855)— Delta Pi Chapter, 1949

Alpha Phi Alpha (1906)— Phi Chapter, 1950

Sigma Nu (1869)— Zeta Mu, 1951

Sigma Alpha Epsilon (1856) Ohio Gamma Chapter, 1953

Phi Kappa Sigma (1850)— Beta Zeta Chapter, 1953

Delta Upsilon (1834)— Ohio Chapter, 1955

Tau Gamma Delta Local, 1957

Chi Kappa Nu Local, 1957

PANHELLENIC ASSOCIATION (WOMEN)*

Pi Beta Phi (1867)t— Ohio Alpha Chapter, 1889 Alpha Gamma Delta (1904) Zeta Chapter, 1908 Alpha Xi Delta (1893)— Pi Chapter, 1911 Chi Omega (1895)— Tau Alpha Chapter, 1913 Alpha Delta Pi (1851)— Xi Chapter, 1914 Zeta Tau Alpha (1898)— Alpha Pi Chapter, 1922 Phi Mu (1852)— Delta Delta Chapter, 1927 Sigma Kappa (1874) Beta Upsilon Chapter, 1949 Alpha Epsilon Phi (1909)— Alpha Phi Chapter, 1951 Kappa Delta (1897) Gamma Eta Chapter, 1955 Theta Phi Alpha (1912)— Delta Chapter, 1957 Kappa Alpha Alpha (local), 1955

•Listed in order of establishment at Ohio University. tYear of founding of national organization.

50

Ohio University

INDEPENDENT GROUP

This organization is for students who are not affiliated with Greek- letter social groups. Men's Independent Association, 1938

STUDENT GOVERNMENT ASSOCIATIONS AND CLASS ORGANIZATIONS

Biddle Hall House Council

Boyd Hall House Council

Bryan Hall House Council

Bush Hall House Council

Campus Affairs Committee

Class, Senior

Class, Junior

Class, Sophomore

Class, Freshman

East Green Inter-Dorm Council

Gamertsfelder Hall House

Council Howard Hall House Council Inter-Dormitory Council Interfraternity Council Jefferson Hall House Council Johnson Hall House Council

Junior Panhellenic Association Lindley Hall House

Organization Men's Union Governing Board 0. U. Center Dormitory Council 0. U. Center Program Board Panhellenic Association Perkins Hall House Council Read Hall House Council Scott Quad Council Shively Hall House Council Student Council Tiffin Hall House Council Voigt Hall House Organization Washington Hall House Council Women's League Assembly Women's League Senate

UNIVERSITY REGULATIONS

Admissions

Fees

Expense Estimate

Registration

Scholarship

Grade Reports

Honors

Probation

Transcripts

Attendance and Absences

Graduation

UNIVERSITY REGULATIONS

ADMISSIONS

GENERAL ADMISSION INFORMATION. All correspondence pertaining to the admission of a student to the University should be addressed to the Director of Admissions and University Examiner, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio.

Students are accepted for admission to the University for the fall semester, the second semester wMch begins in February, and the sum- mer sessions.

Application for admission consists of the presentation of an appli- cation blank filled in by the applicant, official transcripts of all high school or college credit, two small photographs of the applicant, a vacci- nation blank certified by a physician, and a medical history blank filled in by the applicant and completed by a physician. These documents when submitted become the permanent property of the University and are never returned to the applicant.

The application blank for admission and the transcript of high school record may be sent in any time after the completion of the junior year and the applicant then will be given provisional acceptance or denial. Final admission is granted upon satisfactory completion of the secondary school course.

If the applicant is transferring from another university, he must request the registrar of that university to forward an off'icial transcript of college record direct to the Director of Admissions, Ohio University.

It is important to get all entrance credentials to the Director of Admissions early enough so that the applicant can be informed concern- ing his admission and the opening of the session he wishes to enter. If accepted, the applicant will be forwarded information which he will need for registration at the University. For the fall semester, appli- cations are usually not accepted after September 1 and for the second semester, after January 10.

SUBJECTS IN HIGH SCHOOL. Because Ohio University accepts gradu- ates of first-grade high schools in Ohio, no particular pattern of high school subjects is required for admission. Hov/ever, since prospective students frequently ask what subjects they should take in high school, the following is suggested as a reasonable minimum distribution. This distribution meets the specific University College requirements (see page 76) and prepares the student for the pursuit of any curriculiim in the University:

English 3 or 4 units

Foreign language 2 units

52

University Regulations 53

Social sciences 2 units

(One of which should be United States history and civics.)

Laboratory sciences 2 units

(Biology, botany, zoology, chemistry, or physics pre- ferred. General science and senior science do not meet University College requirements. Prospective engineering students should take chemistry and physics.)

Algebra 1 unit

Plane geometry 1 unit

(Prospective engineering students should take ad- vanced algebra, solid geometry and trigonometry.)

Electlves 4 or 5 units

Total 16 units

THE TESTING PROGRAM. Each new student is required to take the college ability test. A notice of the date, place and hour is included in his admission credentials. A student who fails to take the college ability test at the appointed time, or who applies too late to take the test at the appointed time is required to take the test at a later date and to pay an aaditional fee of $2, A student transferring to Ohio University from another college is not required to take the test if he has had the Ohio State Psychological Examination or American Council Examination at that college and the record of the test is on the transcript from the college.

In addition to the college ability test, an English placement test, a reading examination and a mathematics achievement test are adminis- tered to all freshmen. Additional information regarding the testing pro- grams is given under the heading "Testing and Vocational Counseling Service," page 21, and "University College," page 76.

RESIDENTS AND NONRESIDENTS OF OHIO. The scholastic require- ments for admission and the general registration fee for non-residents of the State of Ohio are higher than for residents of the State.

1. No student shall be considered eligible to register in the Univer- sity as a resident of the State of Ohio unless he has had bona fide domicile in the state twelve consecutive months before he registers at the University. There is a strong presumption that one who comes into the state to attend college has a temporary residence, not a domicile.

2. No student whose domicile was outside the State of Ohio in the year preceding his original enrollment in the University shall be considered a resident unless it can be clearly established by him that his former domicile has been abandoned and a new domicile

54 Ohio University

established in the State of Ohio and maintained for at least twelve consecutive months. No application for residence of one whose legal residence is not determined by his parents or legal guardian can be considered until the applicant is 22 years of age.

3. No student whose domicile was outside the State of Ohio at any time after his original enrollment in the University shall be con- sidered a resident unless he has established his domicile as stated in paragraph 2,

4. Minors: The domicile of a student who is a minor shall be con- sidered the same as that of his parents or legal guardian, if any, regardless of emancipation. If an Ohio resident is appointed guardian of a nonresident minor, the latter shall be considered a nonresident until twelve months after the appointment.

5. Wives : A wife shall be classed as a resident student for registra- tion purposes if her husband has had a bona fide residence in the State of Ohio for a period of at least twelve months preceding her registration and is a resident of the state at the time of her reg- istration.

6. Losing Ohio Classification: A student, who at time of entrance is classified as an Ohio resident, loses his Ohio classification if his legal residence is changed to another state, but not until one year has elapsed.

APPLICANTS FROM OHIO (High School Graduates). All residents of Ohio who are graduates of approved high schools and who have not attended another college are eligible for admission to the University. An applicant, however, who ranks in the lower half of his graduating class and, in addition, has a low expectancy of success in college, will be admitted on special warning. This status for the low-in-class gradu- ate will be determined on the basis of freshman test scores, pattern of high school subjects, and high school recommendations. The decision as to the special warning status will be made during the pre-college counseling program held in midsummer which every applicant gradu- ating in the lower half of his high school class must attend. Many students required to participate in the pre-college counseling program will avoid the special warning status by means of satisfactory test scores. If, for an acceptable reason, a student does not attend the pre-college conference, it is necessary for him to complete the tests by individual appointment. Completion of the tests at an authorized time is required for admission and enrollment.

For further statements relative to students admitted on special warning, see page 79.

In the case of a veteran of military service, Ohio University recognizes a diploma issued by an accredited Ohio high school on the basis of the General Educational Development Tests. The applicant,

University Regulations 55

however, may be accepted only for a two-year terminal program if his test scores are low.

APPLICANTS FROM OHIO (Transfer Students.) Any applicant, a resident of Ohio, who has attended another college and who desires to transfer to Ohio University is considered for admission if he has a point-hour ratio of 2.0 (C) on all hours attempted, and if he is eligible for good standing at Ohio University.

APPLICANTS FROM OUT OF THE STATE. An application from an out- of-state student is considered if the applicant ranks in the upper half of his graduating class in an approved high school.

A veteran who ranks above the 50 centile on the General Educa- tional Development Tests (High School Level) may be considered for admission.

A transfer student from out of the state who makes application for admission to any college of the University is considered for admission if he has a point-hour ratio of 2.0 (on the Ohio University grade-point system) on all hours attempted in all of his previous college work, and if he is eligible for good standing at Ohio University.

APPLICANTS FROM FOREIGN COUNTRIES. An applicant from a foreign country makes application for admission on a special foreign student application blank. This application form is obtained by writing to the Director of Admissions, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio. If the ap- plicant has need for scholarship aid he so indicates on the application form.

No application will be considered until complete official credentials from all secondary schools, colleges, universities, normal schools, or tech- nical schools attended have been received. These should indicate the degree or diploma received, if any, all subjects studied, and grades, marks, or standing achieved in examinations. If original documents are issued in native language, the original documents or certified copies thereof shall be accompanied by official translations in the English language. Three letters of recommendation should be submitted, includ- ing one from an administrative officer of the last educational institution attended and one from a teacher.

English Certification. The application should be accompanied by an English certification signed by a professor of English, cultural relations attache, a diplomatic or consular official of the United States, or a dele- gated representative of one of these persons, certifying that the ap- plicant speaks English fluently and understands English sufficiently well to profit by study in a university in which English is used exclusively. It is essential that a foreign student be able to understand directions and lectures in English and express his thoughts clearly in spoken English immediately upon arrival at the University. Ohio University

50 Ohio University

reserves the right to require the taking of an English language pro- ficiency test under the auspices of such an agency as the English Language Institute of the University of Michigan, Ann Arbor, Michigan, or the American-Korean Foundation which has offices in New York City and Seoul.

Health Certification. A statement signed by a licensed physician certifying as to the general state of the student's health and a smallpox vaccination certificate should be submitted along with the application for admission. The medical forms are provided by Ohio University and must indicate that the applicant is:

1. Free from contagious or communicable disease.

2. Able physically and mentally to perform satisfactorily as a full- time student.

3. Sufficiently stable, emotionally, to make adjustment to an Ameri- can university environment.

4. Vaccinated against smallpox.

GRADUATE STUDENTS. For admission to the Graduate College, see page 160.

TRANSFER FROM ANOTHER GRADUATE COLLEGE. An applicant for admission to the Graduate College of Ohio University who has attended a graduate college elsewhere must have a point-hour ratio of 3.0 (B) on all graduate course? attempted. For acceptance of credits see catalog page 162 under "Credit and Residence."

SPECIAL STUDENTS. A person who has completed a minimum of 15 units of high school work and is not planning to work toward a degree or diploma at Ohio University, or a mature person (ordinarily 21 years of age or over) not planning to work toward a degree or diploma, may be accepted as a Special Student. Such a person must file an application for admission to the University and clear through the Admissions Office. He is permitted to carry a full class load and may take any course for which he is qualified.

A person may register as a Special Part-Time Student for a maxi- mum of six semester hours of work a semester without clearing through the Admissions Office. Such a student, however, is not permitted to retain this special status after he has accumulated 32 semester hours of credit at Ohio University or its Branches; or is within 32 semester hours of having sufficient credit for a degree or diploma. A student

University Regulations 57

who has attended another college or university must be eligible for good standing at Ohio University.

ADVANCED STANDING EXAMINATIONS. Application for an advanced

standing examination is made with the Director of Admissions and Uni- versity Examiner for any course listed in the current catalog in which the student desires credit witl'out taking the course in class, provided the course lends itself to an examination. An advanced standing exam- ination may not be taken to alter a passing grade at Ohio University. The application must be approved by the chairman of the department and the dean of the college in which the student is classified. Only a student who is enrolled for a minimum of six semester hours as a resi- dent student of Ohio University is eligible to make application. A fee of $5 is charged for each semester hour.

Credit for the course is granted when a student receives at least a C grade and has completed at least 15 semester hours of credit at Ohio University with a point-hour ratio of 2.0. If a student who has not completed 15 semester hours is granted permission to take an examin- ation for advanced standing, the credit is withheld until he has earned the required amount.

Any grade received on the examination for advanced standing be- comes a part of the student's academic record and is used to compute the point-hour ratio.

CREDIT EARNED DURING MILITARY SERVICE. A student in military service may receive college credit for college courses completed through the United States Armed Forces Institute when end-of-the-course exam- inations are passed or when courses are taken in correspondence with accredited colleges.

For training completed by veterans in training units other than those offered in the colleges, the recommendations made for college credit by the American Council on Education are followed in most cases.

A student who has covered the subject matter in certain fields (for example: mathematics, physics, meteorology) during his training period may receive credit in the courses by presenting evidence of having had the courses and by passing satisfactory examinations in the subjects.

CREDIT FOR MILITARY SERVICE. A maximum of 8 semester hours of college credit for basic military training, or 16 semester hours for officer's training with commission will be awarded to a student who, after completing his military service, enrolls in the University. This credit is granted when the student presents a certified copy of his separation papers showing honorable discharge and a minimum of six months of service. A deduction in the amount of credit allowed is made for those students who received high school credit for military service or who have had R.O.T.C. credit in college.

58 Ohio University

FEES

Official enrollment is completed when all fees have been paid. Fees are payable at the Cashier's Office at registration time. Checks and money orders should be drawn in favor of Ohio University in the exact amount of the fees. If paid by mail, by the parents, they should be sent to the student in whose name the account is carried. It is important that the student retain his receipt for it mnst be presented at the time the activity card is issued.

Payment of fees is a prerequisite to official enrollment, and all students should have sufficient funds to cover these expenses. Postdated checks will not be accepted. Checks issued to the University and not paid on presentation to the bank, will automatically cancel any receipts given and result in the assessment of penalties.

Ohio University reserves the right to make, without prior notice, any fee adjustments that may become necessary before the appearance of the next catalog.

REGISTRATION FEES Resident Non-

The Semester: of Ohio Resident

Comprehensive fee for load of 12 to 18 hours,

inclusive $115.00 $240.00

Includes the general registration fee of $75.00,

the student activity fee, student service fees

such as health, library, and testing, and course

and laboratory fees. Excludes fees for private

instruction as in music and bowling, which

are listed in the course descriptions. Extra fee for each semester hour in excess of

18 hours 8.00 20.00

Fee for each hour for load of 7 to 11 hours,

inclusive 10.00 20.00

Fee for each hour for load of 1 to 6 hours,

inclusive 8.00 20.00

The fee for 1 to 6 hours does not carry with it

the privilege of a student activity card or the

use of the Health Service. Auditors pay fees in full as above.

The Summer Session:

Fees for each term are proportionate amounts of the semester fees. See Summer Session bul- letin for details.

Correspondence Study:

Registration for each semester hour 9.00 10.00

Extension Class:

Registration fee, each semester hour 10.00 22.00

Fee is increased if class is organized with an enrollment below the required quota.

University Regulations 59

MISCELLANEOUS FEES

Certificate of completion $ 2.50

Change of course or change of college 2.00

Entrance Tests, when not taken at the designated time 2.00

Duplicate official forms, fee receipts, grade report, etc 1.00

Examination for advanced standing, each semester hour 5.00

Graduation

Application for degree 10.00

Application for Associate in Arts diploma 5.00

Re-application 2.00

Penalty for late application 5.00

Diploma mailing fee for those absent from commencement 2.00 Late registration or late payment of fees $3.00 Minimum,

$10.00 Maximum 3.00-10.00

R.O.T.C. Deposit Fee 20.00

Dissertation Microfilming 25.00

Thesis Editing and Abstract Printing 5.00

Dissertation or Thesis Binding, Each copy 2.50

Transcript of record, after first transcript request 1.00

Group requests of five to ten copies, $5.00; five to twenty copies, $10.00

Vocational Counseling Fee for students and prospective students 5.00

REFUND OF FEES. Voluntary and official withdrawal from the Uni- versity entitles the student to a refund of 80% of the comprehensive fee if he withdraws within the first and second weeks of a semester, and 50% if he withdraws within the third and fourth weeks. A week is interpreted to mean a calendar week and ends at noon on Saturday.

If a student withdraws from the University before he pays his registration fees or before he completes the payment for his registration fees, he is considered indebted to the University for the amount de- termined according to the refund regulations.

EXPENSE ESTIMATE

The following is an estimate of expenses for one eighteen-week semester at Ohio University:

Comprehensive registration fee* $115.00

Rent of room in dormitory (average rental) 117.00

Board in dormitory 216.00

Total for semester $448.00

The estimate does not include the cost of books, which amounts to approximately $25 a semester for the average student.

The real differences in the costs of attending the University are to be found in such personal maintenance expenditures as those for laundry, clothes, recreation, and other incidentals. These may vary greatly and are determined by the individual's tastes and interests.

The University does not make provision for handling student ac- counts, this service being available through local banks.

*The i-ecristration fee for a student who is not a resident of Ohio is increased by the nonresident fee. See "Fees and Deposits," page 58.

60 Ohio University

REGISTRATION

Details concerning the registration procedure are given in the schedule of classes which is obtained at the office of the Registrar before each registration.

PERMITS TO REGISTER. A permit to register which shows the hour and place for advising and registration must be obtained for each regis- tration. A student enrolled in the University obtains his permit in accordance with regulations announced by the Registrar.

A former student obtains a permit to register by calling at the office of the Registrar or by making his request by mail about a month before the opening of the session he wishes to attend.

A new student receives his permit to register by mail with other admission material.

STUDENT LOAD. A full-time student normally carries a minimum of 15 semester hours. A student on warning or probation carries a maxi- mum of 14. A student must obtain approval from the dean of his college to carry less than the minimum prescribed by his college or more than 17 semester hours (19 if registered for an engineering degree), or more than 14 if on warning or probation. Specific regulations are given in the respective college sections of the catalog.

AUDITING PRIVILEGE. At the time he is advised a student may re- ceive permission to audit courses as part of his load. The courses must be marked "Audit" on the schedule and registration cards. The fee for auditing is the same as for credit. Subsequent to registration, changes from audit to credit or from credit to audit are made by change order during the period when changes are permitted.

CLASSIFICATION OF STUDENTS. A student who has been regularly admitted to the University and who expects to pursue a degree or a diploma course is given rank according to the number of semester hours completed: Freshman, 0-24; Sophomore, 25-54; Junior, 55-86; and Senior, 87 and over.

All other students are unclassified. If an unclassified student has completed 24 or fewer semester hours, he enrolls as a special student in the University College; if he has completed 25 or more semester hours, he registers in the degree college of his choice as a special student. An unclassified student continues to enroll as a special student until he has made up high school credit deficiencies or is regularly admitted to a degree or diploma course.

A student who has earned a degree and desires to register for undergraduate courses without pursuing another degree enrolls as a special student in the degree college from which he was graduated; however, a student who wishes to enroll for a special interest subject only may register in the college offering the course.

A student who has been admitted to the Graduate College enrolls as a special student when he does not wish to pursue a program leading to a degree.

University Regulations 61

CHANGE ORDERS. When a student finds it necessary to add a course, withdraw from a course, or correct his registration, he requests a change order in the office of the dean of the college in which he is enrolled. The order does not go into effect until it has been presented to and accepted by the office of the Registrar.

A course may not be added after the close of the third week of a semester.

When a student withdraws from a course by change order his grade is recorded W; and the instructor destroys the class card on receipt of a notice from the Registrar.

A course cannot be dropped by change order by a student in a degree college after the third week and by a student in University College after the close of the eighth week of the semester, or in the case of a course that has a late starting date, one week after the start- ing date.

The following procedure is authorized for making a change order: The student secures a change order form in the dean's office, and then consults the designated departmental representative or the instructor of each course being dropped or added. If the departmental representative or the instructor approves the change, he signs the change order form. If the change is not approved, the reason may be indicated on the change order form or in a separate communication to the dean. The change order form is returned to the dean of the college in which the student is enrolled for approval. After securing the dean's approval, the student deposits the change order form in the office of the Registrar and pays the change order fee of $2 if it was assessed by the dean.

Changes correcting mechanical errors in registration during the first week of classes may be approved by the dean of the college follow- ing approval of the departmental representative.

Exceptions to the above regulations are made only with the ap- proval of the Executive Committee.

The dates marking the close of each period mentioned are shown in the calendar.

CHANGE OF ADDRESS. A student is responsible for any university office communication sent to him at the last address reported to the office of the Registrar. Forms for reporting a change of home or Athens address are available in the Registrar's office.

CHANGE OF COLLEGE. Application for transfer from one degree college to another is made in the office of the dean of the college in which the student is enrolled and should be made before registration. The change goes into effect when the application, signed by the two deans concerned, has been presented to the Registrar and the transfer fee of $2 has been paid. A student is required to fulfill all the require- ments of the degree and the college to which he transfers. The change must be completed within two weeks after the opening of a session or the student remains in the college in which he was registered until the next session.

62 Ohio University

WITHDRAWAL FROM THE UNIVERSITY. Application is made on a withdrawal form obtained in the office of the dean of the college in which the student is registered. When the request for the withdrawal has been approved by the dean of the college, the order is referred to the Registrar who grants an official withdrawal after it has been deter- mined that all obligations to the University have been met. A refund of registration fees is made according to regulations under "Fees."

"W" is recorded for a University College student who is granted a withdrawal from the University during the first eight weeks of a semester, and for a degree college student during the first three weeks; and on receipt of notice from the Registrar, the instructor destroys the class card. The weeks are counted from the date marking the opening of the semester.

When a University College or degree college student is granted a withdrawal from the University following the close of the eighth or third week of a semester, respectively, his grade in each course is recorded "WP" if he is passing or "WF" if failing at the time of withdrawal. Hours of "WP" are not included in total hours attempted; hours of "WF" are. "WP" and "WF" appear on the transcript of record.

A student who leaves the University without obtaining an official withdrawal is not permitted a refund of fees and is given F in all courses. The University reserves the right to ask a student to withdraw at any time when it considers such action to be in its best interests.

CREDIT. All credit is designated in semester hours. A semester hour is the equivalent of one recitation or two or more laboratary periods a week throughout a semester. In order to receive credit, students are required o take final examinations. The final examinations are held during the last week of a session and all students are required to take the examinations according to the schedule issued by the Registrar.

The final examination for honors work must be taken before the opening of the regular examination period. For information concerning honors work, refer to "Honors Work Program."

REGISTRATION OF MOTOR VEHICLES

University policy and regulations require that all students operat- ing automobiles, motorcycles, or other types of motor vehicles, including students who are residents of the city of Athens, must register these vehicles and pay a $2 registration fee during registration at the beginning of each semester. In turn, each student will be given a wind- shield sticker, upon registration and payment of fee, which will entitle him to park in the areas designated. Failure to display the sticker on the lower right-hand corner of the windshield will result in a fine of $3.

If a vehicle is brought to the campus after registration day, it must be registered within twenty-four hours at the Office of the Dean of Men. Persons violating this regulation will be fined $10 in addition to the I'equired registration fee, and it will be counted as a first offense.

University Regulations 63

SCHOLARSHIP REGULATIONS

THE GRADING SYSTEM. At the close of a session or upon the comple- tion of a course an instructor reports a letter grade indicating the quality of a student's work in the course. Points are assigned for each semester hour of credit earned, according to the following grading system :

Points Letter Grade Explanation Per Semester Hour

A Very high 4

B High 3

C Average 2

D Passing but low 1

F Failure 0*

I Incomplete 0*

W Withdrawn -**

WP Withdrawn Passing -**

WF Withdrawn Failing 0*

Cr. *** Credit without grade -**

* Hours are included in total hours attempted. ** Hours are not included in total hours attempted. *** Not used at Ohio University for regular courses. Recorded if a part of a transferred record.

THE POINT-HOUR RATIO is the basis for determining scholastic standing. It is obtained by dividing the total number of points earned by the total number of semester hours undertaken, excluding courses in which the marks "W", "WP", or "Cr." are recorded (those with ** in the table).

"W" is recorded for a University College student who is granted a withdrawal from a course or from the University during the first eight weeks of a semester, and for a degree college student during the first three weeks. University College students may not withdraw from a course after the close of the eighth week, and degree college students after the third week. The weeks are counted from the date marking the opening of the semester.

When a University College or degree college student is granted a withdrawal from the University following the close of the eighth or third week of a semester, respectively, his grade in each course is recorded "WP" if he is passing or "WF" if failing at the time of withdrawal. Hours of "WP" are not included in total hours attempted; hours of "WF" are. "WP" and "WF" appear on the transcript of record.

Unofficial withdrawals result in "F" grades.

"I" is given to a student who, in a course in which he is doing passing work, has a relatively small part of the session's work not completed because of illness or other reason beyond his control as verified by the Dean of Men or the Dean of Women, or for some reason acceptable to the dean of the college in which he is enrolled. Two meth- ods are available to the student for removing an "I" grade from his

64 Ohio University

record: by arranging with the instructor to complete the work of the course within six weeks after the opening of the next semester he is in residence, or by re-registering for the course and completing it with a passing grade. An extension of time for the removal of an "I" may be made by the dean of the college.

POINT-HOUR RATIO (SCHOLASTIC AVERAGE). Except for hours of "W," "WP," and "Cr.", the entire record including each grade in each course attempted, is used to determine probation status, eligibility for honors, and class ranking, and for all purposes where a cumulative point-hour ratio is requested.

MINIMUM STANDARD FOR GRADUATION. To meet the minimum standard for graduation from Ohio University, a student must have a point-hour ratio of 2.0 (C) on all hours attempted, but including only the final hours and points in repeated courses. This applies to his total record, and to his major or equivalent as determined by his college. For a student, with transferred credit, this rule applies to both his cumulative record, which includes transferred credits, and to his Ohio University record exclusive of transferred credits.

REPEATING A COURSE. When a course is repeated, the last grade becomes the grade in that course for graduation purposes. Previous grades in repeated courses continue to be used to determine the cumu- lative point-hour ratio. A course may not be repeated after a more advanced course in the same field has been passed. A course passed may not be repeated in the semester in which the student is a candidate for graduation.

GRADE REPORTS

STUDENTS IN THE UNIVERSITY COLLEGE. At the end of the seventh and thirteenth weeks, grades for University College students are re- ported to the Registrar. The grades are available to the student through his counselor. The Dean of the University College sends a notice of warning at the close of the seventh week to the student who has a point-hour ratio below 1.5. At the close of the thirteenth week, a similar point-hour ratio results in a notice of warning being sent to the student and his parents.

A student who is on probation will have a notice of warning sent to his parents both at the seven and thirteen week grading periods if his point-hour ratio is below 2.0.

A final grade report is mailed to each student immediately after the close of a session.

STUDENTS IN DEGREE COLLEGES. At the end of the seventh and thirteenth weeks instructors report to the student his standing in class. His dean receives a report if he has F or low D in a course. If at the end of a session, a degree college student's cumulative point-hour ratio falls below 2.0 (C) but not low enough to place him on probation, a notice is sent to the student and to his parents by the dean of his college.

A final grade report is mailed to each student immediately after the close of a session.

% 3

f -I*;

.^^

m -^ w

«^ t

University Regulations 65

HONORS

DEAN'S LIST. The Dean's List, compiled at the close of each session, includes the names of all freshmen who have a point-hour ratio of at least 3.0 (B) on a minimum load of 15 semester hours of credit; and the names of all upperclassmen who have a point-hour ratio of at least 3.3 on a minimum load of 15 semester hours of credit.

HONORS DAY. The Honors Day Convocation, held each spring-, is for the purpose of honoring students who have attained high scholastic standing. The names of all undergraduate students who have attained a point-hour ratio of 3.0 (B) on a minimum total of 15 semester hours at Ohio University, and who in their last semester preceding Honors Day completed a minimum of 15 semester hours, are listed in the Honors Day Program. Students with transferred credits who have the necessary standing at Ohio University as well as on their cumulative record are also honored.

Graduate students are honored if they have attained a point-hour ratio of 3.5 (B-f) on a minimum of 12 semester credit hours earned in residence, and if in their last semester preceding Honors Day they completed a minimum of 9 semester hours.

The student who attains these honors will have an indication of them on his record and on the transcript of his record.

GRADUATION. The name of the recipient of the bachelor's degree is distinguished in the commencement program by the notation "with honor" if his point-hour ratio on all hours attempted is 3.0 to 3.5, and with "high honor" if 3.5 or above. The name of one with transferred credits is similarly distinguished if both his Ohio University and total record meet the requirement.

PROBATION REGULATIONS

GRADE-POINT DEFICIENCY. A student whose total grade points is less than twice the number of hours attempted has a grade-point de- ficiency. A student's grade-point deficiency is found by taking two times the number of hours attempted minus total grade points accumu- lated. Thus, a student who has attempted a total of 31 semester hours and earned 48 grade points has a grade-point deficiency of 14 (2x31-48 = 14).

At the close of each session the record of every student is reviewed. If a student's cumulative record shows a grade-point deficiency, he is subject to being placed on probation or dropped from the University. Action taken as the result of poor scholarship is indicated on the grade repoi-t which is mailed to the student. A notice is also sent by the Registrar to the student's parent or guardian. In general, action will be taken in accordance with the following regulations:

66 Ohio University

PROBATION. A student who has attempted fewer than 30 hours is placed on scholastic probation when his grade-point deficiency is greater than half the number of hours attempted. A student who has attempted 30 hours or more is placed on scholastic probation when his grade-point deficiency is greater than 15 grade points.

PROBATION REMOVED. If a student on probation has attempted a total of fewer than 30 hours and his grade-point deficiency is not greater than half the total hours attempted, probation is removed. If a student on probation has attempted 30 hours or more and his grade- point deficiency is not greater than 15 grade points, probation is re- moved.

PROBATION CONTINUED. A student who has been on probation for one session may be continued on probation for one additional session if his grade-point deficiency has not increased and he is not eligible to be removed from probation. However, at the close of this additional session he must be eligible to be removed from probation or he will be dropped from the University.

DROPPED FROM THE UNIVERSITY. A student on probation is dropped from the University if his grade-point deficiency has increased and he is not eligible to be removed from probation.

Any student whose grade-point deficiency at the close of any session exceeds the number of hours attempted will be dropped from the Uni- versity whether or not he has been on probation. A student may be dropped even though he has not previously been on probation. See SPECIAL ACTION.

Normally a petition for reinstatement will not be considered until a year after the student was dropped. He presents the petition to the dean of his college for consideration by the Executive Committee.

A student who is dropped may not enroll for courses on campus, in a Branch, or in correspondence or extension courses conducted by Ohio University until he is reinstated by the Executive Committee.

SPECIAL ACTION. In individual cases the Executive Committee may drop, impose or remove probation, or grant continuation or reinstate- ment if the circumstances appear to justify special action.

TRANSCRIPTS

A photograph of a student's record is issued by the office of the Registrar as an official transcript. Transcripts are made only upon request. Each student is entitled to one copy free of charge. A transcript requested after the free copy has been issued costs $.1. For a group request of from five to ten copies the fee is $5; for five to twenty copies, $10. The transcript fee must accompany the transcript request.

A transcript carries a statement of good standing except when a student has been dropped from the University because of poor scholar- ship, nonpayment of fees, or unsatisfactory conduct. A student on scho- lastic probation has his status indicated on his transcript.

University Regulations 67

CLASS ATTENDANCE AND ABSENCES

A student is expected to attend all scheduled meetings of his classes and all examinations.

REGULATIONS PERTAINING TO CERTIFIED ABSENCES. If because of illness or other authorized reasons a student is absent, it is his re- sponsibility to obtain the appropriate certificate of absence and to present it to his instructor immediately upon his return to class. Qualifying for a certificate does not exempt a student from class work. In making up work he must meet the requirements prescribed by the instructor.

The following two types of certificates are available to the student and are honored by instructors.

Certificate of absence due to illness: This is given by the Health Service to a student who has received treatment at the clinic; who has been a patient in the infirmary, or who presents evidence of illness from a physician.

Certificate for other authorized reason: This is obtained from the Dean of Men or the Dean of Women for an absence resulting from serious illness or death in the family; a wedding in the immediate family; trips in connection with authorized educational and univer- sity activities; other educational trips, appointments, meetings, mandatory tests (as for example, the selective service test), manda- tory court appearances, approved extracurricular activities, and any occurrence which can be classified as an act of God. Extended group educational trips that make it necessary for stu- dents to be absent from classes require the approval of the dean of the college or the director of the division under whose auspices the trip is made. The dean or director certifies the list of participants to the Dean of Men or Dean of Women.

ADDITIONAL REGULATIONS. Apart from the requirements of the following additional regulations, all uncertified absences are handled by the instructor concerned.

Instructor's Attendance Reports: Instructors will submit absence reports to the Dean of Men or the Dean of Women for students who are frequently tardy, frequently absent on any one day of the week, absent from so many meetings that academic work is aff"ected, or absent from all meetings of a class for one week. This will enable the Deans of Men and Women and the dean of the student's college to follow up irregular and excessive absences because it is often the first indication that a student is in trouble outside the class- room. Upon the recommendation of the personnel dean to the dean of the college, a student may be dropped from the University be- cause of excessive absence.

Class Probation and Penalties: At the discretion of the instructor a student may be placed on class probation for uncertified absences. Instructors request the Dean of Men or the Dean of Women to place the student on class probation. The Dean of Men or Dean of

68 Ohio University

"Women notifies in writing the student, the parents, the Registrar, the dean of the student's college, and the instructor who made the request. After being placed on probation an additional uncertified absence will result in the student receiving "F" in the course. The "F" is reported to the Registrar immediately with the reason in- dicated on the class card.

Uncertified Absences Before and After Vacations: Each instructor will report all absences from class on the two days preceding and following official vacation periods for the assignment of penalty absences. A penalty of one semester hour is added to the require- ments for graduation for an uncertified absence from the student's last scheduled class preceding a vacation and his first scheduled class period following a vacation. If a student is absent from all periods on the day immediately preceding a vacation and his last class period on the second day preceding a vacation, he is penalized two semester hours. The same penalty applies to the two days im- mediately following an official vacation. A total of four semester hours may, therefore, be added to an individual's graduation require- ments for absences incurred at any one holiday period.

Absence from Final Examinations : Certification for absences from examinations for the usual authorized reasons (family emergency, etc.) is obtainable from the appropriate personnel dean, or, in case of illness, from the Health Service. Application for absence for other reasons must be made through the academic dean and requires approval of the instructor concerned and the Executive Committee of the University.

Special Requests: If unusual circumstances not covered by these regulations make it necessary for a student to request absence he consults the dean of his college who will confer with the instructors concerned. Executive Committee action may be required at the dis- cretion of the deans involved.

GRADUATION

APPLICATION. A candidate for graduation must make application in the office of the Registrar, and pay the application fee, not later than the date given in the university calendar for the session in which he plans to graduate. The application fee for a degree is $10; for the Associate in Arts diploma, $5. Application for graduation made after the time designated adds a penalty of $5.

If an applicant fails to meet the requirements for graduation, he may reapply for the session in which he plans to complete the require- ments. The reapplication fee is $2. The penalty fee of $5 is added for late reapplication.

SCHOLASTIC AVERAGE FOR GRADUATION. To meet the minimum standard for graduation from Ohio University, a student must have a point-hour ratio of 2.0 (C) on all hours attempted, but including only

University Regulations 69

the final hours and points in repeated courses. This applies to his total record, and to his major or equivalent as determined by his college. For a student with transferred credit, this rule applies to both his cumula- tive record, which includes transferred credits, and to his Ohio Univer- sity record exclusive of transferred credits.

The minimum number of semester hours required is increased by the number of hours received as a penalty for excess absences before or after a holiday vacation, by the number of hours of repeated subjects, and by the number of hours in courses not allowed toward a degree by catalog designation or by the dean of the college, and may be increased by the number of semester hours earned in physical activity coiirses.

A student who fails to graduate because of a grade-point deficiency may take, with approval of his dean, up to a maximum of 6 semester hours of work in correspondence, extension, or Branches of Ohio Uni- versity to make up his deficiency. Work may not be taken at another college to make up this deficiency.

MAJOR AREAS OF STUDY. Requirements for majors and fields of concentration are outlined by the individual colleges. A transfer student whose transcript shows the completion of most or of all the courses in a major area of study may be required by the dean of his college to satisfy the departments concerned that he has met Ohio University's standards in that area before it is recognized for purposes of gradua- tion.

PROFICIENCY IN ENGLISH. A degree student who failed to make a grade of A or B in English 4 is required to take the English proficiency test the first time it is given after his record shows a total of 45 semes- ter hours of credit. A student who transfers to Ohio University in his junior or senior year takes the test during his first semester in resi- dence, and one who transfers in his sophomore year takes the test after his record shows a total of 45 semester hours of credit, regardless of the grade he received in freshman English in another school. Any trans- fer student who must take English 3 at Ohio University to complete his freshman composition requirements may be excused from the pro- ficiency test if his grade is A or B.

The proficiency test is off"ered each semester. Dates are shown in the calendar. It consists of a few paragraphs of prose, written on a subject chosen by the student from a list of subjects given to him at the test. The papers are later marked Passed or Failed.

The student who fails the test will be required to repeat English 3 during the following semester. If the student then makes a grade of A or B in this semester of repetition, he is excused from the profi- ciency test. A student who makes a grade below B on repetition must take the proficiency test.

The student who fails to take the proficiency test at the scheduled time will be required to take a make-up examination.

70 Ohio University

PHYSICAL EDUCATION. Men students have a flexible physical edu- cation requirement. The normal requirement of two semesters may be reduced by passing physical proficiency and sports tests which are offered near the close of each semester and summer session. After completing one semester with credit, the student may elect to try physi- cal proficiency tests or continue to register for additional credit. Having passed testing standards prescribed by the Division of Physical Educa- tion and Athletics, the student is excused from further requirement.

Men classified as veterans of the armed forces are not held to the one-semester rule and, therefore, may take proficiency tests on entrance to the University.

Women students are required to complete two semesters with credit in physical education.

Men and women may, however, elect additional semesters in physi- cal education service courses and, subject to exceptions listed by the colleges, may use four hours of this credit toward degree requirements.

See "Service Courses" in "Courses of Instruction" for regulations governing service course credit toward the degree requirement.

Exceptions, Excuses, and Deferments are allowed for both men and women as follows:

Exemption from the physical education requirement is made auto- matically for a graduate student, for a student who is 30 years of age or over, or for a veteran who is 25 years of age or over, provided he has completed the requirement up to and including the semester in which he attained the required age.

An excuse from the physical education requirement is granted to a permanently disabled student by the Director of Physical Education upon the recommendation of the Director of the Health Center.

Deferment postponement for one semester is authorized by the Director of Physical Education upon the recommendation of the Dean of Men or the Dean of Women for a student who has an excessive physical load in connection with part-time work or by the student's academic dean in cases of serious scheduling conflicts. Any student who is granted a deferment in physical education courses must complete before gradu- ation the requirement he otherwise would have had to meet without deferment.

RESERVE OFFICERS' TRAINING CORPS. The Army and Air Force R.O.T.C. oifers a two-year basic course and a two-year advanced course. Once either course is elected, completion of that course becomes a pre- requisite for graduation, unless the student is relieved of this obligation by proper authority. R.O.T.C. credit does not increase the total semester hours required for most degrees, provided the student utilizes his cur- ricular elective hours for this credit. See college sections, and "R.O.T.C. Division."

University Regulations 71

RESIDENCE. In general the minimum residence requirement for a degree or a diploma course is two semesters or the equivalent in summer sessions which should total not fewer than 30 weeks with the completion of a minimum of 30 semester hours. If a student spends the minimum of 30 weeks, or less than 45 weeks with the completion of less than 45 semester hours, in residence, the 30 weeks must be the final weeks before graduation.

If a student spends 45 weeks or more in residence with the com- pletion of a minimum of 45 semester hours, his last residence may be reduced to 15 weeks with the completion of 15 semester hours.

If a student begins graduate study before he completes all require- ments for a bachelor's degree, residence for the bachelor's degree will be reduced by as many weeks as credit hours of gi^aduate work com- pleted. The number of weeks subtracted will be credited toward the residence requirement for a master's degree if the credit is acceptable in the program approved for graduate work tov/ard a degree. Residence used for meeting requirements for one or more bachelor's degrees may not be used for meeting the residence requirements for a master's de- gree.

The residence regulations apply to a student who has been approved for graduation in absentia and is completing his last year in an ac- credited professional school, except that the regulations apply to his residence before he leaves the University to attend the professional school.

An exception to the final semester or final year of residence may he made in the case of a student who has otherwise met the minimum residence and scholastic requirements and who has completed all but 6 semester hours, or fewer, required for a degree. When this occurs a stu- dent may complete the final semester hours, 6 or fewer, at another insti- tution, or by extension, correspondence or Branch study at Ohio Uni- versity.

Credit earned at an Ohio University Branch, and Saturday and evening class credit may be used to satisfy the residence requirements in combination with one semester or several summer sessions. The num- ber of weeks' residence for part-time students enrolled in Branch, Sat- urday, evening, and day classes is determined by the number of hours of credit allowed for the course. A student whose work has been exclu- sively at a Branch, is required to spend the last 15 weeks of residence on the Athens campus with the completion of a minimum of 15 semester hours.

Credit earned in the Extension Division, whether in extension classes or in correspondence study, does not count toward the fulfillment of the residence requirement.

IN ABSENTIA. In absentia permission is obtained in writing from the dean of the college in which the student is enrolled. Application for graduation in absentia is made by a student in the office of the Registrar before he leaves the campus. To obtain his bachelor's degree a student

72 Ohio University

who has been approved for the senior-in-absentia privilege in an ap- proved professional school must have completed a full year's work of the quality prescribed for the bachelor's degree at Ohio University, and be eligible for advancement without condition to the second year. The official transcript from the school, and the statement from the dean of the school certifying that he has satisfactorily completed the full year's work and is eligible for advancement without condition to the second year, must be in the office of the University Examiner, Ohio University, tv>^o weeks before the commencement date, or a notice of the last date it will be received prior to commencement must be sent.

A student graduating in absentia is excused from attending com- mencement exercises.

TIME LIMIT. A student first registers for a bachelor's degree when he enrolls in a degree college, after he has been released or advanced from the University College, and may secure that degree by fulfilling the requirements as outlined in the catalog of the year in which he first registered in the University. A student who does not complete the degree requirements within the usual three years spent in a degree college may be allowed to fulfill the same requirements at a later date, provided he completes them within seven years after his first enrollment in the Uni- versity. A transfer student is governed by the same regulations, except that the number of years in which to complete the degree requirements is reduced by the number of years of transferred work.

GRADUATION WITH HONOR. A candidate for the bachelor's degree who is graduated with a point-hour ratio of 3.0 to 3.5 on all hours attempted is distinguished on the commencement program by the nota- tion "with honor"; with 3.5 or above, by the notation "with high honor." A student with transferred credit is similarly distinguished if both his Ohio University record and his cumulative record meet the requirement.

A candidate who has successfully completed a program of study in honors work is, in addition, distinguished on the commencement pro- gram by the notation "with honors in ," with the indication

of the field in which he has achieved distinction.

HONORS WORK PROGRAM. Honors work is offered to give the supe- rior student freedom to pursue the study of his chosen field as rapidly as his talents permit. The aims of the program include acquisition of knowledge in a chosen field, integration of knowledge of one field with that of related fields, development of the ability to carry on independent investigation and research, enhancement of skill in the written expres- sion of the results of reading or investigation, and development of creative talents.

Students who have attained a point-hour ratio of 3.0 or better on all work attemped and possess a talent to work independently may be- come candidates for a degree with honors in their chosen field of study. Application is m.ade to the Honors Work Committee during the junior year or at the beginning of the senior year. The committee, with the

University Regulations 73

approval of the student's dean, assigns the student to an instructor who will serve as the student's adviser in honors work.

At the beginning of each semester, the student files with the com- mittee a brief plan of his program of honors work for the semester. Near the close of the semester, he files with the committee a statement of work accomplished and a notation of any changes in plan. At the close of the senior year, a final essay, research paper, or completed creative project is submitted to the committee. At the end of each semester a grade for honors work is sent to the Registrar by the stu- dent's honors adviser. A student registered for honors work who at the end of any semester has not maintained a point-hour ratio of 3.0, or who has received a grade below B in his honors work, is dropped as a candi- date for honors but receives course credit.

All general requirements for the degree sought by the student must be met either before or while the student is registered in honors work. The student may register for from three to eight semester hours of honors work each semester as a part of his student load. Normally, the student will be permitted to carry only one honors work project. In exceptional cases permission to enroll for more than one program may be obtained from the Executive Committee of the University.

Upon completion of the project a student whose adviser does not grant a grade of B or better is disqualified for honors in his field but retains course credit earned by his honors work. Final judgment on the projects of otherwise qualified candidates is made by the Honors Work Committee.

COMMENCEMENT. Degrees and diplomas are granted at the close of each session even though the session may not close with formal com- mencement exercises. Attendance at graduation exercises is required in academic costume. Students who have been granted permission to graduate in abentia are excused from attendance. Oher candidates, due to unusual circumstances, may need to request absence. Application for excuse is made with the dean of the college. The application form which is filed with the Registrar includes instructions for the mailing of the diploma and carries a diploma handling charge of $2.

A SECOND BACHELOR'S DEGREE. A student who desires two bache- lor's degrees may meet the requirements for them either simultaneously or successively:

(a) If a student desires to complete the requirements for the two degrees simultaneously and have the degrees conferred on the same date, he must meet the particular subject requirements for both degrees; earn a minimum of 154 semester hours approved for the degrees (170 for two engineering degrees) with the requisite scholastic average, both on Ohio University work and on the total record when credit has been transferred from another school; and must have completed a total of 9 semesters of college work or its equivalent, witli a minimum of three

74 Ohio University

semesters of residence, or the equivalent, at Ohio University. When the two degrees are offered by different colleges, the student must register in both collges during the session in which the degrees are to be con- ferred.

(b) If a student has met the requirements for two degrees as indi- cated above and desires to have the degrees conferred in successive semesters, he may do so without further credit or residence. He may, for example, have one degree conferred at the end of one semester or summer session and may make application for the second degree at a subsequent session. If the session closes with commencement exercises, he will be required to attend in academic costume unless his application for excuse from commencement is approved.

(c) If a student desires to take a second bachelor's degree after he has received his first, he must complete the subject requirements for the second bachelor's degree, earn a minimum of 30 acceptable semester hours beyond the requirements for the first degree with the requisite scholastic average and have at least an additional semester of residence, or equivalent, in the college offering the second degree with the com- pletion of at least 15 acceptable semester hours.

Basic Preparation for admission [o each of the degree-granting colleges

Two-Year Terminal programs leading to Associate in Arts diploma

THE UNIVERSITY COLLEGE GAIGE B. PAULSEN

DEAN

BERNARD R. BUkCK

ASSISTANT DEAN

THE UNIVERSITY COLLEGE

All freshmen enroll in the University College which concerns itself primarily with the problems of first-year students their courses of study, and their guidance during the period of transition from high school to college. The freshman year in the University College and the following three years in one of the degree colleges represent the normal time required for completion of any of the baccalaureate degree programs.

During the first week of the semester in which a student is first enrolled, designated as "Freshman Week," the University College con- ducts a program of orientation for freshmen. All new students are required to attend Freshman Week activities. Various tests are given to assist students and their counselors in the selection of courses and ed- ucational objectives. Meetings are held during the week to help students become acquainted v/ith the University its history and traditions, regu- lations, opportunities for development, and student activities and organi- tions. A copy of the "Orientation and Studies in the Freshman Year" bulletin is sent to each new student prior to his enrollment in the Uni- versity. It includes the program for the week, giving the exact time and place of all events.

A Pre-College Conference in July provides an early opportunity to come to the campus for one day to complete the freshman tests, to learn the significance of the scores, and to confer with a faculty counselor and prepare a schedule of classes.

The University College aims to provide an educational progi-am that will best meet the individual needs of the student. No prescribed course of study is required of all. The courses in the freshman year are planned so as to provide studies that are generally recognized as most essential to the educated person. Students are advised to consider it a year of broad preparation for later specialization. General course re- quirements are determined so as to complement the work done in high school and to take into account the educational objective of the student.

General requirements of the University College are determined as follows :

1. English Composition Eng. 3-4.

Students who place low on the English Placement Test given all entering freshmen take Eng. 1, then complete Eng. 3-4 in their second and third semesters in the University. Hours earned in Eng. 1 are added to the re- quirements for graduation.

Students who demonstrate superior ability on the Placement Test will be registered in an Honor Section of Eng. 3.

2. Fundamentals of Speech Speech 1.

3. Physical Education

For detailed statement concerning this requirement see page 70.

4. One year in each of two of the following groups:

In case a student has a specific requirement due to a high school deficiency, as in Humanities and Mathematics, the courses taken to meet these two requirements also meet the two group re-

The University College 77

quirement, or a course taken to meet one specific requirement also is counted as meeting one of the two-group requirement. In other words, a course or courses taken to meet specific requirements also apply toward the two-group requirement.

A. Humanities: (a) Foreign language; (b) Humanities 7, 8 The Great Books (see "General Studies") ; (c) Fine Arts 17-18 In- troduction to the Fine Arts; (d) Phil. 1 Principles of Reason- ing, and Phil. 2 Moral Philosophies.

Students with less than two years of foreign language in high school are required to take a year in one subject in the Humanities group.

B. Mathematics: Math. 1 Elementary Algebra, Math. 2 Plane Geometry, Math. 3 Intermediate Algebra, Math. 5 Freshman Mathematics, Math. 6 Analytic Geometry and Calculus I, Math. 9 Fundamentals of Mathematics, Math. 34 Mathe- matics of Finance, Math. 107 Elementary Statistics (taken by freshmen only following Math. 5 or 9).

Students who have had no algebra or plane geometry in high school take Math. 1 Elementary Algebra and Math. 2 Plane Geometry. Students who have had one year of algebra and no plane geometry take Math. 2. Math. 1 and Math. 2 are offered only in the Summer Session. Students are strongly urged to complete algebra and plane geometry in high school.

C. Natural Sciences:

Biological Biol. 1-2 The Living World (see "General Studies"); Bot. 3-4 General Botany; Zool. 3-4 Principles of Zoology.

Physical Astron. 11-12 Elementary Astronomy; (Chem. 1-2 or (Chem. 3-4 and 99)— General Chemistry; Geol. 1-2— Elements of Geology; and Phys. Sci. 3, 4 The Physical World or Phys. 5, 6 Introduction to Physics.

Students with less than two full years of laboratory science in high school take a year in one science in the area in which no science was taken in high school, i.e., if Biological Science was taken in high school tb" require- ment is in Physical Science. (High school courses such as general science and senior science are excluded). Exceptions to this requirement must be approved by the Dean of the University College.

D. Social Science: Ec. 11-12 Principles of Economics; Geog. 3 Elements of Physical Geography; Geog. 4 World Regional Geography; Govt. 1, 2 American Government; Hist. 1, 2 Western Civilization in Modern Times; Psych. 1 General Psychology, Psych. 2 Psychology of Everyday Problems; Soc. Sci. 9, 10 Citizenship in the Modern World (see "General Studies") ; and Soc. 1, 2 General Sociology.

Students with less than two years in any combination of courses in social science taken in high school are required to take one year of social science.

In addition to the above listed courses, a large number of courses have been selected which a freshman student may carry on an elective basis, but which do not meet the specific requirements outlined above.

The student normally plans his schedule so as to complete the Uni- versity College requirements in the freshman year. A student who has chosen the degree he wishes ultimately to receive is advised to select courses from among those offered in the four groups above that are

78 Ohio University

especially recommended for the particular curriculum he expects to follow. For example, it is suggested that a student who expects to pur- sue a program in the Arts and Sciences and who will have a requirement in language carry a language course to meet the humanities requirement, while a student who plans to major in the Fine Arts should select F.A. 17-18 Introduction to the Fine Arts to meet the humanities require- ment. The student who has not decided upon any definite course will find that the University College program affords him an opportunity to ex- plore various fields of knowledge so that a wiser final choice may be made. No student's schedule may include more than five semester hours in courses not included in the general requirements or in any one of the four groups.

COUNSELING PROGRAM. This program is designed to help the stu- dent make wise decisions regarding his academic plans. In addition, it encourages him to develop initiative and increasing responsibility for his personal development. Each student is assigned to a faculty counsel- or selected on the basis of having professional interests similar to those of the student. Throughout the year the student confers with his coun- selor: at the beginning of each semester for schedule preparation, at the time of the two grade periods each semester (end of seventh and thir- teenth weeks), and at other times as he may need advice or assistance.

ADVANCEMENT TO DEGREE COLLEGE. At the end of two semesters, the student is advanced to the degree college of his choice. Graduation from the University requires the completion of all University College requirements. The student is advised to include courses for completing any unfulfilled University College requirements in his sophomore sched- ule of classes.

REGISTRATION. All entering freshmen must register and participate in the orientation program. A copy of the complete schedule of events is mailed to each new student before registration. Announcements for registration in the second semester and the summer session are made to students registered in the University directly by mail and through the student newspaper, the Ohio University Post.

TERMINAL PROGRAM LEADING TO ASSOCIATE IN ARTS DIPLOMA. The

University College offers a program of study for the student who does not intend to complete a four-year degree program and who plans to spend only two years in the University. Its completion leads to the Associate in Arts diploma.

The Associate in Arts program includes English composition, physi- cal education, speech, Social Science 9 and 10, and other general educa- tion and career courses. The same standards of academic achievement as for the degree are required during the progress of the program. The student must complete 62 hours with a minimum of 124 grade points. Application for the diploma is made at the office of the Registrar at the time announced for all degree and diploma candidates and must be ac- companied by a fee of $5.

The University College 79

A number of curricula for terminal programs have been outlined. They furnish the student with a background for admission to certain professional schools or for employment in a special position. The out- lined curricula include: Agriculture; Commerce, including General Business or Secretarial Studies; Home Economics; Journalism, with work in either Advertising or Radio Speech; Medical Technology; Meteorology; Premortuary Science; Prephaimacy ; Preveterinary Medi- cine; and Recreation Leadership. There are additional curricula, and other special programs may be planned to meet the needs of the student.

When the student decides to pursue one of these programs, he con- fers with his counselor and prepares an outline of courses which he will carry to complete the program. This is filed with the University College office. Credit earned while enrolled in a terminal program may be counted on a four-year degree course, subject to the approval of the dean of the degree college in which he later enrolls. A student who shifts to a degree program is required to complete all University Col- lege requirements. This shift from a terminal program to a degree pro- gram may involve spending additional time in completing the degree requirements, since some of these requirements are normally completed in the first two years and may not have been a part of the Associate in Arts program.

STUDENT HOUR LOAD FOR FRESHMEN IN THE UNIVERSITY COLLEGE.

It is important that a university student should establish good study habits and that he should normally complete one fourth of the work required for a degree (from 31 to 36 semester hours credit) during his freshman year.

So that a student may accomplish these things and carry a load adjusted to his demonstrated ability in high school, a full-time student not admitted on warning and not on probation is required to carry a minimum load of 15 semester hours credit. The maximum load will usually not exceed 17 semester hours (18 or 19 semester hours for an engineering student).

A full-time student admitted on "special warning" (see page 54) or who is on probation is required to carry a minimum load of 12 semester hours credit. The maximum load for such a student is 14 semes- ter hours credit.

Any exceptions to the above regulations either to carry a load in excess of the maximum or less than the minimum must be approved by the dean of the University College.

THE COLLEGE OF APPLIED SCIENCE

E. J. TAYLOR. JR..

DEAN

ENGINEERING

Architectural

Chemical

Civil

Electrical

Engineering Drawing

Mechanical

[Industrial and Technical Options)

THE SCHOOL OF HOME ECONOMICS

VIVIAN M. ROBERTS, DIRECTOR

Child Development and Family Life Foods and Nutrition Home Economics Education Housing and Home Management Institution Administration Textiles and Clothing

THE DEPARTMENT OF INDUSTRIAL ARTS Industrial Arts Industrial Technology Printing Administration

THE COLLEGE OF APPLIED SCIENCE

The College of Applied Science offers curricula leading to the Bachelor of Science degree in the fields of engineering, industrial tech- nology, and home economics.

Candidates for degrees must fulfill the general graduation require- ments of the University (see page 68), Candidates for the degree in industrial technology must complete a minimum of 130 hours and for the degree in home economics a minimum of 124 hours, plus any physical education requirements in excess of 2 hours with a point-hour ratio of 2,0 (see page 68) on all hours attempted, but including only the final hours and points in repeated courses. This applies to his total record and to his major or equivalent. Candidates for degrees in engi- neering must complete a minimum of 140 semester hours plus satis- faction of physical education requirements with a point-hour ratio of 2.0 (C) on all hours attempted, but including only the final hours and points in repeated courses. Not more than 8 semester hours credit in ROTC may be included in the 140 semester hours required for graduation. At least 18 semester hours of credit in humanities and social sciences is required for a degree in engineering, with at least 6 hours credit in each field.

For a student with transferred credits, these rules apply to both his cumulative record, which includes transferred credits, and to his Ohio University record exclusive of transferred credits,

STUDENTS WHO DESIRE TO TEACH. Students who desire to teach in- dustrial arts or home economics may enroll for the degree Bachelor of Science in Education offered by the College of Education. Students who enroll in the College of Applied Science may complete the requirements for the degree Bachelor of Science in Home Economics and secure a teaching certificate by satisfying the requirements in education speci- fied by the State Department of Education for the field in which the student desires to teach. Requirements of the State Department of Education are listed under "Teaching Certificates" on page 141.

ENGINEERING

Engineering curricula accredited by the Engineer's Council for Professional Development are offered in Architectural Engineering, Civil Engineering, Electrical Engineering, and Mechanical Engineering (Industrial and Technical Options). A curriculum in Chemical Engi- neering has recently been organized.

All engineering faculty members are registered professional engi- neers in the State of Ohio. New faculty members are expected to register in the State of Ohio within a year after they have been appointed to the faculty.

A four-year engineering program necessarily limits the time which may be devoted to study in other colleges of the University. Since a background in English, the humanities, and the social sciences is

82

The College of Applied Science 83

essential for an engineer who hopes to advance in his profession, the faculty requires that all candidates for an engineering degree must have completed at least 18 semester hours of credit in the humanities- social sciences (including English courses numbered above 100). At least 6 hours credit in each field is required. The student is urged to plan in consultation with his advisor a program in these fields which will be most helpful to him. Engineers are frequently chosen for management; hence it is to the student's advantage to secure the broadest possible education.

ADMISSION TO AN ENGINEERING PROGRAM

High school students who wish to follow an engineering curriculum should plan to present for admission to the University those subjects which meet the area requirements of the University College, including the additional mathematics courses listed under "Subjects in High School" on page 52. Students should indicate their choice of an engi- neering curriculum on their official application for admission to the University. This precaution will assure proper guidance in the Uni- versity College program of study.

To be admitted to an engineering program from the University College a student must at the time of admission to the engineering program have (1) satisfactorily completed Math. 6 Analytic Geometry and Calculus I, (2) satisfied all University College requirements, and (3) have a cumulative point-hour ratio of at least 1.8.

Students who are not properly prepared in high school mathematics must enroll in preparatory mathematics courses. No mathematics course below Math. 5 will be counted toward satisfying the requirements for a degree in engineering.

A student whose point-hour ratio is less than 2.0 for the second semester of the freshman year, or who receives a grade lower than "C" in the mathematics course taken during the second semester of the freshman year, is admitted to an engineering program on warning. Such a student remains on warning until the end of the first semester in which he achieves a cumulative point-hour ratio of 2.0.

Students who wish to lighten the strenuous load of a four-year program may plan their program to take nine semesters or to attend a summer session. Students who have high school deficiencies to make up are urged to consider this alternative. With proper planning a student may obtain a degree from the College of Arts and Sciences, the College of Commerce, or the College of Fine Arts as well as a Bachelor of Science degree in an engineering field upon the completion of 10 semes- ters in the University. (See "A Second Bachelor's Degree" on page 73.)

University College students who intend to study engineering are urged to consider a foreign language for the humanities requirement. Those intending to enroll in Chemical Engineering should choose Ger- man. Opportunities for engineers who are acquainted with a foreign language are increasing.

84 Ohio University

Every engineering student should be prepared after completion of his four-year program to pass the examination given by the Board of Registration for Professional Engineers of the state in which he intends to practice. The Ohio Board allows those who have completed the stand- ard four-year curriculum to appear for examination. It is to the stu- dent's advantage to take the examination as soon as possible after graduation.

REQUIREMENTS FOR CONTINUING IN AN ENGINEERING PROGRAM

A student who has been admitted to an engineering program with a point-hour ratio of less than a 2.0 must remove the grade-point defi- ciency by the end of the second semester in the engineering program. A grade-point deficiency in engineering subjects will not be permitted after two semesters in an engineering program. Failure to meet these requirements will result in a student being dropped from the engineering program by special action.

CURRICULA IN ENGINEERING

The faculty has established basic curricula in Architectural Engi- neering, Civil Engineering, Chemical Engineering, Electrical Engineer- ing, and Mechanical Engineering (Industrial and Technical Options).

University requirements pertaining to English Composition, physi- cal education, the humanities, social sciences, and speech (see page 76) are not indicated in the engineering curricula which follow.

HUMANITIES-SOCIAL SCIENCE ELECTIVES. The following subjects will meet the humanities and social science requirements.

Humanities Elective Group Social Science Elective Group

English courses numbered over 100 Courses in Economics Courses in Fine Arts Courses in Geography- Humanities 7, 8 Great Books Courses in Government A foreign language Courses in History Courses in Philosophy General Studies 9, 10 Citizenship In Human Relations 303, 304 Human the Modern World Relations Courses in Psychology

Courses in Sociology

If a student desires to take other courses to satisfy the restricted elective requirement, he must receive prior approval of his department chairman and the dean.

ELECTIVES. Any courses listed other than those used to remove high school deficiencies may be selected as free electives. ROTC courses not to exceed eight hours credit may be used for free electives. The follow- ing are recommended.

Accounting 75-76 Elementary Accounting Management 312 Administration

Accounting 175 Cost Accounting of Personnel

Business Law 255-256 Business Law Physics 115 Modern Physics

C. E. 270 Engineering Economy Physics 349-350 Atomic and Nuclear

Math. 207 Applied Statistics Physics

Math. 304— Advanced Calculus Physics 365— Nuclear Reactor Theory and

Math. 315 Advanced Applied Practice

Mathematics I Statistics 155 Business Statistics

Management 302 Production Management Speech 3 Public Speaking

The College of Applied Science 85

Freshman Program

(For all engineers)

The University College Program should include :

First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

Chem. 1 or 3 General Chemistry 4 Chem. 2 or 4 General Chemistry* 4 or 3

E. D. 1 Engineering Drawing 2 E. D. 2 Engineering Drawing** 2

Math. 5 Freshman Mathematics 5 E. D. 21 Descriptive Geometry 2

•Chemical Engineers take Chem. 99 Math. 6 Analytic Geometry and

Calculus 1 5

**Ai-chitectural Engineers take Art 1 3

BACHELOR OF SCIENCE IN ARCHITECTURAL ENGINEERING

The curriculum for this degree is planned to give the student a broad fundamental background in architecture and engineering. The elective hours of study may be used to increase either the engineering or architectural content of the curriculum, or to broaden it by study in other divisions of the University.

Freshman Program

(See top of page)

Sophomore Program

Hours Hours

Math. 101 Analytic Geometry and Math. 102 Analytic Geometry and

Calculus II 4 Calculus III 4

Phys. 113 General Physics 4 Phys. 114 General Physics 4

C. E. 120— Applied Mechanics 3 C. E. 10— Plane Surveying 3

Arch. 55 Fundamentals of Architecture 3 Arch. 56 Architectural Graphics 3

Humanities or Social Science Elective 3 C. E. 121 Applied Mechanics 8

B. D. 3— Slide Rule 1

Junior Program

C. E. 222 Strength of Materials 3 C. E. 228— Reinforced Concrete Theory— 2

C. E. 223— Materials Test Lab 1 C. E. 330— Structural Analysis II 4

C. E. 230 Structural Analysis I 4 Arch. 156 Architectural Design 5

Arch. 155 Architectural Design 5 Arch. 183 Architectural Equipment 3

Arch. 179 Architectural Materials 3 English Literature Elective 3

Math. 315 Advanced Applied Elective 2

Mathematics I 3

Senior Program

E. E. 201 Circuits and Measurements 4 E. E. 328 Illuminating Engineering 3

C. E. 231— Structural Design I 4 C. E. 331— Structural Design II 3

Bus. L. 255 Business Law 3 C. E. 270 Engineering Economy 3

C. E. 225— Soil Mechanics 3 F. A. 176— History of Architecture 3

Arch. 254 Working Drawings 2 Basic Science Elective or Engr.

F. A. 175 History of Architecture 3 Sci. Elec. 3

Humanities or Social Science Elective 3

BACHELOR OF SCIENCE IN CHEMICAL ENGINEERING

The rapid rise of the chemical industry in the Ohio Valley has prompted the faculty to establish a curriculum in chemical engineering. Classrooms and space for laboratory instruction in unit operations and unit processes as well as facilities for chemical engineering research are included in the Engineering Building.

This curriculum is designed to provide a broad but thorough train- ing in chemical engineering. The graduate from the program will have an adequate background for graduate study in engineering or the

86 Ohio University

sciences, or for further self -training in the areas of engineering develop- ment, research, management, or technical sales in the chemical or re- lated industries.

In the first two years, chemistry, mathematics, physics, and the sciences basic to all engineering, are emphasized. Simultaneously an integrated sequence of courses in engineering science and analysis is developed which leads to intensive study of the fundamentals of chemical engineering in the latter years. In addition to technical training, the professional engineer needs to have some knowledge of fields other than his own. Approximately a fifth of the curriculum is elective, v/hich permits the student to pursue his interests, under guidance, in the humanities and social studies.

Freshman Progrram

(See page 85)

Sophomore Progrram

First Semester Hours Second Semestar Hotirs

C. E. 120 Applied Mechanics 3 C. E. 121— Applied Mechanics 3

Chem. 107 Quantitative Analysis 4 Ch. E. 101 Introduction to Chemical

Math. 101 Analytic Geometry and Process Prin. 3

Calculus II 4 Math. 102 Analytic Geometry and

Phys. 113 General Physics 4 Calculus III 4

E. D. 3— Slide Rule 1 Phys. 114— General Physics 4

Elective 2 English Literature Elective 3

Elective 2

Junior Program

C. E. 222— Strength of Materials 3 M. E. 221— Thermodynamics I 3

C. E. 223— Materials Testing Lab. 1 Chem. 202— Organic Chemistry 3

Chem. 201— Organic Chemistry 3 Chem. 314 Physical Chemistry 3

Chem. 313 Physical Chemistry 3 Chem. 315 Physical Chemistry Lab. __ 2

Chem. 203 Organic Chemistry Lab. 2 Ch. E. 310 Unit Operations 3

Elective from Group A 3 Social Science or Humanities Elective 3

History Elective 3

Senior Program

Ch. E. 311 Unit Operations 3 Ch. E. 340 Design and Instrumenta-

Ch. E. 312 Unit Operations Lab. 2 tion 5

Ch. E. 320— Unit Processes 3 Engr. 391 Seminar in Ch. E. 1

Ch. E. 211— Materials & Metallurgy or B. E. 309— Applied Electronics 3

Ch. E. 220 Thermodynamics & Elective from Group B 2-3

Kinetics 3 Elective from Group C 3

E. E. 201 Circuits and Measurements _ 4 Social Science or Humanities Elective 3

Social Science or Humanities Elective 3

Group B Electives :

Group A Electives: Phys. 115 Modem Physics 2-3

Math. 301 Theory of Equations 3 Phys. 365 Nuclear Reactor Theory

(Math. 304 Advanced Calculus 3 and Practice 3

(Math. 315 Advanced Applied Phys. 314 Modern Spectroscopy 3

Math 316 Advanced Applied Phys. 349 Atomic & Nuclear

Mathematics I 3 Physics 3

Mathematics II 3 Group C Electives :

Ch. E. Advanced Topics 3

M. E. 314— Heat Transfer 3

Senior Level Chemistry 3

BACHELOR OF SCIENCE IN CIVIL ENGINEERING

The curriculum for this degree is planned to give the fundamental training necessary for a broad understanding of the profession. The following fields are studied: structures and foundations, hydraulics, highway and railroad layout and construction, water supply, sanitation, and surveying. Courses which consider the economic and legal aspects of engineering are required. Although the program is comprehensive.

The College of Applied Science 87

it allows the student elective hours of study during the last two years. By a proper choice of these electives he may extend his study of one or more of the several fields discussed above or he may pursue further the business aspects of engineering, or he may broaden himself in a more general way by a judicious selection of courses in various divisions of the University.

Freshman Program

(See page 85)

Sophomore Program First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

E. D. 3 Slide Rule 1 C. E. 121 Applied Mechanics 3

C. E. 120 Applied Mechanics 3 Phys. 114 General Physics 4

Phys. 113 General Physics 4 Math. 102 Analytic Geometry and

Geol. 103 Engineering Geology 3 Calculus III 4

Math. 101— Analytic Geometry and C. E. 224 Fluid Mechanics 3

Calculus II 4 C. E. 240 Hydraulics Lab. 1

C. E. 10 Plane Surveying or C. E. 10 Plane Surveying or

Humanities or Social Science Elective 3 Humanities or Social Science Elective 3

Junior-Program

C. E. 213 Advanced Surveying 3 C. E. 228 Reinforced Concrete Theory _ 2

C. E. 260— Route Engineering 2 C. E. 330 Structural Analysis II 4

C. E. 222 Strength of Materials 3 C. E. 249 Water Supply Engineering _ 3

C. E. 223 Materials Testing Labora- Math. 315 Advanced Applied Mathe-

tory 1 matics I 3

C. E. 230 Structural Analysis I 4 C. E. 270 Engineering Economy 3

C. E. 241 Hydrology 2 Humanities or Social Science Elective 3

Humanities or Social Science Elective 3

Senior Progrram

C. E. 225— Soil Mechanics 3 C. E. 331 Structural Design II 3

C. E. 231 Structural Design I 4 C. E. 250 Sanitary Engineering 3

E. E. 201 Circuits and Measurements _ 4 C. E. 261 Highway Engineering 3

Bus. L. 255 Business Law 3 E. E. 309 Applied Electronics 3

English Literature Elective 3 Basic Science Elective or Engr. Sci. 2-3

Humanities or Social Science Elective 3 Humanities or Social Science Elective 3

Basic Science or Engineering Science Elective Group:

Phys. 115 Modem Physics Math. 316 Advanced Applied

M. E. 221 Thermodynamics I Mathematics II

C. E. 326— Advanced Strength of Phys. 349, 350— Atomic and Nuclear

Materials Physics

Chem. 113 Organic Chemistry Chem. 99 Qualitative Analysis

M. E. 394 Mechanical Vibration

BACHELOR OF SCIENCE IN ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING

It is the aim of the department of Electrical Engineering to provide tlie background of general information and basic knowledge of principles which enables a student to analyze situations and to think intelligently and effectively in the field. The curriculum to be pursued has grown out of the belief that these are the most essential foundation elements for the various specialized fields, as well as for early advancement in prac- tical electrical engineering. A choice of electives offers a limited amount of specialization in eitlier power engineering or communication engi- neering.

88 Ohio University

Freshman Progrram

(See page 85)

Sophomore Program

First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours E. E. 103 Basic Electrical Engi- E. E. 104 Basic Electrical Engi- neering 5 neering 5

Physics 113 General Physics 4 Physics 114 General Physics 4

End. A. 13— General Cold Metals 3 C. E. 120— Applied Mechanics 3

Math. 101 Analytic Geometry and Math. 102 Analytic Geometry and

Calculus II 4 Calculus III 4

Humanities or Social Science Electives _ 3 Humanities or Social Science Electives _ 3

Junior Program

E. E. 303 Electrical Machines 5 E. E. 304 Electrical Machines 5

C. E. 121— Applied Mechanics 3 C. E. 222— Strength of Materials 3

Math. 315 Advanced Applied Mathe- Phys. 115 Modern Physics 3

matics I 3 E. E. 308 Engineering Electronics 3

E. E. 307 Engineering Electronics 3 Humanities or Social Science Electives _ 3

Humanities or Social Science Electives _ 3 Electives 2

Electives 2

Senior Program

E. E. 301 Communication Engi- E. E. 302 Communication Engi- neering 4 neering 4

E. E. 334 Advanced Electrical E. E. 335 Electric and Magnetic

Circuits 3 Fields 3

Technical Electives 6 Technical Electives 6

Thermodynamics 3 Electives 2

Humanities or Social Science Electives _ 3 Humanities or Social Science Electives _ 3

BACHELOR OF SCIENCE IN MECHANICAL ENGINEERING

The technical option in mechanical engineering emphasizes machine design and heat engineering. The work covered in the first two years is general and fundamental and parallels that in the other engineering curricula. The last two years cover comprehensive courses in the theory, development, and design of machines and mechanical equipment, and in thermodynamics and its application to steam generators, steam engines and turbines, combustion engines, and refrigeration and air conditioning. To give a well-rounded curriculum, work is included in other fields of engineering, such as fluid mechanics and electrical engineering. Limited specialization is provided for by elective courses.

The industrial option provides a fundamental engineering back- ground as in the technical option but, instead of focusing the early training on machine design and heat engineering, it emphasizes training in fields leading to careers in industrial management.

TECHNICAL OPTION

Freshman Program

(See page 85)

Sophomore Program

First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

Econ. 101 Principles of Economics 3 C. E. 120 Applied Mechanics 3

[nd. A. 14— General Hot Metals 3 Ind. A. 13— General Cold Metals 3

Math. 101 Analytic Geometry and Math. 102 Analytic Geometry and

'Calculus II 4 Calculus III 4

Phys. 113 General Physics 4 Phys. 114 General Physics 4

E. D. 3 Slide Rule 1 Social Science or Humanities Elective 3

Elective 2 Elective 2

17 19

The College of Applied Science

89

Junior Prog:rain

C. E. 121— Applied Mechanics 3

E. E. 201 Circuits and Measurements _ 4 M. E. 201 Kinematics 3

M. E. 211 Engineering Metallurgy 3

M. E. 221— Thermodynamics I 3

History Elective 3

19

C. E. 222— Strength of Materials 3

C. E. 223 Materials Testing Lab 1

E. E. 202 Electrical Machinery 2

Math. 315 Advanced Applied Mathe- matics I 3

M. E. 113— Metal Processing 2

M. E. 222— Thermodynamics II 3

M. E. 302 Dynamics of Machinery 3

Phys. 115— Modern Physics 3

20

Senior Program

C. B. 224— Fluid Mechanics 3

E. E. 309 Applied Electronics 3

M. E. 227— Steam Power Plants 3

M. E. 303— Machine Design I 3

M. E. 311— Air Cond. and

Refrigeration 3

Social Science or Humanities Elective 3

18

Engr. 391 Seminar 1

M. E. 229— Steam Power Laboratory ___ 2

M. E. 304— Machine Design II 3

M. E. 312 Internal Combustion

Engines 4

M. E. 314— Heat Transfer 3

English Literature Elective 3

Social Science or Humanities Elective _ 3

19

INDUSTRIAL OPTION

Freshman Program

(See page 85)

Sophomore Program

Hours

Econ. 101 Principles of Economics 3

End. A. 13— General Cold Metals 3

Math. 101 Analytic Geometry and

Calculus II 4

Phys. 113 General Physics 4

E. D. 3— Slide Rule 1

Elective 2

Hours

C. E. 120 Applied Mechanics 3

Econ. 102 Principles of Economics 3

Ind. A. 14 General Hot Metals 3

Math. 102 Analytic Geometry and

Calculus III 4

Phys. 114 General Physics 4

Elective 2

17

19

Junior Program

Acct. 75 Elementary Accounting 3

C. E. 121 Applied Mechanics 3

E. E. 201 Circuits and Measurements _ 4

M. E. 113 Metal Processing 2

M. E. 211 Engineering Metallurgy 3

History Elective 3

18

Acct. 76 Elementary Accounting 8

C. E. 222— Strength of Materials S

C. E. 223— Materials Testing Lab. 1

E. E. 202— Electrical Machinery 2

M. E. 221— Thermodynamics I 3

Mgt. 302 Production Management 3

Phys. 115 Modern Physics 3

IS

Senior Program

C. E. 270 Engineering Economy 3

M. E. 201— Kinematics 3

E. E. 309— Applied Electronics 3

Social Science or Humanities Elective 3

Elective from the following:

Acct. 175 Cost Accounting 3

C. E. 10— Plane Surveying 3

Econ. 335 Labor Economics 3

Math. 207— Applied Statistics 3

Mgt. SOS Production Planning and Control 3

Elective from the following:

Ch.E. 310— Unit Processes 3

Math. 315 Advanced Applied

Mathematics I 3

M. E. 222— Thermodynamics II 3

M. E. 227— Steam Power Plants 3

Engr. 391 Seminar 1

M. E. 303— Machine Design I 3

BIgt. 321— Motion and Time Study 3

Elective from the following:

Ch. E. 320— Unit Processes 3

C. E. 224— Fluid Mechanics 3

M. E. 304— Machine Desicn II 3

M. E. 311— Air Cond. and Refrig. _ 3 M. E. 312 Internal Combustion

Eng. 4

English Literature Elective 3

Social Science or Humanities Elective 3

Elective 8

90 Ohio University

BACHELOR OF SCIENCE IN HOME ECONOMICS

The School of Home Economics plays a dual role in training young women for home and family living as well as a business or professional career. During the freshman and sophomore years, emphasis is placed upon general education and basic training for home and family living. The student thus has the opportunity of becoming acquainted with all areas of Home Economics and is better able to select the field of spe- cialization she wishes to follow during the junior and senior years.

Ten professional curricula, and one nonprofessional, are available, all of which lead to the degree of Bachelor of Science in Home Econom- ics. The curricula are as follows :

Professional

Foods and Nutrition (Dietetics) Home Economics in Business

Clothing and Textiles with Design Journalism

Home Economics Education Commercial Foods and Equipment

Home Economics Extension Clothing Merchandising

Child Development with Nursery School Home Planning and Decoration

Radio-TV

Nonprofessional Home and Family Living

Career opportunities for the home economist in the business and the professional world are numerous. Hospitals, restaurants, hotels and college residence halls are seeking the major in Dietetics. Public utility companies and manufacturers or retailers of food seek women trained in Commercial Foods and Equipment for promotional activities or for writing publications or for experimental work with foods and equipment.

The girl interested in Textiles will find opportunities in textile testing or in developing promotional and educational programs for tex- tile concerns. Clothing manufacturers, pattern companies, and clothing departments in retail stores seek the Clothing specialist for promotional work, for designing garments, for merchandising and buying, for altera- tions, for comparison shopping, or for fashion coordination.

Home Economics Teachers, both vocational and nonvocational, are always in demand. The School of Home Economics is approved by the State of Ohio Department of Education for training vocational home economics teachers.

The broad program of Home Economics Extension in rural and urban areas of Ohio requires a large stafi' trained in extension for posi- tions as home demonstration agent, extension specialist, or 4-H Club leader.

The home economist interested in Child Development will find op- portunities in private or industrial nursery schools, or in welfare agen- cies caring for young children. By meeting the state requirements for certification, she may teach young children in public schools.

The College of Applied Science 91

Newspapers, women's magazines, radio and television companies seek the home economist with a flair for writing, speaking or demon- strating, since she is trained to direct her program to the homemaker and consumer.

The Home Planning and Decoration specialist finds opportunities in gift and decorating establishments helping the consumer in the selec- tion of furnishings for the home. Or she may become associated with magazine or advertising concerns writing articles or assisting with promotional programs.

SPECIAL FACILITIES. The program in Home Economics at Ohio Uni- versity is not confined to the classroom and laboratories; other activities and experiences are encouraged. A Nursery School and a Home Man- agement House are maintained by the department. Nearby high school home economics laboratories are available for student teaching. Off- campus activities have been developed with the Ohio State Extension Service, with the Health Department, with business organizations, with department stores, and with radio-TV stations to give the student op- portunities for field work in specialized areas. Affiliation with the Merrill-Palmer School in Detroit, Michigan, provides a unique experience for the junior or senior desiring a semester of specialized training in all areas related to marriage and the family.

CORE COURSES. The School of Home Economics offers a group of core courses having no prerequisites, and open to any student in the University. These courses are the basic courses taken by all students in home economics. However, they emphasize the practical aspects of home economics and are planned for women students desiring basic training in the activities relating to the successful management of a home. Individual courses may be elected.

H. Ec. 1-2 Foods, Nutrition and Meal Planning

H. E. 3-4 Clothing Selection and Construction

H. Ec. 5 Child Development

H. Ec. 6 Family Living

H. Ec. 7 The Home and Its Furnishings

H. Ec. 108 Consumer Problems of the Family

H. Ec. 110— Textiles

H. Ec. 161 Home Nursing and Family Health

MINORS IN HOME ECONOMICS. Programs may be set up with some one phase of home economics as a minor field. For instance, students in any department in the University may elect a minor in Home and Family Living, or Clothing and Textiles, or Foods and Nutrition, or Child Development and Family Life, or School Lunch and Institution Management.

I FRESHMAN AND SOPHOMORE PROGRAM

The lequirements of the University College relative to high school deficiencies, English composition, physical education, and speech must be fulfilled. In addition the freshman and sophomore program should in- clude the following basic courses :

92

Ohio University

Hours H. Ec. 51 Orientation in Home

Economics 2

Science (See Note 1) 6-8

Soc. 1 General Sociology 3

Psych. 1 General Psychology 3

Ec. 11 or 101 Principles of Economics _ 3 Art 1, 2 Drawing and Design (6) or Art 91 Design and

Composition (3) 3-6

Hours H. Ec. 1-2 Foods, Nutrition and

Meal Planning 6

H. Ec. 3-4— Clothing Selection and

Construction 4

H. Ec. 5— Child Development 3

H. Ec. 6 Family Living 3

H. Ec. 7 The Home and its

Furnishings 2

H. Ec. 108 Consumer Problems of the

Family 2

H. Ec. 110— Textiles 2

Note 1: Chemistry is required of those majoring in Foods and Nutrition, Clothing and Textiles, or Commercial Foods. Students following other curricula in home economics may take either Biol. 1-2 Living World, Zool. 3-4 Principles of Zoology, or chemistry. Chemistry is strongly recommended for those students who do not know which curriculum they wish to follow.

II JUNIOR AND SENIOR PROGRAM

If the student wishes to prepare for a career in some phase of home economics, she follows one of the ten professional curricula during her junior and senior years. If she is not interested in a professional or business career, she may follow the nonprofessional curriculum with emphasis on home and family living.

PROFESSIONAL CURRICULA

Foods and Nutrition (Dietetics)

Hours

H. Ec. 125— Family Nutrition 3

H. Ec. 322— Experimental Cookery 3

H. Ec. 326— Advanced Nutrition 3

H. Ec. 327— Quantity Cookery 3

H. Ec. 329— Nutrition in Disease 2

H. Ec. 351 Home Management 2

H. Ec. 353 Home Management

Laboratory 3

Acct. 75 Elementary Accounting 3

Chem. 113 Organic Chemistry 4

Hours H. Ec. 342 Institution Marketing and

Food Cost Control 2

H. Ec. 343 Institution Equipment and

Furnishings 2

H. Ec. 348 Institution Management 3

H. Ec. 269— Teaching of Foods and

Nutrition 3

Zool. 235 Elements of Physiology 4

Zool. 241 Elementary Bacteriology 4

Zool. 309- Biological Chemistry 4

Clothing and Textiles with Merchandising

H. Ec. 212-213— Flat Pattern Design __ 4 H. Ec. 313— Clothing and Textiles

for the Consumer 2

H. Ec. 315 History of Costume and

Textiles 2

H. Ec. 316— Tailoring 3

H. Ec. 318— Advanced Textiles 3

H. Ec. 319 a and b Special studies in

Textiles and Clothing 6

H. Ec. 351 Home Management 2

H. Ec. 353 Home Management

Laboratory 3

Advt. 155 Advertising Principles 3

Art 28 Figure Drawing 2

Art 120— Textile Design 3

Art 137 Fashion Design 2

Ec. 12 or 102 Principles of Economics _ 3 Jour. 322 Feature and Magazine

Writing 3

Mkt. 155 Marketing Principles 3

Six hours selected from the following:

Acct. 75 Elementary Accounting 3

Mgt. 211 Industrial Management 3

Mkt. 271 Principles of Personal

Selling 2

Psych. 135 Psychology of Advertising

and Selling 3

Sec. St. 220 Business Communications _ 3

Sec. St. 285— Office Management 3

Clothing and Textiles with Design

H. Ec. 212-213— Flat Pattern Design __ 4 H. Ec. 313— Clothing and Textiles

for the Consumer 2

H. Ec. 315 History of Costume and

Textiles 2

H. Ec. 316— Tailoring 3

H. Ec. 318— Advanced Textiles 3

H. Ec. 319, a and b Special Studies in

Textiles or Clothing 6

H. Ec. 351 Home Management 2

H. Ec. 353 Home Management

Laboratory 3

Art 28 Figure Drawing 4-6

Art 120— Textile Design 3

Art 137 Fashion Design 2

Art 321 Advanced Fashion Design

and Illustration 2-4

Six hours selected from the following:

Art 107 Advanced Design 3

Art 113— Lettering 3

Art 147-148 Advertising Design 4

Art 301 Individual Problems 1-3

The College of Applied Science

93

Home Economics Education

H. Ec. 161— Home Nursing and

Family Health 2

H. Ec. 125— Family Nutrition 3

H. Ec. 172— Advanced Child

Development 2

H. Ec. 268— Teaching of Home

Economics 3

H. Ec. 316— Tailoring 3

H. Ec. 327— Quantity Cookery 3

H. Ec. 330 Workshop in Home

Furnishings 3

H. Ec. 334 Household Equipment 3

H. Ec. 351 Home Management 2

H. Ec. 353 Home Management

Laboratory 3

H. Ec. 368— Demonstration Tech- niques 2

Zool. 241 Elementary Bacteriology 4

Humanities Literature, Philosophy, Fine

Arts, or Foreign Language 6-8

Psych. 5 Educational Psychology 3

Ed. 130 Secondary Education 3

Ed. 229 Curriculum and Teaching

Practices 4

Ed. 281— Observation and Student

Teaching in High School 7

Home Economics Extension

H. Ec. 161 Home Nursing and

Family Health 2

H. Ec. 125— Family Nutrition 3

H. Ec. 172— Advanced Child

Development 2

H. Ec. 268— Teaching of Home

Economics 3

H. Ec. 316— Tailoring 3

H. Ec. 323— Food Preservation 2

H. Ec. 330 Workshop in Home

Furnishings 3

H. Ec. 334 Household Equipment 3

H. Ec. 351 Home Management 2

H. Ec. 353 Home Management

Laboratory 3

H. Ec. 368 Demonstration Tech- niques 2

Zool. 241 Elementary Bacteriology 4

Psych. 5 Educational Psychology 3

Ed. 130 Secondary Education 3

Ed. 229 Curriculum and Teaching

Practices 4

Ed. 281 Observation and Student

Teaching in High School 7

Six hours selected from the following: H. Ec. 369 Home Economics in

Adult Education 3

H. Ec. 390a— Field Work in Home

Economics Extension 4-6

Jour. 322 Magazine and Feature

Writing 3

Child Development With Nursery School Training

H. Ec. 161 Home Nursing and

Family Health 2

H. Ec. 125— Family Nutrition or H. Ec.

155 Home Economics for the

Elementary School 2-3

H. Ec. 172— Advanced Child

Development 2

H. Ec. 351 Home Management 2

H. Ec. 353 Home Management

Laboratory 3

H. Ec. 377— Techniques with Young

Children 3

H. Ec. 379 a and b Guidance of

Nursery School Children 6

Zool. 241 Elementary Bacteriology (4)

or Biol. 1— The Living World (3) or Phys. Sci. 3— The Physical World (3) -3-4

Psych. 5 Educational Psychology 3

Ed. 101— Materials and Methods in

Kindergarten-Primary

Education 2

Ed. 102— Literature for Children 3

Mus. 72 Music Fundamentals 2

Minor directed toward Child Welfare*

Soc. 2 General Sociology 3

Soc. 133 Social Work in the American

Community 3

Soc. 234— Child Welfare 3

H. Ec. 375 a and b Readings in

Child Development or Family

Living 4

H. Ec. 378 Administration of Group

Care of Young Children 3

H. R. 303— Human Relations 3

Home Economics With Journalismf

Hours H. Ec. 161 Home Nursing and

Family Health 2

H. Ec. 125— Family Nutrition 3

H. Ec. 172— Advanced Child

Development 2

H. Ec. 316— Tailoring 3

H. Ec. 330 Workshop in Home

Furnishings 3

H. Ec. 334 Household Equipment 3

H. Ec. 351 Home Management 2

H. Ec. 353 Home Management

Laboratory 3

OFIours

Humanities Literature, Philosophy, or

Fine Arts 6-8

Jour. 107 Newspaper Reporting 3

Jour. 146 Typography, Mechanics,

and Make-up 3

Jour. 322 Feature and Magazine

Writing 3

8-9 hours selected from the following: Jour. 323 Advanced Feature and

Magazine Writing 2

Jour. 375 Specialized Journalism 3

Jour. 327 Public Relations Techniques- 2

Eng. 290— Creative Writing 3

Eng. 293 Sophomore Composition 3

*A minor directed toward Child Welfare is required with this curriculum. An exception is made for students in Child Development who want to meet state certification re- quirements for Kindergarten as well as training for Nursery School. In that case, the Director of the School of Home Economics will waive the sociology requirements and make substitutions necessary for certification.

tStudents may combine Journalism with a special area of Home Economics. In such cases Journalism course?, may be substituted for the Business courses as listed under the Clothing and Textiles, or the Commercial Food and Equipment curricula.

94

Ohio University

Commercial Food and Equipment

H. Ec. 125— Family Nutrition 3

H. Ec. 322 Experimental Cookery 3

H. Ec. 323— Food Preservation 2

H. Ec. 327— Quantity Cookery 3

H. Ec. 334 Household Equipment 3

H. Ec. 340— Problems in Food and

Nutrition 3

H. Ec. 351 Home Management 2

H. Ec. 353 Home Management

Laboratory 3

H. Ec. 368 Demonstration Techniques 2

Advt. 155 Advertising Principles 3

Ec. 12 or 102 Principles of Economics- 3

Chem. 113 Organic Chemistry 4

Mkt. 155 Marketing Principles 3

Jour. 322 Feature and Magazine

Writing 3

Speech 3 Public Speaking 2

Six hours selected from the following: Sec. St. 220 Business Communications- S Mkt. 271 Principles of Personal

Selling 2

Econ. 309— Public Utilities 2-3

Radio-TV 79— Introduction to

Radio-TV 2

Jour. 323 Advanced Feature and

Magazine Writing 3

Psych. 135 Psychology of Advertising

and Selling 3

Eng. 290 Creative Writing 3

Eng. 293 Sophomore Composition 8

Home Planning and Decoration

H. Ec. 330— Workshop in Home

Furnishings 3

H. Ec. 331 Economics of Furnishings _ 2

H. Ec. 334 Household Equipment 3

H. Ec. 351 Home Management 2

H. Ec. 353 Home Management

Laboratory 3

Arch. 56 Architectural Graphics 3

Art 120— Textile Design 3

Art 125 Art in Every Day Life 2

Art 271-272— Interior Design 6

Art 313 Advanced Interior Design 3

Ec. 12 or 102 Principles of Economics 3

Advt. 155 Advertising Principles 3

Mkt. 155 Marketing Principles 3

Six hours selected from the following:

Acct. 75 Elementary Accounting 8

Jour. 322 Feature and Magazine

Writing 3

Mgt. 211 Industrial Management 3

Mkt. 271 Principles of Personal

Selling 2

Psych. 135 Psychology of

Advertising and Selling 3

Sec. St. 220 Business Communications 3 Sec. St. 285— Office Management 3

Home Economics with Radio-TV*

Hours 161 Home Nursing and Family Health 2

125— Family Nutrition 3

172— Advanced Child

Development 2

316— Tailoring 3

330 Workshop in Home

Furnishings 3

334 Household Equipment 8

351 Home Management 2

353 Home Management

H. Ec.

H. Ec. H. Ec.

B. Ec. H. Ec.

H. Ec. H. Ec. H. Ec.

Laboratory 8

H. Ec. 368 Demonstration

Techniques 2

Hours Humanities Literature, Philosophy, or

Fine Arts 6

Jour. 107 Newspaper Reporting 3

Speech 2 Voice and Articulation 2

Radio-TV 79— Introduction to 7-iadio-

TV 2

Radio-TV 180— Radio Speech 3

8-9 hours selected from the following:

Radio-TV 147— Radio Workshop 2-4

Radio-TV 247— Advanced Radio

Workshop 2

Radio-TV 280— Radio-TV News

Writing and Editing 2

Radio-TV 285— Radio-TV News

Practice 2-3

Radio-TV 316— Continuity Writing 2

NONPROFESSIONAL CURRICULUM

Home and Family Living

H. Ec. 172— Advanced Child

Development 2

H. Ec. 125— Family Nutrition 3

H. Ec. 161 Home Nursing and

Family Health 2

H. Ec. 316— Tailoring 3

H. Ec. 330 Workshop in Home

Furnishings 3

H. Ec. 334 Household Equipment 3

H. Ec. 351 Home Management 2

H. Ec. 353 Home Management

Laboratory 3

Social Science Electives 9

Fin. 75 Personal Finance 2

Humanities Philosophy, Fine Arts or

Foreign Language 6-8

Literature Electives 6

H.R. 301 Marriage or

Soc. 260 Marriage and the Family 3

* Students may combine Radio-TV with a special area of Home Economics. In such cases Radio-TV courses may be substituted for the Business courses as listed under the Clothing and Textiles, or the Commercial Food and Equipment curricula.

The College op Applied Science 95

BACHELOR OF SCIENCE IN INDUSTRIAL TECHNOLOGY

There is a heavy demand from industry for men trained as tech- nicians. These technicians assist engineers and management in the field of operations. They frequently attain responsible executive positions.

The curriculum in Industrial Technology includes a group of courses selected for their contribution to a knowledge and understanding of the manufacturing phase of industry. Some of these courses give an under- standing of the economic and legislative controls within which industry operates, others deal with personal and social problems of the worker and his relation with labor groups and management. The shop courses provide experiences with materials, tools and machines. They contribute some of the basic, technical knowledge necessary for the development of skills pertinent to the manufacturing and production phases of industry.

The block of restricted electives is provided in order to allow the student to pursue and build a degree of specialization within related areas. The choice of courses identifying this specialization will generally be restricted to the areas of industrial arts, engineering, architecture, drafting, management, or the physical sciences. The student in consultation with his adviser is expected to select the program of courses designated as his vocational objective before the close of his sophomore year.

BACHELOR OF SCIENCE IN INDUSTRIAL TECHNOLOGY CURRICULUM

Freshman Program

The University College Program should include:

Hours (Hours

Eng. 3 Composition 3 Eng. 4 Composition 3

Hist. 1, 101, Govt. 1, 101 or Hist. 2, 102, Govt. 2, 102 or

Soc. Sc. 9 3 Soc. Sc. 10 3

Physics or Chemistry 3-4 Physics or Chemistry 3-4

E. D. 1, Engineering Drawing 2 E. D. 2 or 15, Drawing 2-3

Speech 1, Fundamentals 1 Elective 3-5

Elective 3-5

Sophomore Program

Math. 5, Freshman Math. 5 E. D. 3, Slide Rule 1

Ec. 11 or 101, Principles 3 Ec. 12 or 102, Principles 3

Acct. 75, Elem. Accounting 3 Psych. 1 or 101, General 3

Ind. A. 1, General Woodworking 3 Ind. A. 2, General Woodworking 3

Ind. A. 13. Gen. Cold Metals 3 Ind. A. 14, Gen. Hot Metals 3

Elective 3-4

Junior Program

Ind. A. 11, Duplicating 3 Ind. A. 134, Power & Trans. 3

Ind. A. 133, Prac. Electricity 3 Ind. A. 141, Printing 3

Mgt. 211, Industrial 3 Mgt. 321, Motion & Time Study 3

Bus. Law 25."), Business Law 3 Sec. St. 220, Business Commun. 3

Restricted Electives* 5 Restricted Electives* 5

Senior Program

Ind. A. 105, Mat. and Finishes 3 Mgt. 302. Production 5

Restricted Electives* 9 Restricted Electives* 6

Electives - 4-5 Electives 6-7

♦Restricted electives will be chosen by the student and his adviser to satisfy the student's specific objective in the fields of industrial arts, engineering, architecture, drafting, management, physical science, etc.

-!■'«

H

'f;..K'^

180^

^:^ J-

>. %^^

L,r-i^

y

If*

■PI'

#% w

\

^>'--'^

» 1

)

"liii M"

' f

i-iJ%»

THE COLLEGE OF ARTS AND SCIENCES

RUSH ELLIOn

DEAN

Archaeology and Antiquities

Astronomy

Botany

Chennistry

Classical Languages

English

General Studies Biology Great Books Physical Science Social Science

Geography and Geology

German

Government

History

Human Relations

Mathematics

Philosophy

Physics

Psychology

Romance Languages

Russian

Sociology

Zoology

THE COLLEGE OF ARTS AND SCIENCES

Ohio University remained a liberal arts college for almost one hundred years after it was founded. With the expansion of curricula and organization of new colleges and divisions during the last fifty years, the College of Arts and Sciences has held to what has been the central purpose of the college for a century and a half; namely to provide opportunities for the student to secure a general, liberal education. Since its focus is on more general concerns of man, it is broader than an education for immediate application. Liberal education implies knowledge, critical mindedness, the capacity for clear and inde- pendent thinking and expression, and ideas important to the thinking of free men and women. A liberal education affords an acquaintance with the language, skills, and methods in some area at a level that is beyond introductory concepts and methods. It prepares the student for more advanced graduate or professional training in some field or for immediate vocation.

These objectives are achieved through courses which make up the curriculum of the college courses which historically have been regarded as the means whereby man has come to understand himself and the world in which he lives and through degree requirements so arranged that the student gets specialized knowledge in some particular field or area together with a fundamental education in the humanities, natural sciences, and the social sciences.

The College includes the following departments:

Botany Human Eelations

Chemistry Mathematics and Astronomy

Classical Languages Philosophy

English Physics

Geography and Geology Psychology

General Studies Romance Languages

German Russian

Government Sociology

History Zoology

Departments of the College are accredited or recognized by leading professional associations. These include the Council on Social Work Education, the American Chemical Society, the American Psychological Association, and the Board of Registry of the American Society of Clinical Pathologists.

A student enrolled in any college at Ohio University may elect courses in any other college with considerable freedom. Thus, much of the course work required by the other colleges is offered by the faculty of the College of Arts and Sciences. In turn, a student pursuing a degree in this college may elect courses, in some instances completing a major in a department of one of the other colleges.

98

The College of Arts and Sciences 99

When a student enters the College of Arts and Sciences from the University College, or by transfer from another college or university, he is assigned an adviser who is a member of the faculty teaching in the area in which the student expects to major. The faculty adviser will assist the student in the preparation of his schedule each semester so that proper sequences of courses in the major, and appropriate related courses, are selected. The student is responsible for being certain that all requirements for the degree are being met.

The College offers two degrees: the Bachelor of Arts and the Bach- elor of Science. The requirements for the degrees represent a consider- able distribution of studies, yet they require sufficient stress in a major field to insure some degree of mastery of at least one area. All candi- dates in the College of Arts and Sciences must have a point-hour ratio of 2.0 (C) on all hours attempted, but including only the final hours and points in repeated courses. This applies to the major also.

The normal load requirement for a student enrolled in the College is a minimum of 1-5 semester hours and a usual maximum load of 17 semester hours when not on probation, and a minimum of 12 semester hours and a maximum of 14 semester hours when on probation. Any exception to these load requirements must be approved by the dean of the College.

Students who do not complete all University College requirements in the freshman year are expected to have these completed before being advanced to the junior year. Students who have requirements which in- volve courses numbered below 100 should start meeting such require- ments not later than the beginning of the sophomore year. This is par- ticularly recommended in the case of foreign language. Eegistration for courses numbered below 100 is prohibited for juniors and seniors in many areas and is discouraged in all areas.

BACHELOR OF ARTS

A total of 124 hours is required for the degree of Bachelor of Arts subject to the following:

(a) At least 60 hours must be in courses numbered above 100.

Elective credit is given for courses taken in divisions or depart- ments for which no major is provided in the College, as, for example, industrial arts, military science and physical education, and for courses in departments not listed as meeting degree requirements. A maximum of eight elective credit hours in applied music, four elective credit hours in physical education activities courses, including the two-hour require- ment, and six elective hours in industrial arts, are accepted toward the 124-hour degree requirement. Advanced courses for which elective credit is extended are not counted toward the 60-hour requirement in courses numbered above 100. Exception is made for courses in Education above 100 required for teacher certification (see page 112). Further exceptions are made only on review by and approval of the dean of the College.

100 Ohio Univeesity

(b) At least six hours in the major field must be in courses num- bered above 300. (See preceding paragraph.)

(c) A minimum of 70 hours must be in courses included in humani- ties, social sciences, and natural sciences. The hours included in the major in departments of the College of Arts and Sciences are applied toward this total.

(d) Not more than 40 hours in any one department may be counted in the 124 hours required.

(e) No course may satisfy two of the following requirements, and the courses selected to meet the requirements in foreign languages, hu- manities, social sciences and natural sciences must be from departments other than the major.

For example, an English major may not apply courses in English toward the humanities requirement, even though these be courses not required for the major, or in excess of the hours required for the major. Likewise, a zoology major must meet the natural science requirement in departments other than zoology.

The specific requirements for the degree are: Hours

English Composition: Courses numbered 3-4 6

Physical Education: Activities courses as required 0-2

Speejch: Fundamentals of Speech 1

Foreign Language: Complete in sequence through course 102 in

a language, or equivalent 0-16

Achievement of proficiency in a foreign language equiva- lent to that attained upon completion of two college years of one language is required. Exception is made for the student with 2 years of high school Latin who may complete the requirement by taking one year of Greek. A student who has had equivalent preparation to the above requirement may satisfy this requirement by passing an examination given by the language department con- cerned.

A student who is a major in one language must meet the foreig-H language degree requirement in another language.

Humanities: Select courses from two or more of the following

with at least six hours in one 12

(a) Archaeology

(b) 'English courses numbered 100

(c) Foreign language courses other than those necessary to com- plete the foreign language requirement

(d) Philosophy

(eV Humanities 7, 8 or 107, 108 Great Books (f) Fine arts

Of the fine arts only courses in the history and appreciation of fine arts may be taken to satisfy the 12-hour group require- ment, (Courses listed on page 222.) Music 5 (Music Appreciation) may be taken except in cases where Fine Arts 123-124 have been previously completed.

Social Sciences: Select courses from two or more departments

with at least six hours in some one department 12

(a) Economics (e) Government

(b) History (f) Psychology (except 209, 301, or 807)

(c) Human Relations - (g) Sociology

(d) Geography (except 175, 176) (h) Social Science 9, 10 or 209, 210

The College of Arts and Sciences 101

Natural Sciences: A one-year course in one department and at least a one-semester course in another 12

A minimum of a one-year course in biological science and a one-year course in physical science must be completed in either high school or college. If either requirement was not com- pleted in high school, this must be done in college as part of the 12-hour requirement. If the requirement was completed in high school, the 12-hour requirement may be met in any two of the following science departments or courses: Biological Sciences: Physical Sciences:

(a) Biology 1-2 (a) Astronomy

(b) Botany (b) Chemistry

(c) Psychology 209, 301, or 307 (c) Geography 17.5 or 176 ex- except for psychology majors cept for geography majors

(d) Zoology (d) Geology

(e) Physics

(f) Physical Science 3, 4

(g) Mathematics (except 1, 2) Students who have completed Biology 1-2 cannot receive credit for Botany 3-4 or Zoology 3-4. Students who have completed Botany 3-4 or Zoology 3-4 cannot receive credit for Biology 1-2.

Major: See departmental requirements for particular courses in the major and related fields recommended or required.

(a) A minimum of twenty-four hours, including six hours in courses numbered above 300, selected from a single depart- ment (see specific department requirements), in consultation with an adviser from that department, or

(b) Dual Major Twelve hours in courses numbered above 100, including six hours in courses numbered above 300, in each of two closely related departments, chosen with the approval of an adviser from each of the two departments. Courses taken in either or both of two departments for a dual major, even though not required for the major, cannot be used to meet the general area requirements in language, humanities, natural science and social science.

A transfer student is required to complete eight hours toward the major in courses at the 100 level or above at Ohio University, the courses to be approved by the department chairman. A transfer student completing the dual major is required to complete six hours at the 100 level or above in each of two departments at Ohio University, the courses to be approved by the chairmen of the two departments.

A student may complete a major for the A.B. degree in any of the following departments by meeting the specific requirements outlined above and the number of hours and courses specified by the department concerned: botany, chemistry, classical languages, dramatic art and speech, economics, English, geography, geology, German, government, history, home economics. Journalism, mathematics, music, painting and allied arts, philosophy, physics, psychology, romance languages, soci- ology, speech therapy and zoology.

The specific requirements in the departments in the College of Arts and Sciences are indicated in the descriptive material covering the de- partment. Requirements in departments outside the College are deter- mined by an adviser in the department.

A minor is not required. However, the student may wish to complete one or more minors. A minor consists of at least twelve hours in a single department, including six hours in courses numbered above 100. Courses used to satisfy any of the above degree requirements may not be counted toward the minor.

It is left to the discretion of the dean of the College to approve modification of these requirements in exceptional cases.

102 Ohio University

BACHELOR OF SCIENCE

A total of 124 hours is required for the degree of Bachelor of Science subject to the following:

(a) At least 60 hours must be in courses numbered above 100.

Elective credit is given for courses taken in divisions or depart- ments for which no major is provided in the College, as, for example, industrial arts, military science and physical education, and for courses in departments not listed as meeting degree requirements. A maximum of eight elective credit hours in applied music, four elective credit hours in physical education activities courses, including the two-hour require- ment, and six elective hours in industrial arts, are accepted toward the 124-hour degree requirement. Advanced courses for which elective credit is extended are not counted toward the 60-hour requirement in courses numbered above 100. Exception is made for courses in Education above 100 required for teacher certification (see page 112). Further exceptions are made only on review by and approval of the dean of the College.

(b) At least six hours in the major field must be in courses num- bered above 300 (see the preceding paragraph).

(c) A minimum total of 70 hours must be in courses included in humanities, social sciences, and natural sciences. The hours included in the major in departments of the College of Arts and Sciences are applied toward this total.

(d) Not more than 45 hours in any one department may be counted in the 124 hours required.

(e) No course may satisfy two of the following requirements.

The specific requirements for the degree are: Hours

English Composition: Courses numbered 3-4 6

Physical Education: Activities courses as required 0-2

Speech: Fundamentals of 1

Foreign Language: Two college years, or equivalent 0-16

Two years of one high school language are considered equiva- lent to one year in college. The requirement may be satisfied by taking more than one language. Students who enter with two years of language, but with less than four years have a one-year requirement in language. Students who enter with only one year of language have a two-year language requirement. Credit is not extended toward meeting the language requirement for the first semester of a beginning language unless the second semester is completed.

Humanities: Select courses from two or more of the following

with at least six hours in one 12

(a) Archaeology (d) Philosophy

(b) English courses numbered above 100 (e) Humanities 7, 8 or 107, 108 Great

(c) Foreign language courses other than Books those necessary to complete the for- (f ) Fine Arts leign language requirement

Of the fine arts, only courses in the history and appreciation of fine arts may be taken to satisfy the 12-hour group requirement. (Courses listed on page 222.) Music 5 (Music Appreciation) may be taken except in cases where Fine Arts 123-124 have been previously completed.

The College of Arts and Sciences 103

Social Sciences: Select courses from two or more departments

with at least six hours in some one department 12

(a) Economics (e) Government

(b) History (f) Psychology (except 209, 301, or 307)

(c) Human Relations (g) Sociology

(d) Geography (except 175, 176) (h) Social Science 9, 10 or 209, 210

Natural Sciences: A one-year course in one department and at

least a one-semester course in another 12

a minimum of a one-year course in biological science and a one- year course in physical science must be completed in either high school or college. If either requirement was not completed in high school, this musT be done in college as part of the 12-hour require- ment. If the requirement was completed in high school, the 12-hour requirement may be met in any two of the following departments or courses:

Biological Sciences : Physical Sciences :

(a) Biology 1-2 (a) Astronomy

(b) Botany (b) Chemistry

(c) Psychology 209, 301, or 807 (c) Geography 175, 176 except for psychology majors (d) Geology

(d) Zoology (e) Physics

(f) Physical Science 3, 4

(g) Mathematics except 1, 2

Courses meeting this requirement must be selected from depart- ments other than the one in which the student is a major. Students who have completed Biology 1-2 cannot receive credit for Botany 1-2 or Zoology 3-4. Students who have completed Botany 3-4 or Zoology 3-4 cannot receive credit for Biology 1-2.

Major: See departmental requirements for particular courses in the major and related fields recommended or required.

(a) A minimum of twenty-four hours. Including six hours in courses numbered above 300, selected from one of the following departments : Botany, Chemistry, Geology, Home Economics, [Mathematics, Physics or Zoology in consultation with an adviser from that department, or

(b) Dual Major twelve hours in courses numbered above 100, including six hours in courses numbered above 300, in each of two of the above departments, chosen with the approval of an adviser from each of the two departments. Courses taken in either or both of two departments for a dual major, even though not required for the major, cannot be used to meet the general area requirement in natural science.

A transfer student is required to complete eight hours toward the major in courses at the 100 level or above at Ohio University, the courses to be approved by the department chairman. A transfer student completing the dual major is required to complete six hours at the 100 level or above in each of the two departments at Ohio University, the courses to be approved by the chairmen of the two departments.

A minor is not required. However, the student may wish to complete one or more minors. A minor consists of at least twelve hours in a single department, including six hours in courses numbered above 100. Courses used to satisfy any of the above degree requirements may not be counted toward the minor.

It is left to the discretion of the dean of the College to approve modification of these requirements in exceptional cases.

104 Ohio University

SPECIAL CURRICULA

ATOMIC ENERGY AND INDUSTRIAL PHYSICS

Students preparing for a career in the atomic energy industry or in an industrial physics laboratory should elect the Bachelor of Science degree with a major in physics. The basic curriculum shown below is recommended. Some specialization in a particular phase of physics can be obtained in the junior and senior years by the choice of electives. General university requirements in physical education and speech and the foreign language requirements for the Bachelor of Science degree are omitted from the curriculum below. For these requirements see pages 68, 76, and 102.

Freshman Program

(First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

Chem. 3 General 4 Chem. 4 and 99 General and

Eng. 3 Composition 3 Qual. Analysis 5

Math. 5 Freshman 5 Eng. 4 Composition 3

Social science or humanities 3 Math. 6 Analytic Geometry and

Electives* 1-2 Calculus I 5

Social science or humanities 3

Electives* 1-2

Sophomore Program

Phys. 113— General 4 Phys. 114 General 4

Math. 101 Analytic Geometry and Math. 102 Analytic Geometry and

Calculus II 4 Calculus III 4

Ec. 101— Principles of 3 Ec. 102— Principles of 3

Social science or humanities 3 Social science or humanities 3

Electives** 2-3 Electives** 2-3

Junior Program

Math. 304 Advanced Calculus 3 Math. 315 Advanced Applied

Phys. 201 Mechanics 3 Mathematics I 3

Phys. 219— Electricity and Magnetism __ 3 Phys. 305— Light 3

Advanced physics laboratory 2 Phys. 220 Electricity and

Social science or humanities 3 Magnetisna 3

Electives** 2 Advanced physics laboratory 2

Social science and humanities 3

Electives** 2

Senior Program

Phys. 314 Modern Spectroscopy 3 Phys. 352— Quantum Mechanics 3

Phys. 349 Atomic and Nuclear 3 Phys. 350 Atomic and Nuclear 3

Phys. 310 Heat and Thermodynamics 3 Phys. 361 Special Problems in

Advanced physics laboratory 2 Physics . 1

Electives** 5 Phys. 365^Nuclear Reactor Theory

and Practice 3

Electives**

PREPARATION FOR DENTISTRY

The minimum requirement for admission to dental school is the completion of at least 60 semester hours of college work which must include general chemistry, organic chemistry, physics, zoology, and English. A broad training in courses other than natural science is urged. Predental students have the same degree-in-absentia privileges as pre- medical students (see page 108).

♦See University College requirements. **See requirements for Bachelor of Science degree.

The College of Arts and Sciences 105

The following sequence of courses is recommended. The require- ments pertaining to English composition, physical education and speech are not indicated in the curriculum below. See pages 68 and 76.

Freshman Program

The University College Program should include:

Hours Hours

Chem. 3-4, 99 General and Zool. 3-4 Principles of 6

Qual. Analysis 9 Requirements and/or electives*

Math. 9 Fundamentals of 3

Sophomore Program

Chem. 113 Organic 4 Zool. 120 Comparative Vertebrate

Chem. 117 Organic Chemistry Anatomy 4

Laboratory 2 Zool. 311- General Bacteriology*** 4

Phys. 5, 6 Introduction to 8 Requirements and/or electives**

Zool. 107— Prin. of Heredity 3

Junior Program

Phil. 110— Introd. to 3 Zool. 301— Mammalian Anatomy*** 4

or Zool. 305 Principles of Physiology 4

Phil. 209 Logic 3 Requirements and/or electives**

PREPARATION FOR FORESTRY

The curriculum outlined may be followed, and by meeting the re- quirements of the College of Arts and Sciences, the Bachelor of Arts or Bachelor of Science degree may be earned.

Freshman Program

The University College Program should include :

Hours Hours

Agr. 1 or 2 Intro, to 3 Bot. 3-4 ^General 6

or Math. 5 Freshman 5

Agr. 30 Forestry 3 Requirements and/or electives*

Sophomore Program

Bot. 117^Dendrology 3 Phys. 5 Introduction to 4

Chem. 1-2 General 8 Zool. 3-4 Principles of 6

C. E. 10 Plane Surveying 3 Requirements and/or electivesf

Geol. 106— Agricultural 3

Junior and Senior Programs

All preforestry students should consult the preforestry adviser concerning course requirements in the junior and senior programs. These requirements will vary with the student's preparation, with the degree program the student elects to follow, and the field of concentration. It is recommended that appropriate selections from the following courses be included :

Agr. 216 Crops and Soils 4 Bot. 318— Wood Technolociy 3

Bot. 105— Elem. Plant Physiology 3 Bot. 324— Forest Pathology 3

Bot. 203 Plant Ecology 4 Zool. 216 Animal Communities 4

Bot. 211 Plant Anatomy 3 Zool. 219 General Entomology 4

*See requirements for University College (page 76). **See requirements for Bachelor of Arts or Bachelor of Science degree. ***Suggested.

tSee requirements for the Bachelor of Science degree.

106 Ohio University

PREPARATION FOR GOVERNMENT FOREIGN SERVICE

Students desiring to prepare for the government foreign service examinations, which are given twice yearly, are advised to concentrate their attention on those aspects of history, economics, and government which relate to world problems. Com-petency in some foreign language such as French, Spanish, German, or Russian is essential, in addition to superior command of English diction.

PREPARATION FOR LAV/

A student in the College of Arts and Sciences who plans to entei law school normally completes the specific requirements for the degree of Bachelor of Arts. No special curriculum is prescribed. The prelaw student may complete a major in the area of his principal interest. The student is advised to select courses from as many of the following as possible : English composition and literature and American literature ; history, with a preference for English and American history; govern- ment; economics; sociology; at least one laboratoi-y science and an addi- tional advanced course is advised; mathematics; philosophy; ethics; logic; accounting; psychology; and a foreign language, preferably Latin. Courses in speech and training in expression, as well as activities that develop the capacity for independent thought and action, are rec- ommended.

The Ohio Supreme Court has ruled that a student entering law school after January 1, 1960 must be able to show that he possesses an undergraduate degree from an approved college if he wishes to take the Ohio Bar Examination. Law schools in the state of Ohio are sup- plementing this Supreme Court ruling by requiring the degree of all entering students beginning in the fall of 1960, regardless of the state in which they plan to take the bar examination.

PREPARATION FOR MEDICAL TECHNOLOGY

Preparation in medical technology trains students in laboratory methods used in hospitals, physicians' offices, public health bureaus, and other laboratories concerned with medical diagnosis and investiga- tion.

Technologists who wish to be recognized by the American Society of Clinical Pathologists and entitled to use the initials, M.T., must have had a minimum of 60 semester hours of college work in a college or university recognized by the regional accrediting association, and a year's training in an approved school of medical technology.

The Ohio University Mount Carmel Hospital Affiliated Training for Medical Technologists fulfills these requirements and affords the student an opportunity to earn the bachelor's degree. After completing six semesters ( a minimum of 94 semester hours with a point-hour ratio of 2.0 or above in all hours attempted, including the major, and with

The College of Arts and Sciences 107

courses which meet degree requirements) at Ohio University, and while still registered in the University, prospective technologists spend twelve months in residence at Mount Carmel Hospital, Columbus, Ohio. Upon satisfactory completion of the University and hospital training require- ments, the student is eligible to receive from Ohio University the degree of Bachelor of Science and to take the qualifying examination given by the Board of Registry of the American Society of Clinical Patholo- gists for the professional designation of Medical Technologist. Credit toward the degree for the hospital training program is extended only in case all basic science courses which are required for admission to the Mount Carmel Hospital affiliated training program are completed previ- ous to the hospital residence.

The W. K. Kellogg Foundation of Battle Creek, Michigan, has granted the University the sum of $4,000 to be used as a loan fund for students during their year at Mount Carmel.f Expenses to be met during the year in Columbus are room rent and a small sum for books and laboratory gowns. No fees are charged by Mount Carmel Hospital, nor does it pay any remuneration except that it furnishes board.

The requirements pertaining to English, physical education and speech are not indicated in the curriculum below. See pages 68 and 76.

Freshman Program

The University College Program should include :

Hours Hours

Chem. 3-4, 99 General and Zool. 3-4 Principles of 6

Qual. Analysis 9 Requirements and/or electives*

Sophomore Program

Chem. 107 Quantitative Analysis 4 Zool. 107 Principles of Heredity 3

Chem. 113 Organic 4 Zool. 121 Elements of Anatomy 3

Chem. 117 Organic Chemistry Zool. 304 Histology 4

Laboratory 2 Zool. 311 General Bacteriology 4

Requirements and/or electives**

Junior Program

Phil. 110— Introduction to 3 Zool. 245 Clinical Technic 2

or Zool. 309 Biological Chemistry 4

Phil. 209— Logic 3 Zool. 312 Pathogenic Bacteriology 4

Zool. 225 Animal Microtechnic 1-2 Zool. 316 Animal Parasites 4

Zool. 235 Elements of Physiology 4 Requirements and/or electives**

Senior Program

Med. Tech. 291— Urinalysis 3 Med. Tech. 295— Histologic Technic 4

Med. Tech. 292— Hematology 5 Med. Tech. 296 Basal Metabolism and

Med. Tech. 293 Bacteriology, etc. 11 Electrocardiography 1

Med. Tech. 294— Chemistry S

PREPARATION FOR MEDICINE

Medical colleges require their prospective students to spend from six to eight semesters in premedical preparation. A number of medical colleges give preference to holders of a bachelor's degree and some re- quire the degree for admission.

*See requirements for University College (page 76) **See requirements for the Bachelor of Arts or the Bachelor of Science degree. tApplication for aid should be filed with Chairman, Department of Zoology.

108 Ohio University

For most colleges the requirements for admission include general chemistry, organic chemistry, physics, zoology, comparative anatomy, embryology and English. Courses in government, history, economics, sociology, philosophy, and literature are strongly advised. A year's course in mathematics (Math 5-6, or 9-10) is required by some and advised by most schools. A student who plans to complete only three years at Ohio University is advised to meet the degree requirements so as to be eligible for the degree in absentia privilege.

DEGREE IN ABSENTIA. Students who have completed 94 semester hours (six semesters) at Ohio University with a point-hour ratio of 2.0 or above, on all hours attempted, and have satisfied the requirements for the degree of Bachelor of Arts or Bachelor of Science may obtain the degree after completing a full year's work in an accredited school of medicine of the quality prescribed for the bachelor's degree at Ohio University, including advancement, without condition, to the second year of medical school, provided before entering the school of medicine, the student secures a statement in writing from the dean giving the senior-in-absentia privilege.

The following sequence of courses is recommended. The require- ments pertaining to English composition, physical education and speech are not indicated in the curriculum below. See pages 68 and 76.

Freshman Program

The University College Program should include:

Hours Hours

Chem. 3-4, 99 General and Math. 10 Fundamentals of 3

Qualitative Analysis 9 Zool. 3-4 Principles of 6

Math. 9 Fundamentals of 3 Requirements and/or electives*

Sophomore Program

Chem. 107- Quantitative Analysis 4 Zool. 107 Principles of Heredity 3

Gk 27— Greek Words in English^ 2 Zool. 120— Comparative Vertebrate

Phil. 110 Introduction to Anatomy 4

Philosophy 3 Requirements and/or electives**

or Phil. 209— Logic 3

Junior Program

Chem. 113 Organic 4

Chem. 201-202— Organic 6 and

and Chem. 117 Organic Chemistry

Chem. 203-204 Organic Chemistry Laboratory 2

'Laboratory 4 Phys. 5, 6 Introduction to 8

or Requirements and/or electives**

Senior Program

Chem. 211— Physical! 3 Zool. 305— Principles of Physiologyf 4

Zool. 301 Mammalian Anatomyf 4 Zool. 311 General Bacteriology^ 4

Zool. 302 Vertebrate Embryologyf 4 Requirements and/or electives**

*See requirements for University College (page 76) **See requirements for the Bachelor of Arts or the Bachelor of Science degree. ■[Students leaving at the end of the third year should elect this in the third year. ^Suggested.

The College of Arts and Sciences 109

PREPARATION FOR NURSING

Education for nursing has come to fall into three categories: (1) the hospital school of nursing which requires no training beyond high school for admission, (2) the college school of nursing which is either a combined four-year program in which a limited amount of liberal edu- cation is combined with the training for nursing and leads to the Bache- lor of Science in Nursing degree, or (3) a program in which a minimum of two years of college work is required for admission and then upon the completion of nurses training, the Bachelor of Science in Nursing degree is awarded.

In present day society, a broad education, with a reasonable degree of specialization, is generally regarded as being the most valuable for life, so that an Ohio University student interested in nursing is advised to complete requirements for either the Bachelor of Arts or Bachelor of Science degree and then to complete nurses training in an approved program. In many cases the length of time required for the hospital training is shortened as a result of the student having completed the college degree.

The curriculum to be followed in such a program should include courses which provide a scientific background for nursing. The following curriculum will lead to either the A.B. or B.S. degree, and if only part of the program is completed, will prepare a student for admission to a nursing program which requires less preparation than the college degree. No credit is extended by Ohio University for work completed in a nursing program except in a collegiate school of nursing.

Freshman Program The University College Program should include:

Hours (Hours

Chem. 3-4, 99 General and Psych. 5 Educational 3

Qualitative Analysis 9 Zool. 3-4 Principles of 6

Psych. 1 General 3 Requirements and/or electives*

Sophomore Program

Chem. 113 Organic 4 H. Ec. 1-2 Foods, Nutrition and

Chem. 117 Organic Chemistry Meal Planning 6

Laboratory 2 Soc. 101 Principles of 3

Eng. 101, 102— Soph. Eng. Literature Zool. 107 Principles of Heredity 3

or Zool. 121 Elements of Anatomy S

Eng. Ill, 112 Chief American Writers 3-6 Zool. 311 General Bacteriology 4

Requirements and/or electives**

Junior Program

Phil. 110— Introduction to 3 Zool. 235— Elements of Physiology 4

or Zool. 312 Pathogenic Bacterology' 4

Phil. 209 Logic 3 Requirements and/or electives**

Psych. 310 Mental Hygiene 3

Senior Program

Requirements and/or electives** ♦See requirements for University College (page 76) •*See requirements for Bachelor of Arts or Bachelor of Science degree. 'Suggested.

110 Ohio University

PREPARATION FOR OCCUPATIONAL THERAPY

Colleges offering programs in Occupational Therapy require two years of college work in preparation for the two years of professional work leading to the degree. The first two years may be taken at Ohio University, after which transfer can be made to another institution where the work will be completed and the degree conferred.

The first two years of college should include English 3-4 and six hours of literature; Chemistry 1-2 or Physics 5, 6; physical education; psychology, 6 hrs.; sociology, 6 hrs.; Zoology 3, 4 and 107. The remainder of the credit to complete the minimum of 60 hours may be elected from education, foreign language, science, etc. The particular requirements of the school to which the student may wish to transfer should be fol- lowed in planning the program at Ohio University.

Further information relative to requirements and the profession of Occupational Therapy may be obtained by writing the American Occupational Therapy Association, 250 West 57th Street, New York 19, N.Y.

PREPARATION FOR OPTOMETRY

The requirements for admission to schools of optometry are not identical. A minimum of two years of college work is required and should include the following courses: English 3-4; Chemistry 1-2; for- eign language (the requirement must be determined from the particular school the student wishes to attend); humanities; Mathematics 5-6, 101-102; physical education; Physics 5, 6 or 113, 114; and Zoology 3-4 and 107. Total hours to make a minimum of 64 should include electives from literature, philosophy and psychology, if these have not been selected in the above outlined courses.

Further information relative to requirements and the profession of optometry may be obtained by writing to the American Optometric Association, Department of Public Information, 4030 Chouteau Avenue, St. Louis 10, Missouri.

PREPARATION FOR PHARMACY

Most schools of pharmacy require two years (minimum of 60 semes- ter hours) of prescribed college courses. The following program will meet these entrance requirements.

Freshman Program

Hours Hours

Biol. 1-2 Living World 6 Humanities and/or social science 6

or Math. 9 ^Fundamentals of 3

Zool. 3-4 Principles of 6 Math. 10 Fundamentals of 3

Chem. 3-4, 99 General and Physical Education 2

iQualitative Analysis 9 Speech 1 1

Eng. 3-4 English Composition 6

Sophomore Program

Chem. 107 Quantitative Analysis 4 Econ. 10-11 Principles of 6

Chem. 201-202 Organic 6 Humanities and/or social science 3

Chem. 208-204— Organic Chemistry Phys. 5, 6^— Introduction to 8

Laboratory 4

'Not required but suggested.

The College of Arts and Sciences 111

PREPARATION FOR PHYSICAL THERAPY

The following program extending over a period of three years at Ohio University is recommended to those students who wish to enter the field of physical therapy. Upon completion of 94 semester credit hours, if a scholastic average of 2.0 or better on all hours attempted has been maintained, the student is eligible for admission to a school of physical therapy fully accredited by the American Medical Association. An insti- tution affiliating in this program is the Frank E. Bunts Educational Institute of the Cleveland Clinic Foundation, Cleveland, Ohio, which offers a 14-month course in physical therapy. Upon satisfactory comple- tion of the three-year program at Ohio University, including degree requirements, and the course in physical therapy, Ohio University will award the student the bachelor's degree.

Freshman Program

Hours Hours Chem. 1-2 General 8 Psych. 1 General 3

Math. 9 Fundamentals of 3 Zool. 3-4 Principles of 6

Requirements and /or electives (a course in swimming is advised for the physical edu- cation requirement.)*

Sophomore Progrram

Psych. 103— Child 3 Zool. 107— Principles of Heredity 3

Soc. 101 Principles of 3 Zool. 241 Elementary Bacteriology 4

Zool. 133-134 Anatomy, Kinesiology Requirements and/or electives (Psych. 5,

and Physiology 8 Educational Psychology, is advised)**

Janior Program

Phil. 110— Intro, to 3 Zool. 304— Histology 4

or Zool. 308— Physiology of

Phil. 209 Logic 3 Exercise 2

Phys. 5,6 Intro, to 8

Requirements and/or electives (activity courses in physical education, and Sociology 204, Urban Communities, are advised)**

PREPARATION FOR SOCIAL WORK

The Department of Sociology is a member of the Council on Social Work Education and offers a limited sequence of courses for prepro- fessional training for social work in conjunction with a major in sociology. These courses also offer students preparing for medicine, law, teaching, and nursing an opportunity to become acquainted with the functions of social agencies which they will encounter frequently in their professional activities or as citizens.

At present there is a national need for professionally trained social workers. Generous financial assistance is available to enable qualified students to obtain a professional education at one of the many accredited graduate schools of social work throughout the nation. Students intend- ing to pursue a career in social work should plan to continue their

*See requirements for University College (page 76) **See requirements for Bachelor of Arts or Bachelor of Science degree.

112 Ohio University

preparation beyond the undergraduate level, and should Inquire regard- ing scholarships at the institution of their choice.

(1) Preparation for Professional Training. The undergraduate foundation for professional training at graduate schools of social work is a broad liberal arts education, with a concentration of studies in the social, psychological, and biological sciences. Students should elect sociology as their major field, with a minor or second major to be chosen in consultation with the departmental adviser.

(2) Preparation for Employment. Students who intend to seek employment in some phase of social work immediately upon completion of the A.B. degree should meet the requirements stated on page 288. Successful completion of these will assist in qualifying for appointment to certain positions in public welfare offices, children's institutions, Red Cross, YMCA, YWCA, Girl Scouts, and Boy Scouts. Admission to 300- level courses in social v/ork requires the specific consent of the instruc- tor based upon an individual conference prior to registration.

PREPARATION FOR TEACHING

A student pursuing either the Bachelor of Arts or Bachelor of Science degree may meet the special requirements in education for certi- fication to teach in the secondary schools in Ohio by completing the following :

Fsyeh. 5 Educational Psychology 3

Ed. 130 Secondary Education 3

Ed. 229 Curriculum and Teaching Practices 4

Ed. 287— Student Teaching Lab. 2

Or

A methods course 2-3

Ed. 281— Student Teaching 2-12

Total hours required 19-20

PREPARATION FOR THEOLOGY

No fixed sequence of courses is outlined for a student who wishes to enter a theological seminary. A broad general background is advised, with a major in philosophy or the social sciences suggested. A strong background in English is urged and courses in speech are particularly valuable. The student should check the entrance requirements of the theological seminary of his choice and plan his course to meet these requirements as well as the requirements for the Bachelor of Arts de- gree at Ohio University.

PREPARATION FOR VETERINARY MEDICINE

Schools of veterinary medicine require sixty semester hours of academic credit, exclusive of physical education and military science, for admission. The following program will meet such requirements.

The College of Arts and Sciences 113

Freshman Program

Hours Hours

Chem. 3-4,99 General and Speech 1 Fundamentals of 1

Qualitative Analysis 9 Zool. 3-4 Principles of 6

Eng. 3-4 Composition 6 Humanities and/or social science 8

Physical Education 2

Sophomore Program

Chem. 113 Organic 4 Zool. 107 Principles of Heredity 8

Chem. 114 Organic Chem. Laboratory 2 Humanities and/or social science to make

Math. 9-10— Fundamentals of 6 total of 32 hours

or Phys. 5,6 Introduction to 8

In addition to the above program, some schools require either farm experience or courses in agriculture, either of which must be arranged for and approved by the school of veterinary medicine. This additional requirement can be met in summers previous to enrollment or during the progress of the veterinary program.

PREPARATION FOR WORK IN JUVENILE DELINQUENCY AND CRIMINOLOGY

Police and court services and the supervision and training of juve- nile delinquents, young offenders, and criminals offer career positions for college graduates with special training in these fields. Preparation should be based upon the liberal arts subjects with concentration in the social sciences and in specialized courses in sociology and social work. By careful planning the student will be able to spend the second semester of his senior year as an intern in a court or correctional insti- tution and thus obtain experience which will assist him in qualifying for appointmient in one of the above fields. To qualify for positions in metropolitan courts, federal institutions, and newer branches of cor- rectional education, students should plan to complete the M.A. degree in sociology and social work. See the requirements for admission to the Graduate College, page 160. Admission to 300-level courses in crimi- nology and social work requires the specific consent of the instructors based upon individual conferences prior to registration.

THE COLLEGE OF COMMERCE

KARL H. KRAUSKOPF ACTING DEAN

Accounting

Advertising-MarlceHng

Agriculture

Business Law

Economics

Finance

Management

Secretarial Studies

Statistics

THE SCHOOL OF JOURNALISM

LOREN J. HORTIN

DIRECTOR

Advertising-Management Magazine Journalism News Writing and Editing Public Relations Radio-Television News

THE COLLEGE OF COMMERCE

Consistent with its character and history as a pioneer educational institution, Ohio University inaugurated courses in accounting and secretarial studies in 1893 at a time when few colleges and universities offered instruction in commerce or business administration. As the conception of collegiate training for business broadened, the oiferings were steadily expanded until today the College of Commerce oflFers com- prehensive programs of study in business and in economics which lead to the degree of Bachelor of Science in Commerce. The College is ac- credited by and is a member of the American Association of Collegiate Schools of Business.

The College also includes the Department of Agriculture, which offers programs of study leading to the degree of Bachelor of Science with a major in Agriculture, the Department of Secretarial Studies, which offers programs of study leading to the degree of Bachelor of Science in Secretarial Studies, and the School of Journalism, which offers theoretical and practical programs of study leading to the degree of Bachelor of Science in Journalism.

It is deemed as essential to teach students the art of living as it is to teach them how to earn a living. Further, it is a duty of every col- lege graduate to participate in and, if possible, to assume responsibility for intelligent leadership in civic, governmental, professional, and social activities of life. Every student in the College of Commerce, therefore, is required to take some courses offered by the other colleges of the Uni- versity in order to widen his scope of knowledge and interest.

Through a wise use of the elective hours given in all programs of

study in the College of Commerce, a student may stress an interest by choosing courses offered by any other college of the University. Such courses are open to students in the College of Commerce on the same basis as they are open to students in those colleges. The College of Commerce, in turn, aims to serve students enrolled in the other colleges of the University and admits them to its courses on the same basis as students registered in the College of Commerce.

The mutual relationship between the colleges whereby a student in one college may take courses in another gives a breadth of combi- nations in education which only a university can offer. The colleges of Education and Commerce, for example, cooperate in offering teaching majors in agriculture and commerce and the colleges of Applied Science and Commerce cooperate in offering industrial technology or an indus- trial option in mechanical engineering. However, it is impossible to set up predetermined curricula for each and every possible combination. For this reason, the College of Commerce stresses its faculty advisory system for students. Each student may choose as an adviser a member of the College of Commerce faculty who is a specialist in the student's field of interest. Student and adviser together then mold the skeletal outlines of courses into an integrated program of study best suited to the student's individual needs.

116

The College of Commerce 117

A candidate for a degree in the College of Commerce must complete the general university requirements for graduation which include a minimum of 124 semester hours with a point-hour ratio of 2.0 (C) on all hours attempted, but including only the final hours and points in repeated courses. This point-hour ratio requirement applies to his total record and to his major or equivalent as determined by the college. For a student with transferred credit, this rule applies to both his cumula- tive record, which includes transferred credits, and to his Ohio Univer- sity record exclusive of transferred credits.

BACHELOR OF SCIENCE WITH A MAJOR IN AGRICULTURE

The curriculum in agriculture is designed to provide the student with a broad, basic background in the areas of agriculture, business, and science. Persons completing the work for the degree are trained to take responsible positions in the various non-farming business and scien- tific phases of agriculture. This curriculum also provides opportunities for the student to achieve the basic skills and training necessary for farming and for advanced study in agriculture and business.

Considerable emphasis is stressed in the laboratory and classroom on the practical application of scientific techniques in farm operations. Opportunities for practical experience in all fields are provided in the greenhouse and on the Ohio University farm.

For a teaching major in agriculture see page 131. A Preforestry curriculum is offered in the College of Arts and Sciences. See page 105.

CURRICULUM IN AGRICULTURE

The university requirements pertaining to English composition, physical education, and speech are not indicated in the curriculum below. See pages 68 and 76.

Freshman Program

The University College Program should include :

First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

Agr. 1 Introduction to Agriculture* 3 Agr. 2 Introduction to Agriculture* 3

Ec. 11 Principles of Economics 3 Ec. 12 Principles of Economics 3

Sophomore Program

Chem. 1 General Chemistry 4 Chem. 2 General Chemistry 4

Acct. 75 Elementary Accounting 3 Acct. 76 Elementary Accounting 3

Bot. 3 General Botany 3 Bet. 4 General Botany 3

Agr. 30 Forestry 3 Geol. 106 Agricultural Geology 3

Commerce elective 3 Agriculture elective 3

Junior Program

Agr. 121 Livestock Management 4 Agr. 216 Crops and Soils 4

Mkt. 155 Marketing Principles 3 Fin. 101 Financial Institutions 3

Commerce elective 3 Agriculture elective 3

Science elective 3 Science elective 3

Senior Program

Agr. 201 Agricultural Practices 3 Ajrr. 202 Agricultural Practices 3

Agr. 217 Soil Conservation 3 Zoo!. 241 Elementary Bacteriology 4

Agr. 235 Farm Management 3 Agriculture elective 3

Speech 3 Public Speaking 2 Commerce elective 3

Commerce elective 3

*Not required for students who have had 3 years of vocational agriculture in high school

118 Ohio University

A minimum of eight hours of required agriculture electives must be selected from the following courses:

Agr. 1,2 Introduction to Agriculture 3,3 Agr. 320 Agricultural Organizations 3

Agr. 102 Gardening 3 Ind. A. 51 Farm Shop 3

Agr. 104 Fruit Production 3

A minimum of twelve hours of required commerce electives must be selected from the following courses:

Advt. 155 Advertising Principles 3 Mgt. 211 Industrial Management 3

B. L. 255-256 Business Law 3-3 Sec. St. 220 Business

Fin. 121 Corporation Finance 3 iCommunications 3

Advanced Economics 2-3 Stat. 155 Business Statistics 4

A minimum of 6 hours or required science electives may be selected from any laboratory science.

BACHELOR OF SCIENCE IN COMMERCE

All students following programs of study leading to the degree of Bachelor of Science in Commerce must take the basic subjects indicated in the freshman, sophomore, junior, and senior programs of the curricu- lum outline. The sequence of the courses introduces a logical develop- ment of the student's knowledge but it can be varied to fit his or her particular interest.

The core curriculum permits a maximum of elective hours through which the needs of each individual student may be met and his interests may be developed. There are only two limitations on the choice of elec- tive hours. They must be chosen so that no fewer than 54 semester hours required for graduation are in commerce and economics subjects, and no fewer than 47 semester hours are in subjects offered in other fields. This distribution of semester hours includes those earned in the Univer- sity College and the basic subjects listed in the curriculum outline. The second limitation on the choice of elective semester hours is that they must be approved by the Dean of the College or the student's faculty adviser. This approval safeguards the student's own best interests.

FIELDS OF SPECIALIZATION. It is felt that a student who follows a program of studies leading to the degree of Bachelor of Science in Commerce automatically has chosen a field of concentration. Further concentration, therefore, by way of a major is not required; however, additional specialization may prove desirable, especially when a student seeks employment, and it is recommended. Some of the fields which may be stressed are listed below. Others based on a student's particular interest may be developed.

ACCOUNTING General

General accounting International

Cost accounting Labor relations

Public (C.P.A.) accounting Public utilities

DISTRIBUTION FINANCE

Marketing Banking

Advertising Business finance

Retailing Investments

iSelling and sales management MANAGEMENT

ECONOMICS Personnel

Economic history Production

Economic theory PREPARATION FOR LAW SCHOOL

Business cycles STATISTICS

Detailed information about the possibilities of developing a special interest may be

obtained from the office of the Dean.

The College of Commerce 119

CURRICULUM IN COMMERCE

The university requirements pertaining to English composition, physical education and speech are not indicated in the curriculum below. See pages 68 and 76.

Freshman Program

The freshman program will be determined largely by the requirements of the University College.

The University College Program should include:

First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

Math. 3 Intermediate Algebra (3) or Math. 34 Mathematics of Finance 3

Math. 5 Freshman Mathematics (5) 3-5 Speech 3 Public Speaking 2

Ec. 11 Principles of Economics 3 Ec. 12 Principles of Economics _3

Acct. 75-76 Elementary Accounting, which is a curriculum requirement, is strongly recommended for the freshman year, especially for those students who plan to specialize in this field.

Sophomore Program

Acct. 75 Elementary Accounting 3 Acct. 76 ^Elementary Accounting 3

Mkt. 155 Marketing Principles 3 Fin. 101 Financial Institutions* 3

Stat. 155 Business Statistics* 4 Advt. 155 Advertising Principlest 3

Eng. 293 Sophomore Composition 3 Eng. Literature* 3

Electives 3 Electives 4

16 16

Jonior Program

Bus. L. 255 Business Law 3 Bus. L. 256 Business Law 3

Fin. 121 Corporation Finance* 3 Ec. (advanced) Elective* 2-3

Mgt. 211 Industrial Management* 3 Electives 11

Sec. St. 220 Business

Communications* 3 16-17

Electives 4

Senior Program

Electives 16 Electives 16

PREPARATION FOR LAW SCHOOL. A student in the College of Com- merce who plans to enter law school should follow the Bachelor of Science in Commerce degree curriculum and also elect, with the approval of his adviser, courses in other fields, especially American government, American and English history, English, philosophy, and speech.

A student who desires to enter a school of law at the end of three years of college work and receive the Bachelor of Science in Commerce degree from Ohio University after completing his first year in law school may do so, provided the following conditions are met: the student has the written approval of the dean of the College of Commerce; the requirements of the University College are met; a minimum of 94 approved semester hours, including the required courses in the Bachelor of Science in Commerce degree curriculum with the exception of Busi- ness Law 255-256, are completed with a point-hour ratio of 2.0 on all hours attempted (see page 117); and a full year's work in an accredited law school is completed with an average equivalent to that prescribed for the bachelor's degree at Ohio University, and the student is eligible for advancement without condition to the second year.

♦May be taken either semester. tMkt. 258 or 301 may be substituted.

120 Ohio University

PERSONNEL MANAGEMENT IN INDUSTRY. The College of Commerce has designed a field of specialization which will prepare the student for personnel-management v/ork either in industry or government service. Preparation in this field must be broadly based, and it is recommended that courses be selected on the advice and guidance of the faculty adviser from the offerings in the departments of Economics, Manage- ment, Secretarial Studies, Statistics, Government, Human Relations, Psychology, and Sociology.

OFFICE MANAGEMENT. Students interested in office management as an area of specialization should take the core curriculum for the Bache- lor of Science in Commerce degree as well as Office Management, Office Procedures, Office Machines, and Typewriting, In consultation with the faculty adviser, other courses should be selected from the following areas: accounting, management, psychology, sociology, government, speech, and mathematics,

RESTAURANT MANAGEMENT, Students interested in restaurant man- agement should take the core curriculum for the Bachelor of Science in Commerce degree plus courses in foods and nutrition selected with the advice and approval of the director of the School of Home Eco- nomics. In consultation with the faculty adviser, other courses should be selected from the following areas: accounting, government, manage- ment, psychology, and speech.

INDUSTRIAL TECHNOLOGY OR INDUSTRIAL OPTION IN MECHANICAL ENGINEERING. In recognition of the increasing need that executives in industry have a knowledge of and training in economics and business management, the College of Applied Science, in cooperation with the College of Commerce, offers two curricula, one leading to the degree of Bachelor of Science in Industrial Technology and the other leading to the degree of Bachelor of Science in Mechanical Engineering with an industrial option. These curricula are listed under the College of Applied Science.

BACHELOR OF SCIENCE IN SECRETARIAL STUDIES

The curriculum leading to the degree of Bachelor of Science in Secretarial Studies is designed to give the student: (1) high proficiency in the secretarial skills, (2) an understanding of the basic business areas, and (3) a well-rounded background in cultural subjects. Persons completing the work for the degree are trained to take responsible secretarial positions. Their technical skills and training also may be used as a stepping stone to other positions in business.

For those who enter without high school credit in typewriting and shorthand, the number of hours required in secretarial, commerce, and economics subjects is 68, and the minimum number of semester hours required in other fields is 50.

The College of Commerce 121

Students entering with high school credits in typewriting or short- hand should enroll in the advanced classes in these subjects. Whenever a student is unable to meet the prerequisite standard of achievement for the advanced courses in shorthand or typewriting, he may change to the beginning courses in these subjects. The hours of credit earned, however, will be added to the hours for graduation.

Special care is taken to enable students to secure carefully super- vised practice in the secretarial fields as a part of the curriculum. This practice includes the use of all representative office machinery and experience in using secretarial techniques under normal business office conditions.

During the student's final semester, he must take proficiency tests in shorthand, typewriting, and business procedures. These tests are similar in nature to those given in business for the selection of secre- tarial employees.

CURRICULUM IN SECRETARIAL STUDIES

The university requirements pertaining to English composition, physical education and speech are not indicated in the curriculum below. See pages 68 and 76.

Freshman Program

The freshman program will be determined largely by the require- ments of the University College.

The University College Program should include:

First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

Ec. 11 Principles of Economics 3 Ec. 12 Principles of Economics 3

Sec. St. 15 Beginning Typewriting 2 Sec. St. 16 Intermediate Typewriting 2

Sec. St. 31 Beginning Shorthand 3 Sec. St. 32 Intermediate Shorthand _ 3

Those students who enter with high school credit in typewriting and shorthand should postpone the advanced courses in these subjects until the sophomore year.

Sophomore Program \

Acct. 75 ^Elementary Accounting 3 Acct. 76 Elementary Accounting 3

Sec. St. 172 Filing Systems and Sec. St. Ill Advanced Typewriting 2

Procedures 1 Sec. St. 181 Office Procedures 2

Sec. St. 180— Office Machines 2 Advt. 155 Advertising Principles 3

Mkt. 155 Marketing Principles 3 Sec. St. 173 Machine Transcription 1

Psych. 1 General Psychology 3 Eng. Elective 3

Electives 4 Electives 2

16 16

Junior Program

Sec. St. 151 Beginning Dictation and Sec. St. 152 Advanced Dictation and

Transcription 3 Transcription 3

Fin. 101 Financial Institutions 3 Fin. 121 Corporation Finatce 3

Eng.— Electives 3 Sec. St. 285— Office Manager»ent 3

Electives 7 Electives 7

16 16

Senior Program

Bus. L. 255^Business Law 3 Bus. L. 256 Business Law 3

Sec. St. 220 Business Sec. St. 275 Secretarial Practice 3

Communications 3 Electives 10

Mgt. 211 Industrial Management (3)

Mgt. 312 Administration of Personnel 3 Electives 7

16

16

122 Ohio University

PREPARATION OF SECRETARIES FOR SPECIALIZED FIELDS. Students may prepare themselves to do secretarial work in specialized offices; such as legal, medical, governmental, educational, merchandising, or advertis- ing. These students follow the secretarial studies curriculum and, in addition, select courses from a prescribed group considered basic for training in the specialized field. Careful guidance in the selection of elective courses is given by the college adviser.

BUSINESS TEACHER TRAINING. Students trained to teach business subjects in the high school should be as well prepared in the basic busi- ness and technical subjects as those trained to enter business offices. In order to prepare students for effective teaching of business subjects, the College of Education in cooperation with the College of Commerce offers comprehensive majors in the business fields. These majors, which include bookkeeping-social business and business education (comprehensive), are outlined under the "College of Education," page 131.

Students preparing to teach are expected to meet the same stand- ards as those entering business, and are required to take proficiency tests in shorthand, in typewriting, and in business procedures during their last semester in school. These students are also given an oppor- tunity to apply their skills and knowledge through actual working experience.

BACHELOR OF SCIENCE IN JOURNALISM

The Ohio University School of Journalism is accredited by the American Council on Education for Journalism. It is one of a limited number of accredited schools and departments of journalism in the United States. As such, it is one of the members of the Amei'ican Asso- ciation of Schools and Departments of Journalism.

Journalism today is a profession like medicine, law, teaching, or engineering. It requires its practitioners to be culturally educated and professionally trained. Blending the liberal arts with professional courses, Ohio University journalism students take approximately two- thirds of their courses outside the professional school.

Five sequences are offered, all leading to the degree of Bachelor of Science in Journalism: Advertising-Management, Magazine Journal- ism, News Writing and Editing, Public Relations, and Radio-Television News. Along with these sequences, several specialized study areas are possible for example, scientific writing, religious journalism, or foreign correspondence. The master of science degree is also offered for work in journalism.

While working toward their degrees, students serve on the staff of the Athens Messenger, an independently-owned daily newspaper. The city editor, managing editor, and advertising manager are faculty members of the School of Journalism. The student staff members of the Messenger gather and write news, edit local and Associated Press copy, write headines, and prepare advertising copy and layouts. This training prepares students to take and hold jobs immediately after graduation.

The College of Commerce 123

Practical experience is also available in the University News Bu- reau, in the Photography Department, and in the journalism labora- tories. Many students also add to their experience by helping edit the Ohio University Post, daily newspaper, the Athena, the university year- book, and other campus publications.

In Radio-Television News, students get practical experience in pre- paring and broadcasting news over the University's AM and FM sta- tions, WOUB and WOUI, and in the University's television studios. The United Press radio news teletype service is available for journalism students in this sequence.

INTERNSHIP PROGRAM. Consistent with its policy of combining class- work with practical training, the School of Journalism has inaugurated a Journalism Internship Program. Juniors or seniors who have ranked high in their courses are eligible for appointment as interns. The pe- riod of internship is ten weeks or more during the summer. The intern is provided with as varied experience in practical journalism as possible. The intern will be paid a moderate sum for his work and study. No credit will be granted for internship work itself. However, upon comple- tion of the internship period, a student is permitted to enroll the follow- ing semester in Journalism 370 Internship, 3 hours credit. The selection of the interns is made by the Director of the School of Journalism.

CURRICULA AND REQUIREMENTS IN JOURNALISM

Not more than 40 hours in the School of Journalism may be counted in the 124 hours required for graduation. Not more than 12 additional hours may be counted in any one of the following departments: Adver- tising, Photography, Radio.

Journalism students must take a group of courses specifically selected to serve as a background for journalism. These courses should include at least 20 hours of courses numbered 200 and above in other social sciences, humanities, or natural sciences. But students may, with the approval of the director, substitute up to 18 hours of courses in agriculture, commerce, home economics, education, engineering, or other fields to permit a background for specialized reporting in the chosen field.

Non-Journalism courses required of all students include :

Hours

English Composition 6 Speech 1-5

Literature (above freshman) 6 Foreigrn Lang\iages or Humanities 3-8*

Economics 6 Mathematics 3-6*

Psychology _ 3 Natural Sciences 3-6*

Sociology 3 Physical Education 2

Government 3 Typewriting 2*

History 6

Other non-journalism courses are required, but they are not the same for all sequences. See individual sequences for listing. ♦Depending upon high school deficiency.

124 Ohio University

FRESHMAN PROGRAM

Freshmen should meet the requirements of the University and the University College in English Composition, Speech, Physical Education, and a year's work in each of two of the following groups: Humanities, Mathematics, Natural Sciences, and Social Sciences. In selecting the groups, the student must conform to the specific requirements based upon high school deficiencies, if he has any. He should plan his program for the freshman year to include the following courses:

Sec. St. 15 Typewriting (2), unless he can operate a typewriter by the touch system.

Hist. 1,2 Western Civilization in Modern Times (6)

Psych. 1 General Psychology (3)

All students except those expecting to enter the Advertising- Management sequence should take F. A 17 Introduction to Fine Arts (3), or two semesters of a foreign language. Students preparing for Advertising-Management will find it advantageous to take Ec. 11-12 Principles of Economics (6) in their freshman year and may, if neces- sary, have the requirement in History delayed to permit scheduling of the Economics course. Acct. 75-76 Elementary Accounting (6) also may be taken in the freshman year.

If a student chooses to fulfill his group requirements with science, he should take Eiol. 1-2— The Living World (6), or Phys. Sci. 3,4— The Physical World (6).

ADVERTISING-MANAGEMENT

Sophomore Program

(Hours -Hours

Acct. 75 Elementary Accounting 3 Jour. 146 Typography, Mechanics, and

Advt. 155 Advertising Principles 3 Makeup 3

Jour. 107 Newspaper Reporting 3 Mkt. 155 Marketing Principles 3

Students interested in Management training will take in addition:

Acct. 76 Elementary Accounting (3) and Jour. 105 History of American Journalism (3).

Junior Program

Jour. 217 Newspaper and Magazine Jour. 247 Newspaper Advertising and

Editing 3 [Layout 3

Advertising students will take these courses:

Advt. 286 Retail Advertising 3 Jour. 348 Advertising Production 2

Jour. 309 Radio-TV Advertising and

Management 3

Management students will take these courses:

Bus. L. 255 Business Law 3 Mgt. 211 Industrial Management 3

Jour. 251 Contemporary Thought and

Developments 3

Senior Program

Jour. 277 Newspaper Advertising Jour. 306— Newspaper and

DPractice 2 each semester Communications Law 3

Jour. 343 Newspaper Management 2

Advertising students also will take Advt. 332 Copy Writing (2).

Management students also will take Psych. 231 Employee Selection and Placement (2).

Electives should include an advanced Economics course.

The College of Commerce 125

MAGAZINE JOURNALISM

Sophomore Program

Hours Hours

Ec. 11-12 Principles of Economics 6 Jour. 105 History of American

Eng. 101, 102 Sophomore English Journalism 3

Literature or Jour. 107 Newspaper Reporting 3

Eng. Ill, 112 Chief American Writers Jour. 146 Typography, Mechanics,

(total of 6) and Makeup 3

Soc. 1 General Sociology 3

Junior Program

Eng. 290 Creative Writing 3 Jour. 251 Contemporary Thought and

Jour. Ill Reporting Practice 2 Developments 3

Jour. 217 Newspaper and Jour. 329 Business and Magazine

Magazine Editing 3 Journalism 2

Jour. 230 Reviewing and Photog. 133 Basic News Photography 3

iCriticism 2

Senior Program

Jour. 221 Editing Practice 2 or Jour. 322 Feature and Magazine

Photog. 145 Workshop in Writing 8

Photography 3 Jour. 323 Advanced Feature and

Jour. 306 Newspaper and Magazine Writing 2

Communications Law 2

NEWS WRITING AND EDITING

Sophomore Program

Hours Hours

Ec. 11-12 Principles of Economics 6 Jour. 146 Typography, Mechanics,

Jour. 105 History of American and Makeup 3

Journalism 3 Radio-TV 79 Introduction to

Jour. 107 Newspaper Reporting 3 Radio-TV 2

Soc. 1- General Sociology 3

Junior Program

Advt. 1B5 Advertising Principles 3 Jour. 251 Contemporary Thought and

Jour. Ill Reporting Developments 3

Practice (2 each semester) Photog. 133 Basic News Photography 3

Jour. 217 Newspaper and Magazine

Editing S

Senior Program

Jour. 221 Editing Practice 2 Jour. 307 Reporting of Public

Jour. 306 Newspaper and Affairs 2

(Communications Law 2 Jour. 825 The Editorial Page 2

Jour. 343 Newspaper Management 2

PUBLIC RELATIONS

Sophomore Program

Hours iHours

Advt. 155 Advertising Principles 3 Jour. 107 Newspaper Reporting 3

Ec. 11-12 Principles of Economics 6 Jour. 146 Typography, Mechanics, and

Jour. 105 History of American Makeup 3

Journalism 3 Soc. 1 General Sociology 3

Junior Program

Jour. Ill Reporting Practice 2 Photog. 133 Basic News Photography 3

Jour. 217 Newspaper and Magazine Psych. 315 Social Psychology 3

Editing 3 Radio-TV 79— Introduction to

Jour. 251 Contemporary Thought and Radio-TV 2

Developments 3 Speech 3 Public Speaking 2

126 Ohio University

Senior Program

Advt. 332 Copy Writing 2 Jour. 329 Business and Magazine

H. R. 303— Human Relations 3 Journalism 2

Jour. 306 Newspaper and Jour. 348 Advertising Production 2

Communications Law 2 Psych. 341 Psychology of

Jour. 327 Public Relations Techniques 3 Communications 3

Jour. 328 Public Relations 3 Soc. 336 Public Opinion and Mass

Communications 3

The course in Human Relations and the advanced courses in Psychology and Sociology listed above are a partial fulfillment of the requirement that students must take at least 20 hours of courses numbered 200 and above in departments other than journalism, advertising, and radio.

RADIO-TELEVISION NEWS

Sophomore Program

Hours Hours

Ec. 11-12 Principles of Economics 6 Radio-TV 79 Introduction to

Jour. 107 Newspaper Reporting 3 Radio-TV 2

Photog. 133— Basic News Photography— 3 Radio-TV 180— Radio Speech 8

Speech 2 Voice and Articulation 2

Jnnior Program

Advt. 155 Advertising Principles 3 Jour. 280 Radio-TV News Writing and

Jour. Ill Reporting Practice 2 ^Editing 2

Jour. 251 Contemporary Thought and Radio-TV 301 Principles of

Developments 3 TV Production 3

Senior Program

Jour. 285 Radio-TV News Jour. 306 Newspaper and

Practice 4 Communications Law 2

Jour. 303— TV News Production 3 Jour. 309— Radio-TV Advertising and

Management 3

THE COLLEGE OF EDUCATION

F. N. HAMBLIN

DEAN

Elementary Education

Secondary Education

Guidance and Counseling

Teaching Special Subjects

School Adnninistration and Supervision

Library Science

Research and Scientific Techniques

History and Philosophy of Education

Student Teaching

Center for Educational Service

Teaching Certificates

THE COLLEGE OF EDUCATION

The College of Education is devoted to the education of men and women who intend to enter the fields of teaching and educational ad- ministration. A wide range of programs prepares students for teaching in elementary schools, high schools, and colleges; for positions as super- visors, school principals, or superintendents; and for such specialized educational work as that of the guidance counselor or school psycholo- gist.

All these programs include a broad base of general education, in- tensive preparation in the subjects to be taught, and professional em- phasis and focus which combine educational theory with actual practice in meeting the responsibilities of the profession. Each program is thus designed to prepare students to enter the profession possessing the liberal background, the functional knowledge, and the professional un- derstanding and skill which are requirements for professional success.

The College of Education is accredited by the National Council for Accreditation of Teacher Education, and is approved for teacher train- ing by the State of Ohio Department of Education.

BACHELOR OF SCIENCE IN EDUCATION

The degree, Bachelor of Science in Education, represents the com- pletion of a program designed to develop in the student competence in three areas: in the broad awareness of the principal academic fields developed through a true university education; in the deeper study of the particular studies in which the student seeks the undergraduate mastery necessary for teaching these subjects; and in the understanding of the professional responsibilities of teaching, and demonstrated skill in meeting them.

The degree is granted upon completion of the general graduation requirements of the University, including a minimum of 124 semester hours with a point-hour ratio of 2.0 (C) on all hours attempted, but including only the final hours and points in repeated courses, and in addition this same point-hour ratio on one of the approved programs in the College of Education. For a student with transferred credit, this rule applies to both his cumulative record, which includes transferred credits, and to his Ohio University record exclusive of transferred credits. These programs are of four main types:

Elementary Education. This program prepares for teaching in kin- dergarten, primary, or intermediate grades, with specialization in one of these groups.

Secondary Education. This program prepares for teaching any of the academic fields in high school. Students planning to teach at the secondary school level will ordinarily be prepared in one or more minor teaching subjects, in addition to their major field. Such minors should be carefully selected in consultation with the student's adviser, in the light of the student's interests and abilities. (See outlines for the majors be- ginning on page 130.)

128

The College of Education 129

Teaching Special Subjects. Such special subjects as art, home eco- nomics, industrial arts, music, physical education, speech, and speech and hearing therapy are ordinarily not limited to any grade level. Stu- dents who major in these subjects will be prepared to teach their specialty in both elementary and high school.

ELEMENTARY EDUCATION

The following program includes all requirements, except those established by deficiencies in the high school pattern, for students who plan to specialize in elementary education.

Psych. 1 General Psychology 3 Govt. 106 Current Political and Social

Psych. 5 Educational Psychology 3 Problems or

Eng. 3-4 English Composition 6 See. Sci. 10 Citizenship in the

Eng. Ill or 112 Chief American Modern World 2-3

Writers 3 Social science elective 3-4

Speech 1 Fundamentals of Speech 1 Ed. 102 Literature for Children 3

Physical education 2 Ed. 103— Studies of Children 3

P.E. 102 Personal and Community Ed. 165 Teaching Arithmetic in the

Health 3 Elementary School 3

P.E. 270 Teaching of Physical Ed. 163 Teaching Reading and Lang-

'Education 1 uage in the Elementary School 3

Mus. 72 Music Fundamentals 2 Eki. 169 Teaching Social Studies and

Mus. 266 Teaching of Music in Science in the Elementary

Elementary Grades 2 School 3

Art 3 Elementary Design for Ed. 210 Student Teacher Laboratory 3

Teachers 2 Ed. 272— Student Teaching in the

Art 160 Practical Design Workshop Elementary Grades 7

for Elementary Teachers 3 E. 211— The Child and the Cur- Select from following: 9 riculum 3

Biol. 1-2— The Living World Ed. 277— Field Experience in Student

Phys. Sci. 3-4 The Physical Teaching 2

World Electives in education 2

Hist. 1, 2— Western Civilization in Mod- Ed. 101 Materials and Methods in

ern Times 6 Kindergarten Primary

Hist. 102— History of the United Education 2

States 3 [Required of Kindergarten - Primary

Geog. 150 Geography and Environment 3 majors]

Electives to total 124 semester hrs, for graduation.

Kindergarten-Primary Education. A student majoring in Elemen- tary Education may receive the kindergarten-primary certificate by com- pleting the general pattern of the elementary curriculum as shown above. Student teaching must be done on the kindergarten-primary level and specialized courses in theory, materials, and methods of kinder- garten-primary education must be taken as indicated by the adviser.

SPECIAL CADET PROGRAM

To assist in meeting the critical shortage of elementary teachers, Ohio University will tentatively continue to offer a special two-year program. The four-year provisional "cadet" certificate is granted upon the satisfactory completion of this accelerated course. Only those high school graduates who are superior both in academic aptitude and in social maturity, are encouraged to enter this program, which should be pursued in four successive regular semesters. The provisional cadet certificate may be renewed only upon completion of 24 semester hours of additional credit applicable to the degree in elementary education.

130 Ohio University

The program for the Cadet Provisional Certificate is as follows:

Freshman Proirram

First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

Eng. 3 English Composition 8 Eng. 4 English Composition 3

Hist. 1 or 2 Western Civilization Ed. 102 Literature for Children 3

in Modern Times 3 Biol. 2 The Living World 8

Biol. 1 The Living World 3 Mus. 72 Music Fundamentals 2

Psych. 1— General Psychology 3 Hist. 101 or 102— History of the

Speech 1 Fundamentals of Speech 1 United States 3

Art 160 Practical Design Workshop P. E. 102 Personal and Community

for Elementary Teachers 2 Health 8

P. E. Physical education 1

Sophomore Program

Ed. 103 Studies of Children 3 Ed. 169— Teaching of Social Studies

Ed. 163 Teaching of Reading and and Science in the Elementary

'Language 3 'School 8

Ed. 165 Teaching of Arithmetic in Ed. 210 Student Teaching Laboratory 3

the Elementary School 8 Ed. 272 Student Teaching in the Ele-

Mus. 266 Teaching of Music in mentary Grades 7

Elementary Grades 2 Electives 2

Geog. 150 Geography and Environment 3

SECONDARY EDUCATION

The following are the general requirements for all students in the College of Education who plan to specialize in the teaching of the academic subjects in the secondary school.

1. Psychology 6

Psych. 1 General Psychology

Psych. 5 Educational Psychology 3

2. Education 16-17

Ed. 130 Secondary Education 3

Ed. 229 Curriculum and Teaching Practices 4

Ed. 281 Observation and Student Teaching in High School 7

Ed. 287 Student Teaching Laboratory or

Methods in Major 2-3

3. English 12

Eng. 3-4 English Composition 6

Eng. 101 or 102 Sophomore English Literature and

Eng. Ill or 112— The Chief American Writers 6

4. Humanities (Fine or Applied Arts or Philosophy) 6

5. Mathematics (as required by University College)

6. Military Science (See page 70.)

7. Physical Education (See page 70.) 2

8. Natural Science 6-8

(One year in one field): biology, botany, zoology; chemistry, physics, geology.)'

9. Social studies 12

History 101 or 102 History of the United States 3

Economics, sociology, geography, government, or

Social Science 9 or 10 3

Social science electives 6

10. Speech 1 Fundamentals of Speech 1

11. Elective approved by adviser 2-3

The College of Education 131

Specialization requirements for a major in academic high school subjects.

Asricoltare

Select 27 semester hours in agriculture :

Agr. 1, 2 Introduction to Agriculture _ 6 Agr. 216 Crops and Soils 4

Agr. 30 Forestry 3 Agr. 217 Soil Conservation S

Agr. 102 Gardening 3 Agr. 235 Farm Management 3

Agr. 104 Fruit Production 3 Geol. 106 Agricultural 3

Agr. 121 Livestock Management 4 Ind. A. 51 Farm Shop 8

Agr, 201, 202, Agricultural Practices _ 6

Biological Science

Bot. 3-4— General Botany 6 Bot. 203— Plant Ecology (4)

Any three of the following courses Bot. 212 Plant Microtechnique (3)

or groups of courses: 9-10 Zool. 3-4 Principles of Zoology 6

Bot. 105 Elementary Plant Any three of the following courses: 9-10

Physiology (3) Zool. 107— Principles of Heredity (3>

Bot. 106— Local Flora (3) or Zool. 113— Biology of Vertebrates (4>

Bot. 117— Dendrology (3) 'Zool. 118— Ornithology (3)

Bot. 123 Introduction to the Zool. 121 Elements of Anatomy (3)

Fungi (3) Zool. 216 Animal Communities (4)

Bot. 173— Elementary Plant Zool. 219 General Entomology (4)

Morphology (3) or Zool. 235 Elements of Physiology (4>

Bot. 211 Plant Anatomy (3)

Commerce Bookkeepingr-Basic Business

Acct. 75-76 Elementary Accounting 6 Mkt. 271 Principles of Personal

Acct. 125 Intermediate Accounting 3 Selling 2

Bus. L. 255-256 Business Law 6 Fin. 101 Financial Institutions 8

Ec. 11-12 or 101-102— Principles of Sec. St. 261— Teaching of Business

Economics 6 Subjects 8

Geog. 15 Economic Geography 3 Electives in commerce 6

Sec. St. 180— Office Machines 2 ;(Suggested: Sec. St. 15, 16

Mgt. S^Introduction to Business . 3 Typewriting)

Mkt. 155 Marketing Principles 3

Commerce Business Education

Acct, 75-76 Elementary Accounting 6 See, St. 152 Advanced Dictation and

Adv. 155 Principles of Advertising 3 Transcription 3

Bus. L. 255 Business Law 3 Sec, St. 172 Filing Systems and

Mgt. 3 Introduction to Business 3 Procedures 1

Ec. 11-12 Principles of Economics 6 Sec. St. 173 Machine Transcription 1

Mkt. 155 Principles of Marketing 3 Sec. St. 180 Office Machines 2

Sec. St. 15 Beginning Typewriting 2 Sec. St. ISl Office Procedures 2

Sec. St. 16 Intermediate Typewriting _ 2 Sec. St. 220 Business Communications _ 3

Sec. St. 31 Beginning Shorthand 3 Sec. St. 275 Secretarial Practice 3

Sec. St. 32— Intermediate Shorthand __ 3 Sec. St. 28.5— Office Management 3

Sec. St. Ill Advanced Typewriting 2 Sec. St. 261 Teaching of Business

Sec, St. 151 Beginning Dictation 'Subjects 3

and Transcription 3

Earth Science

Geog. 3-4 Elements of Phys. Geog. ; Geog. 232 Conservation of Natural

World Regional Geog. (6) or Resources 3

Geog. 150 Geography and Environment Geol. 1-2 Elements of Geology 6

(3) 3-6 Geol. 111-112— Historical Geology 4

Geog. 175 Fundamentals of Meteor- Geol. 223 Principles of Geomorphology _ 3

ology 3 Electives in geography or geology to

Geog. 202 Geography of the United make 34 sem. hrs.

States and Canada 3

English

Eng. 3-4 English Composition 6 Eng. 264 Teaching of High School

Eng. 101 or 102 Sophomore English English 3

Literature and Eng. 293 Sophomore Composition 8

Eng. Ill or 112 The Chief American Additional electives suggested from the

Writers 6 fields of library science, dra-

Eng. Approved electives (preferably matic arts, speech correction,

on 300 level) 16 or journalism.

Elective in library science 2-3

132

Ohio University

Fr. 1-2 Beginning French

Fr. 101-102 Intermediate French

French

. 8 Fr. Approved electives

German

Ger. 1-2 Beginning German 8

Ger. 101-102— Intermediate German 8

Ger. 209-210 German Grammar and

Composition 4

Ger. ^Approved electives 10

History and Goyemment

Govt. 1, 2 American Government 6 Hist. 101, 102 History of the United

Hist. 1, 2 Western Civilization in States 6

Modern Times 6 Approved electives :

Hist. 269— Teaching of Social Studies History 6

in Junior and Senior High Government or history 4

Schools 2

Latin

Lat. 101 Latin Review and Reading 4

Lat. 102— Vergil 4

Lat. 151 Familar Essays 3

Lat. 152 Horace and Terence 3

Lat. 331 The Life of the Romans 2

Lat. 333 Advanced Latin Syntax 2

Lat. and Gk. Approved electives 10

Library Science

Minor for certification for teacher-librarians includes 16 hours from the following:

Ed. 102— Lit. for Children 3

Lib. Sci. 191— History of Libraries and

The Use of Library Resources _ 3

Lib. Sci. 192 Classification and Cata- loging of Books 3

Lib. Sci. 194 History of Books and

Printing 3

Lib. Sci. 202 Books for High School

Lib. Sci. 291— The~¥chToT~Lrbrary~-~~ 8 Lib. Sci. 393 Administrative Problems

4n a School Library 8

Mathematics

Math. 5, 6 Freshman Mathematics ; Astron. 11 or 12 Elementary

Analytic Geometry and Calculus Astronomy (3)

T 10 Math. 34 Mathematics of Finance (8)

Math. 101— Analytic Geometry and Math. 107 Elementary Statistics (3)

Calculus II 4 Math. 301 Theory of Equations (3)

Math. 102 Analytical Geometry and Math. 317 Introduction to Modern

Calculus III 4 Algebra (3)

Math. 104 College Geometry 3 Math. 268 Teaching of Mathematics

Ed. 263 Teaching of Arithmetic in In High School 2-8

the Upper Grades 3 Ed. 381 Educational Statistics 3

Select from following: 2-3

Physical Science

Chem. 3-4 General Chemistry or

Chem. 1-2— General Chemistry 8

Chem. 99 Qualitative Analysis 2

Chem. 107 Quantitative Analysis or Chem. 113 Organic Chemistry 4

Math. 5-6 Freshman Mathematics ; Anaylitic Geometry and Calculus I 10

Phys. 5, 6 Introduction to Physics or

Phys. 113-114— General Physics 8

Phys. 115 Modern Physics 3

Psychology*

Psych. 1 General Psychology 3 Psych. 209— Experimental Psy-

Psych. 5— Educational Psychology 3 chology (3)

Psych. 103 Child Psychology or Psych. 316 Psychology of Individual

Psych. 113 Psychology of Adolescence _ 2 Differences (2)

Psych. 303 Mental Measurements 3 Psych. 309 Motivation and Emo-

Psych. 310 Mental Hygiene 3 tions (3)

Psych. 320 Personnel and Vocational Psych. 319 Psychology of Person- Counseling 8 ality (3)

Psych, electives (to be chosen in con- iPsych. 406 An Introduction to sultation with a departmental Psychodiagnosis (3)

adviser and selected from the Psych. 353 Learning and Memory

following) : 12 (3)

Psych. 204 Psychology of Excep- Psych. 337 Counseling and tional Children (2) Psychotherapy (3)

•Persons selecting a psychology major will be expected to complete certification re- quirements in two high school subjects.

The College of Education 133

Science Comprehensive Major

Chemistry, Physics, Botany-Zoology, as Astronomy, geology, meteorology, or

approved by major adviser, mathematics, or excess course

with 20 semester hours in one worlc in above 9

of these sciences, and 8 semes- ter hours in each of the other two fields 36

Social Studies Comprehensive Major

See. Sci. 9 Citizenship in the Modern Hist. 101, 102 History of the

V/orld or United States 6

Soc. 1 General Sociology 3 Govt. 1 American Government 3

Hist. 1, 2 Western Civilization in Geog. 150 Geography and

Modern Times 6 Environment 3

Mgt. 3 Introduction to Business or Electives in history 9

Eg. 11 or 101 Principles of Economics _ 3 Additional electives in above

fields 12

Spanish

3p. 1-2- Beginning Spanish 8 Sp. Approved electives 14

Sp. 101-102— Intermediate Spanish 8

In addition to the majors described above, a student in the College of Education may arrange another major when such arrangements meet his needs. The student will be expected to meet the professional require- ments for certification, and qualify for certification in at least two teaching areas as described by the State Department of Education,

TEACHING SPECIAL SUBJECTS

The following are the general requirements for students in the College of Education who plan to specialize in the teaching of the special subjects. A special program for Speech and Hearing Therapy students will be found on page 136.

1. Psychology 6

Psych. 1 General Psychology 3

Psych. 5 Educational Psychology 3

2. Education* 14

Ed. 130 Secondary Education 3

Ed. 229- Curriculum and Teaching Practices 4

Ed. 281— Observation and Student Teaching in High School 7

Special Methods (See Major)

3. English 9

English 3-4 English Composition 6

English 101, 102, HI or 112 3

4. Humanities (Fine or Applied Arts or Philosophy

unless the requirement is met by the major) 6

5. Mathematics (as required by University College)

6. Military Science (See page 70.)

7. Physical Education (See page 70.) 2

8. Natural Science 6-8

(One year in one field) : Biology, Botany, Zoology ; Chemistry, Physics, Geology)

•Special methods in the subject to be taught are not included in the total.

134

Ohio University

9. Social Studies 9

History 101 or 102— History of the United States 3

Economics, sociology, geography, government, or

Social Science 9, 10 3

Social Science elective 3

10. Speech 1 Fundamentals of Speech 1

11. Elective approved by adviser 2-3

Specialization requirements for a major in special subjects;

Art

Hours

Art 1-2 Drawing and Design 6

Art 101-102 Drawing and Design 6

Art 21 Elementary Sculpture 2

Art 28 Figure Drawing 2

Art 103 Representation 3

Art 111 Drawing W^orkshop 2

Art 113— Lettering 3

Art 115 Ceramics 3

Art 118— Watercolor 3

Art 120— Textile Design 3

F. A. 121-122— History of Painting

and Sculpture 6

Art 123— Jewelry 2

Art 128 Advanced Figure Drawing 3

Hours

Art 137 Fashion Design 2

Art 205— Painting 2

Art 240 Design Applied to

Materials 2

Art 260— Teaching of Art 3

Art 271 Interior Design 8

Art 309— Prints 8

Photog. 77 Basic Photography 2

Either of the following:

Arch. 257 Fundamentals of

Residential Architecture 2

Arch. 375 Architecture in the

United States 2

Home Economics

H.

Ec.

H.

Ec.

H. H. H.

Ec. Ec. Ec,

H.

Ec.

H.

Ec.

H.

Ec.

H, H. H.

Ec. Ec. Ee.

1-2 Foods, Nutrition, and Meal

Planning 6

3-4 Clothing Selection and

Construction 4

5 Child Development 3

6 Family Living 3

7 The Home and Its

Furnishings 2

51 Orientation in Home

Economics 2

108 Consumer Problems of

the Family 2

161 Home Nursing and Family

Health 2

110— Textiles 2

125— Family Nutrition 3

172— Advanced Child

Development 2

H. Ec. 268— Teaching of Home

Economics 8

H. Ec. 316— Tailoring 3

H. Ec. 327— Quantity Cookery 3

H. Ec. 330— Workshop in Home

Furnishings 3

H. Ec. 334 Household Equipment 8

H. Ec. 351 Home Management 2

H. Ec. 353 Home Management

Laboratory 8

H. Ec. 368— Demonstration Tech- niques 2

Chem. 1-2 General Chemistry

(8) or Biol. 1-2— The Living World (6) or Zool. 3, 4— Principles of Zoology (6) __6-8 Art 1, 2 Drawing and Design (6) or

Art 91 Design and Composition (3) 3-6

Zool. 241 Elementary Bacteriology 4

Industrial Arts

Ind. A. 1, 2 General Woodworking

I, II 6

Ind. A. 9— Craft and Hobby Work 2

Ind. A. 11 Duplicating 3

Ind. A. 13 General Cold Metals 3

Ind. A. 14 General Hot Metals 3

Ind. A. 105 Materials and Finishes 3

Ind. A. 116 Constructive Design 2

Ind. A. 131 Intro, to Ceramics 2

Ind. A. 133— Practical Electricity 3

Ind. A. 134 Practical Power and

Transportation 3

Ind. A. 141— Printing 3

Ind. A. 260 Teaching of Industrial

Arts 8

Ind. A. 309 Administration of the

General Shop 8

Electives in Industrial Arts 6

E. D. 1 Engineering Drawing 2

E. D. 15 Industrial Arts Drawing 3

By taking the core courses listed and appropriate electives, a specialization in draw- ing, graphic arts, naetalworking, or woodworking may be developed.

The College of Education

135

Music General Supervision

Applied Music (16 hrs.) : P. A.

Mus. Voice (must include Mus.

completion of Voice 14) 4 Mus.

Mus. Piano (must include Mus.

completion of Piano 6) 4

Mus. Additional study in selected Mus.

fields of applied music 8

Mus. Chiorus 4 Mus.

Mus. Participation elective (Chorus,

Band, Orchestra) 4 Mus.

Mus. 3-4— Theory 6

Mus. 103-104— Dictation and Mus.

Sight Singing 4

Mus. 105-106 Harmony 6 Mus.

123-124— History of Music 6

201 Analysis and Form 2

233 Instrumentation 3

261 String Techniques

and Materials 2

263 Wind and Percussion

Techniques and Materials 2

267 Supei-vision of Music in

the Elementary School 3

268 Music in the Junior and

Senior High School 3

265 Vocal Techniques

and Materials 2

273 Conducting 2

Music Instrumental Supervision

Applied Music (17 hrs.) : Mus.

Mus. Major Instrument (must Mus.

include completion of course

.18) 8 Mus.

Mus. Minor Instrument (if major F. A

'instrument is wind, 3 hrs. must Mus.

be in strings ; if major instru- Mus.

ment is stringed, 3 hours must Mus.

be in winds) 3

Mus. Piano (must include com- Mus.

pletion of Piano 4) 4

Mus. Voice 2 Mus.

Mus. Band 4

Mus. Orchestra 4 Mus.

Mus. Chorus 1

3-4— Theory 6

103-104 Dictation and Sight

Singing 4

105-106— Harmony 6

123-124— History of Music 6

201 Analysis and Form 2

233 Instrumentation 3

261 String Techniques

and Materials 2

263 Wind and Percussion

Techniques and Materials 6

268 Music in the Junior and

Senior High School 8

273— Conducting 2

Physical Education Men

P.

E.

P.

R.

p.

E.

p.

E.

p.

K.

p.

E.

p.

K.

p.

E.

p.

E.

P. E.

65— Program Skills 2

66— Program Skills 2

102 Personal and Community

Health 3

121— Program Skills 2

122— Program Skills 1

127— First Aid 2

135 Program Techniques 1

150 Recreation 3

233— Theory of Adapted

Activities 2

267— Athletic Coaching 2-4

P. E. 268— Athletic Coaching 2-4

P. E. 304— History and Principles 3

P. E. 306 Organization and

Administration 2

P. E. 395— School Health Problems or

Psych. 310 Mental Hygiene 8

Zool. 3 Principles of Zoology 8

Zool. 133-134 Anatomy, Kinesiology

and Physiology 8

Ed. 103— Studies of Children 3

P. E. 269— Teaching of Health 3

Physical Education Women

P. E. 1 Hockey and Soccer 1

P. E. 4 Intermediate Swimming 1

P. E. 6 Elementary Tap Dancing 1

P. E. 7 Beginning Modern Dance 1

P. E. 8 Intermediate Modern Dance 1

P. E. 17 Beginning Tennis 1

P. E. 102 Personal and Community

Health 3

P. E. 121, 122— Program Skills 4

P. E. 127— First Aid 2

P. E. 131— Mass Games 1

P. E. 135 Program Techniques 1

P. E. 150— Recreation 8

P. E. 233— Theory of Adapted Activities 2 P. E. 304 History and Principles 8

P. E. 306 Organization and

Administration 2

H. E. 161 Home Nursing and Family

Health (2) or P. E. 395— School Health Problems (3)

or

Psych. 310— Mental Hygiene (3) 2-3

Zool. 3 Principles of Zoology 8

Zool. 133-134 Anatomy, Kinesiology

and Physiology 8

Ed. 103— Studies of Children 3

P. E. 272 Coaching Methods 2

P. E. 273— Coaching Methods 2

P. E. 269— Teaching of Health 3

P. E. 274,275— Teaching of

Rhythmic Activities 2

Speech

Speech 2 Voice and Articulation 2

Speech 3 Public Speaking 2

Speech 25 Principles of Argumentation 2 Speech 34 Oral Interpretation of

Literature 3

Speech 104 Bases of Speech 8

Speech 112 Advanced Public Speaking _ 2 Speech 195 Principles of Speech

Correction 3

Speech 307— Clinical Methods 8

Speech 325 Direction of Forensic

Programs 8

Radio-TV 79 Introduction to Radio-

Dram. A. 21 Elements of Stage

Scenery 3

Dram. A. 48— Make-Up 1

Dram. A. 99 Movement and Pan- tomime 2

Dram. A. 207 Costuming 4

Dram. A. 123 Elements of Stage

Lighting 8

Dram. A. 299 Principles of Acting 3

Dram. A. 350— Play Direction 8

Dram. A. 260— Teaching of High

School Dramatics and Speech 3

136 Ohio Univeirsity

Speech and Hearingr Therapy

The following program includes all the requirements, except those

established by deficiencies in the high school pattern, for students preparing to be speech and hearing therapists in the public schools. This program meets the requirements of the State of Ohio for the special certificate in this field.

General, Education, and Psychology Speech Requirements:

Eequirements : Hours

Hours Dram. A. 10 Introduction to Theatre _ 2

Eng. 3-4 English Composition 6 Radio-TV 79 Introduction to Radio-TV 2

Eng. 101, 102, 111 or 112 3 Speech 2— Voice and Articulation 2

Social Studies (history, government, Speech 3 Public Speaking 2

sociology, economics, geography, Speech 25 Prin. of Argumentation 2

Social Science 9, 10) 9 Speech 34 Oral Interpretation of

Natural Science or Mathematics Literature 3

(biology, botany, zoology. Speech 104 Bases of Speech 3

physics, chemistry, or mathe- Speech 195 Principles of Speech

matics) 6-10 Correction 3

Speech 1 Fundamentals 1 Speech 247 Clinical Practice in

Physical Education 2 'Speech Correction 1

Ed. 103— Studies of Children or Speech 307— Clinical Methods 3

Psych. 103— Child Psychology 3 Speech 310— Speech Pathology 3

Ed. 125 Purposes and Practices of Speech 312 Phonetics 3

Education 3 Speech 319 Audiometry and Speech

Ed. 229 Curriculum and Teaching and Hearing Problems S

Practices 4 Speech 320 Advanced Clinical Methods _ 3

Speech 262 Speech and Hearing Speech 323 Lip Reading 3

Therapy in the Public Speech 335 Diagnostic Procedures in

Schools 2 Speech and Hearing Therapy 3

Ed. 272 Student Teaching 5 Speech 345 Stuttering and Psychogen-

Psych. 1 or 101 General Psychology 3 etic Disorders of Speech 3

Psych. 5 Educational Psychology 3

Psych. 113 Psychology of Adolescence _ 2 Psych. 204 Psychology of Exceptional

Children 2

Psych. 310— Mental Hygiene 3

PREPARATION FOR PUPIL PERSONNEL SERVICE

Pupil Personnel Service involves the work of the School Counselor, the School Psychologist, and the Visiting Teacher. In the State of Ohio, and many other states, professional workers in these fields must earn a state certificate. This requires teaching experience and graduate work beyond the bachelor's degree, including a master's degree for the counselor and the school psychologist.

SCHOOL COUNSELOR. The certified counselor must hold a master's degree in guidance and have three years of experience, one of which must be in teaching. Undergraduates interested in this field will prepare to be teachers and should also take the following courses (starred courses are required) :

*Ed. 360— Guidance Principles (3) *Ed. 361— Guidance Practice (3) *Ed. 362 Information Service in Guidance (2) At least two courses from the following :

Ed. 103— Studies of Children (3)

Ed. 385 Educational Measurements (3)

Ed. 381 Educational Statistics (3)

Psych. 113 Psychology of Adolescence (2)

Psych. 204 Psychology of Exceptional Children (2)

Psych. 231 Employee Selection and Placement (2)

Psych. 310— Mental Hygiene (3)

Graduate students who desire preparation in this field will find programs outlined in the Graduate College Bulletin under Education.

The College of Education 137

SCHOOL PSYCHOLOGIST. The certified school psychologist must have one year of teaching experience and must hold a master's degree which includes at least twenty hours of work distributed as follows: Clinical work and individual testing (9-12 hours), group testing of intelligence and school achievement (2-4 hours), child development (4-5 hours), psychology of learning (3-5 hours), and counseling with laboratory practice (2-5 hours). Undergraduates interested in this field should prepare to teach and should include in their programs as much of the strictly undergraduate work in psychology as possible. Because the school psychologist is so often involved in problems of special education, the student should take work also in the field of special education.

VISITING TEACHER. The certified visiting teacher must have at least one year of teaching experience and must have earned at least 20 hours of graduate credit in child development, measurements, community or- ganization, pupil personnel work, guidance, school administration, and orientation to social case work. Undergraduates interested in this field should prepare to teach and should include in their program as much work in the areas listed above as is possible within degree requirements and the availability of undergraduate courses.

STUDENT TEACHING

Successful student teaching represents the culmination of the pro- gram of professional preparation; it is a requirement for the degree. Bachelor of Science in Education. No candidate will be considered for the degree, or for recommendation for a teaching certificate, who has not completed, under the supervision of Ohio University, at least six hours of observation, participation, and student teaching, of which at least three hours are in student teaching. The degree of Bachelor of Science in Education will be granted only to candidates who have given, within the five years immediately preceding, satisfactory evidence of a high degree of teaching skill, and a knowledge of modern methods and ability to employ them in the classroom.

APPLICATION: It is the responsibility of the student to enter an application for student teaching in the office of the Director of Student Teaching, not later than the middle of the academic year preceding the year in which he desires a student teaching assignment.

FACILITIES: Due to limited facilities available for stvident teaching in the city of Athens and a commuting radius of thirty miles, it is necessary for a large number of student teachers to be assigned to off-campus locations. Student teachers are assigned to the public school systems of the cities where there are Ohio University Branches and in the city of Cleveland. Students who are assigned in the local area are assigned to the University Elementary School, the Athens city elementary and high schools, and to the school systems of The Plains, Mechanicsburg, Nelsonville, and Logan.

138 Ohio University

SCHEDULE: Students assigned to off-campus centers have the op- portunity to experience the complete range of a teacher's activities in their full-time student teaching assignments. It is necessary for all students who pursue curricula leading to teacher certification to plan carefully during their first three years of college so that they may spend one complete semester off campus for student teaching. Student Teachers in elementary education may engage in student teaching in either the second semester of the Junior year or the first semester of the Senior year. Student teachers in secondary education and in the special fields normally take student teaching in the Senior year. The limated number of student teaching applicants who can be assigned in the local area are restricted to half-day assignments. These stu- dents must have either a morning or an afternoon free in their schedule for student teaching.

PREREQUISITES FOR STUDENT TEACHING: A. General Prerequisites

1. Residence: at least one semester of residence work must be completed prior to admission to student teaching.

2. Scholastic Average: the student must have a point-hour ratio of 2.0 (C) on all hours attempted.

3. English Proficiency: the student must have demonstrated pro- ficiency in English usage. This requirement may be satisfied by earning an "A" or "B" in English 4, or by passing the English proficiency test. (All transfer students must pass the English proficiency test regardless of the English grade trans- ferred from another institution.)

4. Speech Proficiency: the student must have successfully pass- ed a speech proficiency test given by the Speech Department. A card certifying that this test has been passed must be on file in the Office of the Director of Student Teaching.

5. Field Experience: All students in the elementary education curricula must present evidence of an experience of ten con- secutive school days duration in an elementary school during the opening days of the public school in the fall. Students in secondary academic and special subjects should present evidence of an adequate background of Field Experience. This field experience shall include either or both of the following types :

a. An experience of ten consecutive school days duration in a secondary school during the opening days of school in the fall;

b. Experience in working with children in informal situations such as camp counseling and playground supervision.

Field experience in September in a public school should be taken no later than the September prior to the student's Junior year. Any student who engages in ten consecutive days of experience in the public school in September may elect to secure course credit by enrolling for Education 277 in the fall semester.

The College of Education 139

B. Special Prerequisites for Student Teaching in Elementary Edu- cation.

1. Completion of at least seventy-five semester hours of course credit.

2. 2.0 (C) cumulative point-hour ratio on all courses completed in the following group:

a. Ed. 102-Literature for Children

b. Ed. 103-Studies of Children

c. Ed. 165-Teaching of Arithmetic

d. Ed. 163-Teaching of Eeading and Languages

e. Ed. 169-Teaching of Social Studies and Science

f. Mus. 266-Teaching of Music in the Elementary Grades

g. Art 160-Practical Design Workshop for Elementary Teach- ers.

h. P.E. 270-Teaching of Physical Education i. Psych. 5-Educational Psychology

3. A student who has more than one "D" in the three courses, Ed. 103, Studies of Children, Ed. 163, Teaching of Reading and Language; and Ed. 165, Teaching of Arithmetic, will not be admitted to Student Teaching.

C. Special Prerequisites for Student Teaching in Secondary Aca- demic and Special Subjects.

1. Completion of ninety semester hours. Exception may be made for students who have completed seventy-five hours who wish to be placed in an off-campus student teaching center. Such a student should have achieved an academic average above the minimum stated herein, and possess a well-rounded back- ground of professional preparation.

2. Completion of Psych. 5, Educational, Ed. 125, Purposes and Practices of Education, or Ed. 130, Secondary Education, and Ed. 229, Curriculum and Teaching Practices.

3. A cumulative point-hour ratio of 2.0 (C) must be attained in all education courses attempted. This includes Psych. 5, Ed. 125 or Ed. 130, and Ed. 229, a teaching methods course, and any other courses oifered in the Department of Education.

4. Completion of a major portion of the work in each of the teaching fields in which the student wishes to be certified. A cumulative point-hour ratio of 2.0 must be attained in each of these fields.

THE UNIVERSITY ELEMENTARY SCHOOL

The College of Education of Ohio University maintains the Uni- versity Elementary Scliool, consisting of a four-year and a five-year kindergarten, and grades one through six. The first function of this school is to furnish the best possible learning environment and in- struction for children, since this is essential if good laboratory ex- periences are to be made available to college students who are training for elementary teaching. Teachers in the University Elementary School are members of the university staff with training in elementary edu- cation and supervision, and successful teaching experience.

140 Ohio University

CENTER FOR EDUCATIONAL SERVICE

The Center for Educational Service is a division of the College of Education and is designed to make available the resources of the College of Education and of the University to educational workers teachers, administrators, and supervisors. These services are also avail- able to boards of education and to the public in communities served by Ohio University.

For operational purposes, the Center is divided into the following sections: Administrative Services; Curriculum and Instructional Ser- vices; Economic Education; and Pupil Personnel Services.

The Center's chief functions are: (1) to provide consultant services in such areas as curriculum planning, use of community resources, economic education, guidance programs, school-community relations, reading, testing, and supervisory and administrative problems (such consultative services may involve one or several staff members and may be a single meeting or a series of conferences and meetings) ;

(2) to conduct school surveys of educational programs and curricula, school building and site needs, and organization of school districts;

(3) to assist in solution of professional problems through off -campus and on-campus workshops; (4) to promote conferences on vital prob- lems confronting public education; (5) to publish those studies and re- ports which will aid in solving educational problems, and to distribute such publications; (6) to assist schools with the organization or re- vision of programs of reading (especially for exceptional children), guidance and testing; and (7) to encourage cooperative attack by teach- ers, administrators, boards of education, and the public toward solution of educational needs.

The Center's collection of materials from public school systems and universities in all parts of the United States forms a curriculum and administrative materials laboratory. These materials are available to students and staff members for on-campus courses and to workshop study groups for resource material. Selected items may be loaned to teachers and administrators for committee work in their own school systems.

GRADUATE WORK IN EDUCATION

Graduate work at Ohio University is under the direction of the Graduate College and its Graduate Council, and is described on page 160.

The College of Education offers many advanced graduate courses to help school workers raise the level of their competence in their pro- fessional work. The types of programs offered cover the following pro- fessional fields:

Elementary Education teaching in elementary schools, supervision,

and administration of elementary schools. History and Philosophy of Education. Research Work in Education.

The College of Education 141

Secondary Education teaching in secondary schools, supervision, and administration of secondary schools.

School Administration and Supervision the school superintendency, the school principalship, school supervision.

Guidance Services in the Schools the school counselor, the director of guidance, school psychologist, visiting teacher, the guidance functions of teachers and administrators.

In each of these fields, and to a limited extent in some other fields, the College of Education is prepared to advise students and to help them plan graduate programs most appropriate for their professional goals. Upon consultation with the dean of the Graduate College, the prospective graduate student in Education will be directed to the Grad- uate Committee of the College of Education. He will be assigned a grad- uate adviser and will be given every opportunity to develop a rich and rewarding graduate experience.

TEACHING CERTIFICATES

A student who plans to teach in Ohio makes application for a teach- ing certificate in the office of the Registrar at the time of application for graduation. The teaching certificate is issued by the State Depart- ment of Education upon the recommendation of the dean of the College of Education, and qualifies the student to teach the subjects indicated on the certificate.

Completion of requirements for graduation and of the professional courses required for certification does not insure that the individual will be recommended for certification. Instructors in various courses, and especially in courses in education and student teaching, will attempt to evaluate a student's fitness for the teaching profession in ways other than observation of academic performance in the classroom. Any reports of limitations which might tend to impair the individual's usefulness as a teacher in the public schools will be made a part of the student's rec- ord. When the student makes application for certification this record will be examined and the question of his fitness for teaching will be given further consideration.

Students who are not planning to teach in Ohio should inform them- selves concerning the requirements specified by the department of educa- tion of the state in which they expect to teach.

A student who plans to teach in the elementary grades registers in the College of Education when he has completed the requirements of the University College. The curricula offered by the College of Education include the requirements of the State Department of Education and qualify a student to obtain a provisional certificate to teach in the ele- mentary grades or the kindergarten-primary grades, depending upon the student's preparation.

142 Ohio University

Students who plan to teach high-school academic or special sub- jects, ordinarily enroll in the College of Education. The curricula of the College of Education include the requirements of the State Depart- ment of Education and qualify the student to obtain a provisional cer- tificate to teach the subjects indicated on the certificate. Students en- rolled in other colleges of the University may meet certification require- ments by completing the necessary professional subjects and completing requirements in the subjects which they plan to teach.

Students meet the minimum professional requirements for secondary certification to teach in Ohio by completing the following:

Subject Sem. Hrs.

Psych. 5 Educational Psychology 3

Ed. 130 Secondary Education 3

Ed. 229 Curriculum and Teaching Practices 4

Ed, 287 Student Teaching Laboratory or

a methods course 2-3

Ed. 281 Student Teaching in the Secondary Schools 7

Minimum standards for certification in the various secondary and special subjects have been established by the State Department of Edu- cation. Students wishing information about certification requirements should consult the Ofi"ice of the Dean of the College of Education.

THE COLLEGE OF FINE ARTS

EARL C. SEIGFRED DEAN

THE SCHOOL OF DRAMATIC ART AND SPEECH

CLAUDE E. KANTNER, DIRECTOR

Dramatic Art

Radio-Television

Public Address

Speech and Hearing Therapy

THE SCHOOL OF MUSIC

KARL AHRENDT. DIRECTOR

Applied Music

Music Education

Music History and Literature

Music Therapy

Theory and Composition

THE SCHOOL OF PAINTING AND ALLIED ARTS

FREDERICK D. LEACH. DIRECTOR

Architecture

Art Education

Art History

Design

Painting and Drawing

Photography

Sculpture and Ceramics

THE COLLEGE OF FINE ARTS

The College of Fine Arts comprises the School of Dramatic Art and Speech, the School of Music, and the School of Painting and Allied Arts, oifering a broad, cultural education in the fine arts and special training in the following departments: Dramatic Production, Radio- Television, Public Address, Speech and Hearing Therapy, Applied Music, Music History and Literature, Music Theory and Composition, Music Education, Music Therapy, Architecture, Design, Painting and Draw- ing, Photography, Art History and Appreciation, Sculpture and Cer- amics, and Art Education.

BACHELOR OF FINE ARTS

The Bachelor of Fine Arts degree fulfills three functions: to pro- vide the student with specialized training in one of the fine arts; to pro- vide a cultural background through a study of the relationship of all of the arts; and to prepare the student, as far as possible, to become a responsible member of society. To these ends, the program has been kept flexible to meet individual needs. Every effort is made for edu- cational and vocational counseling.

Candidates for the degree in the College of Fine Arts complete the general graduation requirements, which include a minimum of 124 semester hours with a point-hour ratio of 2.0 (C) on all hours attempt- ed, but including only the final hours and points in repeated courses, and in addition this same point-hour ratio on all hours in the field of specialization. For a student with transferred credit, this rule applies to his cumulative record, which includes transferred credits, and to his Ohio University record, exclusive of transferred credits. These require- ments include the program of the University College.

Students working toward the Bachelor of Fine Arts degree must complete a major in one of the schools of the College of Fine Arts and a minor of 18 hours in general courses in the fine arts, including F.A. 17-18 Introduction to the Fine Arts. In addition to this course, five others are offered from which the student must select two to complete the minor : History of Painting and Sculpture, History of Music, History of Architecture, History of the Visual Theatre, History of Oratory. Six hours of the minor must be in an area outside of the School in which the student is pursuing his major. Descriptions of the general courses may be found under "Fine Arts."

As an alternate to the eighteen-hour minor in history and apprecia- tion, it is possible in certain areas to fulfill the minor requirement by completing F.A. 17-18 and twelve semester hours of applied work in one of the schools of the College of Fine Arts other than that in which a major is being pursued. Before undertaking an alternate minor it is necessary to obtain written permission from the dean of the college.

144

The College of Fine Arts 145

Those who are planning to teach in Ohio should fulfill the minimum requirements for certification by completing the following:

Hours Hours

Psych. 5 Educational Psychology 3 A methods course 2-3

Ed. 125 Purposes and Practices of Student teaching 7

Education 3

Ed. 229 Curriculum and Teaching

Practices '!

MAJORS IN THE SCHOOL OF DRAMATIC ART AND SPEECH. The cur- riculum of the School of Dramatic Art and Speech provides a compre- hensive major for those who wish a general background and also per- mits more specialized majors in theatre, public address, radio, and speech and hearing therapy for those who wish to concentrate their work in one of these areas. The requirements for these specialized majors are, however, based upon the principle that all majors in any phase of dramatic art and speech should have a general background of certain basic courses. The program is flexible and is intended to meet the needs and abilities of the individual students.

The University College program should include Speech 1, Speech 2, and F.A. 17-18 Introduction to the Fine Arts. Other courses open to students in the University College are: Speech 3, 25, 34, Radio-TV 79, and Dramatic Art 10.

Majors in theatre must elect 12 hours of English beyond the Uni- versity College requirement, including either Eng. 223, 224, 323 or 324 Shakespeare, and at least three additional hours in dramatic litera- ture. Comprehensive majors and majors in radio, speech and hearing therapy, or public address must elect six hours of English beyond the University College requirement or General Studies 7, 8 Great Books. Students who plan to teach speech and English in the public schools should consult with their advisors concerning additional requirements in English and Education.

SPEECH AND HEARING CLINIC. The School of Dramatic Art and Speech maintains a speech and hearing clinic which serves the needs of students, faculty, and the public. Consultations concerning all types of speech disorders may be arranged with the director of the clinic. Remedial treatment for cases of a functional nature is provided free of charge under the direction of a competent speech pathologist. A special speech clinic for children serves the Athens area and provides excellent training opportunities for students in speech correction.

Practical experience in radio and television is provided in the Uni- versity radio station, WOUB -AM and WOUI -FM and in the closed circuit television laboratory. Students wishing to work in the theatre may take part in the productions of the University Theatre, the Play- shop and the Ohio Valley Summer Theatre. Those interested in public address may participate in first-year debate, varsity debate, and inter- collegiate contests in oratory, extemporary speaking and interpretation. For a more complete description of these activities, see page 43. The School of Dramatic Art and Speech also sponsors the following profes- sional societies: Tau Kappa Alpha (forensics), Chi Rho Beta (radio), Footlighters and National Collegiate Players (theatre), and the Speech and Hearing Therapy Club.

146 Ohio University

basic courses required for all majors

Hours

Speech 2 Voice and Articulation 2 Speech 195 Principles of Speech

Speech 3— Public Speaking 2 Correction 8

Speech 25 Principles of Argumentation 2 Radio-TV 79— Introduction to

Speech 34 Oral Interpretation of Radio-TV 2

Literature 3 Dram. A. 10 Introduction to Theatre _ 2

Speech 104 Bases of Speech 3

COMPREHENSIVE MAJOR IN DRAMATIC ART, RADIO, SPEECH AND SPEECH AND HEARING THERAPY

In addition to the basic courses listed above, the following must be completed :

Hours

Dram. A. 47 or 147 Theatre Radio 225 Radio Play Production or

Laboratory 1-2 Speech 303 Advanced Oral In-

Dram. A. 99 Movement and terpretation or

Pantomime 2 Speech 309 Rhetorical Theory 8

Dram. A. 105 Play Production 3 Speech 307 Clinical Methods or

Dram. A. 299 Principles of Acting 3 Speech 312— Phonetics 8

Speech 112 Advanced Public Speaking _ 2 Speech 205 Dynamics of Group

Discussion 3

MAJOR IN PUBLIC ADDRESS*

In addition to the basic courses listed above, the following must be completed :

Hours

Speech 110 Parliamentary Procedure 1 Speech 305 Problem Solving Through

Speech 112 Advanced Public Speaking _ 2 Group Discussion 8

Speech 147 Workshop in Speech 2 Speech 309 Classical Rhetorical

Speech 205 Dynamics of Group Theory 8

Discussion 3 Speech 325 Direction of Forensic

Speech 303 Advanced Oral Interpreta- Programs 3

tion or Dram. A. 105 Play Production 3

MAJOR IN RADIO-TELEVISION**

In addition to the basic courses listed above, the following must be completed :

Hours Radio-TV 225, 226— Radio Play Pro- Radio-TV 105 Radio Broadcasting duction 6

Mechanics 2 Radio-TV 247 Advanced Radio

Radio-TV 180— Radio Speech 3 V^orkshop 2

Radio-TV 301 Principles of Television _ 3 Radio-TV 375 Program Planning and

Radio-TV 316— Continuity Writing 2 Building 3

MAJOR IN SPEECH AND HEARING THERAPY

In addition to the basic courses listed above, the following must be completed :

Hours

Speech 307 Clinical Methods 3 Speech 819 Audiometry and Speech

Speech 310 Speech Pathology 3 and Hearing Problems 8

Speech 312 Phonetics 3 Speech 320 Advanced Clinical Methods 8

Speech 323 Lip Reading 8

Students who anticipate obtaining positions in speech and hearing therapy in the public schools of Ohio must also include in their elective subjects the following courses in speech and hearing therapy, psy-

Majors in public address must also elect F.A. 203-204, History of Oratory, as one of the minor subjects.

•* Students who do not have a reasonable proficiency in typewriting must elect, in addition, Sec. St. 15, Typewriting. Students are also advised to take additional elective courses in such areas as theatre, foreign languages, sports, philosophy, history, psychology, commerce, music.

The College of Fine Arts 147

cholo^ and education. This program meets the requirements in the State of Ohio for the special certificate in this field. A student who wishes to prepare for a public school position in speech correction in any state other than Ohio should obtain the requirements of the state in question and, with his adviser, plan his program accordingly.

Hours Speech 345 ^Stuttering and Psycho- genetic Disorders of Speech 3 Psych. 310 Mental Hygiene 3

Speech 335 Diagnostic Procedures in Ed. 125 The Purposes and Practices of

'Speech and Hearing Therapy 3 Education 3

Psych. 1 or 101 General Psychology 3 Ed. 229 Curriculum and Teaching

Psych. 6 Educational Psychology 3 Practices 4

Psych. 103 Child Psychology or Ed. Speech 262 Speech and Hearing

103, Studies of Children 3 Therapy in Public Schools 2

Psych. 113 Psychology of Adolesence 2 Ed. 272 Practice Teaching in the

Psych. 204 Psychology of Exceptional Elementary Grades (Speech

iChildren 2 correction) 5

All students who major in speech and hearing therapy whether looking forward to certification or not, must complete a minimum of 22 hours in psychology and education including Speech 262, Ed. 272, 103, or Psych. 103, Psych. 204, 310 or 337, and Speech 335.

MAJOR IN THEATRE*

In addition to the basic courses listed above, the follov/ing must be completed :

Hours

Dram. A. 21 Elements of Stage Dram. A. 207 Costuming 4

Scenery 3 Dram. A. 123 Elements of Stage

Dram. A. 48 Make-up 1 Lighting 3

Dram. A. 99-100 Movement and Dram. A. 299 Principles of Acting 8

Pantomime 4 Dram. A. 350 ^Play Direction 3

MAJORS IN THE SCHOOL OF MUSIC. Ohio University is a member of the National Association of Schools of Music. The requirements for entrance and for graduation as set forth in this catalog are in accord- ance with the standards set up by the association.

The School of Music makes provisions for individual study in all branches of vocal and instrumental music and offers a wide range of courses in the fields of theory and composition, music history and litera- ture, m.usic education, and music therapy. Opportunities are provided for individual participation in student recitals, as well as for ensemble experience in groups such as the chorus, symphony orchestra, symphonic band, chamber music, and glee clubs.

Six hours of English beyond the University College requirement or Gen. Studies 7, 8 Great Books are to be taken by candidates for the degree of Bachelor of Fine Arts with a major in music. A required minor consists of 18 hours of general courses in the fine arts. (See page 222.)

Students who desire to specialize in the field of music education are given the opportunity of preparing for the positions of special music teacher or music supei-visor while working toward the degree of Bache- lor of Fine Arts. In accordance with state requirements, the major may be either vocal or instrumental.

Theatre majors must also elect F.A. 179-180 History of the Visual Theatre, as one of their minor subjects.

148 Ohio University

Students in the College of Arts and Sciences may major in two areas music history and literature or music theory. The director of the School of Music should be consulted as the adviser of the course.

Examinations in applied music are given at the end of each se- mester by a faculty committee in the applied music field concerned. The examinations must be taken by all music majors in those applied music courses which are required for the degree. It should be under- stood that completion of credit hours in applied music should be in agreement with the proficiency requirements as set up by the School of Music. These requirements may be secured at the office of the School of Music.

Majors are required to attend all recitals and to participate in orchestra, chorus, or band, depending upon their applied major.

The following curricula have been set up for music majors in the College of Fine Arts.

MAJOR IN PIANO (Four- Year Cnrricnlam)

Twenty-six semester hours in applied music including 18 hours in piano, and 8 hours in ensemble (chorus, orchestra, band, or chamber music).

Twenty-six semester hours in the theory and literature of music, including Mus. 3-4, 103-104, 105-106, 201-202, 340, and one of the fol- lowing: Mus. 313-314, 315-316, 317-318, or 319-320.

Eighteen semester hours, to constitute the minor, in general courses in the fine arts, including F.A. 17-18 and 123-124. (See page 222.)

Twenty-one to twenty-five hours of general requirements, including 12 hours of English, Speech 1, two hours in physical education, and other subjects to fulfill the University College requirements.

Twenty-five to twenty-seven semester hours of elective courses.

Total requirements: 124 semester hours.

Freshman Program*

The University College Program should include:

First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

Freshman Piano 2 Freshman Piano 2

Mus. 3— Theory 3 Mus. 4— Theory 3

F. A. 17 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3 F. A. 18 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3

Ensemble 1 Ensemble 1

University College requirements 7 University College requiremenls 8

16 17

Sophomore Program*

Sophomore Piano 2 Sophomore Piano 2

Mus. 103 Dictation and Sight Singing _ 2 Mus. 104 Dictation and Sight Singing _ 2

Mus. 105 Harmony 3 Mus. 106 Harmony 3

English elective 3 English elective 3

Fine arts minor 3 Fine arts minor 3

Ensemble 1 Ensemble 1

Electives 3 Electives 3

17 17 'Physical education should be added as required.

The College of Fine Arts 149

Junior Program

Junior Piano 2 Junior Piano 2

Mus. 201 Analysis and Form 2 Mus. 202 Analysis and Form 2

F. A. 123 History of Music 3 F. A. 124 History of Music 3

Ensemble 1 Ensemble 1

Electives 7 Electives 7

15 15

Senior Program

Senior Piano 3 Senior Piano 3

Mus. 340 The Literature of Advanced music theory elective 2

Piano Music 2 Ensemble 1

Advanced music theory elective 2 Electives 8

Ensemble 1

Electives 7 -'*

15

MAJOR IN VOICE (Four- Year Curriculum)

Thirty semester hours in applied music, including 18 hours in voice, 4 hours of piano, and 8 hours in ensemble (chorus).

Twenty-two semester hours in the theory and literature of music including Mus. 3-4, 103-104, 105-106, 201-202, and 337 or 339.

Eighteen semester hours, to constitute the minor, in general courses in the fine arts, including F.A. 17-18 and 123-124. (See page 222.)

Thirty-nine to forty-three hours of general requirements, including 12 hours in English, Speech 1, two hours in physical education, and other subjects to fulfill the University College requirements.

•Physical education should be added as required.

Seven to nine semester hours of elective courses. Total requirements: 124 semester hours.

Freshman Program*

The University College Program should include:

First Semester Hours Second Semester iloura

Freshman Voice 2 Freshman Voice 2

Mus. 3 Theory 3 Mus. 4 Theory 3

F. A. 17 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3 F. A. 18 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3

Ensemble 1 Ensemble 1

University College requirements 7 University College requirements 8

16 17

Sophomore Program*

Sophomore Voice 2 Sophomore Voice 2

Secondary Piano 1 Secondary Piano 1

Mus. 103 Dictation and Sight Singing 2 Mus. 104 Dictation and Sight Singing _ 2

Mus. 105 Harmony 3 Mus. 106 Harmony 3

English elective 3 English elective 3

Fr. 1 Beginning French 4 Fr. 2 Beginning French 4

Ensemble 1 Ensemble 1

16 16

•Physical education should be added as required.

150 Ohio University

Junior Pro-am

Junior Voice 2 Junior Voice 2

Secondary Piano 1 Secondary Piano 1

Mus. 201 Analysis and Form 2 Mus. 202 Analysis and Form 2

F. A. 123— History of Music 3 F. A. 124— History of Music 3

Ger. 1 Beginning German 4 Ger. 2 Beginning Gernaan 4

Ensemble 1 Ensemble 1

Electives 2 Electives 2

15 15

Senior Program

Senior Voice 3 Senior Voice 3

It. 1 Beginning Italian 4 Mus. 337 The Literature of

Fine arts minor S Vocal Music or

Ensemble 1 Mus. 339— The Evolution of the Opera _ 2

Electives 4 Fine arts minor 3

Ensemble 1

15 Electives 5

14

MAJOR IN ORCHESTRAL INSTRUMENTS: STRINGS, WOODWINDS,

BRASS, OR PERCUSSION

(Four-Year Curriculum)

Thirty semester hours in applied music, including 18 hours in ma- jor instrument, 4 hours in piano, and 8 hours of ensemble (orchestra, band, or chamber music) .

Twenty-six semester hours in the theory and literature of music, including Mus. 3-4, 103-104, 105-106, 201-202, 338, and one of the fol- lowing: Mus. 313-314, 315-316, 317-318, or 319-320.

Eighteen semester hours, to constitute the minor, in general courses in the fine arts, including F.A. 17-18 and 123-124. (See page 222.)

Twenty-one to twenty-five hours of general requirements, including 12 hours in English, Speech 1, two hours in physical education, and other subjects to fulfill the University College requirements.

Twenty-one to twenty-three semester hours of elective courses.

Total requirements: 124 semester hours.

Freshman Program*

The University College Program should include:

First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

Major Instrument 2 Major Instrument 2

Mus. 3 Theory 3 Mus. 4 Theory 8

F. A. 17 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3 F. A. 18 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3

Ensemble 1 Ensemble 1

University College requirements 7 University College requirements 8

16 17

Sophomore Program*

Major Instrument 2 Major Instrument 2

Secondary Piano 1 Secondary Piano 1

Mus. 103 Dictation and Sight Singing _ 2 Mus. 104 Dictation and Sight Singing _ 2

Mus. 105 Harmony 3 Mus. 106 Harmony 8

English elective 3 English elective 8

Fine arts minor 3 Fine arts minor 3

EJnsemble 1 Ensemble 1

15 15

'Physical education should be added as required.

The College of Fine Arts 151

Jnnior Program

Major Instrument 2 Major Instrument 2

Secondary Piano 1 Secondary Piano . 1

Mus. 201 Analysis and Form 2 Mus. 202— Analysis and Form 2

F. A. 123— History of Music 3 F. A. 124 History of Music 3

Ensemble 1 Ensemble 1

Electives 7 Electives C

16 16

Senior Program

Major Instrument 3 Major Instrument 8

Advanced music theory elective 2 Advanced music theory elective 2

Ensemble 1 Mus. 338 The Literature of

Electives 9 Orchestral Music 2

Ensemble 1

15 Electives 7

15

MAJOR IN MUSIC EDUCATION (Four- Year Curriculum)

Sixteen semester hours in applied rnusic, including completion of voice and piano requirements for vocal majors and required proficiency for the major instrument for instrumental majors. Instrumental majors must also complete at least three hours in a minor instrument (if major instrument is wind, 3 hours must be in string, and vice versa). Instru- mental majors must further complete piano proficiency and two hours of voice.

Twenty semester hours of theory, including Mus. 3-4, 103-104, 105- 106, 201 and 233.

Eighteen semester hours, to constitute the minor, in courses in the fine arts, including F.A. 17-18, and F.A. 123-124. (See page 222.)

Eighteen semester hours of music education to include Mus. 261, 263, 265, 267, 268 and 273.

Twenty-three semester hours of general requirements, including 12 hours in English, Speech 1, two hours in physical education, and 6 hours in social sciences and other courses to fulfill the University Col- lege requirements.

Twenty hours in education for completion of certification require- ments to include Psych. 1 and 5, Ed. 130, 228, 272, 280, and 281.

Eight semester hours for ensemble participation (band, chorus, glee clubs, or orchestra) .

Total requirements: 124-135 semester hours.

Freshman Program*

The University College Program should include:

First Semester OEIours Second Semester Hours

Eng. 3 English Composition 3 Eng. 4 English Composition 8

F. A. 17 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3 F. A. 18 Introduction to the Fine Arts 8

Mus. 3 Theory 3 Mus. 4— Theory 8

Psych. 1 General Psychology 3 Speech 1 Fundamentals of Speech 1

P. E. Physical education 1 P. E. Physical education 1

Applied 2 Applied 2

Participation 1 Participation 1

Social science 8

17

16

•Physical education should be added as required.

152

Ohio University

Sophomore Program*

Mus. 103 Dictation and Sight Singing _ 2

Mus. 105 Harmony 3

Eng. 102 Sophomore English Literature 3

P. E. Physical education 1

Psych. 5 Educational Psychology 3

Applied 2

Participation 1

Elective 3

18

Mus. 104 Dictation and Sight Singing 2

Mus. 106 Harmony 8

Ed. 130 Secondary Education 3

P. E.— Physical education 1

Applied 2

Participation 1

Elective 4

If

Jonior Program

Mus. 261 String Techniques and

Materials 2

Mus. 263 Wind and Percussion

Techniques and Materials 2

Mus. 273— Conducting 2

Teaching minor 3

F. A. 123— History of Music 3

Eng. Ill or 112 Chief American

■Writers 3

Applied 2

Participation 1

18

Mus. 263 Wind and Percussion

Techniques and Materials 2

Mus. 265 Vocal Techniques and

Materials 2

Ed. 280 Observation and Partici- pation in High School 3

Ed. 228 Principles of Teaching 3

F. A. 124— History of Music 3

Applied 2

Participation 1

!6

Senior Program

Ed. 272 Student Teaching in the

Elementary Grades 2

Mus. 233 Instrumentation 3

Mus. 201 Analysis and Form 2

Mus. 267 Supervision of Music

dn Elementary Schools 3

Applied 2

Participation 1

FHne Arts minor 3

16

Ed. 281— Student Teaching in the

Secondary Schools 2

Mus. 268 Music in Junior and

Senior High Schools 3

Applied 2

Participation 1

Fine Arts minor 3

Elective 3

14

MAJOR IN MUSIC THEORY OR COMPOSITION (Fonr-Year Curriculnm)

Eight semester hours in applied music, including required pro- ficiency in the principal instrument, Mus. 261, 263, and 8 hours in en- semble (chorus, orchestra, band, or chamber music). Piano proficiency is required if the principal instrument is not piano.

Forty to forty-four semester hours in the theory and literature of music, including Mus. 3-4, 103-104, 105-106, 201-202, 313-314, 315-316, 317-318, 319-320, 357-358, and 371-372. (Mus. 371-372 is required only of majors in composition.)

Eighteen semester hours, to constitute the minor, in general courses in the fine arts, including F.A. 17-18 and 123-124. (See page 222.)

Twenty-one to twenty-five hours of general requirements, including 12 hours in English, Speech 1, two hours in physical education, and other subjects to fulfill the University College requirements.

Seventeen to twenty-three semester hours of elective courses.

Total requirements: 124 semester hours.

"Physical education should he added as required.

The College of Fine Arts 153

Freshman Program*

The University College Program should include:

First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

Principal instrument 1 Principal instrument 1

Mus. 3 Theory 3 Mus. 4 Theory 8

F. A. 17 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3 F. A. 18 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3

Ensemble 1 Ensemble 1

University College requirements 7 University College requirements 8

15 16

Sophomore Program*

Principal instrument 1 Principal instrument 1

Mus. 103 Dictation and Sight Singing 2 Mus. 104 Dictation and Sight Singing 2

Mus. 105— Harmony 3 Mus. 106 Harmony 3

Mus. 261 String Techniques English elective 3

and Materials 2 Fine arts minor 3

English elective 3 Ensemble 1

Fine arts minor 3 Electives 2

Ensemble 1

15

15

Junior Program

Principal instrument 1 Principal instrument 1

Mus. 263 Wind and Percussion Mus. 202 Analysis and Form 2

Techniques and Materials 2 Mus. 316 Advanced Harmony 2

Mus. 201 Analysis and Form 2 Mus. 318— Counterpoint 2

Mus. 315 Advanced Harmony 2 Mus. 320 Composition 2

Mus. 317— Counterpoint 2 F. A. 124 History of Music 3

Mus. 319 Composition 2 Ensemble 1

F. A. 123— History of Music 3 Electives 3

Ensemble 1 '

Electives 1 16

16

Senior Program

Principal instrument 1 Principal instrument 1

Mus. 313— Orchestration 2 Mus. 314 Orchestration 2

Mus. 357 Counterpoint 2 Mus. 358 Counterpoint 2

Mus. 371— Composition** 2 Mus. 372— Composition** 2

Ensemble 1 Ensemble 1

Electives 8-10 Electives 7-9

16-18 15-17

MAJOR IN MUSIC LITERATURE

(Four-Year Curriculum)

Eight semester hours in applied music, including required pro- ficiency in principal instrument, and 8 hours ensemble (chorus, orches- tra, band, or chamber music). Piano proficiency is required if the prin- cipal instrument is not piano.

Twenty-six semester hours in the theory and literature of music, including Mus. 3-4, 103-104, 105-106, 201-202, and 6 hours chosen from Mus. 337, 338, 339, and 340.

Eighteen semester hours to constitute the minor in general courses in the fine arts, including F.A. 17-18 and 123-124. (See page 222.)

•Physical education should be added as required. '•Required of majors in composition only.

154 Ohio University

Forty-three to forty-seven hours of general requirements, including 12 hours in English, Speech 1, two hours in physical education, and other subjects to fulfill the University College requirements.

Thirteen to fifteen hours of elective courses.

Total requirements: 124 semester hours.

Freshman Program* The University College Program should include:

First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

Principal instrument 1 Principal instrument 1

Mus. 3— Theory 3 Mus. 4— Theory 3

F. A. 17 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3 F. A. 18 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3

Ensemble 1 Ensemble 1

University College requirements 7 University College requirements 8

16 16

Sophomore Program*

Principal instrument 1 Principal instrument 1

Mus. 103 Dictation and Sight Singing 2 Mus. 104 Dictation and Sight Singing 2

Mus. 105 Harmony 3 Mus. 106 Harmony 8

English elective 3 English elective 3

Fine arts minor 3 Fine arts minor 3

Hist. 1 Western Civilization Hist. 2 Western Civilization

in Modern Times 3 in Modern Times 3

Ensemble 1 Ensemble 1

16

Junior Program

Principal instrument 1 Principal instrument 1

Mus. 201 Analysis and Form 2 Mus. 202 Analysis and Form 2

F. A. 123— History of Music 3 F. A. 124— History of Music 3

Ft. 1 Beginning French 4 Fr. 2 Beginning French 4

Ensemble 1 Ensemble 1

Electives 5 Electives 5

16 16

Senior Program

Principal instrument 1 Principal instrument 1

Music literature elective 4 Music literature elective 2

Ger. 1 Beginning German 4 Ger. 2 Beginning German 4

Ensemble 1 Ensemble 1

Electives 5 Electives 6

15 14

MAJORS IN THE SCHOOL OF PAINTING AND ALLIED ARTS. Basic Program. The following program is intended to serve as a foundation for specialization in the Junior and Senior years. It is planned in a way to give the student a thorough preparation in drawing and design and an introduction to the various media through which this knowledge may find expression in aesthetic form. At the end of the sophomore year, each student will have become familiar with the basic problems in draw- ing, design, sculpture, commercial art, and painting, and will have completed a survey of the history of the fine arts. At this time he will, together with his adviser, determine for himself the course of study he will follow for the remaining two years. Thus the freshman and sopho-

*Physical education should be added as required.

The College of Fine Arts 155

more years constitute an extensive program and the junior and senior years a more intensive plan. This division of the undergraduate degree program is based on the belief that the students, having been well grounded during the first two years of their college careers, are suflS- ciently mature to help direct the course through their own areas of specialization.

The Bachelor of Fine Arts degree in the School of Painting and Allied Arts requires a minimum of 32 semester hours of work in the School, including four semesters of Drawing and Design (Art 1, 2, 101, 102) and one semester each of Elementary Sculpture (Art 21) and Figure Drawing (Art 28). Architectural majors are a partial exception to this stipulation because of the demands of their schedules. The minor requirement for the B.F.A. degree is met with 18 semester hours of general courses in the fine arts.

Six hours of English beyond the University College requirement, or Gen. Studies 7, 8, Great Books, are to be completed by candidates for the B.F.A. degree.

Those students desiring mastery of the field of Painting, Sculpture, Printmaking, or Ceramics, will find little difficulty in planning a pro- gram in accordance with their personal objectives as they relate to the demands of the field involved.

Possible fields of specialization, beyond the sophomore year, would include the general field of design or concentration in Advertising De- sign, Fashion Design, Industrial Design, or Interior Design. Programs leading to the realization of competence in these areas can be arranged to suit the demands of the individual student in conference with his adviser.

In every case, entrance upon a plan of study beyond the sophomore level involves a decision on the part of the student regarding his future role in the field of art. For this reason, each student is advised to make the most of the basic program outlined below in order that it may pro- vide a means by which he will be better prepared to enter his chosen field.

Freshman Program

First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

Art 1 Drawing and Design 3 Art 2 Drawing and Design 3

Art 21* Elementary Sculpture 2 Art 28* Figure Drawing 2

P. A. 17 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3 F. A. 18 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3

U. C. requirements 8 U. C. requii-ements 8

16

Sophomore Program

Art 101 Drawing and Design 3 Art 102 Drawing and Design 8

F. A. 121— History of Painting & F. A. 122— History of Painting &

Sculpture 3 Sculpture 8

Art 128 Advanced Figure Drawing 3 Art 111 Drawing Workshop 2

Art 113 Lettering 3 Art 118 Watercolor 8

Electives 5 Electives 6

17 17 ♦May be taken either semester.

156 Ohio University

biajor in architecture

Candidates for the Bachelor of Fine Arts degree may elect archi- tecture as a major within the School of Painting and Allied Arts. A curriculum has been designed to provide an over-all knowledge of the subject supported by a study of the liberal arts and related fine arts. Students upon completing the architectural curriculum, should be pre- pared for positions as architectural draftsmen and assistants in archi- tects' offices, where they may gain practical experience usually required by state boards. Certain students with outstanding skill should plan, upon receiving the B.F.A. degree, to pursue graduate study at one of the accredited schools of architecture.

For the student who chooses, upon graduation, to enter fields closely allied to architecture and building, opportunities exist in the design, manufacture, distribution, and installation of the materials of architec- ture. A developed, imaginative power and a structural sense are desirable attributes for work in industrial design and in the design and construction of display features and structures.

Freshman Program

First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

Art 1 Drawing and Design 3 Art 2 Drawing and Design 3

F. A. 17 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3 F. A. 18 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3

Math. 5 Freshman Mathematics 5 Math. 6 Analytic Geometry and

U. C. requirements 6 'Calculus I 5

U. G. requirements 6

17

17

Sophomore Program

Phys. 5 Introduction to Physics 4 Phys. 6 Introduction to Physics 4

Arch. 55 Fundamentals of Archi- Arch. 56— Architectural Graphics 3

tecture 3 Arch. 183 Architectural Equipnaent 3

Arch. 179 Architectural Materials 3 Fine Arts miinor 3

Fine Arts minor 3 Electives 5

Arch. 105 ^Architectural Rendering 2

Electives 2 18

17

Junior Program

F. A. 175 History of Architecture 3 F. A. 176 History of Architecture 3

Arch. 257 Fundamentals of Residential Arch. 258 Design of Residential

Architecture 2 Architecture (optional) 3

Arch. 281 Architectural Construction _ 2 Arch. 282 Architectural Construction _ 2

Arch. 155 Architectural Design 5 Arch. 156 Architectural Design 5

Electives 4 Electives 3

16 16

Senior Program

Arch. 284 Working Drawings 2 Arch. 286— Senior Design 5

Arch. 285 Senior Design 5 Arch. 301 Problems in Architecture

Fine Arts minor 3 (optional) 3

Electives 8 Fine Arts minor 3

Electives 7

18

18

The College of Fine Arts 157

major in art education

The program below is designed for those who wish certification as teachers in the public schools while completing requirements for the Bachelor of Fine Arts degree. All required courses are specified and should be taken as listed. Substitutions may be made only after consul- tation with an adviser.

Freshman Program

First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

Art 1 Drawing and Design 3 Art 2 Drawing and Design 3

Art 28* Figure Drawing 2 Art 21* Elementary Sculpture 2

F. A. 17 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3 F. A. 18 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3

Psych. 1 General Psychology 3 Eng. 4 English Ck)mposition 3

Eng. 3 English Composition 3 Physical Education 1

Physical Education 1 Electives 4

15 16

Sophomore Program

Psych. 5 Educational Psychology 3 Ed. 130 Secondary Education 3

Art 101— Drawing and Design 3 Art 102 Drawing and Design 3

Art 103 Representation 3 Art 123 Jewelry 2

Art 113— Lettering 3 Art 137— Fashion Design 2

F. A. 121— History of Painting & F. A. 122— History of Painting &

Sculpture 3 Sculpture 3

Eng. 101 Sophomore English Literature 3 Eng. 102 Sophomore English Literature 3

18 16

Junior Program

Art 115— Ceramics 3 Art 118— Watercolor S

Art 111 Drawing Workshop 2 Art 128 Advanced Figure Drawing 3

Art 240 Design Applied to Materials __ 2 Ed. 228 Principles of Teaching 3

Art 271— Interior Design 3 Art 120— Textile Design 3

F. A. Minor 3 F. A. Minor 3

Electives 3 Electives 3

16 18

Senior Program**

Ed. 272— Student Teaching in the Art 260 Teaching of Art S

Elementary School 3 Art 341 Painting (Advanced) 2

Ed. 281— Student Teaching in the Art 309— Prints 3

Secondary School 4 Electives 7

Art 205— Painting 2

Electives 6 15

15

MAJOR IN PHOTOGRAPHY

Candidates for the Bachelor of Fine Arts degree electing photogra- phy as a field of concentration follow the regular sequence of photog- raphy courses during their freshman and sophomore years with advanced study in commercial and illustrative photography and por- traiture.

In addition to a specialized understanding of photographic tech- niques and practices, a general education in contributing fields is desirable. The successful photographer must appreciate the ideas and interests of those with whom he deals.

•May be taken either semester. ••Each 15 hour block may be taken either semester.

158 Ohio University

A planned course of study should include courses in art history, design and drawing for technical information contributing directly to the major interest. From the general educational field, courses in journalism, commerce, and the sciences should be chosen to fit individual needs.

Prospective photography majors should contact a staff member before registration and follow the program below as closely as possible.

Freshman Prognram

First Semester iHours Second Semester Hours

Art 1 Drawing and Design 3 Art 2 Drawing and Design 3

Photog. 77— Basic 3 Photog. 78— Basic S

F. A. 17 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3 F. A. 18 Introduction to the Fine Arts 3

U. C. requirements 7 U. C. requirements 7

16 16

Sophomore Program

Photo. 145 Workshop in Photography _ 3 Photo. 145 ^Workshop in Photography _ 3

Photo. 143— Photographic Processes 3 Photo. 144 Photographic Processes 8

F. A. 121— History of Painting & F. A. 122— History of Painting &

Sculpture 3 Sculpture 8

Art 101 Drawing and Design 3 Art 102 Drawing and Design 3

Electives 5 Electives 6

17 17

Jnnior Program

Photog. 277— Portraiture 3 Photog. 278 Portraiture 8

Fine arts minor 3 Photog. 381 Problems in Photography _ 3

Electives 10 Fine Arts minor 8

Electives 7

16

16

Senior Program

Photog, 379— Commercial and Photog. 380 Commercial and

Illustrative Photography 3 Illustrative Photography 8

Photog. 381 Problems in Photography _ 3 Photog. 381 Problems in Photography _ 3

Electives 7 Electives 7

13 13

THE GRADUATE COLLEGE

DONALD R. CLIPPINGER

DEAN

Art

Home Economics

Bacteriology

Human Relations

Botany

Industrial Arts

Chemistry

Journalism

Classical Languages (minor work only)

Management Mathematics

Connmerce an

d Business

Music

Dramatic Art

Philosophy

Economics

Photography

Education and School Administration

Physical Education and Athletics

Engineering, Electrical and

Physics

Mechanical

Public Address

English

Psychology

Geography

Radio-Television

{nninor work Geology

only)

Romance Languages Sociology

German Government

Speech and

Hearing Therapy

History

Zoology

THE GRADUATE COLLEGE

The graduate program at Ohio University provides advanced pro- fessional training in the area of a student's field of specialization and affords opportunities for the conduct of research and special investiga- tions in these same areas. The program of graduate study should be- come an initiation into methods of intensive study and research in some selected area of knowledge. It is the objective of the Graduate College to provide its students with a high degree of professional competence.

The Graduate College confers the degree of Master of Arts, Master of Education, Master of Science, Master of Fine Arts, or Master of Business Administration.

The degree of Doctor of Philosophy is granted in certain selected areas of study in the University. At present these are Chemistry, Pub- lic Address, and Speech and Hearing Therapy. Detailed information on these programs may be found in the Graduate College bulletin.

ADMISSION. Students holding a bachelor's degree from an accredited college or university who have attained an undergraduate scholastic point-hour ratio of 2.5 or better on hours attempted, and preferably a 3,0 (B) in the area of the proposed major, may be admitted and granted regular status in the Graduate College. Further supporting evidence of the student's ability in the form of the Graduate Record Examination or other college ability tests and letters of recommendation may be re- quested.

Students holding a bachelor's degree from unaccredited institutions or persons whose undergraduate preparation is deficient will be required to supplement their undergraduate record with a satisfactory score on an acceptable standard college ability test.*

Students with a master's degree will be admitted to graduate study for the doctorate with the amount of graduate credit accepted, by trans- fer, subject to review and recommendation by the graduate committee of the department concerned.

All correspondence pertaining to the admission of a student to the Graduate College should be addressed to the Director of Admissions and University Examiner, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio.

Students are accepted for admission in advance of the beginning of each of the semesters of the regular year and at the beginning of each term of the summer session.

•Information regarding these examinations may be had at the office of the Director of Admissions or the office of the Supervisor of Testing Service. While it is not re- quired except as indicated above, applicants for admission may submit their scores on the Graduate Record Examination as valuable evidence of fitness for admission. The Graduate Record Examination is a test of general intellectual ability. Those who have taken this test are urged to have the Graduate Record Office report their scores to the Director of Admissions, Ohio University. Examinations will be given in January, April, July, cind November. Further information about the Graduate Record Examina- tion may be obtained by writing to the Educational Testing Service, P. O. Box 592, Princeton. New Jersey. Applicants in the West Coast region should write to the Edu- cational Testing Service, P. O. Box 27896, Los Angeles 27, California.

160

ri

-•«gfc t

O

*f I

T f

a

f?r ^ ^'.ci'

The Graduate College 161

Application for admission consists of the presentation of an appli- cation blank filled in by the applicant, an official transcript of college credit, two small photographs of the applicant, a vaccination blank certified by a physician, and a medical history blank filled in by the ap- plicant and completed by a physician. The vaccination and medical his- tory blanks are not required if a student plans to attend the summer session only as a special student.

A graduate student who is attending another university may be ad- mitted for the summer session as a special transient student by present- ing an official statement of good standing from the university in which he is enrolled. Admission for the summer session only as a special stu- dent does not constitute admission to the regular academic year.

Admission to the Graduate College does not imply admission to candidacy for a degree.

For information concerning application for living quarters, write the Director of Housing, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio.

CLASSIFICATIONS OF STUDENTS ADMITTED TO GRADUATE STUDY:

1. Those students approved by the major department and the Dean of the Graduate College for unqualified admission to graduate study are granted regular status.

2. Students admitted under the provisions of special status may include those who wish to pursue course work with no intention of qualifying for a degree, those who are transient registrants, those who fail to qualify for admission to candidacy, and those with some deficiency in entrance requirements. Students in this last category may achieve regular status after the satisfactory completion of a prescribed program of study to remove deficiencies.

SENIORS AND GRADUATE STUDY. A student who is within nine hours of completing all requirements for the bachelor's degree at Ohio Uni- versity may take courses applying toward the master's degree, provided he otherwise meets the requirements of admission and secures the writ- ten recommendation from the dean of his college, the chairman of his major department, and approval of the Dean of the Graduate College. Request for the above privilege must be made in advance of registration through the Graduate College office.

REGISTRATION AND ASSIGNMENT TO ADVISERS. A student who quali- fies for admission to the Graduate College receives a permit to register. He then confers with the Dean of the Graduate College concerning the general nature of his interests in graduate study and is directed to the departmental chairman or chairman of the graduate committee who has supervision over the subject matter in the area of major interest. The chairman, together with the Dean of the Graduate College, will assign a faculty adviser in the major and minor fields to counsel with the grad- uate student and prepare the outline of graduate study. The outline is returned to the Graduate College office where it is filed and becomes a part of the record of the graduate student.

162 Ohio University

PROGRAM OF STUDY AND STUDENT LOAD. A student's program of study is made up of two parts, a major and a minor, unless a program otherwise arranged is approved by the adviser and the graduate commit- tee of the department. Since graduate work implies advanced study and some degree of specialization, a prescribed amount of undergraduate preparation in a subject or field of study is presupposed before graduate study may be undertaken in that subject or field. Naturally, the under- graduate preparation required to begin a graduate major is greater than that required to begin a graduate minor. In most departments a mini- mum of 18 semester hours of undergraduate work is required to begin a graduate major while 6 to 12 semester hours is required for the minor.

A master's program of graduate study without the thesis require- ment is now available to graduates preparing for educational work in the public schools. Students desiring the Master of Education degree may have a program of study arranged with or without thesis, provided the program is approved by the committee on graduate study in the major department.

The full-time load for a graduate student is 16 credit hours per semester (12 hours in the summer session of ten weeks). A student wishing to register for extra hours must secure approval of his major adviser and the Dean of the Graduate College.

STANDARDS OF WORK, All work submitted for graduate credit shall be of high quality. The minimum standard acceptable is a point-hour ratio of 3.0 in all courses attempted in fields chosen to meet degree re- quirements, with no grade below C, and not more than 20 per cent of the work accepted tvith a grade of C. A minimum average of B is required in all courses taken at Ohio University for application on the degree requirements.

RESIDENCE AND CREDIT. At least 32 semester hours of credit are required for the master's degree. A maximum of eight semester hours of graduate credit with A or B grades may be accepted by transfer from approved institutions which offer the master's degree, provided the transferred course work is acceptable to the student's adviser and is not more than five years old. Credit for courses taken by correspon- dence is not accepted toward the degree. A maximum of six semester hours taken off campus is accepted toivard the master's degree, provided the courses are conducted by< instructors who regularly teach thon on the campus. A minimum of six semesters of study and research beyond the bachelor's degree is needed to meet the requirements of the doctor's degree. At least two semesters of the doctoral program of study shall be in continuous residence at Ohio University, preferably the last semesters of study for the degree. The continuous residence require- ment applies to the period of graduate study following the completion of the master's degree or the equivalent of 32 semester hours.

The amount of credit accepted by transfer from another university will be determined by the graduate committee of the department con- cerned and the Dean of the Graduate College.

The Graduate College 16S

REQUIREMENTS FOR THE DEGREES. Detailed information on specific requirements involving admission to candidacy, comprehensive exam- inations, preparation of the thesis or dissertation, time limit for meet- ing requirements, and other details of the graduate programs are de- scribed in the Bulletin and other publications of the Graduate College. For more explicit information address the Dean of the Graduate College.

GRADUATE ASSISTANTSHIPS; TEACHING AND RESEARCH FELLOWSHIPS. A number of graduate assistantships and research fellovv^ships are available in the Graduate College of Ohio University. Persons receiving these appointments are selected on a basis of merit from students who have received the baccalaureate degree from approved institutions and who wish to pursue work leading to the master's degree.

Graduate assistantships provide a stipend of $1600 to $1800 for the academic year of two semesters and waiver of all fees (resident and non-resident) with the exception of a $25 incidental fee. The graduate assistant is required to give approximately 18 hours of service weekly to the University, and is permitted to carry 9 to 12 hours of graduate work, the hours in excess of 9 being subject to the approval of the Dean of the Graduate College and the chairman of the department in which the student is serving as an assistant.

The general registration fee and laboratory fees will also be waived during the summer sessions directly preceding and following the period of a graduate assistant's appointment.

A graduate assistant continuing study for a second year is eligible for a second appointment to the assistantship. The assistant who has completed two semesters of service with an exceptionally good record may, on the recommendation of his department, be reappointed for a second year at an increased stipend with waiver of the fees as noted above. Reapplication must be made annually.

Graduate assistantships are usually available to qualified students in the following fields: accounting, bacteriology, botany, business edu- cation, chemistry, dramatic art and speech, economics, education, elec- trical engineering, English, finance, fine arts, French, government, his- tory, home economics (including nursery school), human relations, in- dustrial arts, journalism, management, mathematics, music, philosophy, photography, physical education, physics, psychology, sociology, Spanish, and zoology.

Teaching fellowships are granted to selected students in advanced graduate study and provide a stipend of $1800 to $2200 with the usual waiver of fees.

Research fellowships are established on the basis of grants-in-aid to the University for the conduct of research. Appointees to these fellow- ships must show exceptional aptitude for research. Their obligation involves the promotion of the research program of the department through which the grant is made. Fellows have no instructional service to perform and may normally carry 9 to 12 semester hours of work to- ward their graduate program. In general, the stipend and waiver of fees will be the same as that of an assistantship.

164 Ohio University

APPOINTMENTS IN PERSONNEL WORK. Positions are open annually for graduate assistants who will be appointed to assist the Personnel Deans. These assistants may pursue graduate work in human relations, psychology, and related fields. Stipend and other terms are the same as those of other graduate assistants.

Graduate appointments are also available to married men, with no children, as Heads of Residence in the dormitories for men. The com- pensation for this service is a furnished apartment and board for the man and wife, a stipend of $700 per year plus the waiver of fees as indicated for the graduate assistant. The Head of Residence will super- vise the functions of the dormitory and coordinate the responsibilities of graduate assistants assigned to work with him. He is limited to nine hours of course work per semeser.

Applications for all graduate appointments must be filed with the Dean of the Graduate College by March 1. Application blanks may be obtained from the office of the Graduate College.

SCHOLARSHIPS. University scholarships are available to college graduates who have maintained a high scholastic record. These permit full-time study and pay the basic registration (resident or non-resident) fee. Information may be obtained by addressing the Director of Student Financial Aids, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio.

THE DIVISIONS THE BRANCHES

ALBERT C. GUBITZ, DEAN

THE DIVISION OF PHYSICAL EDUCATION AND ATHLETICS

CARROLL C. VViDDOES, DIRECTOR

W. J. TRAUTWEIN, ASSOCIATE DIRECTOR

CARL T. NESSLEY, ASSISTANT DIRECTOR

THE RESERVE OFFICERS' TRAINING CORPS

JAMES R. PATRICK, COORDINATOR

BURTON S. ANDREWS, P.M.S.T.

CALEB POWERS MOBERLY, P.A.S.

THE UNIVERSITY EXTENSION DIVISION

GILFORD W. CROWELL, ACTING DIRECTOR

THE SUMMER SESSION

GILFORD W. CROWELL, ACTING DIRECTOR

THE BRANCHES

Branches of Ohio University are located in Chillicothe, Ironton, Lancaster, Martins Ferry, Portsmouth, and Zanesville. Work at the freshman and sophomore levels is offered. Branches were originally established in 1946 in Chillicothe, Portsmouth, and Zanesville to accom- modate the large number of World War II veterans desiring to enter college. They continued to develop and are now a permanent and significant part of the total University program. The branches in Lancaster and Ironton were established in 1956. The Martins Ferry Branch opened in 1957.

All qualified high school graduates and adults are eligible to take work in the branches and may earn up to two years of credit in the fields of commerce, arts and sciences, and education. One year of credit may be earned in engineering and fine arts. A limited amount of gradu- ate work is also offered. A two-year technical institute curriculum at the Zanesville Branch allows interested high school graduates and adults an opportunity to train as engineering technicians. Work given in the branches is like that given on the main campus, with students receiving full residence credit. Many students after the second year transfer to the main campus or to other colleges and universities to complete the baccalaureate degree.

The Cadet Teacher program is featured in each branch and makes possible the completion of all requirements for the Cadet Teaching cer- tificate. Twenty scholarships, ten freshmen and ten sophomore, are awarded annually in each branch to students in the Cadet Teaching program. Locally sponsored scholarships are also available.

Thousands of students have received training through the branch program, which allows them to pursue a college education while living at home and working full time or part time.

THE DIVISION OF PHYSICAL EDUCATION AND ATHLETICS

For nearly a century colleges and universities have to some degree recognized a responsibility for programs of student health practices, re- quired physical education, recreational activities, intramural sports or intercollegiate athletics. Ohio University has kept abreast of this edu- cational movement. It is now developing extensive plans for an ex- pansion of facilities and programs to meet the increasing demands of the future.

One problem which is particularly significant for technically trained and professional people arises out of a developing conflict between the forces of a commercial and industrial civilization and the biological needs of growing, developing, human organisms. Modern man faces the

166

The Division of Physical Education and Athletics 167

necessity of preserving the achievements of his evolution. Urbaniza- tion and mechanical progress have taken away from large segments of our population natural forms of activity which developed organic structure, muscular tonus and coordination. Formerly one's develop- mental activities, if he were to survive, were inherent in the driving necessities of his daily life. Rapid changes in our culture and patterns of living have necessitated substitutions of sports, hobbies, recreational skills, and methods of adaptation to a more sedentary life with larger portions of leisure time. This was not an acute problem even two gen- erations ago. It is important in these times, and it will become increas- ingly imperative in the future that educational programs be directed to this problem in our society.

Participation in selected physical activities which are harmonious with one's ability and desires contributes something to general health, endurance, physical skill, mental and emotional poise, and to interesting recreational forms. These activities should be engaged in throughout life in order to develop and maintain an efficient physiology. When students ignore this phase of their education, they should understand that they are closing doors against many interesting and beneficial activities which would contribute to better living. In addition to purely physical development, sports and athletic programs are rich with possi- bilities for the acquiring of social intelligence, sportsmanship, recrea- tional skills and lasting friendships. These qualities fit into the Ameri- can way of living.

With this in mind the Division of Physical Education and Athletics is pursuing a broad educational program which is designed to fit the diversified interests of all men and women at the University. The func- tions of the Division fall into the following categories:

1. Close coordination with the program of health services directed by physicians and nurses at the University Health Center.

2. Required physical education courses for men and women.

(a) The physical education program for men includes dual, individual and team sports, aquatics, combatives, gymnastics, and rhythmics.

Two semesters of physical education are required. Near the close of each semester physical proficiency and sports tests may be taken and, meeting prescribed standards, this requirement could be reduced. For a detailed description of this plan refer to page 70.

(b) The two-semester required physical education program for women is on a basis of choice selected from four areas: sports and games, swimming, rhythmics, and outing activities. For addition- al information refer to page 70.

3. Adapted Activities.

Men and women who for any medical reason are unable to par- ticipate in the regular progi*am are assigned with medical permis- sion to a class where they will be directed in activities adapted to their special needs.

168 Ohio University

4. Intercollegiate Athletics.

Ohio University is a charter member of the Mid- American Con- ference which is composed of seven prominent universities in the Midwest area. The other members are Miami, Toledo, Western Michigan, Kent, Bowling Green, and Marshall.

In the administration, financing, organization and management of the intercollegiate athletic program, the Division of Physical Education and Athletics adheres to the amateur code and policies of the National Collegiate Athletic Association. All students are en- couraged and welcomed to try out for any team of their choice. Ohio University teams go into competition thoroughly coached and trained to play hard and clean athletics. This training under ex- cellent leadership makes it a privilege and an honor to participate on athletic teams at the University.

Medical attention for athletic squads is under the attention of a team physician. He has at his disposal the personnel and facili- ties of a modern university hospital, and is aided by a qualified and experienced trainer.

University teams are organized in the following sports: foot- ball, basketball, baseball, track, wrestling, cross country, golf, soccer, tennis, swimming, and riflery.

5. Intramural sports and recreational activities.

The Division offers an extensive program of intramural sports for men and women. Students are encouraged to make use of all available facilities in their leisure time. This provides a way for all students to participate in sports and recreation. Upon request, clubs will be organized in sports or physical recreation activities as facilities and personnel are available.

6. Major and minor curricula.

Major and minor curricula are offered for prospective teachers of health education, physical education, athletic coaching, and recreational leadership. By fulfilling the requirements, students who vv^ish to major in the Division of Physical Education and Ath- letics will apply for the degree, Bachelor of Science in Education.

A major in physical education and athletics prepares men and wo- men students for the following positions: teacher of physical education in the elementary and secondary schools, teacher of health, playground director, athletic coach, camp counselor, and recreational leader for industrial concerns and municipalities. The University has been suc- cessful in assisting well-qualified graduates to find placement.

All students majoring in physical education and athletics are re- quired to purchase a uniform as prescribed by the Division.

The Division encourages major students to assist with the instruc- tion in men's and women's physical activity classes. This experience is advantageous to a prospective teacher.

The Division of Physical Education and Athletics 169

A minor in physical education and athletics is the minimum pro- gram acceptable to the State Department of Education for teaching physical education and coaching athletic teams in the secondary schools of Ohio.

A minor in health education will qualify the student to assume health education responsibilities in the elementary and secondary schools.

A minor in recreation will prepare the student for leadership in school, industrial and community recreation, summer playground pro- grams and outing or camping activities.

The university requirements pertaining to English composition, physical education, and speech are not indicated in the curricula below. See pages 69, 70 and 76.

The following courses constitute a teaching major in physical edu- cation and athletics:

MEN Freshman Program

First Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

Zool. 3— Principles of Zoology 3 P. E. 66— Program Skills 2

P. E. 65— Program Skills 2

Sophomore Program

P. E. 102— Personal and Community Ed. 103— Studies of Children 3

Health 3 P. E. 122— Program Skills 1

P. E. 121 Program Skills 2 Zool. 134 Anatomy, Kinesiology and

P. E. 127— First Aid 2 Physiology 4

Zool. 133 Anatomy, Kinesiology and P. E. 150 Recreation 3

GPhysiology 4

Junior Program

P. E. 233— Theory of Adapted Activities 2 P. E. 135— Program Techniques 1

P. E. 267— Athletic Coaching 2-4 P. E. 268— Athletic Coaching 2-4

Psych. 310— Mental Hygiene or P. E. 269— Teaching of Health 3

P. E. 395— School Health Problems 3

Senior Program

P. E. 304— History and Principles 3 P. E. 306 Organization and

Administration 2

WOMEN

Freshman Program

iFirst Semester Hours Second Semester Hours

P. E. 1 Hockey, Soccer (1) and P. E. 4 Intermediate Swimming (1) and

P. E. 7 Beginning Modern Dance 1 P. E. 8 Intermediate Modern Dance 1

Zool. 3 Principles of Zoology 3

Sophomore Program

P. E. 6— Elementary Tap Dancing 1 P. E. 122— Progi-am Skills 1

P. E. 121 Program Skills 2 Zool. 134 Anatomy, Kinesiology and

P. E. 127— First Aid 2 .Physiology 4

P. E. 150— Recreation 3 P. E. 102— Personal and Community

Zool. 133 Anatomy, Kinesiology and Health 3

Physiology 4

170

Ohio University

Junior Program

P. E. 131— Mass Games 1 P. E. 233— Theory of Adapted Activities 2

P. E. 272 Coaching Methods 2 H, E. 161 Home Nursing and Family

P. E. 17— Beginning Tennis 1 Health (2) or

P. E. 269— Teaching of Health 3 Psych. 310— Mental Hygiene (3) or

P. E. 273— Coaching Methods 2 P. E. 395— School Health Problems (3) 2-8

Ed. 103— Studies of Children 3 P. E. 275— Teaching of Ballroom and

P. E. 274 Teaching of Folk Dancing _ 1 Modern Dance 1

Senior Program

P. E. 304 History and Principles of Physical Education and Athletics 3

P. E. 306 Organization and Adminis- Itration of Physical Education and Athletics 2

The following' courses are suggested to meet the minimum of 24 semester hours required by the State Department of Education for a teaching minor in health education and physical education: Hours

1. Principles and Organization 5

MEN AND WOMEN

P.E. 304 History and Principles of Physical Education and Athletics (3).

P.E. 306 Organization and Administration of Physical Ed- ucation and Athletics (2).

2. Theory and Practice

MEN P. E. 65— Program Skills (2) P. E. 66— Program Skills (2) P. E. 121— Program Skills (2) P. E. 122— Program Skills (1)

3. Theory and Coaching

iMEN P. E. 139 Athletic Officiating (2) P. E. 267— Athletic Coaching (2-4) P. E. 181 Intramural Sports (2) P. E. 268— Athletic Coaching (2-4)

4. Health Education

WOMEN P. E. 6 Elementary Tap Dancing (1) P. E. 7 Beginning Modern Dance (1) P. E. 8 Intermediate Modern Dance (1) P. E. 15— Folk and National Dancing (1) P. E. 121. 122— Program Skills (2-4) P. E. 131— Mass Games (1)

WOMEN P. E. 272— Coaching Methods (2) P. E. 273— Coaching Methods (2) P. E. 139 or 140 Athletic Officiating (2)

7-8

MEN AND WOMEN

P.E. 102 Personal and Community Health (3)

P.E. 269— Teaching of Health (3)

Elect from following (2-3) : P.E. 127— First Aid (2) P.E. 128— Physical Therapy (2) P.E. 142— Camp Leadership (2) Ind. A. 5 Driver Education (1)

5. Biological Life Sciences

The following courses constitute a state certified minor in health education :

MEN AND WOMEN

Speech 1 Fundamentals of Speech 1

P. E. 102 Personal and Community Health 3

Ed. 103— Studies of Children 3

P. E. 127— First Aid 2

Zool. 133-134 Anatomy, Kinesiology and Physiology 8

P. E. 289— Teaching of Health 3

Psych. 310 Mental Hygiene 3

P. E. 395— School Health Problems 3

26

The Reserve Officers' Training Corps Division 171

The following courses constitute a minor in recreation leadership:

MEN AND WOMEN

Soc. 101 Principles of Sociology 3

Speech 3 Public Speaking 2

Ind. A. 9— Crafts and Hobby Work 2

P. E. 15 Folk and National Dancing- 1

P. E. (65-66)— (121-122) Program Skills 2

P. E. 127— First Aid 2

P. E. 150 Recreation (Social and party games, low cost crafts,

square dance, theories of play, institutional recreation) 3

P. E. 349 Community Recreation forganization & adminis- tration, finance, facilities, history of, play ground super- vision) 3

18

Elective courses :

P. E. 7 Beginning Modern Dance

P. E. 8 Intermediate Modern Dance

P. E. (65-66)— (121-122) Program Skills

Dram. A. 105 Play Production

P. E. 114— Camp Craft

P. E. 118— Life Saving and Water Safety

P. E. 142 Camp Leadership

P. E. 153 Nature and Function of Play

P. E. 275 Teaching of Ballroom and Modem Dance

P. E. 274 Teaching of Folk Dancing

Elect from the above to total a minimum of 24 hours.

THE RESERVE OFFICERS' TRAINING CORPS DIVISION

GENERAL. Ohio University maintains a Senior Division, Reserve Officers' Training Corps, consisting of two coequal departments:

THE DEPARTMENT OF MILITARY SCIENCE AND TACTICS

THE DEPARTMENT OF AIR SCIENCE

In 1935, the Board of Trustees entered into an agreement with the Government for the establishment of a voluntary ROTC unit which, during subsequent years, has been developed and expanded into the two coequal departments indicated above. A coordinator appointed by the president of the University coordinates affairs of the ROTC and acts as liaison officer between these departments and the university admini- stration.

Each department chairman is the senior officer on duty in the department and is referred to either as the Professor of Military Science and Tactics (P.M.S.T.) or the Professor of Air Science (P.A.S.). Other officers are assigned as assistant professors and enlisted men are assigned as instructors.

Each department offers a two-year basic course and a two-year advanced course. Enrollment in either course is elective and may be pursued as a course for elective credits required for a degree. However, once either course is elected by a student, it becomes a prerequisite for graduation, unless he is relieved from this obligation by the secretary of the Army or the Air Force.

172 Ohio University

MISSION. The mission of university-level Reserve Officers' Training is to train college students who have the qualities and attributes essen- tial to progressive and continued development so that they may take their places as junior officers in the Regular and Reserve components. In addition, the Army ROTC program provides a source of procure- ment of junior officers for the Regular Army through the selection of outstanding students for direct appointments as second lieutenants. The Air Force ROTC designates certain Distinguished Cadets who may apply for Regular Air Force Commissions and receive special consider- ation. All others commissioned by the Air Force ROTC are also eligible to apply for Regular Air Force commissions after serving a part of their active duty tour.

ENTRANCE REQUIREMENTS. In general, any physically qualified male student, who is a citizen of the United States and is more than 14 years of age yet has not reached his twenty-third birthday is eligible for enrollment in the basic course. Certain exceptions to age require- ments may be made in the case of veterans.

Applicants for the advanced course must have completed or re- ceived credit for the basic course and must meet current selection criteria and must not have reached their twenty-fifth birthday at time of enrollment in the advanced course.

It is necessary for nonveteran students desiring to complete the entire ROTC course to register for ROTC when they first enter college as four years are required to complete the course.

OBLIGATION. A member of the ROTC is not in the military service of the United States and membership in the ROTC carries no legal obligation to serve in any of the Armed Forces. The only obligation is to complete the basic or advanced course, once either course is elected.

DRAFT DEFERMENTS. Since the mission of the ROTC is to produce junior officers who can be called to serve in times of national emergency, the Armed Forces are authorized to grant deferments from military service, subject to quota limitations, to students who are pursuing a ROTC course and who maintain a satisfactory scholastic standing in their academic studies. At present, the authorized quota is sufficient to defer most formally enrolled ROTC students. Military service is an obligation of citizenship and the deferments granted to ROTC students in no way cancel their obligations under the existing selective service law. All students who are granted deferment from military service are required to sign a "Deferment Agreement" under the provision of Public Law 51, the Universal Military Training and Service Act of 1951.

UNIFORMS AND EQUIPMENT. Textbooks, training equipment and complete uniforms are issued to all ROTC students without cost. These articles remain the property of the United States and must be returned. Each ROTC student is required to make a $20 deposit with the treasurer of the University to cover loss or damage to issued property. This deposit is refunded when all items have been returned to the military property custodian.

The Reserve Officers' Training Corps Division 173

Students entering the advanced course receive without cost a com- plete, tailored officer-type uniform. Upon completion of the advanced course, the student retains this uniform as his own. An allowance of $0.90 per day is paid to all enrolled advanced course students, except during the period of attendance at summer camp. During attendance at summer camp, students receive pay amounting to approximately $78 per month and other allowances. Thus it is possible for a cadet to receive over $700 while in the advanced course.

ROTC COURSES. (See "Courses of Instruction" for a detailed de- scription of ROTC courses.)

ARMY:

The General Military Science program is designed to prepare the individual for a commission in any of the various branches which make up the Army. For example, during recent years Army ROTC graduates of Ohio University have been commissioned in the Adjutant General Corps, Armor, Artillery, Chemical Corps, Finance Corps, Infantry, Medical Service Corps, Ordnance Corps, Quartermaster Corps, and Signal Corps. Assignment to branch will depend on several factors including the needs of the service, the desires of the individual, and his academic background. Every effort will be made to commission Army ROTC graduates in a branch for which they are particularly well fitted by virtue of their college training. From this it may be seen that there are many opportunities available to the student who receives a com- mission in the Army. Individuals commissioned as a result of their Army ROTC training may be called to active duty for a period of from six months to two years thus fulfilling their military obligation as required by existing laws.

AIR FORCE:

The Air Force ROTC course of study is divided into the basic course covering the first two years and the advanced course covering the junior year, summer camp, and the senior year in that order. The course consists of blocks of instruction totaling 480 hours, allocated as follows: freshman and sophomore years 90 hours each; junior and senior years 150 hours each. In addition, courses of instruction are provided at the summer camp. (See "Courses of Instruction.") This course is designed to provide that fundamental training, both personal and professional, which will best fit the cadet to become a well-rounded junior Air Force officer possessing a high growth potential; and to develop and stimulate a growing desire on his part to enter the Air Force flight training program. Upon completing the course and being selected for commissioning he is assigned a military occupational specialty in accordance with his academic training, his desires and job experience. Cadets who are commissioned may be required to serve a minimum of three years of active duty to fulfill their military obligation as required by existing laws.

174 Ohio University

COMMISSIONS. Students who have completed the basic course and certain veterans are eligible to apply for the advanced course, specializ- ing in that department and branch of service for which their basic training and academic background have fitted them. A student who successfully completes the advanced course and his academic studies leading to a baccalaureate degree may be offered a commission as a second lieutenant in the U.S. Army Officers' Reserve Corps or the U.S. Air Force Reserve.

Students who have successfully completed the first year of the Army ROTC advanced course and have shown evidence of outstanding achievement in scholarship or extra-curricular activities are eligible for appointment as "distinguished military students" upon recommen- dation of the president of the University and the P.M.S.T. Distinguish- ed military students are eligible to apply for commissions in the Regular Army. Those students who are selected for Regular Army commissions will be so appointed upon their graduation from the University.

The Air ROTC has a similar program of designation of distinguish- ed AFROTC students. Such students may apply for Regular Air Force commissions and receive special consideration. All other graduates with Air Force Reserve officer corn-missions are eligible to apply for Regular Air Force commissions after serving on active duty.

SPECIAL SCHOOLING. Under the provisions of the Army and Air Force Civilian School program, Army and Air Force commissioned graduates may apply for graduate study in specialized fields such as -automotive engineering, electronics, meteorology, nuclear physics, busi- ness administration, economics, educational administration, and psychol- ogy. These specialized studies are pursued at government expense by the student officer in residence at distinguished and eminently qualified in- stitutions and lead to a master's degree, or in exceptional cases, to the degree of Doctor of Philosophy.

THE UNIVERSITY EXTENSION DIVISION

The University Extension Division offers work in the form of exten- sion classes and correspondence study. It is approved by and holds membership in the National University Extension Association.

EXTENSION CLASSES. An instructor will be sent to a community once a week for an extension class provided a sufficient number of persons has agreed upon a course. The number necessary depends upon the dis- tance from the campus. The number and length of class periods are determined by the amount of credit allowed for the course.

CORRESPONDENCE STUDY. Courses in many departments are offered and are taught by members of the regular faculty. These courses appeal to any person who wishes to engage in systematic study during his spare time. They may be studied on a credit basis or a non-credit basis, and registration can be made at any time.

The Summer Session 175

ADMISSION. An extension class student or a correspondence student is not required to present an application for admission to the University. A student under 21 years of age cannot enroll in an extension class or in correspondence study for college credit unless he has fifteen units of high school work earned in an accredited secondary school. A person 21 years of age, or over, however, who lacks the required high school units for college entrance may enroll for college credit in any course if the instructor finds him qualified to carry the course.

To be admitted to Ohio University for correspondence instruction or for extension class instruction does not imply that the student will be admitted later for study in residence. A sepai-ate application must be filed with the Director of Admissions for admission to residence study.

CREDIT. In extension classes and in correspondence study a student may earn as many as 40 semester hours toward the requirements for a bachelor's degree.

No credit toward a master's degree may be earned by the corre- spondence method.

Students who are employed full time are limited to a registration of six hours each semester.

If a student is currently registered in residence at Ohio University, or at another college or university, he must have the written permission of his dean to enroll in correspondence study.

BLANKS. Applications for correspondence instruction may be se- cured from the Director of the Extension Division. Registration blanks for extension class instruction may be obtained from the instructor when the class is organized.

Persons interested in any of the opportunities afforded by the Ex- tension Division may obtain additional information by writing to the Director of University Extension, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio.

THE SUMMER SESSION

The Summer Session at Ohio University consists of two five-week terms. It represents a cross section of the total program of the Uni- versity. Enrollment in the Session in conjunction with the two semesters provides an opportunity for year-round study. A student who enrolls at Ohio University immediately after high school graduation and who attends all summer sessions, may i-easonably expect to graduate in three years.

A special bulletin covering the offerings of the Summer Session is available and may be secured by sending a request to the Dii'ector of the Summer Session, Ohio University, Athens, Ohio.

COURSES OF INSTRUCTION

Course offerings of tfie University grouped and listed alphabetically according to departments

COURSES OF INSTRUCTION

EXPLANATION

CATALOG NUMBER. The catalog number indicates the student classi- fication for which the course is primarily intended.

1- 99 for Freshmen 100-199 for undergraduates above the Freshman level 200-299 for advanced undergraduates (Juniors and Seniors) 300-399 for advanced undergraduates and graduates 400-499 for graduates

In genera], an odd number indicates the first semester of a two- semester course; an even number, the second semester. An exception occurs in the numbers used for the teaching techniques courses.

Two numbers at the beginning of a course indicate a two-semester or year course. A hyphen between the numbers indicates that the course is a continuous course; that is, the first semester course is a prerequisite for the second semester. A com/ma between the numbers indicates that although the course is a two-semester course, the first semester course is not a prerequisite for the second semester,

CREDIT. Credit for a course is indicated by the number or numbers in parentheses following the course title, and, in case of a year course, is shown for each semester. In a semester course it may be expressed thus : (3), (1 to 3), or (2 or 3); in a year course, (3-3), (3,3), (1 to 3— 1 to 3), or (2 or 3—2 or 3).

A course with one semester hour credit (1) is the equivalent of one recitation or two or more laboratory periods a week throughout a se- mester.

In a course carrying variable credit the credit may be expressed thus, (1 to 4), indicating that one hour is the minimum and four hours the maximum amount of credit allowed for the course in one semester. A student may enroll for a course with a variable credit any number of times and for any number of semester hours, within the semester limit, provided the total registration for the course does not exceed the maxi- mum credit indicated in the course description.

Course prerequisites are indicated at the end of course descriptions following the abbreviation, "Prereq."

INSTRUCTORS. The instructors in a department are arranged ac- coi'ding to seniority of service within the respective ranks as of December 1957.

FEE. When a course requires a private instructional fee, the amount is stated in the description of the course.

CLASS SCHEDULE. A Schedule of Classes is available each semester from the Registrar.

178

Accounting 179

ACCOUNTING Professors Roy, Beckert (chairman)

Associate Professors Fenzel, Reininga

Assistant Professor Via

Instructor McLaren

75-76. ELEMENTARY ACCOUNTING (3-3) Beclcert. Fenzel, McLaren, Ray,

Reininga, Via

The fundamental principles of accounting theory and practice as they affect corporations, partnerships, and proprietorships.

125-126. INTERMEDIATE ACCOUNTING (3-3) Beclcert, Fenzel, Reninga

Preparation and analysis of accounting statements; special problems in accounting for current, fixed, and intangible assets, for liabilities, and for corporate net worth; funds and reserves; and investments. Prereq., 76.

175. COST ACCOUNTING (3) Ray

Manufacturing cost determination under the job-order and process systems. Prereq,, 125 or 76 and permission.

217, TAX ACCOUNTING (2) Reininga

Beginning study of Federal income taxes and State taxes for indi- viduals, partnerships, and corporations. Prereq., 125.

261. TEACHING OF BOOKKEEPING AND BASIC BUSINESS (2) Beckert

Prereq., 125.

275. GOVERNMENTAL AND INSTITUTIONAL ACCOUNTING (2) Staff

An application of general accounting principles to state, city, and county fund units such as the general, special assessments, highway, and other funds; and to institutions such as hospitals, universities, and other endowed institutions. Prereq., 126,

305-306. ADVANCED ACCOUNTING (3) McLaren

Problems peculiar to partnerships, receiverships, fiduciaries, in- stallment sales, consignments, insurance, estates and trusts; compound interest applications; governmental accounting; branches, consolidations, and mergers; and foreign exchange. Prereq., 126.

324. STANDARD COSTS AND BUDGETS (3) Ray

The establishment of standard costs, preparation of budgets, and analysis of cost variances. Prereq., 175.

343. FEDERAL INCOME TAX ACCOUNTING (2) Reininga

Study of advanced tax problems of individuals, partnerships, and corporations including tax planning and administration. Prereq., 217,

355. INDUSTRIAL AUDITING AND INTERNAL CONTROL (3) Beclcerf Study of types of internal audits, audit reports, fraud, and an

appraisal of the standards of internal auditing as a profession, Basic and internal controls are studied in their relation to the auditor's program, Prereq,, 126 and 175,

356. AUDITING PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE (3) Beckert Purposes and scope of audits and examinations; audit principles

and procedure; application of audit principles to practice material based on actual audit; and audit reports and certificates. Prereq., 126 and 175,

378. C.P.A, PROBLEMS (3) Reininga

The accounting profession; C.P,A, coaching; analysis, interpreta- tion, and solution of state board problems, Prereq., 175, 306, 356.

180 Ohio Univeirsity

379. CONTROLLERSHIP (3) Reininga

Case method study of problems and policy-forming decisions of the controllership function comprising the fields of general accounting, internal control, budgeting, taxes, cost control, and financial reporting. Prereq., 18 hrs. accounting including 324 which may be taken con- currently.

381. RESEARCH IN ACCOUNTING (lto8) Staff

Prereq., 306, 324 and permission.

391. SEMINAR IN ACCOUNTING {2 to 4) Staff

Maximum credit in course, 10 hrs. Prereq., 15 hrs. accounting and permission.

495. THESIS (lto6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

ADVERTISING Professor Krauskopf

Associate Professors Paynter (chairman), Turnbull, Raymond

Assistant Professor Ricnmond

155. ADVERTISING PRINCIPLES (3) Krauskopf, Raymond, Richmond, Turnbull

A survey of advertising which considers its place in the field of marketing and its fundamental procedures. Prereq., Mkt. 155 or permis- sion.

286. RETAIL ADVERTISING (3) Krauskopf, Richmond

The principles of advertising as related to the needs of retailers. Prereq., 155.

332. COPY WRITING (2) Turnbull

The elementary essentials of copy developed by the study of current theory and analysis of tested examples. Considerable constructive work is required. Prereq., 155 and Ec. 12 or 102.

376. ADVERTISING PROBLEMS (3) Krauskopf, Richmond

A logical sequel to Advt. 155. It emphasizes administrative prob- lems and the coordination of advertising with other marketing activities. Prereq., 155.

381. RESEARCH IN ADVERTISING (lto8) Staff

Prereq., 18 hrs. commerce including 5 hrs. advertising and permis- sion.

391. SEMINAR IN ADVERTISING (2to4) Staff

Maximum credit in course, 10 hrs. Prereq., 18 hrs. commerce in- cluding 5 hrs. advertising and permission.

495. THESIS (lto6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

Additional courses:

Psych. 135 Psychology of Advertising and Selling

Jour. 146 Typography, Mechanics, and Makeup

Jour. 247 Newspaper Advertising and Layout

Jour. 277 Newspaper Advertising Practice

Jour. 327 Public Relations Techniques

Jour. 328 Public Relations

Jour. 348 Advertising Production

Jour. 309 Radio TV Advertising and Management

Art 147-148 Advertising Design

Agriculture 181

AGRICULTURE Associate Professor DeVeau (chairman)

Instructor and Farm Superintendent Stright

1,2. INTRODUCTION TO AGRICULTURE (3.3) DeVeau

A two semester general education course for all students to develop an understanding of the efficient use and conservation of agriculture's resources. A survey of the different agricultural enterprises, their interrelationships, and their relation to state and national agricultural problems. Identification of crops and livestock and their use. 2 lee. and 2 lab. (Yearly.)

30. FORESTRY (3) S+right

The practical application of forest products to the farm including identification of common trees and woods. 2 lee. and 2 lab. (Each se- mester.)

102. GARDENING (3) DeVeau

A study of the production, marketing, and preservation of vege- tables for the home and market. A survey of plants raised in the garden and greenhouse. Garden planning and flower arrangement. 2 lee. and 2 lab. (2nd semester.)

104. FRUIT PRODUCTION (3) Strrght

Study of propagation, planting, fruit-setting, nutrition, thinning, disease and insect control, harvesting, grading, and marketing of tree and small fruits. (2nd semester.)

121. LIVESTOCK MANAGEMENT (4) DeVeau

The fundar«entals of dairy, poultry, and general livestock pro- duction. A study of feeding programs, breeding methods, housing, judg- ing and selection, record keeping, disease control, and marketing. 3 lee. and 3 lab. (1st semester.)

201-202. AGRICULTURAL PRACTICES (3-3) DeVeau, Stright

Practical experience either on the University farm or in the Uni- versity greenhouse. 1 lee. and 4 lab. (Yearly.)

216. CROPS AND SOILS (4) DeVeau A study of the common grain and forage crops. Soil types and

their relation to crop production. Use and analysis of manures and fer- tilizers. 3 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., Geol. 106. (2nd semester.)

217. SOIL CONSERVATION (3) Stright A study of recommended practices in soil conservation for practical

application on the farm. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 216 or permission. (1st semester.)

235. FARM MANAGEMENT (3) DeVeau

The application of agricultural technology and economic informa- tion to the securing of maximum income from the farm. Experience in planning a five year farm program for a specific farm in the local community. 2 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., 121, 216. (1st semester.)

320. AGRICULTURAL ORGANIZATIONS (3) DeVeau

A study of the major educational, commercial, cooperative and service agencies organized to promote agriculture and rural living. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq. 15 hr. agriculture or commerce or both, per- mission. (2nd semester.)

182 Ohio University

322. AGRICULTURAL PROBLEMS (1-4) Staff

Intensive individual work either in research or in systematic read- ing or both in some advanced phase of agriculture under the guidance of the instructor to meet the needs and interests of the student. Maxi- mum credit in course 9 hrs. Prereq. 15 hrs. and permission. (Each semester.)

381. RESEARCH IN AGRICULTURE (2-4) Staff

Independent research. Maximum credit in course 6 hours. Prereq., 18 hrs. and permission. (Each semester.)

ARCHAEOLOGY AND ANTIQUITIES

Instructor Huitgren

101. INTRODUCTION TO ARCHAEOLOGY (3) Huitgren

The development of archaeology to its present status of dignity and scientific method. Aims, methods and techniques; general types of archaeological work and excavation with emphasis on important sites. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

252. ARCHAEOLOGY OF THE MEDITERRANEAN AREA (3) Huitgren

The archaeology of Egypt, Palestine, Greece, and the Aegean is- lands, with emphasis on Minoan (Cretan) and Mycenean civilization; to a lesser extent the archaeological remains of the Roman period. Prereq., 101, or 11 hrs. foreign language, or 8 hrs. history (or art history) and antiquities. (2nd sem., yearly.)

Additional courses (fuller descriptions under appropriate depart- ments) :

Art Hist. 371 Latin-American Art.* From the pre-Columbian period to the present. Term paper may be specifically archaeological.

Ed. 350 The History of Education. Including ancient, classical, medieval, and modern.

Eng. 284 Mythology in English and American Literature. Classical, Teutonic, and Scandinavian.

F.A. 121-122 History of Painting and Sculpture.* Art from the earliest times to the Renaissance.

F. A. 175-176 History of Architecture. From prehistoric times to the Renaissance.

Geol. 111-112 Historical Geology. Origin of the earth and its forms of life.

Geol. 251-252 Paleontology.* Invertebrate fossils, including larger forms of ancient animal life.

Hist. 115 Ancient History. From prehistoric times.

Lat. 331 The Life of the Romans.* Including evidence from archae- ology and antiquities.

Phil. 221 History of Western Philosophy: Ancient and Medieval.

•This and other courses starred are more specifically archaeological.

Architecture 183

ARCHITECTURE Associate Professor Denison

Assistant Professor OIpp Lecturer LeBoutillier

55. FUNDAMENTALS OF ARCHITECTURE (3) LeBoutillier Architecture as environmental design. 1 lee. and 4 lab.

56. ARCHITECTURAL GRAPHICS (3) LeBoutillier Drafting room exercises in the theory and techniques of architec- tural drawing. 1 lee. and 4 lab.

105. ARCHITECTURAL RENDERING (2) OIpp

Familiarization with basic techniques as used in architectural ren- dering. Pencil, pen, wash-drawing, and watercolor. Prereq., Art 1 and

2 or permission.

155-156. ARCHITECTURAL DESIGN (5-5) LeBoutillier

Design of non-residential buildings and their sites. 1 lee. and 6 lab. Prereq., .55 and 56.

179. ARCHITECTURAL MATERIALS (3) Denison

2 lee. Prereq., permission.

183. ARCHITECTURAL EQUIPMENT (3) Denison

Mechanical equipment used in buildings including plumbing and heating systems. 2 lee. Prereq., Phys. 5, 6 or permission.

257. FUNDAMENTALS OF RESIDENTIAL ARCHITECTURE (2) Denison

Lectures on residential architecture and housing. Prereq., permis-

258. DESIGN OF RESIDENTIAL ARCHITECTURE (3) Donison

Drafting room exercises supplementing material in 257. 6 lab. Prereq., 257.

281-282. ARCHITECTURAL CONSTRUCTION (2-2) Denison

Architectural construction in wood, steel, concrete, and masonry as applied to residential and small commercial and public buildings. 2 lee. Prereq,, Math 5, 6 or permission.

284. V/ORKING DRAWINGS (2) Denison

Drafting room application of the coordinated uses of materials and construction principles. 4 lab. Prereq., 179, 282.

285-286. SENIOR DESIGN (5-5) LeBoufillier

6 lab. Prereq., 156, 281, 282.

301. PROBLEMS IN ARCHITECTURE (1 to 3) StoH

Supervised individual projects. Maximum credit in course, 12 hrs. Pi'ereq., senior and junior majors.

375. ARCHITECTURE IN THE UNITED STATES (2) Denison

Development of architecture from colonial times. Prereq., 8 hrs., including F.A. 175-176 or equivalent.

184 Ohio University

ART Professors Mitchell, Way, Leach (director)

Associate Professors Willis, Work

Assistant Professors Leonard, C. L. Smith,

OIpp, Hostetler, D. O. Roberts

Instructors Freinnork, Mihal, Toth, Beale

Lecturers Mutchler, Kelly

ART HISTORY

302. THE NORTHERN RENAISSANCE (3) Leach

The Renaissance as it appeared in the Netherlands, Germany, France, and England in the fifteenth and sixteenth centuries, Prereq., F.A. 17 and 18 or permission.

303. ITALIAN RENAISSANCE PAINTING (3) OIpp Painting in Italy from the early Florentine and Sienese schools

through the fifteenth and sixteenth centuries. Prereq., F.A. 17 and 18 or permission.

304. MANNERISM AND THE BAROQUE (3) Leach Origin and development in Italy subsequent to 1520 with attention

to variations in the North of Europe and in England. Prereq., F.A. 17 and 18 or permission.

371. LATIN-AMERICAN ART (3) OIpp

Architecture, sculpture, and painting of the Hispanic Southwest, Mexico, Central America, the Caribbean area, and South America from Pre-Columbian times to the present. Prereq., F.A. 122, F.A. 176, or per- mission.

381. IMPRESSIONISM AND POST-IMPRESSIONISM (3) OIpp Emphasis in developments in French Art between the 1848 Revolu- tion and 1900. The problems of the Academy, Romanticism, Classicism, Realism, Impressionism, Post-Impressionism, Cezanne, and the Symbol- ists. Prereq., F.A. 17 and 18 or permission.

382. CUBISM, EXPRESSIONISM, AND LATER DEVELOPMENTS (3) Leach Appearance and development of basic artistic expressions from the

beginning of the twentieth century to the present. Prereq., F.A. 17 and 18 or permission.

390. SEMINAR IN ART HISTORY (2 or 3) SfaH

Individual and group problems on periods and movements. Detailed reports. Recommended for graduate students in the process of writing a thesis. Prereq., 18 hrs., including F.A, 122 and permission.

Additional courses: F.A. 121-122 History of Painting and Sculp- ture and F.A. 175-176 History of Architecture. Attention is called to Philosophy 302 Aesthetics.

ART

1-2. DRAWING AND DESIGN (3-3) Staff

Emphasis on the inseparability of drawing and design. Aesthetic principles are dealt with as they arise out of specific problems rather than as separate entities. Required of all freshmen.

Art 185

3. ELEMENTARY DESIGN FOR TEACHERS (2) Staff

Principles of design, color, lettering, and related problems. Planned for students who expect to major in elementary education. 1 lee. and 3 lab.

21. ELEMENTARY SCULPTURE (2) StaH

Theory and aesthetic application of principles of art with emphasis on volumetric organization. Required of all freshmen.

28. FIGURE DRAWING (2) Staff

Study of the human figure from the nude and draped model. Maxi- mum credit in course, 6 hrs.

91. DESIGN AND COMPOSITION (3) Willis

Special emphasis on color and design. Planned for students who expect to major in home economics. 1 lee. and 5 lab.

101-102. DRAWING AND DESIGN (3-3) Staff

Continuation of Art 1 and 2. Required of all Sophomores. Prereq., Art 1 and 2 or equivalent.

103-104. REPRESENTATION (3-3) Mitcfiell

Concentration on and analysis of the representational function in drawing and painting. Especial attention to the demands of scientific illustration. First semester's work in black and white, second semester's in color. Max. credit in course 6 hrs. Prereq., Art 1 and 2 or equivalent.

107. ADVANCED DESIGN (3) Willis

Composition in different media with special attention to practical application. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., Art 2.

111. DRAWING WORKSHOP (2) Freimark

Experimentation and familiarization with traditional and contem^- porary drawing techniques and media. Maximum credit in course 4 hrs. Prereq., Art 1 and 2 or equivalent.

113-114. LETTERING (3-3) Smitfi

Basic relationships to typography. Application in the production of posters, book jackets, trade-marks. Experimentation with various media. 6 lab. Prereq., Art 1 and 2 or equivalent.

115. CERAMICS (3) Hosfetler Production processes. Introduction to the chemistry of glazes and

simple geology of clays. Field trips to potteries and native clay deposits. 1 lee. and 5 lab.

116. CERAMICS (3) Hostetler

Decorative techniques. Slide lectures concerning decorative tech- niques of ancient and contemporary ceramic art. Introduction to glaze testing methods. 1 lee. and 5 lab. Prereq., Art 115.

118. WATER COLOR (3) Work

Painting in the studio and out-of-doors. 6 lab. Prereq., Art 2.

120. TEXTILE DESIGN (3) Way

Weaving, block printing, silk screen. Maximum credit in coui-se, G hrs. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., Art 2 or permission.

186 Ohio University

123. JEWELRY (2) Willis

Original designs executed in silver and copper. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. 1 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., Art 2 and permission.

125. ART IN EVERYDAY LIFE (2) Way

Appreciation and selection of the best articles available for the home, costume, etc., according to their functional qualities.

128. ADVANCED FIGURE DRAWING (3) Mutchler

Accent on anatomical construction. For students who have a mini- mum grade of "B" in the second semester of Art 28. Prereq., permission.

137. FASHION DESIGN (2) Way

Design in relation to dress and to individual characteristics. Adap- tation of historic styles to modern costume. 1 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., Art 2 or Art 91 and Art 28 or with 28.

147-148. ADVERTISING DESIGN (2-2) Smith

Slagazine, newspaper, and direct mail layout. Creative design and advertising production. 4 lab. Prereq., Art 113.

160. PRACTICAL DESIGN WORKSHOP FOR ELEMENTARY TEACHERS

(1 fo 3) Leonard, Miha! Problems in modeling, ceramics, murals, puppets, painting, and other activities related to the elementary school and philosophy of teaching. Prereq., Art 3.

205. PAINTING (2) StaH

Basic techniques and practices in oil painting. Maximum credit in course 12 hrs. Prereq., Art 2 or permission.

231. SCULPTURE (3) Hostetler

Modeling from life in clay and plaster. Work with terra-cotta, stone, wood, and metal. Maximum credit in course, 12 hrs. 6 lab. Prereq., Art 28.

240. DESIGN APPLIED TO MATERIALS (2) Mlhal

For art majors planning to teach art in the elementary and sec- ondary fields. Prereq., 9 hrs.

260. TEACHING OF ART (3) Way

Prereq., 20 hrs. as specified for certification.

271-272. INTERIOR DESIGN (3-3) Way

A brief study of architectural details and historic styles of furni- ture as used in modern homes. House plans, decorative treatments, and materials. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., Art 2 and permission.

301. INDIVIDUAL PROBLEMS (1-3) Staff

Senior and graduate registration for individual instruction. Prereq., permission. Max. credit in course 12 hrs.

309-310. PRINTS (3-3) Roberts

Silk screen, linoleum and wood blocks, etching, aquatint, dry point, lithography, and other related media. 2 lee. and 4 lab, Prereq., 12 hrs. and permission.

313. ADVANCED INTERIOR DESIGN (3) Way

Research is stressed and original adaptations are made from styles of important periods. Maximum credit in course, 12 hrs. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq,, Art 272 and permission.

Art 187

315. ADVANCED FORM AND COMPOSITION (2) StaH Maximum credit in course, 4 hrs. Prereq., 12 hrs. and permission.

316. ADVANCED CERAMICS (3) Hos+etler Advanced production methods. Construction of potter's wheel, ball

mill, and electric kilns. Advanced glaze and clay testing techniques. Maximum credit in course, 12 hrs. Prereq., 12 hrs., including Art 116 and permission.

317-318. ADVANCED ADVERTISING DESIGN (3-3) Smith

Magazine, new^spaper, direct mail, and display layout. Prereq., Art 148, and Advt. 155.

321. ADVANCED FASHION DESIGN AND ILLUSTRATION (2) Way

Maximum credit in course, 10 hrs. 1 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., 12 hrs., including Art 137 and Art 128.

325. ADVANCED JEWELRY (2) Willis

Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. 1 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., 12 hrs., including Art 123.

327. ENAMELING (2) Hoste+ler Design and construction of metallic objects toward ceramic applica- tion of enamels. 1 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., 12 hrs., including Art 115 and Art 123.

328. FIGURE PAINTING (3) Mutchler Painting from the nude or costumed figure. A study of the plastic

qualities in oil painting in relation to the personal objectives of the individual student. Maximum credit in course 12 hrs., prereq., 12 hrs.,

including Art 128 or permission.

341. ADVANCED PAINTING {2 or 3) StaH

Maximum credit in course, 12 hrs. Prereq., 20 hrs. and permission.

351-352. INDUSTRIAL DESIGN (2 or 3-2 or 3) Toth

Design and presentation of industrial products with emphasis on function, appearance, and material. 4 lab. Prereq., 12 hrs., including Art 231.

365-366. ILLUSTRATION (3-3) Mutchler

Accent on student practice. Story and commercial illustration using present-day techniques. Max. credit in course 9 hrs. Prereq., Art 328 and permission.

381. RESEARCH (1-5) StaH

Individual problems of theory and practice involving research tech- niques. Prereq., permission.

428. FIGURE PAINTING (3) Mutchler

Advanced work from the nude or costumed figure. Max. credit in course 12 hrs. Prereq., Art 328 or equivalent.

431. PRINTMAKING (1-5) D. Roberts

Experimental work in various print media and their combinations. Max. credit in course 12 hrs. Prereq., Art 309 and Art 310 and permis- sion.

188 Ohio University

436. SCULPTURE (1-5) Hostetler

Advanced work in plaster, wood, stone, direct steel, and ceramic

media. Max. credit in course 12 hrs. Prereq., Art 231 and/or permission.

451. INDUSTRIAL DESIGN (1-5) Toth

Advanced problems in the design and presentation of industrial

products. Max. credit in course 12 hrs. Prereq., Art 351 or equivalent.

471. PAINTING (1-5) Staff

Advanced work in traditional and contemporary media. Solutions to the student's problems are sought in relation to his personal objec- tives. Max. credit in course 12 hrs. Prereq., permission.

495. THESIS (1-6) StaH

Prereq., permission.

ASTRONOMY Professor Goedicke

11. ELEMENTARY ASTRONOMY (2 or 3) Goedicke

Time, latitude, and longitude from celestial observations. Distances, motions, and physical properties of sun, moon, planets, comets, meteors, and meteorites. Atmosphere and surface conditions of other planets. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Credit in course without lab., 2 hours. Lab. must be included if course is to fulfill science graduation requirements. Prereq., Math 3, or 2 yrs. high school mathematics. (1st sem., yearly.)

12. ELEMENTARY ASTRONOMY (2 or 3) Goedicke

Distances, motions, and physical properties of the stars, the nebu- lae, and the galaxies. Modern theories of the origin and evolution of the stars and galaxies. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Credit in course without lab., 2 hours. Lab. must be included if course is to fulfill science graduation requirements. Prereq., Math 3, or 2 yrs. high school mathematics. (2nd sem., yearly.)

135. ELEMENTS OF NAVIGATION (2) Goedicke

Basic navigational astronomy; the use of the sextant; the Nautical Almanac; the Line of Position Method as used in air and surface navi- gation. Prereq., Math 5. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

350. STUDIES IN ASTRONOMY (1 to 4) Goedicke

Prereq., 11, 12, and permission. (Given upon suflRcient demand.)

ATHLETICS See Physical Education and Athletics BIOLOGY

1-2. THE LIVING WORLD (3-3) Staff

(See "General Studies," page 223.)

268. TEACHING OF BIOLOGY (2) Stehr, V/allace

A consideration of the purposes of high school biology, instructional materials, classroom methods, source of laboratory equipment and sup- plies, and examination techniques. Prereq., 12 hrs. biological science. (Yearly.)

Botany 189

BOTANY Associate Professors Blickle, Wallace (chairman), Gambill

Assistant Professors Vermillion, Wistendahl

The major requirement for the A.B. degree is a minimum of 24 hours, and for the B.S. degree 30 hours. The major program must include Bot. 3-4, 105, 106 or 117, 123 or 173, and 203 with at least 6 hours in courses numbered above 300. Biol. 1 and 2 may be substituted for Bot. 3. General Chemistry is required for all majors. Certain courses require additional background as listed in the prerequisites.

3-4. GENERAL BOTANY (3-3) Staff

The structure and functions of plants, life cycles, classification, genetics, a survey of the plant kingdom, and the fundamental inter- relationships of plants and animals, including man. 2 lee. and 2 lab. No credit if Biol. 1 and 2 have been completed. (Each semester.)

105. ELEMENTARY PLANT PHYSIOLOGY (3) Wallace A basic study of the major plant processes and of the applications

of physiological relations of plants to agriculture, industry, and forestry. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 4 and 1 yr. college chemistry. (1st sem., yearly.)

106. LOCAL FLORA (3) Gambill The collection, identification and classification of the flowering

plants through the study of the native flora, involving both laboratory and field studies. Two Sat. field trips required. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 4 or Biol. 2. (2nd sem., yearly.)

108. VEGETATION OF NORTH AMERICA (2) Wistendahl

An illustrated lecture-demonstration course considering the exten- sive plant formations of the continent with relationship to economic pursuits of man. Prereq., 4 or Biol. 2. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

117. DENDROLOGY (3) Gambill

A field course in collection and identification of native and in- troduced woody plants in both summer and winter condition. 2 lee. and 2 lab. 2 Sat. field trips required. Prereq., 4 or Biol. 2. (1st sem., yearly.)

123. INTRODUCTION TO THE FUNGI (3) Vermillion

A general survey field and laboratory course designed to give the student a working knowledge of the various kinds of fungi. Both taxon- omy and morphology are stressed, one supplementing the other. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 4 or Biol. 2. (1st sem., yearly.)

173. ELEMENTARY PLANT MORPHOLOGY (3) Bliclcle

A course stressing the plant's true structural nature and the inner relationship of its parts through an analysis of the various plant groups except the fungi. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 4 or Biol. 2. (1st sem., yearly.)

203. PLANT ECOLOGY (4) Wistendahl

A course dealing with the biological studies of natural plant com- munities, the environmental factors and their dynamics. 3 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 105 or 106 and 117 or 173. (1st sem., yearly.)

210. PLANT BREEDING AND GENETICS (3) Wallace A course dealing with experimental and practical methods of devel- oping commercial plants and the genetical approach to evolution. 2 lec. and 2 lab. Prereq., 4 and Zool. 107. (2nd sem., 1959-GO.)

211. PLANT ANATOMY (3) Blickle A course designed to embody a comprehensive study of the internal

structure of the vascular plant body. 2 lec. and 2 lab. Prei-eq., 173. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

190 Ohio University

212. PLANT MICROTECHNIQUE (3) Wistendahl

The killing, fixing, imbedding, sectioning, staining, and mounting of plant tissues, and the use of the photomicrographic camera, camera lucida, calibration, and photomicrographic practices. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 173. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

221. PLANT PATHOLOGY (4) Vermillion

A general course dealing with the nature, cause and control of plant diseases. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 4 and 123 or Agr. 216. (2nd sem., yearly.)

304. FOREST ECOLOGY (3) Wisiendahl

The ecological foundations of forestry, site factors, the forest en- vironment and methods of studying it, growth and development of trees and stands; the origin, development, and classification of forest com- munities. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 203. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

307. ADVANCED PLANT PHYSIOLOGY (4) Wallace

An advanced study of plant processes with special emphasis on techniques employed in research. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 105 and a course in organic chemistry. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

311. PALEOBOTANY (3) Blickle

A study of the fossil representatives of the greater plant groups and the sequence of fossil floras throughout geological time. Two Sat. field trips required. Prereq., 117 or 173 and 3 hrs. geology. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

314. ADVANCED PLANT MORPHOLOGY (3) Bliclcle

A course specifically for botany and forestry majors embodying detailed analyses of seed plant gross structures and their comparative evolutionary relations. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 173. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

315. SYSTEMATIC BOTANY (3) Gambill A study of the systematies, nomenclature, and phylogeny of the

higher plants beginning with the ferns; relationship of the principal orders and families; problems of nomenclature; identification of speci- mens. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Two Saturday field trips required. Prereq., 106. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

316. TAXONOMY OF THE NONVASCULAR PLANTS (3) Gambill

A course dealing with the classification and phylogeny of the bryo- phsrtes and lichens. Two Sat. field trips required. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 106 and 173. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

318. WOOD TECHNOLOGY (3) Blickle

The structure identification, properties and uses of North Ameri- can forest products, with special attention given to the macroscopic and microscopic structure. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 117 and 211. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

324. FOREST PATHOLOGY (3) Vermillion

A study of the various types of diseases of forest and shade tree species, their economic importance, prevention and control. Prereq., 117 and 123 or 221. 2 lee. and 2 lab. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

325. MYCOLOGY (3) Vermillion A course designed to acquaint the student with the ways in which

man makes use of fungi in agriculture, medicine, and industry. The physiology of fungi is stressed. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 123 and 1 yr. college chemistry. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

Business Law 191

343. BOTANICAL STUDIES {2 fo 4 a semester In any of the following)

Semi-independent studies supervised by the instructor. May include interdepartmental projects. Maximum credit in any listed area, 4 hrs.; total 8 hrs. Prereq., 12 hrs. including one listed course in that area and permission.

a. Plant Morphology studies of the fundamental plant form, structure, life cycles, and reproduction. Blickle

b. Plant Physiology studies in the primary functions, processes, and growth phenomena of plants. Wallace

c. Plant Ecology studies in the interrelations of plants to one another and to the environment. Wistendahl

d. Plant Classification studies in the principles, theories, and systems of plant classification. Gambill

e. Plant Disease studies in the nature, prevention, cause and con- trol of plant diseases. Vermillion

f. Plant Breeding the study of the several methods of hybridiza- tion of higher plants, polyploidy and speciation. Wallace

g. Mycology Advanced studies of nonpathogenic macrofungi and microfungi. Vermillion

381. RESEARCH PROBLEMS (1 to 4) Staff

Independent research. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 18 hrs. and permission.

391, 392. SEMINAR IN BOTANY (1. 1) StaH

Advanced study and original research. Required of all majors and graduate students. Prereq., 12 hrs. and permission. (Yearly.)

495. THESIS (1 to 6) StaH

Prereq., permission

BUSINESS LAW Assistant Professor Howard (c'nairman)

Instructor Willier

255-256. BUSINESS LAW (3-3) Howard, Willier

The principles of law involved in contracts, agency, sales, negoti- able instruments, partnerships, and corporations. Prereq., junior or senior rank.

275. GOVERNMENT AND BUSINESS (3) Howard

A study of statutes and court decisions by which government con- trols, regulates, and aids business under the commerce clause, the police power, and the anti-trust laws. Prereq., 255.

342. LAW OF REAL ESTATE (2) Howard, Willier

Deeds, mortgages, leases, and other interests in real propert3^, and the relationships between landlord and tenant. Prereq., 256 or permis- sion.

381. RESEARCH IN LAW (1 to 8} Staff

A study of selected cases and current litigation in any field of law of particular interest to the student. Prereq., 18 hrs. commerce includ- ing 256 and permission.

192 Ohio University

CERAMICS— See Art

CHEMICAL ENGINEERING— See Engineering

CHEMISTRY Professors Clippinger, Eblin (chairman)

Associate Professors Day, Huntsman, Kline, Ingfiam

Assistant Professors Sympson, W. B. Smith, Brooks, Tong

A student who completes the requirements for the B.S. degree with a major in chemistry, as outlined below, is eligible for professional status in the American Chemical Society in the minimum period of two years of professional experience after graduation. Completion of the minimium requirements for the A.B. degree with a major in chemis- try, as outlined below, does not qualify a student for certification to the Society.

The major requirement for the B.S. degree is a minimum of 41 hours including Chem. 3-4; 99; 109-110; 201-202; 203-204; 313-314; 315; 333; and three additional hours above 300. Outside requirements include Math. 102 and Physics 114, which should be completed by the end of the second year.

The major requirement for the A.B. degree is a minimum of 28 hours including Chem. 3-4; 99; 109-110 or 107; 201-202 or 113; 203 or 117; 313-314 or 211. A full year's work is required in at least one of the following subjects: Quantitative Analysis (109-110), Organic Chem- istry (201-202), Physical Chemistry (313-314). Those who elect 211 instead of 313-314 are reminded that the requirements for the A.B. degree include six hours in the major field in courses numbered above 300. Such students should take 201-202 and 203-204 in order to be eli- gible for 321 and 333, or 109-110 in order to be eligible for 305 and 333.

Students having foreign language requirements should take Ger- man, including Ger. 103. Those anticipating graduate study should obtain a reading knowledge of both German and Russian or French.

1-2 GENERAL CHEMISTRY (4-4) Broolcs, Day, Eblin.

Huntsman, Tong A beginning course designed to provide a general survey of the subject. Chemistry majors and pre-professional students should register for Chem. 3-4. 3 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., high school algebra.

3-4 GENERAL CHEMISTRY (4-3) Kline, Ingham

A beginning course designed to give a more intensive treatment than is given in Chem. 1-2. 3 lee. and 3 lab. in first semester; 3 lee. and no lab. in second semester. Concurrent registration in Chem. 99 required in second semester. Prereq., high school algebra.

99. QUALITATIVE ANALYSIS (2) Sympson. Kline

The separation and detection of cations and anions by semimicro methods. 1 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., 2 or with 4. (Each semester.)

107. QUANTITATIVE ANALYSIS (4) Clippinger, Sympson

A one-semester course in analytical chemistry designed for students not majoring in chemistry. 2 lee. and 6 lab. Prereq., 99. (Each semes- ter.)

109-110. QUANTITATIVE ANALYSIS (4-4) Clippinger. Sympson

Chem. 109 is primarily volumetric analysis. Chem. 110 includes gravimetric and electrolytic analysis and an introduction to electro- metric analysis, colorimetry, and polarography. 2 lee. and 6 lab. Prereq., 99. (Yearly.)

sm

3^ •t?Vi:

:-lLpfc,|| #^

y«#-'

? ■' /

■Ml^^^^

Chemistry 193

113. ORGANIC CHEMISTRY (4) Huntsman, Ingham, Smith

A one-semester course in the fundamentals of organic chemistry, designed for students not majoring in chemistry or pre-medicine. Prereq., 2 or 4. (Yearly.)

117. ORGANIC CHEMISTRY LABORATORY (2) Huntsman, Ingham, Smith

A one-semester laboratory course in organic preparations and re- actions to accompany Chem. 113. 6 lab. Prereq., 113 or with 113, or 202 or with 202. (Yearly.)

201-202. ORGANIC CHEMISTRY (3-3) Huntsman, Ingham, Smith

A comprehensive course in organic chemistry which integrates cur- rent concepts with a sound classical background. Designed for chemistry and premedical majors as well as others wishing a thorough intro- ductory course in organic chemistry. Prereq., 107 or 109 or with 107 or 109. (Yearly.)

203-204. ORGANIC CHEMISTRY LABORATORY (2-2) Huntsman, Ingham, Smith Practical laboratory work in organic chemistry. Designed to ac- company Chem. 201-202. 6 lab. Prereq., 201 or with 201 for 203; 202 or with 202 for 204. (Yearly.)

211. PHYSICAL CHEMISTRY (3) Broolcs, Day, Eblin

A one semester course in physical chemistry for pre-medical stu- dents and students in liberal arts and education. Prereq., 12 hrs. chem- istry and 5 hrs. mathematics. (1st sem., yearly.)

303. ADVANCED QUANTITATIVE ANALYSIS (3) Sympson

A lecture course in classical analytical chemistry designed for entering graduate students needing further training in analytical chemistry. Prereq., 110 or equivalent. (Yearly.)

305. INSTRUMENTAL ANALYSIS (4) Sympson

Methods of instrumental analysis : Electrometry, polarography, coulometry, emission and absorption spectroscopy, chromatography. Pre- req., 110 and permission. (Yearly.)

313-314. PHYSICAL CHEMISTRY (3-3) Broolcs, Day, Eblin

Not open to graduate students majoring in chemistry. Prereq., 110, Math. 102 and Phys. 114. (Yearly.)

315-316. PHYSICAL CHEMISTRY LABORATORY (2-2) Eblin

6 lab. Prereq., 313 or with 313. (Each semester.)

317. CHEMICAL THERMODYNAMICS (3) Brooks, Day, Tong

Pi'ereq., 314 with a grade of C or better. (1st sem., yearly.)

321. QUALITATIVE ORGANIC ANALYSIS (4) Huntsman, Ingham, Smith

The separation and identification of organic compounds. Prelimin- ary to research in chemistry. 2 lee. and 6 lab. Prereq., 204. (2nd sem., yearly.)

333. INORGANIC CHEMISTRY (3) Kline, Tong

Inorganic chemical reactions and structure. Prereq., 110 or 202. (1st sem., yearly.)

337. INORGANIC CHEMISTRY LABORATORY (2) Kline

Practical laboratory work in inorganic chemistry including the preparation of typical inorganic substances and an introduction to the chemical literature. Prereq., 333 or with 333. 6 lab. (Yearly.)

194 Ohio University

351. SPECIAL PROBLEMS IN CHEMISTRY (2or3) Staff

Minor research with laboratory and library work. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 24 hrs. in chemistry with a B average. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

418. CHEMICAL KINETICS (3) Day, Tong

The purpose of the course is to gain insight into the mechanisms by which chemical reactions occur, and the energies involved, through interpretation of data on rates of reactions. Prereq., 314. (2nd sem., yearly. )

425. QUANTUM CHEMISTRY (3) Brooks

The fundamentals of quantum theory and their application to some simple systems of chemical interest. Prereq., 314. (1958-59.)

427. SPECIAL TOPICS IN PHYSICAL CHEMISTRY (2-4) Brooks, Day, Tong

Deals with a special phase of physical chemistry such as kinetic theory of gases, statistical thermodynamics, molecular structure, or applications of thermodynamics. Prereq., 317. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

434. ADVANCED INORGANIC CHEMISTRY (3) Kline, Tong Modem theoretical inorganic chemistry. Prereq., 333. (2nd sem.,

yearly.)

435. SPECIAL TOPICS IN INORGANIC CHEMISTRY (2 or 3) Kline, Tong Deals with a special phase of inorganic chemistry such as the less

familiar elements, radiochemistry, or the chemistry of coordination com- pounds and complexions. Prereq., 333. (Yearly.)

445-446. ADVANCED ORGANIC CHEMISTRY (3-3) Huntsman, Ingham, Smith

Modem aspects of organic chemistry with emphasis on the re- lationships between structure and reactivity. Prereq., 202. (Yearly.)

451,452. SEMINAR IN CHEMISTRY (1,1) Staff

Selected topics. Required of all graduate students in chemistry each semester in residence. (Yearly.)

471. SPECIAL TOPICS IN ORGANIC CHEMISTRY

(2 or 3) Huntsman, Ingham, Smith Deals with a special phase of organic chemistry such as physical organic chemistry, heterocyclic compounds, steroids or terpenes. Prereq., 202. (Yearly.)

481. RESEARCH IN CHEMISTRY (lto4) Staff

Prereq., 36 hrs. (Yearly.) 495. THESIS OR DISSERTATION (1 to 4 for thesis) Staff

Prereq., permission.

CIVIL ENGINEERING— See Engineering

CLASSICAL LANGUAGES Professor Murphy (chairman)

Instrucfor hlultgren

Two types of courses are included: (1) courses in the Greek and Latin languages in the original; (2) courses requiring no knowledge of the original languages.

The major requirement for Greek or Latin for the AB degree is a minimum of 20 hours above courses 1-2 in either subject, exclusive of courses in class (2) above. Majors in Latin should also include Lat. 331 and 333. The major requirement in Latin for the B.S. in Education degree is given on page 132.

Classical Languages 195

GREEK

1-2. BEGINNING GREEK (4-4) Murphy, Hultgren

An introductory study of the lan^age leading to the reading of classical authors. (Yearly.)

27. GREEK WORDS IN ENGLISH (2) Murphy

Terms of Greek origin which provide a major part of the technical vocabulary in many cultural and professional fields. Laboratory assign- ments in the vocabulary of each student's field of interest. No knowledge of Greek required. Does not give credit toward meeting the foreign language requirement, (1st sem., yearly.)

101-102. GREEK PROSE AND POETRY (3-3) Murphy, Hultgren

Review of language principles. Readings from Homer, Plato, and the New Testament. Prereq., 2. (Yearly.)

309. ADVANCED GREEK READINGS (l+o3) Murphy, Huifgren

Selections from the poets, dramatists, orators, and philosophers to fit the interests and needs of students. Maximum credit in course, 9 hrs. Offered on demand. Prereq., 12 hrs.

LATIN

1-2. BEGINNING LATIN (4-4) Hultgren

Introductory course leading to reading of Latin stories of history and mythology and selections from easier prose literature. The Latin influence on modern language, literature, and culture. (Yearly.)

101. LATIN REVIEW AND READING (4) Murphy For those who have had a break of several years in Latin study

and need a thorough review. Suitable prose readings of literary inter- est. Prereq,, 2 or 2 yrs, high school Latin. (1st sem., yearly.)

102. VERGIL (4) Murphy Readings from Aeneid, Brooks I-VI. Vergil as a stylist, poet, and

philosopher. Prereq., 101 or 3 yrs. high school Latin. (2nd sem., yearly,)

151. FAMILIAR ESSAYS (3) Hultgren Cicero's De Amicitia, De Senectute, Somnium Scipionis. Review of

essential Latin and study of the literature on friendship. Prereq., 102, 4 yrs, high school Latin, or 3 yrs. and permission. (1st sem., yearly.)

152. HORACE AND TERRENCE (3) Hultgren A comedy by Terrence and selections from Horace's Odes and

Epodes. Prereq., 102 or 4 yrs, high school Latin, (2nd sem., yearly.)

303. PLINY AND MARTIAL (3) Murphy Letters and epigrams revealing the human side of Roman life and

society from Nero to Trajan. Prereq., 152, (1st sem., 1959-60.)

304. LIVY AND OVID (3) Murphy The legendary history of early Rome and mjrthology in verse.

Prereq., 152, (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

311. CICERO (LETTERS) AND CATULLUS (POEMS) (3) Hultgren

Prereq., 152. (1st sem., 1958-59,)

196 Ohio University

318. READINGS IN LATIN LITERATURE (lto4) Murphy, Hultgren

Selections from a wide range of Latin literature according to the needs and interests of students. Maximum credit in course, 10 hrs. Prereq., 152. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

331. THE LIFE OF THE ROMANS (2) Hul+gren

The social customs of the Romans: the family, the house, transpor- tation, public amusements, and related features. Illustrations from the archaeological evidence. Prereq., 8 hrs. or 8 hrs. history and antiquities. No knowledge of latin required. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

333. ADVANCED LATIN SYNTAX (2) Murphy

Prereq., 152. (Given upon sufficient demand).

340. SPECIAL WORK IN LATIN (1to4) Murphy, Hultgren

Individual work under careful guidance. Maximum credit in course 8 hrs. Prereq., 152.

DESIGN— See Art

DRAMATIC ART Professors Seigfred, Andersch

Assistant Professors C. Lone, Hohne, Catolono Instructors Trisolini, Reyes, Feidner

10. INTRODUCTION TO THEATRE (2) Lane, Staff

The role of the theatre in our culture and the practical application, interrelationships, and over-all unity of various art forms in play pro- duction.

21. ELEMENTS OF STAGE SCENERY (3) Catalano

Basic principles of scenic construction; types and utilization of stage scenery. 1 lee. and 4 lab.

47. THEATRE LABORATORY (1) Catalano Costuming, make-up, and technical work coincident with the pro- ductions of the University Theatre. Maximum credit in course, 2 hrs.

48. MAKE-UP (1) Trisolini 2 lab.

99-100. MOVEMENT AND PANTOMIME (2-2) Hahne

Movement from the viewpoint of dance and drama; body mechanics; dynamics of movement in space and time; experimental application of discovered techniques to social and dramatic situations.

105. PLAY PRODUCTION (3) Trisolini

A general course in play production including choice of play, cast- ing, direction, and techniques of production. Laboratory experience. Not open to majors in theatre.

123. ELEMENTS OF STAGE LIGHTING (3) Catalano

Stage-lighting units, control equipment, and color media, and their application to play production. 1 lee. and 4 lab.

147. THEATRE LABORATORY (lor2) Catalano

Costuming, make-up, and technical work connected with the produc- tions of the University Theatre. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., permission.

Dramatic Art 197

207. COSTUMING (4) Andersch

The use of color, line and texture in designing, constructing and adapting costumes for the stage. 2 lee. and 4 lab, plus crew work on productions. Prereq., 21.

260. TEACHING OF HIGH SCHOOL DRAMATICS AND SPEECH (3) Andersch Prereq., junior standing, major or minor in Dramatic Art and Speech.

299. PRINCIPLES OF ACTING (3) Hahne Elementary techniques of stage action and practice in the reading,

cutting, and acting of dramatic literature. I lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 99 and Speech 34.

300. ADVANCED ACTING (3) Lane

Creation of roles in plays of different types, styles, and periods. Study of dialects. Laboratory experience in rehearsal and performance. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 299 and permission.

306. ADVANCED STAGECRAFT (3) Catalano

Theories and problems involved in scenic decor. The results of ex- perimentation with paint and structure on the model set are applied to full-scale scenery. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 12 hrs., including 21 and 123.

321,322. DRAMATIC COMPOSITION (3,3) Trisolini

Theory of playwriting. Practical experience in the writing and rewriting of plays. Scripts of sufficient merit are produced under the writer's supervision by the University Playshop. Prereq., 6 hrs. and 12 hrs. English and/or journalism.

323. SCENE DESIGN AND PAINTING (3) Catalano

Theories of the designing and painting of stage settings; effect of stage lighting on scenery and make-up; practical experience. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 21, and 123.

339. ACTING FOR LYRIC DRAMA (3) Trisolini

Advanced techniques of acting in relation to the form and content of lyric drama. Laboratory experience in the creation of roles. Special emphasis on the Elizabethan with some attention to Greek and 20th century authors. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 299, 300; Speech 34; English 223.

350-351. PLAY DIRECTION (3-3) Lane

Preparation of plays for public performance; analysis of the script, methods of casting and rehearsal. Capable students direct one-act plays presented by the University Playshop. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 12 hrs. including 300, and permission.

353. MASTERS OF THE THEATRE (3) Lane

Techniques for the production of histoi-ical plays. Pi-eparation of

the director's manuscript and actual supei'vision of production. Open

only to majors in Dramatic Art. Prereq., 351, F. A. 180, and permission.

355. THEATRE MANAGEMENT (2) Seigfred

Organization and business management of theatres. Prereq., senior or graduate rank and permission.

198 Ohio University

377. PERIOD COSTUME DESIGN (3) Andersch

An intensive study of the history of costuming from the time of the Egyptians through the 19th century. Emphasis on the use of color, line, and texture and adaptation in the designing of period clothes for the stage. Discussion of the relationship between the political and social trends, the architecture, interior design, etc. of the period and the clothes worn. Prereq., 207 or equivalent, Art 28 or equivalent, or per- mission.

425. CONTEMPORARY THEATRE (3) Lane

Trends of modern world theatre beginning with the contributions of Saxe-Meiningen and the growth of realism. Prereq., 18 hrs., including F. A. 179 or equivalent.

435. ADVANCED LIGHTING (3) Catalano

Lighting design, history of stage lighting. Advanced technical consideration of instruments, control equipment and color media. Pro- duction experience. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 21, 123, 323 or with 323 or equivalent.

480. SEMINAR IN TECHNICAL THEATRE OR COSTUMING {3or4) Staff Independent research projects in scene design, lighting, scenery

construction or costuming. To be arranged with supervising faculty member in advance of registration. Prereq., 18 hrs. including 323 or

equivalent.

481. SEMINAR IN DIRECTING OR THEATRE MANAGEMENT (3or4) Staff Conferences, independent research or experimentation, and summary

reports. Independent research projects must be approved prior to regis- tration. Prereq., 18 hrs. including 351 or equivalent.

494. RESEARCH (1-12) Staff Individual, guided research on special problems. Projects must be

approved prior to registration. Prereq., 8 hrs,, permission.

495. THESIS (Ho 6) Staff Prereq., permission.

Suggested courses:

See "Radio-TV" and "Speech and Speech Therapy" under "Courses of Instruction," F. A. 179-180— History of the Visual Theatre, P. E. 7— Beginning Modem Dance, P. E. 8 Intermediate Modern Dance, P. E. 115-116 Advanced Modern Dance, courses in Design or Painting and Drawing (see Art) .

DRAWING— See Art

ECONOMICS Professors Gubitz, Heilebrandt, Picord (cholrman)

Associate Professors Crewson, Levinson Assistant Professors Witte, Olsen

A student may secure an A.B. degree with a major in economics. This program is designed to give a broad cultural background for those who plan careers in such areas as business, government, or law. This program also provides the basis for those who plan to attend graduate school to prepare for teaching and economic research.

The major requirement in economics is 24 semester hours including Economics 11-12 (or 101-102) and 333. In addition, one course in statistics is required, and this will be determined in consultation with the adviser.

Economics 199

Suggested electives should be chosen from government, history, philosophy, psychology, sociology, and other social sciences with the approval of the adviser.

11-12. PRINCIPLES OF ECONOMICS (3-3) Staff

The basic theory and economic analysis of prices, markets, produc- tion, wages, interest, rent, and profits. The second half of the course is concerned with the economic problems and economic institutions of society. Among the problems analyzed are labor unions, money and banking, taxation, public utilities, international trade, business cycles, and agriculture. Not open to juniors and seniors.

101-102. PRINCIPLES OF ECONOMICS (3-3) Staff

The basic theory and economic analysis of prices, markets, produc- tion, wages, interest, rent, and profits. The second half of the course is concerned with the economic problems and economic institutions of so- ciety. Among the problems analyzed are labor unions, money and bank- ing, taxation, public utilities, international trade, business cycles, and agriculture. Not open to freshmen nor to those who have had 11 and 12.

305. ECONOMICS OF TRANSPORTATION (2 or 3 as scheduled) Olsen

The social, political, and economic aspects of transportation. The economic characteristics of transportation rates and the machinery de- veloped for their determination and adjustment are emphasized. Pre- req., 12 or 102.

309. PUBLIC UTILITIES (2 or 3 as scheduled) Levinson

The economic basis of the public utility concept and its relation to business organization. The nature, scope, development, legal organiza- tion and regulation of public utilities. Prereq., 12 or 102.

315. PUBLIC FINANCE (3) Picard

Analysis of spending and taxing functions of federal, state, and local governments. The growing importance of fiscal policy in determin- ing level of employment. The economic effects of the various taxes of federal, state, and local governments. Prereq., 12 or 102.

320. ORGANIZATION AND STRUCTURE OF INDUSTRY (3) Olsen

Emphasizes the economic characteristics of the principal manufac- turing and processing enterprises, and considers their historic de- velopment, financial organization, and legal aspects. Prereq., 12 or 102.

329. COMPARATIVE ECONOMIC SYSTEMS (2 or 3 as scheduled) Crewson

An analysis of the institutional framework of the following sys- tems: modified capitalism, socialism, communism, and fascism. Special emphasis is given to the prevailing economic institutions in the United States, Great Britain, Russia, and Spain. Prereq., 12 or 102.

330. HISTORY OF ECONOMIC THOUGHT

(2 or 3 as scheduled) Heiiebrandt, Picard The historical evolution of the major economic doctrines; mercantil- ists and cameralists, physiocrats, Adam Smith and the classical school, the historical school, the Austrian school, Alfred Marshall and the neo- classicists. Prereq., 12 or 102.

200 Ohio University

332. MODERN ECONOMIC THOUGHT (2 or 3 as scheduled) Picard, Wi+te

An analysis of the contributions to economics of the most signifi- cant writers since Alfred Marshall. Prereq., 12 or 102.

333. ECONOMIC THEORY (2 or 3 as scheduled) Witte

An intensive study of the price system as an allocative mechanism. This includes the price and production policies of individual firms under alternative market conditions and an analysis of the effect of these policies on the social efficiency of resource allocation. Prereq., 12 or 102.

335. LABOR ECONOMICS (3) Levinson

Survey of the economic forces generating modern labor problems. Among the topics considered are: history of the labor movement, labor in politics, labor-management relations, visages, and full employment. Prereq., 12 or 102.

338. LABOR LEGISLATION (2 or 3 as scheduled) Levinson

Survey of the law bearing upon labor problems. Among the topics considered are : labor-relations legislation, old-age and unemployment insurance, workmen's compensation, and wages-and-hours legislation. Prereq., 335.

342. INTERNATIONAL ECONOMICS (2 or 3 as scheduled) Crewson

A study of the economic relations of nations of the world. Some of the topics considered are: the economic basis for international trade and investment; the mechanics of international exchange ; tariff s, quotas, exchange control, cartels, and state trading as devices of economic na- tionalism; and international economic cooperation with special reference to organizations affiliated with the United Nations. Prereq., 12 or 102.

350. NATIONAL INCOME AND EMPLOYMENT ANALYSIS (3) Witte

A study of the factors which determine the level of the nation's economic activity and which are responsible for growth and stability in the nation's economy. Part of the course is devoted to measures of the national income while the remainder consists of an analysis of the interrelationships among production, price levels, relative prices, employment, and capital formation. Prereq., 12 or 102.

355. ECONOMIC HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES (3) Staff

A study of the economic factors in the development of the United States including the historical growth of economic institutions such as banking, manufacturing, labor unions, and agriculture, from colonial times to the present. Prereq., 12 or 102.

375. ECONOMIC DEVELOPMENT (3) Crewson

An analysis of the nature of, obstacles to, and future possibilities for the economic growth of nations. Special emphasis is given to the problems of the underdeveloped countries. Studies of selected countries are utilized. Prereq., 12 or 102.

381. RESEARCH IN ECONOMICS (1 to 8) Staff

Prereq., 15 hrs. and permission.

391. SEMINAR IN ECONOMICS (2 to 4) Staff

Maximum credit in course, 10 hrs. Prereq., 15 hrs. and permission.

495. THESIS (1 to 6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

Education 201

EDUCATION Professors Morton, Hansen, Benz,

Shoemaker, Hill, Hamblin (dean)

Associafe Professors Quick, C. H. Roberts, McKelvey,

Krontz, Crowell, Felsinger, Evans, Lynn

Assistant Professors Dunham, Olson, DeLand, Eisen,

Nelson, Ward, Wilson, Storks, Cooper, Bean,

Shuster, Sllgo, Chase, Ullmann, Ploghoft

Instructors Shrigley, Thompson

ELEMENTARY EDUCATION

101. MATERIALS AND METHODS IN KINDERGARTEN- PRIMARY EDUCATION (2) V/ilson

A study of work and play activities of early childhood; and the development, use, and care of materials best suited to this age group. Prereq., 103.

102. LITERATURE FOR CHILDREN (3) Hansen, Quick, Starks, Ploghoft Introduces the student to a study of literature written for children.

Experiences with children, developing plans for organizing the litera- ture program in the elementary school, and criteria for evaluating books characterize the course.

103. STUDIES OF CHILDREN (3) Quick, Storks,

Sligo, Cooper, DeLand

Bases for a developmental theory of education: growth sequences through adolescence; principles of development, behavior, and learning; techniques of child-study; systematic observation in the University Ele- mentary School; implications for educational practice.

125. THE PURPOSES AND PRACTICES OF EDUCATION (3) Lynn

An introductory survey of the American public school system at all grade levels; objectives, curricular problems, guidance, organization, and administration as they affect the teacher. Not open to students who have had 130. Prereq., second semester sophomore standing.

163. TEACHING OF READING AND LANGUAGE (3) Hansen, Cooper. Olson A practical course covering the language arts program in the ele- mentary school. Methods and materials valuable in promoting child development in reading and the expressional phases of language are given major emphasis.

165. TEACHING OF ARITHMETIC IN THE ELEMENTARY SCHOOL

(3) Morton, Benz, Sligo Criteria for determining the arithmetic program; a grade-by-grade development of topics and of methods of presentation.

169. TEACHING OF SOCIAL STUDIES AND SCIENCE IN THE

ELEMENTARY SCHOOL (3) Felsinger, Shuster

Materials and methods used in teaching the content subjects in the elementary schools, with special emphasis upon unit teaching, social studies skills, and practical experiences in the teaching of science.

209. WORKSHOP IN ELEMENTARY EDUCATION (2 to 6) Staff

A sei'vice course to help teachers solve the problems they are facing in the classroom. Workshop method of teaching and learning will be used. Prereq., 9 hrs. and permission.

202 Ohio University

210. STUDENT TEACHING LABORATORY (3) Felsinger. Olson, Shuster A discussion of problems encountered in Student Teaching. A study

of the generalizations and principles of classroom administration and pupil adjustment. This course is taken by all students in elementary education concurrently with Ed. 272. It is open to other students by permission of the Director of Student Teaching.

211. THE CHILD AND THE CURRICULUM (3) Felsinger A study of the content of the elementary school curriculum. Em- phasis is placed upon the service role of the curriculum to children and society. Prereq., senior rank, Ed. 272.

263. TEACHING OF ARITHMETIC IN THE UPPER GRADES (3) Morton, Bern Organization and methods of teaching the subject matter of the arithmetic curriculum in grades 7 and 8; the number system; arithmetic and life activities; arithmetic and a liberal education.

311. PROBLEMS IN ELEMENTARY TEACHING PRACTICES (3) Stoff

Open only to students with the bachelor's degree who are pre- paring for elementary certification, and who have no student teaching credit. To be given only in connection with the supervision of the stu- dent's on-the-job teaching experience. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., permission.

389. SUPERVISION OF ARITHMETIC (1 to 3) Benz

A summary of research, the implications of educational psychology, and a survey of current trends in the teaching and supervision of arith- metic. Prereq., 9 hrs. education, including a course in the teaching of arithmetic, and Psych. 5.

403. ADVANCED STUDIES OF CHILDREN (3) Quick

An intensive study of certain basic research in child development and its implications for education. Prereq., 15 hrs. education or psychol- ogy, or permission.

411. PROBLEMS IN THE ELEMENTARY CURRICULUM (3) Quick A critical study of the basic issues and theories underlying cur- riculum development. Prereq., permission.

412. SEMINAR IN ELEMENTARY EDUCATION (2 to 4) Staff A course designed for teachers and administrators who wish to

extend their professional preparation through individual research, group study and planning in the areas of elementary education. Maximum credit in a semester, 2 hrs. Prereq., permission.

Note: For other courses designed primarily for kindergarten and elementary teachers, see H. Ec. 155; Ind. A. 115; Mus. 72, 266; P. E. 270; and Art 3, 160.

Special Education Elementary

Students desiring the state certificate to qualify as teachers of special education classes should consult Mrs. DeLand regarding courses in sociology, psychology, and zoology which are required along with the courses listed below.

222. DIAGNOSTIC AND REMEDIAL INSTRUCTION IN

ELEMENTARY SUBJECTS (2) DeLand

A laboratory course in methods of diagnosis and remedial treatment in fundamental school subjects for problem cases. Students are given opportunity to observe and work with exceptional children.

Education 203

223. CURRICULUM FOR SPECIAL CLASSES (3) DeLand

Types of curricula for special classes. Units of work, materials and subject matter suited to the mental ability and level of exceptional children.

321. ORGANIZATION OF SPECIAL EDUCATION FOR EXCEPTIONAL

CHILDREN (2) DeLand

Educational needs of those who differ markedly from normality the slow-learning, the retarded, and the gifted; the physically handi- capped; the emotionally unstable and socially malajusted; their charac- teristics and incidences. Adjustments within regular classrooms, special classes, and special schools; individual child study, classification, and follow-up.

325. PROBLEMS IN SPECIAL EDUCATION— THE

SLOW LEARNER (2 fo 6) DeLand

Designed for the regular classroom teacher in elementary and sec- ondary education who might have retarded or slow learners in with av- erage and rapid learners. How to locate their needs and what to do about them.

SECONDARY EDUCATION

130. SECONDARY EDUCATION (3) Benz. Shoemaker, Kranfz, Bean

A historical, comparative, and contemporary study of secondary education. Emphasis is placed on the interrelations of school and so- ciety; administrative considerations such as pupil personnel, and the control, support, and organization of schools; and the objectives of education, programs of study, and student activities. Prereq., Psych. 5 and sophomore standing.

228. PRINCIPLES OF TEACHING (3) Shoemaker Basic principles of learning and teaching, improving classroom

procedure, selecting teaching-learning experiences, and measuring the effectiveness of teaching. Prereq., 130, with 280, and Psych. 5.

229. CURRICULUM AND TEACHING PRACTICES (4) Lynn. C. Roberts Topics which receive major consideration are curricular content and

organization, principles of teaching-learning, techniques of classroom work, evaluation, and the respective roles of the teacher and the pupil. Consideration is given to the specific methods of the fields in which the student will be certified to teach. Prereq., Ed, 130.

287. STUDENT TEACHING LABORATORY (2) C. Roberts

Concerned primarily with the problems encountered in student teaching and preparation of resource materials. Some consideration is given also to the adjustments needed for successful entrance into the profession. Prereq., 229 and concurrently with Student Teaching.

374. THE IMPROVEMENT OF READING IN SECONDARY SCHOOLS

(2) StaH

The extension of the reading program beyond the elementary school ; the teaching of reading as a developmental process. Prereq., 9 hrs. edu- cation and Psych. 5.

428. ADVANCED PRINCIPLES OF TEACHING (3) Hill, C. Roberts

A critical appraisal of teaching in the light of available research

on learning and teaching. Prereq., 228 (or equivalent) and Psych 5.

470. SEMINAR IN SECONDARY EDUCATION (2 to 4) Staff

A course designed for teachers and administrators who wish to extend their professional preparation through individual reseaixh, gi-oup study and planning in the areas of secondary education. Maximum credit in a semester, 2 hrs. Prereq., permission.

204 Ohio University

PROFESSIONAL LABORATORY EXPERIENCES

272. STUDENT TEACHING IN THE ELEMENTARY GRADES

(2-12) Evans and Staff To be taken concurrently with Ed. 210. Prerequisites indicated on page 138.

277. FIELD EXPERIENCE (2) Evans and Staff

A two-week experience in a public school, taken at the opening of the public school year in September, consisting primarily of observation and participation in the total school program with emphasis upon the grade level or subject of primary interest to the student. This experi- ence must be arranged through the Office of the Director of Student Teaching and with the administrative approval of the public school system. Prereq., Sophomore standing.

280. OBSERVATION AND PARTICIPATION (3) Evans and Staff An experience in a public school or campus school during a regular

University session. Prereq., Junior standing and permission.

281. STUDENT TEACHING IN THE SECONDARY SCHOOLS

(2-12) Evans and Staff Prerequisites indicated on page 138.

462. FIELD EXPERIENCE IN GUIDANCE (2) Hill and Staff

(See below.)

GUIDANCE AND COUNSELING

360. GUIDANCE PRINCIPLES (3) Hill

The need for guidance in the schools. The nature of guidance. The major services, their operation, organization, and evaluation. Prereq., 6 hrs. education and Psych. .5.

361. GUIDANCE PRACTICE (1 to 3) Hill and Staff Directed practice in counseling and other personnel services in

cooperating schools, to develop greater familiarity and skill in some of the commoner guidance services. Prereq., 360, and permission.

362. INFORMATION SERVICE IN GUIDANCE (2) Hill

The collection, evaluation, and use of occupational, educational, and related information in the school guidance program. Prereq., 360.

460. SEMINAR IN GUIDANCE (2) Hill and Staff Advanced study of special problems in guidance. Prereq., 360, 361

(or equivalent).

461. WORKSHOP IN GUIDANCE (By special arrangement in Sumnner Session and Extension only) (1 to 3) Hill and Staff

A concentrated study program for school workers with special at- tention to guidance problems in the participant's school. Prereq., 360 or equivalent, and permission.

462. FIELD EXPERIENCE IN GUIDANCE (2) Hill and Staff

Supervised field work in schools in some guidance service. Periodic campus conferences and visitation conferences in the schools are re- quired. Prereq., 361 and permission.

Related graduate courses: Ed. 381 Educational Statistics (3); Ed. 385 Educational Measurements (3) ; Psych. 303 Mental Measure- ments (3); Psych. 316 Psychology of Individual Differences (2); Psych 320 Personnel and Vocational Counseling (3) ; Psych. 337 Counseling and Psychotherapy (3) ; H.R. 303-304 Human Relations (6); H.R. 493, 494 Seminar in Student Personnel Administration (6).

Education 205

HISTORY AND PHILOSOPHY

350. THE HISTORY OF EDUCATION (3) Shoemaker Studies the agencies of education and the social forces which have

conditioned them during ancient, medieval, and modern times. Prereq., 8 hrs. education and Psych. 5.

351. THE SCHOOL IN THE SOCIAL ORDER (3) Shoemaker Education in the United States from the colonial period to the

present. The social, political, economic, religious, and philosophical foundations which have conditioned the evolution of the public schools. Prereq., 6 hrs. education and Psych. 5.

352. COMPARATIVE EDUCATION (3) Shoemaker A study of the educational systems of various countries and the

extent to Vv^hich they meet the needs of the people. Prereq., 6 hrs. edu- cation or history or government, and permission.

353. THE EVOLUTION OF EDUCATIONAL THOUGHT (3) Shoemaker Deals solely with the educational writings of such theorists as

Plato, Aristotle, Quintilian, Montaigne, Locke, Comenius, Rabelais, Rousseau, Pestalozzi, Froebel, Herbart, and Dewey. Prereq., 6 hrs. edu- cation and Psych. 5.

354. PHILOSOPHY OF EDUCATION (3) Shoemaker A comparison of pragmatism, idealism, and realism as philosophical

bases for education. Each student is helped to formulate his philosophy of education. Prereq., 6 hrs. education.

355. SOCIAL FOUNDATIONS OF EDUCATION (3) Shoemaker

The interactions between the school and the social order in which it exists. The role of the school will be studied in various types of con- temporary societies. Prereq., 6 hrs. education.

358. WORKSHOP IN ECONOMIC EDUCATION

(Summer Session and Extension only) (1 to 3) Bean

A study of basic economic concepts and practical economic problems with the view to their integration into the school curriculum. Prereq., permission.

450. HIGHER EDUCATION (2) Staff

A survey of the background and growth of higher education in the United States. Present status of various types of institutions will be studied. Prereq., permission.

LIBRARY SCIENCE (See Library Science)

RESEARCH AND SCIENTIFIC TECHNIQUES

241. AUDIO-VISUAL TEACHING AIDS (2) Staff

Sources, selection, and use of audio-visual aids to instruction; their integration in the school program; selection, operation, and maintenance of equipment.

381. EDUCATIONAL STATISTICS (3) Sligo

The tabulation and graphical representation of frequency tables, measures of central tendency, percentiles and percentile curves, measures of variability, probability and the normal curve, and correlation. Pre- req., 6 hrs. education and Psych. 5.

206 Ohio University

382. ADVANCED EDUCATIONAL STATISTICS (3) Sligo

Nonlinear relations, partial correlation, multiple correlation, regres- sion, transmutation of scores, reliability, and the interpretation of cor- relation coelficients. Practice in the use of logarithms, statistical tables, and calculating machines. Prereq., 381.

385. EDUCATIONAL MEASUREMENTS (3) Sligo

The improvement of the essay examination; criteria for evaluating tests; teacher-made objective tests; standardized tests; elementary sta- tistical procedures. Prereq., 6 hrs. education and Psych. 5.

388. CONSERVATION EDUCATION V/ORKSHOP (Summer Session only)

(5) Staff A field course designed primarily for teachers in service. Relation- ships between conservation and the natural sciences primarily for the elementary and junior high school teacher. Approval of adviser.

483. RESEARCH IN EDUCATIONAL STATISTICS (lto6) Sligo

An advanced course in statistics dealing with the derivation of formulae, the analysis of relationships, and the interpretations of re- sults. Prereq., 382 and permission.

484. RESEARCH IN EDUCATION {Uo6) Staff Students are directed in the investigation of selected phases of edu- cational theory and practice. Prereq., 9 hrs. education and Psych. 5, and permission.

488. INTRODUCTION TO GRADUATE STUDY (3) Hill, Sligo

Methods of research in education and the selection, planning and evaluation of research problems. The history and purposes of graduate education. Required of all graduate students in education. Prereq., open to all graduate majors and minors in education and to others by per- mission.

495. THESIS |1to6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

SCHOOL ADMINISTRATION AND SUPERVISION

332. THE HIGH SCHOOL CURRICULUM (3) C.Roberts

The high school program of studies, contributions of various sub- jects, theories of curriculum construction, curriculum research, and desirable steps in the reorganization of the high school curriculum. Prereq., 6 hrs. education, including 130.

340. SCHOOL PUBLIC RELATIONS (2) Staff

The function of public relations in school administration in public understanding of the school's work, development of the media for effective communication, and furthering lay participation in determina- tion of school policy. Prereq., 6 hrs. education and Psych. 5.

410. ADMINISTRATION OF THE ELEMENTARY SCHOOL (2) Ploghoft

The responsibilities of both teachers and principal in democratic administration in such areas as curriculum construction, supervision, plant management, public relations. Practical problems used as a basis of study. Prereq., 6 hrs. education, including 440.

430. HIGH SCHOOL ADMINISTRATION (2) Lynn

The program of studies, the program for health, vocational educa- tion, guidance, extracurricular activities, provisions for individual dif- ferences, the selection and assignment of teachers, and the school sched- ule. Prereq., 6 hrs. education, including 440.

Education 207

440. LOCAL SCHOOL ADMINISTRATION (3) Kranfz

Emphasis upon local and community school administration, includ- ing the administrative process, democratic school administration, the role of leadership, structural organization of schools, the board of edu- cation and the superintendency. Prereq., 6 hrs. education.

441. STATE AND NATIONAL SCHOOL ADMINISTRATION (3) KranH

Emphasis upon state and national school administration, including the state program of education, state responsibility, educational organ- ization, certification and tenure, national educational services, federal relations to education and national problems in education. Prereq., 440.

442. SCHOOL FINANCE AND BUSINESS ADMINISTRATION (2) Chase

Local, state and federal finance, with problems in the financing of schools; business management in such areas as the school budget, finan- cial reports, school purchasing, transportation and insurance. Prereq., 6 hrs. education, including 440.

443. SCHOOL LAW |2) Bean The constitutional basis for education, schools and their legal set- ting, school legislation and court decisions, with special reference to Ohio school law. Prereq., 440.

444. HUMAN PROBLEMS IN SCHOOL ADMINISTRATION (3) Benx A course dealing with problems of human relations in school ad- ministration. Prereq,, 9 hrs. education, including 440, and permission.

445. SCHOOL BUILDING PLANNING (2) Chase The planning of new school buildings and sites, plant evaluation,

rehabilitation, maintenance problems, and school equipment. Prereq., 440.

446. SUPERVISION OF INSTRUCTION (2 to 6) Felsinger, Shuster The principles underlying democratic supervision and techniques

which promote the growth of teachers in service. Laboratory experiences in analysis of teaching situations. Prereq., 410 and 211, or 332 and 430.

447. PERSONNEL ADMINISTRATION IN PUBLIC SCHOOLS (3) Kran+i Designed to prepare administrators to meet their personnel problems

including the underlying philosophy of personnel administration, de- velopment of policies covering selection, classification, certification, tenure, contracts, in-service training programs, and placement of teach- ing and non-teaching personnel in the schools. Prereq., 12 hrs. education.

472. LABORATORY SCHOOL PROBLEMS (2) Staff For critic teachers, demonstration teachers, directors of student

teaching in teacher-training institutions, and for those desiring to pre- pare for such positions. Prereq., permission.

473. SUPERVISION OF STUDENT TEACHING (2 to 6) Staff Designed to prepare students for the work of the supervising teach- er in a college or university. Major emphasis will be upon directing student teachers in learning to teach children. Prereq., permission.

TEACHING TECHNIQUES

See the respective departments for courses in methods and tech- niques of instruction.

208 Ohio University

ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING— See Engineering

ENGINEERING Deon E. J. Taylor

Professors Green, P. H. Block

Associate Professors McClure, Thomas, Lausche,

Badger, Quisenberry, Selleck, G. E. Smith,

Curry, hiicks, Nellis

Assistant Professors Wickham, Niesse,

Hof^ee, Barnhill, Lindley, Russ, R. Smith

Instructors Sarchet, Bjerre, Rogers

Acting Instructors Essman, Fletcher

hiinkle, hforvath. Rose

Lecturers Cortland, Larson

ENGINEERING

229. COACHING FOR PROFESSIONAL ENGINEERS EXAMINATION

(Ho 3) StafF

A review of the fundamental engineering subjects with emphasis on the type of questions usually asked on the Ohio State Professional Engineers examination. The first half of the course covers general engi- neering subjects and the second half a specific field. Credit not counted toward an Engineering degree. Prereq., permission.

381. RESEARCH (Mob) Staff

Prereq., approval by chairman of department in which work is per- formed.

390. SPECIAL INVESTIGATIONS IN ENGINEERING {Uo3) Staff Individual work or work in small groups, under guidance, in re- search or advanced study in a particular field of engineering. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq,, approval by chairman of department in which work is performed.

391. SEMINAR (l+o3) Staff Prereq., approval by chairman of department in which work is per- formed.

495. THESIS (lto6) Staff

Prereq., approval by chairman of department in which work is per- formed.

ENGINEERING DRAWING (Mr. Thomas, chairman)

1-2. ENGINEERING DRAWING (2-2) Thomas, Nellis, Wiclcham, Barnhill, Sarchet

Freehand lettering, use of instruments, geometric constructions, freehand drafting, orthographic projection, auxiliary and sectional views, dimensioning. Isometric, oblique, detail and assembly drawing. Intersections, developments, tracings and blue prints. Working drawings made from actual machine parts are dimensioned in the accepted Am- erican Standard method. 6 lab.

3. THE SLIDE RULE (1) Thomas, Nellis

Prereq., Math. 5.

Engineering 209

15. INDUSTRIAL ARTS DRAWING (3) Wickham

Pictorial methods, working drawings, gears, cams, screv\rs, fasten- ings, architectural drawings, delineation, perspective, mechanical let- tering, related information and special instruments of interest to teach- ers of mechanical drawing. 9 lab. Prereq., 1.

21. DESCRIPTIVE GEOMETRY (2) Thomas, Nellis, Wickham, Barnhill, Sarchet

Problems relating to points, lines, planes, solids, and their projec- tions, space visualization, curved surfaces, intersection of planes and solids, model making, practical applications. Daily exercise sheets. 1 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 1.

102. DESCRIPTIVE GEOMETRY (2) Thomas

Practical applications of the representation, intersection and de- velopment of plane surfaces. Double curved surfaces as used in ship, automobile and aircraft construction are included. Daily exercise sheets. 1 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 21.

115-116. MACHINE DRAFTING (3-3) Nellis, Wickham

Standard and basic representations as applied to commercial draft- ing and their application to detail and assembly drawings. 6 lab. Prereq., 2.

CHEMICAL ENGINEERING (Dr. Curry, chairman)

101. INTRODUCTION TO CHEMICAL PROCESS PRINCIPLES AND .

EQUIPMENT (3) Staff

The application of chemistry, physics and elementary thermo- dynamics to the solution of typical industrial problems. Prereq., Chem. 109, Math 101.

211. MATERIALS AND METALLURGY (3) Staff

An introductory course for engineers. Fundamental metallurgical theory, including physical properties of metals and alloys. Selection of engineering materials. Prereq., C.E. 222 or with C.E. 222.

220. THERMODYNAMICS AND KINETICS (3) Staff

Application of thermodynamics to chemical engineering problems. Use of kinetic theory in interpretation of reaction mechanisms and pre- diction of reaction rates for industrial chemical processes. Prereq., 101 and M.E. 221.

310-311. UNIT OPERATIONS (3-3) Staff

A study of the fundamental principles of fluid flow, heat transfer and other basic unit operations with problems to illustrate the prin- ciples. Prereq., Ch.E. 101 and (for 310), Chem. 313, (for 311) Chem. 314.

312. UNIT OPERATIONS LABORATORY (2) Staff

Laboratory practice to illustrate the principles of selected unit operations and unit processes and to aid students in gaining confidence in the handling of pilot plant equipment. Development of ability to devise workable procedures and to conduct experiments with minimum supervision is stressed. Improvement of skill in oral and written report- ing is a parallel objective. 6 lab. hours. Prereq., 310 and with 311 and 320.

320. UNIT PROCESSES (3) Staff

Investigation of typical industrial chemical processes with respect to the unit steps such as nitration, sulfonation, reduction and hydrolysis, which arranged in varying sequence constitute the processes. Consider- ation is also given to sources of raw material and energy, to types of equipment, and to the role of economics. Prereq., 310.

210 Ohio University

340. DESIGN AND INSTRUMENTATION (5) Staff

Project work involving chemical process design, including evalua- tion and extension of fundamental data by calculation, choice of operat- ing conditions, estimation of costs, selection of equipment, and the application of automatic controls. 3 lee. and 6 lab. Prereq., Senior standing; 311, 320 and Chem. 314.

CIVIL ENGINEERING (K/lr. Badger, acting chairman)

10. PLANE SURVEYING (3) Staff

Basic theory underlying field measurements for engineering work. The theory is supplemented by field work in which the student gains proficiency in the use of surveying instruments. 2 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., Math. 5.

120. APPLIED MECHANICS (3) Badger. Russ Laws of equilibrium of forces; friction; centroids and moment of

inertia. Prereq., Math. 101 or with Math. 101.

121. APPLIED MECHANICS (3) Badger, Lindley Motion of a particle and of rigid bodies. Work and energy; im- pulse and momentum. Prereq., 120.

213. ADVANCED SURVEYING (3) Staff

Application of surveying principles to topographic mapping. Field application of the principles of route engineering. 9 hrs. of lab. Prereq. 10, with 260.

222. STRENGTH OF MATERIALS (3) Badger, Russ Elementary stresses and strains, torsion, flexure including elastic

curve equations, columns, combined stresses, stresses due to impact. 3 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 120, Math. 102 or with Math. 102.

223. MATERIALS TESTING LABORATORY (1) Badger A series of experiments on the tensils, compressive, and shearing

strengths of the principal engineering materials. 2 hrs. of lab. Prereq. with 222.

224. FLUID MECHANICS (3) Russ Fundamental principles of the mechanics of fluids and their appli- cation to engineering. Fluid pressure, flow in orifices, weirs, pipes and open channels; elementary theory of pumps and turbines. Prereq., 121 or with 121.

225. SOIL MECHANICS (3) Lindley Theories of earth pressure and bearing capacities, with application

to the design of earth structures. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 222.

228. REINFORCED CONCRETE THEORY (2) Lindley

A study of the basic theory relating to reinforced concrete design. Prereq., 222.

230. STRUCTURAL ANALYSIS I (4) Badger, Russ Application of the laws of static equilibrium to the analysis of

forces in component parts of engineering structures. Prereq., 120.

231. STRUCTURAL DESIGN I (4) Lindley A study of the design of structural members in steel and other

metals. Prereq., 222 and 230.

Engineering 211

240. HYDRAULICS LABORATORY (1) Russ Experimental study of orifices, weirs, flow in pipes and channels;

hydraulic jump; turbines; pumps. 2 lab. Prereq., 224 or with 224.

241. HYDROLOGY (2) Staff A study of precipitation data, relationships between rainfall and

runoff, with applications to irrigation, flood control, erosion control, and municipal and industrial water supply. Prereq., 224.

249. WATER SUPPLY ENGINEERING (3) Staff Source, treatment, and delivery of pure water. Theory of design

and construction of various types of water purification plants. Prereq., 224.

250. SANITARY ENGINEERING (3) Staff Collection, treatment and disposal of sanitary and industrial wastes.

Theory of design and construction of various types of sewage disposal processes. Prereq., 224.

260. ROUTE ENGINEERING (2) Staff Theory of simple and compound curves, spiral easements, vertical

curves, earthwork quantities, construction methods and tracks as applied to transportation routes. Prereq., 10.

261. HIGHWAY ENGINEERING (3) Staff Materials, drainage, alinement, capacity, and finance as used in con- struction, maintenance, and operation of the modern highway. Prereq., 260.

270. ENGINEERING ECONOMY (3) R. D. SmUh

Economy studies for proposed new enterprises, replacement of exist- ing machines or structures, break-even and minimum cost points, plan- ning for growth, and economy studies for public works. Course open to junior or senior engineering students only, except by permission.

313. ADVANCED SURVEYING PROBLEMS (2) Staff Principles and practices in calculations for azimuth, latitude, and

longitude by observations on Polaris and the sun with the transit. Land surveying problems, contour lines, use of the plane table. 1 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., 213.

314. PHOTOGRAMMETRY (3) Staff Equipment and methods used in aerial photography. Use of map- making equipment and study of specialized equipment used by private aerial survey organizations and government agencies. Prereq., 213.

326. ADVANCED STRENGTH OF MATERIALS (3) Staff

Curved bars; stresses in flat plates; buckling of bars, plates, and

shells; theories of strength. Prereq., 222 and Math. 315 or with Math 315.

330. STRUCTURAL ANALYSIS II (4) Russ Theory of analysis of structures for which the conditions of static

equilibrium are not sufficient to obtain a solution. Prereq., 222 and 230.

331. STRUCTURAL DESIGN II (3) Lindley A study of the design of reinforced concrete members and struc- tures, and a continuation of steel design. Prereq., 228, 231, 330 or with 330.

For other advanced courses in Civil Engineering, see page 208.

212 Ohio University

ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING (Dr. Quisenberry, chairman)

103. BASIC ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING (5) Hoffee Basic concepts of D.C. circuits, Kirchoff's laws, network theorems,

bridges, potentiometers, D.C. circuit analysis, potential dividers, D.C. measurements, force on conductors, elements of magnetic theory, bat- teries and electro-chemistry. 3 lee, 2 lab. and 2 computation. Prereq., Math. 6.

104. BASIC ELECTRICAL ENGINEERING (5) Hoffee Basic concepts of A.C. currents, voltage power, inductance and

capacitance. Single phase circuit analysis, complex operators, vector diagrams. Instruments and measurements. Oscilloscope, oscillograph and frequency measurements D.C. time constants. Elements of polyphase circuits. 3 lee, 2 lab. and 2 computation. Prereq., Math. 6, E.E. 103 and with Physics 114.

201. CIRCUITS AND MEASUREMENTS (4) Quisenberry, Smith, Bjerre

Direct current circuits and measurements, magnetic circuits and m.easurements, alternating current circuits and measurements, single- phase and three phase. Not open to Electrical Engineering majors. 3 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq. Math 102 and Physics 113-114.

202. ELECTRICAL MACHINERY (2) Quisenberry, Smith, Bjerre Direct and alternating current machinery. Not open to Electrical

Engineering majors. 1 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq. 201.

301-302. COMMUNICATION ENGINEERING (4-4) Green

A study of the fundamentals of communication engineering at radio and telephone frequencies. Network theorems, resonance, transmission lines, filters, and coupled circuits. Impedance matching, amplifiers, modulators, radiation, and applications to radio and telephone apparatus.

3 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 104 and 308.

303-304. ELECTRICAL MACHINES (5-5) Sellecic

Characteristics and performance of direct and alternating current

motors and generators and single and polyphase static transformers.

4 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 103-104.

307-308. ENGINEERING ELECTRONICS (3-3) Smith

A comprehensive theoretical and practical treatment of the funda- mentals of electronics and the general properties of electron tubes with application to engineering. 2 lee and 2 lab. Prereq., Math. 102 and E.E. 104.

309. APPLIED ELECTRONICS (3) Cartlond Fundamental network analysis, vacuum and gas diodes, triodes,

welding timers and pulse circuits, induction heating, industrial elec- tronic control, magnetic-amplifiers, strain gages. Not open to Electrical Engineering majors. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., E.E. 201.

310. SEMI-CONDUCTORS (3) Bjerre Physics of semiconductors. Transistor equivalent circuits, amplifiers,

oscillators, modulation and detection. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 307 or with 307.

321-322. HIGH FREQUENCY CIRCUITS AND ELECTRO MAGNETIC

RADIATION (3-3) Green

Application of electronic and communication principles to high frequency circuits and a study of electro magnetic radiation and anten- nae. Prereq., 308 or 202 and 309 or permission.

Engineering 213

323,324. ADVANCED RADIO LABORATORY (1to4, 1to4) Green

Special problems of current interest in the field of radio engineer- ing. 2-8 labs. Prereq., 104.

325. ACOUSTICS (3) Green

Principles of sound generation and propagation in free space and in enclosures, methods of sound measurement; characteristics of speakers, microphones and receivers; design of horns; acoustics of auditoriums, theaters and broadcasting studios; public address systems. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., Math. 102 and Phys. 113-114.

328. ILLUMINATING ENGINEERING (3) Staff

Principles of light a.nd radiation; various light sources, their char- acteristics and efficiencies; principles and practice of photometry; design of illumination for various types of homes and industries. Laboratory gives practice in illumination measurements. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., Math. 102 and Phys. 114.

331. SERVOMECHANISMS (3) Quisenberry Automatic controller design, including the study of viscous out- put damping, error rate damping, integral control, error rate stabiliza- tion netv/orks and transfer functions. Prereq., 304 or 202, Math. 315.

332. CONTROL OF ELECTRICAL MACHINERY (3) Selleck Magnetic and electronic motor controllers, including a study of

control theory and applications to given problems. Prereq., 201 or 304.

334. ADVANCED CIRCUITS (3) Quisenberry The Laplace Transform applied to transient solutions of linear

systems. Special attention is given to electromechanical systems, in- cluding feedback and vacuum tube amplifiers. Prereq., Math. 315.

335. ELECTRIC AND MAGNETIC FIELDS (3) G.E.Smith

A study of electrical phenomena from the viewpoint of field theory. Prereq., Math. 315, and E.E. 104.

341. ELECTRICAL TRANSMISSION OF POWER (3) Selleck

Economic and electrical principles of transmission of electrical power, line equations and calculations, hyperbolic solution of long lines, insulation and protection against transients, mechanical principles and practical line construction. Prereq., 202 or 304.

342. SYMMETRICAL COMPONENTS (3) Quisenberry Circuits analysis by symmetrical components. Representation of

unbalanced polyphase currents and voltages by component symmetrical sets; solution of faults on power systems. Prereq., 202 or 304.

344. ELECTRICAL DESIGN (3) Selleck

Fundamental electric machine design relations. After a preliminary study, the student designs a direct current generator, a transformer, and an induction motor and predetermines the performance. Prereq., 304.

345-346. PROBLEMS IN ADVANCED A. C. MACHINERY (3-3) Staff

Problems taken up deal with tiansient conditions in alternators, motors, and transformers. Applications of the methods of symmetrical components to unbalanced operating conditions. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 304.

214 Ohio University

401. ELECTRICAL STATION DESIGN (3) Quisenberry

The application nf economic principles to the problems of electric generating station design, selection of apparatus, balancing initial and subsequent costs, interrelation of the mechanical and electrical elements of design. Prereq., 304.

For other advanced courses in Electrical Engineering, see page 208 under "Engineering."

MECHANICAL ENGINEERING (Mr. Black, chairman)

113. METAL PROCESSING (2) Black

Theory of machining and the mechanics of metal cutting; friction, wear and lubrication in machining. Production processes. Prereq., Ind. A. 13 and/or with C.E. 120.

201. KINEMATICS (3) Niesse

A study of basic mechanisms including analytical and graphical analyses of linkages, cams, gears, and gear production methods. Prereq., C.E. 121 or with C.E. 121.

211. ENGINEERING METALLURGY (3) Taylor

An introductory course for engineers. It includes a survey of the art of extracting metals from their ores and adapting them for use. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., Chem. 4, and Phys. 113.

221. THERMODYNAMICS I (3) Hicks Energy, heat and work, cycles, reversibility, availability, first and

second laws, entropy, real and perfect gases. Laboratory work on ap- plication, calibration of gauges, manometers, indicators, tachometers and other instruments. Prereq., Math. 102 and Phys. 113.

222. THERMODYNAMICS II (3) Hicks Fluid flow, gas mixtures, combustion calculations, power cycles and

dynamics of compressible flow. Laboratory work on flow meters, calorimetry, fuel and gas analysis and testing of steam-power units. Prereq., 221.

227. STEAM POWER PLANTS (3) Lausche

Fuels, principles of combustion, stationary boilers, grates, stokers, furnaces, coal pulverizers, economizers, pre-heaters, superheaters, stacks, forced and induced draft, boiler-feed pumps, steam engines and turbines, and condensers. Prereq., 221 and Math. 102.

229. STEAM POWER LABORATORY (2) Hicks

Testing of engines, turbines, pumps, fans, nozzles, and orifices. Prereq., 222.

295. INDUSTRIAL SAFETY (2) Taylor

The nature, causes and cost of industrial accidents and occupational diseases. Methods of accident prevention; educational, physical and supervisory. Improving ambient environment. Regulations and state laws. Prereq., Phys. 114.

302. DYNAMICS OF MACHINERY (3) Black

Analytical and graphical studies of velocities and accelerations, and of static and inertia forces in machinery; engine force analysis and balancing of machinery. Prereq., 201 and C.E. 121.

Engineering 215

303. MACHINE DESIGN I (3) Black

Application of mechanics, mechanism, materials, and mechanical processes to the design and selection of machine members and units of power transmission. Prereq., 113, 201, 211, and C.E. 222.

304. MACHINE DESIGN II (3) Black Application of the work covered in 303 to the design of complete

machines and sub-assemblies. 6 lab. Prereq., 303 or with 303.

311. AIR CONDITIONING AND REFRIGERATION (3) Staff Psychrometrics, heating, cooling, humidifjdng and decontamination

of air for domestic and commercial purposes. Refrigeration systems. Heat pump. Cooling-load calculations. Refrigeration and heating prac- tice. Prereq., 222, or 221 and permission.

312. INTERNAL COMBUSTION ENGINES (4) Staff Analysis and testing of spark-ignition and compression-ignition

engines including combustion, thermodynamics, carburetion, detonation, fuels and fuel injection. 3 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 222.

314. HEAT TRANSFER (3) Hicks

Basic concepts of conduction, convection and radiation; steady and

unsteady states, film coefficients and dimensional analysis. Prereq., 222.

392. ADVANCED MACHINE DESIGN (3) Black Advanced problems in the design and analysis of machine members

including consideration of stress propogation; stress analysis; fatigue and creep; mechanical vibration; Coriolis' acceleration; Castigliano'a theorem; and gi-aphical analysis. Prereq., 303 and permission.

393. LUBRICATION AND FRICTION (3) Black Derivation of Reynold's equation and its application to bearings

and gear teeth; load capacity and thermal equilibrium. Boundary lubri- cation, lubricant composition, surface finish, bearing materials and bear- ing performance. Prereq., Math. 315, C.E. 121 and permission.

394. MECHANICAL VIBRATIONS (3) Niesse The characteristic phenomena of mechanical vibrations encountered

in machines and structures, and their quantitative investigation. Simple- harmonic motion; combinations of simultaneous motions; free and forced vibration; damping effects; critical speeds; balancing; electro-mechanical analogy; principles of transmission and isolation of vibration; systems of several degrees of freedom; self-excited vibration; instrumentation. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., C.E. 121 and Math. 315.

395. ADVANCED THERMODYNAMICS (3) Hicks A review of classical thermodynamics, the Maxwell relations, free

energy, kinetic equilibrium of combustion. Prereq., 222.

For other advanced courses in Mechanical Engineering, see page 208 under "Engineering."

ENGINEERING DRAWING— See Engineering

216 Ohio University

ENGLISH Professors Wray (chairman), Foster, Kendoll

Visiting McGuffey Professor Sumnners

Associate Professors McQuiston, Losh,

Kirchner, Tfionnpson, Stone

Assistant Professors L. Brown, Hand, Knecfit,

Pickard, Whan (chairman, freshman English),

Aney, Butterworth, Sv/ardson, Culbert

Visiting Assistant Professor Stanton

Instructors Kasten, R. Roe, Wells, R. C. Brown, MacGibbon,

Hogcin, Molin, Davidson, Lettis, Curran, Violette, Morris,

McDonnell, Groff, Purdum, Greene, Williams, Mintzloff,

Palmer, 1. G. LoFollette, E. Raymond, A. Roe

The major requirement for the A.B. degree consists of a minimum of 25 hours beyond 3-4 distributed as follows: (a) 101, 102; (b) 323 or 324; (c) at least six hours chosen from 311, 312, 321, 322, 331, 371; (d) at least nine hours so chosen that two periods (18th, 19th, 20th centuries) are represented from 332, 341, 342, 351, 352, 353, 356, 361, 362, 368,372; (e) 396.

Students who write well may secure permission to vary these re- quirements in order to pursue an English major in creative writing.

A limited number of English majors may before April 15 of their junior year submit to the chairman of the department a written request to follow the honors program during their senior year. In addition to meeting the university requirements for honors work (see page 72), students in this program will attend the English Masters Seminar and achieve distinction in the comprehensive examination in English 396.

The requirement for the minor (optional) is 101, 102, and at least two additional courses (6 hours), chosen from 200 or 300 courses, not concentrated in one literary type, century, or field.

1. ENGLISH COMPOSITION (3) Staff

The grammatical elements of English composition, the sentence, and the paragraph. After com.pleting English 1 with a grade of not less than C, students are required to pass English 3-4. Credit for Eng. 1 is not counted toward a degree. (Each semester.)

3-4. ENGLISH COMPOSITION (3-3) Staff

A progressive course in written composition. Beginning with a brief review of the fundamentals of grammar and paragraph building, English 3 concentrates on the writing of clear, forceful exposition. English 4 offers more scope for reading, discussion, and analytical writ- ing. (Each semester.)

101. SOPHOMORE ENGLISH LITERATURE (1) (3) Staff A survey of English literature from the Middle Ages through the

Seventeenth Century, with particular emphasis upon Chaucer, Shake- speare, and Milton. Prereq., 4. (Each semester.)

102. SOPHOMORE ENGLISH LITERATURE (II) (3) Staff

A survey of English literature from the Eighteenth Century to the present, including major figures. Prereq., 4. (Each semester.)

111. THE CHIEF AMERICAN WRITERS (I) (3) Staff

Examination of the representative prose and poetry of the Colonial writers and a more detailed study of the works of the principal authors before the Civil War. Prereq., 4. (Each semester.)

English 217

112. THE CHIEF AMERICAN WRITERS (II) (3) Staff

A study of selected prose and poetry of the well-established post- Civil War writers and some consideration of well-known recent writers. Prereq., 4. (Each semester.)

223. SHAKESPEARE (1) (3) Wray Shakespeare's principal comedies and historical plays read in con- junction with a review of his life and background. The primai'y em- phasis is on reading with understanding and enjoyment. Pi'ereq., 4. (1st sem., yearly.)

224. SHAKESPEARE (II) (3) Wray

Shakespeare's principal tragedies, with particular attention to his dramatic technique and the Elizabethan stage. Prereq., 4. (2nd sem., yearly.)

262. THE CONTEMPORARY ENGLISH AND AMERICAN NOVEL (3) Kendall

Recent British authors, including Galsworthy, Conrad, Joyce, Ben- nett, and Woolf; American authors, including Cather, Dreiser, Lewis, Wolfe; living writers such as Maugham, Huxley, Hemingway, Faulk- ner; best novels of the season. Prereq., 4. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

263. MODERN BRITISH AND AMERICAN DRAMA (3) Staff Types and tendencies in English, Irish, and American drama since

about 1890. A reading and discussion of plays by Wilde, Shaw, Synge, O'Casey, Fry, O'Neill, Anderson, Connelly, Hellman, Sherwood, Saroyan, and Williams. Prereq., 4. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

264. THE TEACHING OF HIGH SCHOOL ENGLISH (3) L.Brown

A study of the content and presentation of grammar, composition, and literature poetry, drama, novel, and short story. Prereq., 4 and junior or senior rank. (1st sem., yearly.)

266. THE SHORT STORY (3) McQuiston

A historical and critical study of the short story, including its origin and evolution as a literary form, its masters in the past such as Poe and De Maupassant, and modern classics. Prereq., 4. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

275. THE ENGLISH AND AMERICAN NOVEL (I) (3) Stone The message and method of the first great novels in English:

Fielding, Austen, Scott, Dickens, Thackeray, the Brontes, Hawthorne, and Melville. Class discussion and lecture. Frequent quizzes. Prereq., 4. (1st sem., yearly.)

276. THE ENGLISH AND AMERICAN NOVEL (II) (3) Stone The message and method of the great novels from mid-Victorian

times to the first world War: Trollope, Eliot, Twain, James, Crane, Hardy, Conrad, Butler, Dreiser, and Maugham. Class discussion and lecture. Frequent quizzes. Prereq., 4. (2nd sem., yearly.)

277. ENGLISH AND AMERICAN BIOGRAPHY (3) Kendall The development of biography as a literary form in Great Britain

and the United States; its technique; and the masterpieces considered in relation to their authors, subjects, and social background. Prereq., 4. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

218 Ohio University

281. THE EUROPEAN NOVEL (3) Lash

Reading of famous European novels of the Nineteenth and early Twentieth centuries in translation, with chief emphasis on the Russian, French, German, and Scandinavian. Prereq., 4, (1st sem., 1959-60.)

282. EUROPEAN DRAMA (3) Lash Readings in English of typical plays by Sophocles, Aristophanes,

Plautus, Moliere, Ibsen, Strindberg, Hauptmann, Rostand, Chekov, Gorki, Molnar, Pirandello, Capek, and Sartre. Prereq., 4. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

284. MYTHOLOGY IN ENGLISH AND AMERICAN LITERATURE (3) Lash A study chiefly of Greek and Roman mythology with special refer- ence to the allusions found in major English and American writers. Prereq., 4. (2nd sem., yearly.)

285. THE BIBLE AS LITERATURE { I) (3) Foster

An analysis of the historical books of the Old Testament, and other narratives, together with a brief survey of the early poetry and pro- phecy. Prereq., 4. (1st sem., yearly.)

286. THE BIBLE AS LITERATURE (II) (3) Foster Prose and poetry from the Old Testament; the life and the sajrings

of Jesus; and the letters of Saint Paul, with special emphasis on con- tinuity of Hebrew literary traditions in the Old and the New Testa- ments. Prereq., 4. (2nd sem., yearly.)

290. CREATIVE WRITING (3) Kendall

Individual work in the writing of fiction and non-fiction short stories, essays, articles, verse. Prereq., 4. (Each semester.)

293. SOPHOMORE COMPOSITION (3) Culbert, Lash and Staff

An extended study of the rhetorical and grammatical principles of effective composition; practical work in a variety of writing problems. Section 293e is designed specifically for future teachers in English in junior and senior high schools. Prereq., 4. (Each semester.)

311. HISTORY OF THE ENGLISH LANGUAGE (3) R. Roe

An elementary account of the growth of the English language; its relation to other world languages; the vocabulary and grammar of Anglo-Saxon, Middle English, and Modern English; selections from Early English literature. Prereq., 12 hrs. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

312. CHAUCER (3) Staff Chaucer, his life and his world; contemporary literature; his early

works; The Canterbury Tales; Troilus and Criseyde; Chaucer scholar- ship. Prereq., 12 hrs.; 311 recommended. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

321. SIXTEENTH CENTURY LITERATURE (3) Wray

A study of England's part in the Renaissance and the humanistic movement as revealed in the works of the chief poets and prose writers of the century. Prereq., 12 hrs. (1st sem,, 1959-60.)

322. ELIZABETHAN DRAMA (3) Kendall A study of the English drama from 1550 to 1642, thus including

the predecessors, the contemporaries, and the immediate followers of Shakespeare. Prereq., 12 hrs.; or 9 hrs., including 101, and S hrs. dra- matic art. (2nd sem., 1956-60.)

English 219

323. SHAKESPEARE (I) (3) McQuiston Shakespeare's development as a writer of comedies and historical

dramas; his life and social background; the Elizabethan stage and the- atrical companies. A research paper. Prereq., 12 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

324. SHAKESPEARE (II) (3) McQuiston

Intensive analysis of the great tragedies and more rapid reading of the other tragedies and the sonnets; Shakespearean scholarship and criticism. A research paper. Prereq., 12 hrs. (2nd sem., yearly.)

331. SEVENTEENTH CENTURY LITERATURE (3) Foster The poetry and prose of such writers as Donne and Bacon; Herrick

and other Cavalier and "metaphysical" poets; Browne, Walton, Hobbes, Bunyan, Pepys; Restoration plays. Prereq., 12 hrs. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

332. MILTON (3) Foster Emphasis on John Milton's minor poems, some of his prose, and

Paradise Lost, Paradise Regained, and Sampson Agonistes. Prereq., 12 hrs. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

341. EIGHTEENTH CENTURY LITERATURE (I) (3) Molin The poetry of Pope and Gay; the essays of Addison and Steele;

and the works of Swift and Defoe; the novels of Richardson and Field- ing; the drama. Prereq., 12 hrs. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

342. EIGHTEENTH CENTURY LITERATURE (II) (3) Molin

Dr. Johnson, his works, his personality, his friends; Boswell and his biography of Johnson; Goldsmith and Sheridan; Walpole; Gray and Cowper; the philosophers. Prereq., 12 hrs. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

351. POETRY OF THE ROMANTIC PERIOD (3) Kendall The poetry of Wordsworth, Coleridge, Byron, Shelley, Keats; phil- osophical background and historical context of Romanticism Rosseau, Godwin, the French Revolution, the Napoleonic Empire. Prereq., 12 hrs. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

352. VICTORIAN POETS (3) Kirchner The influence of the Victorian Age upon the lives and the poetry

of Tennyson, the Brownings, Arnold, Swinburne, the Rossettis, Morris, and Clough. Prereq., 12 hrs. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

353. ENGLISH PROSE OF THE NINETEENTH CENTURY (3) Wray

A study of the essayists and major prose writers of the Romantic and Victorian periods, including Lamb, Hazlitt, DeQuincey, Coleridge, Carlyle, Newman, Ruskin, Huxley, and Arnold. Prereq., 12 hrs. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

356. EMERSON, THOREAU, AND THE CONCORD GROUP (3) Kirchner

A study of Emerson, Thoreau, Alcott, Fuller, and others whose lives and writings were influenced by that American form of idealism known as Transcendentalism. Prereq., 12 hrs. including 111. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

361. TWENTIETH CENTURY PROSE (3) Stone

An intensive analysis of such writers as Joyce, Faulkner, Heming- way, and Wolfe. Prereq., 12 hrs. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

220 Ohio University

362. TWENTIETH CENTURY DRAMA (3) Thompson

An intensive analysis of such writers as Shaw, O'Neill, Anderson, Williams, and O'Casey. Prereq., 12 hrs. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

368. TWENTIETH CENTURY POETRY (3) Foster

An intensive analysis of such poets as Eliot, Auden, Frost, Thomas, and some younger poets. Prereq., 12 hrs. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

371. HISTORY OF LITERARY CRITICISM (3) Thompson

A review of the theories and practice of literary criticism in Europe from Aristotle through the Renaissance, neoclassic, and Roman- tic schools to the present. Prereq., 12 hrs., (1st sem., 1959-60.)

372. PRACTICAL LITERARY CRITICISM (3) Thompson

A survey of the distinctive ways whereby modern literary scholars attempt to elucidate and evaluate works of literature. Readings in contemporary criticism and preparation of critical papers that will ex- emplify some of the distinctive techniques of literary analysis. Prereq., 12 hrs., including 371 and permission. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

390. STUDIES IN ENGLISH (lto3) Staff

Directed reading and research in English or American literature for individual students with special interests and competence. Confer- ences and papers. (See also the Honors Program.) Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs., Prereq., 12 hrs. and permission of chairman. (Each semester. )

391-392. MASTERS SEMINAR (1-1) Staff

Discussion of problems of research and of criticism in relation to theses in progress. Required of English majors in the honors program and of candidates for the master's degree in English who are writing a research thesis. (Yearly.)

393-394. CREATIVE WRITING SEMINAR (3-3) Kendall

Criticism of manuscripts and discussion of problems of form. Re- quired of candidates for the master's degi-ee in English who are sub- mitting creative work in lieu of the research thesis. Prereq., 290 or equivalent, permission. Admission only in the fall, except for unusual reasons. (Yearly.)

396. SENIOR SURVEY OF ENGLISH LITERATURE (1) Swardson

An intensive survey of English literature including a wide back- ground of reading, weekly lectures presented by staff members and a comprehensive final examination. Required of senior English majors in the College of Arts and Sciences. (Yearly.)

401. BIBLIOGRAPHY AND THESIS WRITING (3) Aney

Students are given an introduction to basic reference works, schol- arly and critical journals, and pertinent bibliographies. Assigned exer- cises in methodology may include the field of the student's course work or thesis. Required of all candidates for the Master's degree in English. (1st sem., yearly.)

470. SEMINAR IN LITERARY PROBLEMS (3) Staff

Intensive study of an author, group, or form. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. (Yearly.)

495. THESIS (lto6) Staff

Prereq., permission. (Each sem.ester.)

Finance 221

FINANCE Professor Cherrington (chairman)

Associate Professor Fichtfiorn

Assistant Professor Dawson

Lecturer Wolfe

75. PERSONAL FINANCE (2) Cherrington

Considered are such subjects as installment purchases, savings ac- counts, savings bonds, borrowing, life insurance, annuities, buying a home, investments in securities, investment companies, and taxes. Pre- req.. Not open to juniors and seniors nor to students working toward the Bachelor of Science in Commerce degree.

101. FINANCIAL INSTITUTIONS (3) Staff

Commercial banking, consumer credit, long-term funds for business, security exchanges, savings institutions, insurance, investment com- panies, urban real estate financing, farm credit, and the Federal Reserve System. Prereq., Ec. 12 or 102.

121. CORPORATION FINANCE (3) Staff

Stocks and bonds, financing industrial, public utility and railroad companies, investment banking, securities markets, short-term financing, dividend policies, expansion and combination, refinancing, recapitaliza- tion, and reorganization. Prereq., 101 and Acct. 76.

275. INVESTMENT PRINCIPLES (3) Cherrington

Information for individual investors which can be used in the management of personal investment problems. Among the topics to be considered are investment risks and how they can be handled, yields, analysis of financial statements, securities markets and their behavior. Prereq., 121.

306. SECURITY ANALYSIS (3) Fich+horn

The problems of selection or sale of securities for investment pur- poses. Industry structure, volume-price-cost relationships, management, financial position, terms of the security contract, and market price be- havior are studied to determine the attractiveness of a security. Con- struction of portfolios for individual investors is considered briefly. Report writing and case discussion. Prereq., 275.

312. CREDIT AND COLLECTION MANAGEMENT (3) Fichthorn

The process of extending credit to business firms and of collecting outstanding indebtedness. Subjects covered include financial statement analysis, types of credit information and its evaluation, policies for extending credit, determining credit limits, collections, and credit de- partment organization and administration. Emphasis is on mercantile and bank credit. Report writing and case discussion. Prereq., 121.

315. PROPERTY AND CASUALTY INSURANCE (3) Fichthorn Analysis of the principal types of property and casualty insurance

policies with respect to protection afforded the policyholder, his obli- gations, and cost of protection. Policies studied include fire and extended coverage, allied lines, business interruption, inland marine, automobile, general liability, theft, and bonds. The subjects of risk, insurance-law, industry organization, and multiple-peril policies are also covered. Pre- req., 121.

316. LIFE INSURANCE (2 or 3 as scheduled) Dawson The fundamental economics of life insurance. The principles and

practices of life insurance including types of contracts, group and in- dustrial insurance, annuities, etc. Prereq., Ec. 12 or 102 or permission.

222 Ohio University

341. MONEY AND BANKING (3) Dawson

The basic concepts of money, credit, and exchange with emphasis on bank credit expansion by the Federal Reserve and commercial banks, and a study of monetary policies followed by the Federal Reserve and Treasury. A historical study of the development of the monetary system of the United States. Prereq., 121 or 12 hours economics.

351. MONETARY THEORY (3) Dawson

A study of the theories advanced to explain the relationship be- tween money and its value, the relationship between money and the level of economic activity, allocations of funds among alternate uses, and interest and interest rates. Prereq., 341 or permission.

356. PROBLEMS IN CORPORATION FINANCE (3) Cherring+on

This course is developed through the use of cases which deal with short-term financing, long-term financing, reserve and dividend policies, expansion and combination, refunding, recapitalization, and reorgani- zation, Prereq., 121.

381. RESEARCH IN FINANCE (lto8) Staff

Special studies in money, banking, or corporation finance. Prereq., 9 hrs., Ec. 12 or 102 and permission.

391. SEMINAR IN FINANCE {2 to 4) Staff

Maximum credit in course, 10 hrs. Prereq., 9 hrs., Ec. 12 or 102 and permission.

495. THESIS (1 to6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

Additional course: Ec. 315 Public Finance.

FINE ARTS

General courses in the history and appreciation of the fine arts are open to all students who wish to broaden their knowledge of the field. Advanced courses are listed under the offerings of the various depart- ments.

The minor requirements for the B.F.A. degree may be fulfilled by completing 18 hours in the following courses, including F.A. 17-18. (See page 144.)

17-18. INTRODUCTION TO THE FINE ARTS (3-3) Seigfred, OIpp, Bergsagel

Analysis of the form, media, and content of the major arts stress- ing interrelationship of architecture, the dance, dramatic art, music, literature, and painting through recognition of common art factors.

121-122. HISTORY OF PAINTING AND SCULPTURE (3-3) OIpp

Periods, styles, and great personalities from early times to the present. Analysis of aesthetic qualities in masterpieces of art.

123-124. HISTORY OF MUSIC (3-3) Bergsagel

Music from ancient times to the present. Not open to students who have received credit in Mus. 5-6. Prereq., 17-18 or permission.

175-176. HISTORY OF ARCHITECTURE (3-3) Denison

The development of architecture with emphasis on environmental influences. Illustrated lectures.

179-180. HISTORY OF THE VISUAL THEATRE (3-3) Lane, Hahne

Survey of theatrical production and acting. Development of the related arts of dance and the motion picture.

Fine Arts 223

203-204. HISTORY OF ORATORY (3-3) Stoats

Survey from the Greek and Roman periods to modem times.

FRENCH See Romance Languages

GENERAL STUDIES

1-2. Biology— THE LIVING WORLD (3-3) Staff

Biol. 1 deals with the fundamental similarities and differences among plants and animals; their protoplasm, cells, tissues, and organs; their physiological processes; and their reproduction, growth, and devel- opment. Biol. 2 is concerned with studies of representatives of the principal groups of plants and animals from the standpoint of structure, life history, and classification. The fundamental principles of heredity, evolution, ecology, and geographical distribution of organisms are set forth. 2 lee. and 2 lab. This course is not designed for botany or zoology majors; but if it is taken, a maximum of three hours' credit may be allowed toward such a major, at the discretion of the department concerned. No credit allowed for this course for students who have com- pleted Bot. 3-4 or Zool. 3-4. Not open to juniors and seniors. (Yearly.)

3.4. Physical Science— THE PHYSICAL WORLD (3,3) Staff

A general physical science course designed for non-science majors. Emphasis is placed on basic scientific laws and principles and the solu- tion of related problems without use of formal mathematics. Laboratory experiments are designed to help in the understanding of the various areas studied. Phys. Sci. 3 includes an introduction to astronomy, meteorology, and topography, while 4 includes chemistry and physics. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Does not fulfill physics requirements for science majors. Not open to juniors and seniors. (Yearly.)

7,8. Humanities— GREAT BOOKS (3,3) Cuibert, Hultgren, Murphy, Wells

Guided reading and discussion of literary masterpieces, ancient and modem, as an introduction to the Western humanistic tradition: man's relation to God, right and wrong, society, and environment. Open to those who are eligible for or have taken English 3. Not open to juniors and seniors. (Yearly.)

107,108. Humanities— GREAT BOOKS (3,3) Cuibert

Guided reading and discussion of literary masterpieces, ancient and modern, as an introduction to the Western humanistic tradition: man's relation to God, right and wrong, society, and environment. Not open to freshmen or to those who have had Humanities 7 and 8. (Yearly.)

9, 10. Social Science— CITIZENSHIP IN THE MODERN WORLD

(3, 3) Everetf, Fairfield, Murphree, Park Soc, Sci. 9 is an introductory analysis of human behavior, drawing primarily on anthropology, sociology, and briefly on biology. Soc. Sci. 10 focuses on parties and politics, the democratic heritage and its rivals, and contemporary political problems. Not open to juniors and seniors. (Yearly.)

209.210. Social Science— CITIZENSHIP IN THE MODERN WORLD

(3,3) Fairfield Approaches to human behavior and personality through advanced readings fi'om several fields. In the second semester the course stresses American culture and character and the political crisis in an inter- national community. Not open to freshmen and sophomoi'es or to those who have had Soc. Sci. 9, 10. (Yearly.)

224 Ohio University

GEOGRAPHY AND GEOLOGY Professor Sturgeon (chairmon)

Assistant Professors Phielps, Aukland Instructors Lehrer, Korsok

The major requirement for the A.B. degree is 30 semester hours in approved departmental courses and Geol. 1-2. Geol. 111-112 and 223 are required for those students specializing in physical geography.

GEOGRAPHY

3. ELEMENTS OF PHYSICAL GEOGRAPHY (3) Staff

An introductory study of the elements of the physical environment: earth-sun relationships, landforms, weather and climate, and soils. Not open to juniors, seniors, or students who have had Geog. 150. (Each semester.)

4. WORLD REGIONAL GEOGRAPHY (3) Staff

An introductory study of the world by regions wherein the physical background, land utilization, and cultural development is surveyed. Not open to juniors, seniors, or students who have had Geog. 150. (2nd sem., yearly.)

15. ECONOMIC GEOGRAPHY (3) Staff

A study of the world distribution of man's basic economic activities: extractive, agricultural, and manufacturing industries, in partial re- lationship to the physical environment. Not open to juniors and seniors.

(Each semiester.)

150. GEOGRAPHY AND ENVIRONMENT (3) Staff

A survey of man's response and adjustment to the varied natural environment throughout the world employing the concepts of human geography. Not open to students who have had Geog. 3 or 4. (Each semester.)

175. FUNDAMENTALS OF METEOROLOGY (3) Lehrer

An introductory study of the elements of weather: temperature, pressure, moisture, and wind. Weather map analysis. 2 lee, 2 lab. (1st sem., yearly.)

176. FUNDAMENTALS OF CLIMATOLOGY (3) Lehrer An introductory study of the climates of the world: their distribu- tion, characteristics, and causes. 2 lee, 2 lab. Prereq., Geog. 175. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

202. GEOGRAPHY OF THE UNITED STATES AND CANADA (3) Lehrer

A systematic and regional study of the U.S. and Canada: the physical environment, natural resources, agriculture, and cultural de- velopment. (1st sem., yearly.)

215. CARTOGRAPHY (3) Korsolc

The elementary principles of map projections, map drawing and graph making. Prereq., permission. (2nd sem., yearly.)

231. GEOGRAPHY OF OHIO (3) Korsok

A detailed regional study of the physical background and economic development of Ohio. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

Geography and Geology 225

232. CONSERVATION OF NATURAL RESOURCES (3) Staff

Problems in the conservation of soils, water, minerals, forests and wild life as related to land use. The interrelations of these various fac- tors and their educational significance are emphasized. Field trips. (1st sem., yearly.)

301. GEOGRAPHY OF THE SOVIET UNION (3) Korsok

Intensive geographic study of the Soviet Union. Prereq., 3 and 4, or 150*. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

305. GEOGRAPHY OF LATIN AlvlERICA (3) Lehrer

Intensive geographic study of Latin America. Prereq., 3 and 4, or 150*. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

308. GEOGRAPHY OF EUROPE (3) Korsok

Intensive geographic study of Europe. Prereq., 3 and 4, or 150*. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

312. GEOGRAPHY OF SOUTHERN ASIA AND ISLANDS (3) Korsok

Intensive geographic study of Southern and Eastern Asia. Prereq., 3 and 4, or 150*. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

322. GEOGRAPHY OF AFRICA (3) Lehrer

Intensive geographic study of Africa. Pi'ereq., 3 and 4, or 150*. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

360. POLITICAL GEOGRAPHY (3) Staff

Geographic basis of national strength or weakness. Physical and cultural influences upon historical development emphasized. Prereq., 6 hrs.* (1st sem., 1958-59.)

382. GEOGRAPHICAL STUDIES (1 to 4 a semester in any of the following) Staff Supervised studies in fundamentals of geographic research. Maxi- mum credit in any one area, 8 hrs. Prereq,, 12 hrs., and permission. (Each semester.)

a. Cartography. Korsok

b. Conservation of Natural Resources. Staff

c. Economic Geography. Korsok

d. Meteorology and Climatology. Lehrer

e. Physiography (See Geol. 383-a). Lehrer

f. Political Geography. Korsok

g. Regional Geography. Staff

GEOLOGY

The major requirement for the A.B. or B.S. degree is a minimum of 30 semester hours in approved departmental courses numbered above 100, including 111, 112, 131, 132, 223, 241, 251, 252, 282, 314, 343, 362, field camp and Geog. 3, 4, and 215. In addition, the following extra- departmental work is required: general chemistry, 8 hrs.; C.E. 10, 3 hrs.; Math. 5, 5 hrs.; physics, 8 hrs.

1-2. ELEMENTS OF GEOLOGY (3-3) Staff

Elementary geology including studies of eai'th features, processes, and principles and an introduction to earth history; laboratory exercises with maps, minerals, rocks, and fossils. 2 lee, 2 lab., and "field trips. Geol. 1 not open to students who have had 103, or 106. (Yearly.)

*Upperclassmen and eraduate students in related fields such as historj', economics, government, and sociology may take the course by special permission.

226 Ohio University

103. ENGINEERING GEOLOGY (3) Phelps

Study of geologic materials, methods, and principles of value to engineers. 2 lee, 2 lab., and field trips. Not open to students who have had 1 or 106. (1st sem., yearly.)

106. AGRICULTURAL GEOLOGY (3) Sturgeon

Study of geologic materials, methods, and principles of value to students of agriculture. 2 lee, 2 lab., and field trips. Not open to stu- dents who have had 1 or 103. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

111-112. HISTORICAL GEOLOGY (2-2) Sturgeon

Earth history emphasizing geologic development and stratigraphy of North America. 2 lee, 1 lab., and field trips. Prereq., 2. (Yearly.)

131. MINERALOGY 1. (3) Phelps Elements of crystallography and the introduction to descriptive

mineralogy. 2 lee, 2 lab. Prereq., 2 and Chem. 2 or 4. (1st sem., yearly.)

132. MINERALOGY li. (3) Phelps Determinative mineralogy using physical and chemical means for

the study of the common ore and rock-forming minerals. 1 lee, 4 lab. Prereq., 131. (2nd sem., yearly.)

223. PRINCIPLES OF GEOMORPHOLOGY (3) Aulcland Introduction to the origin of surface features and pertinent geologic

structures emphasizing the land forms of the world. 2 lee, 2 lab., and field trips. Prereq., 10 hrs. including 112. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

224. GLACIAL GEOLOGY (3) Aukland, Phelps Introduction to study of glaciers and glaciation. 2 lee, 2 lab., and

field trips. Prereq., 112. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

241. PETROLOGY (3) Phelps

Study of rocks emphasizing origin, composition, physical properties, field classification, and identification. 2 lee, 2 lab., and field trips. Prereq., 132. (1st sem., yearly.)

251-252. PALEONTOLOGY (3-3) Sturgeon

Introduction to fossils emphasizing the invertebrates, their mor- phology, classification, identification, and distribution. Index fossils em- phasized. 2 lee, 2 lab., and field trips. Prereq., 112. (Yearly.)

282. GEOLOGIC FIELD METHODS (3) Phelps

Introduction to geologic field methods, especially in use of hand level, Brunton pocket transit, and plane table and telescopic alidade, and aerial photos. 1 lee and field work. Prereq., 12 hrs., C.E. 10, and perm. (2nd sem., yearly.)

314. PRINCIPLES OF STRATIGRAPHY (3) Sturgeon Processes and principles involved in the study of stratigraphy.

2 lee, 2 lab., and field trips. Prereq., 251-252, 343. (2nd sem., yearly.)

315. GEOLOGY OF OHIO (2) Sturgeon

Introduction to the geology of Ohio emphasizing physiography, stratigraphy, and economic geology. 2 lee, and field trips. Prereq., 112. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

Geography and Geology 227

333. OPTICAL CRYSTALLOGRAPHY (2) Aukland

The optical behavior of common rock-fonning minerals by powder immersion techniques and the use of the petrographic microscope. 1 lee, 2 lab. Prereq., 132, physics 6, chemistry 2 or 4. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

342. PETROGRAPHIC METHODS (3) Aukland An introduction to the identification of rocks bj'' thin-sections and

the petrographic microscope. A selection of 100 North American rocks is studied. 2 lee, 2 lab. Prereq., 132, 241, 333, and Chem. 2 or 4. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

343. PRINCIPLES OF SEDIMENTATION (3) Aukland Processes and principles involved in study of sediments. 2 lee, 2

lab. and field trips. Prereq., 112, 132, and 241. (2nd sem., yearly.)

353. MICROPALEONTOLOGY (3) Sturgeon

Similar approach as in 251-252 but dealing with animal fossils commonly studied under the microscope. 1 lee, 4 lab., and field trips. Prereq., 251. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

362. STRUCTURAL GEOLOGY (3) Phelps

Study of the earth's architecture and of the diastrophic forces in- strumental in the deformation of the earth's crust. 2 lee, 2 lab., and field trips. Prereq., 2, 112, Math, through college trigonometry. (2nd sem., yearly.)

371. ECONOMIC GEOLOGY— Metals (3) Phelps Principles of metallic mineral deposition and a survey of the ore

deposits of the world. 2 lee, 2 lab. Prereq., 112, 132, and 241. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

372. ECONOMIC GEOLOGY— Non-metals (3) Aukland Principles of non-metallic mineral deposition and a survey of non- metallic and mineral fuel deposits of the world. 2 lee, 2 lab., and field trips. Prereq., 132, and 241. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

383. GEOLOGIC STUDIES (Ho 4 a semester in any of the following) Staff

Supervised studies in fundamentals of geologic research. Maximum credit in any one area, 8 hrs. Prereq., 12 hrs., and permission.

a. Glacial Geology and Physiography. Aukland, Phelps.

b. Mineralogy, Petrology, or Economic Geology. Aukland, Phelps. e Paleontology. Sturgeon.

d. Sedimentation and Stratigraphy. Aukland, Phelps, Sturgeon.

e. Structural Geology. Phelps.

385,386. GEOLOGIC FIELD RECONNAISSANCE (1-5) Staff

Vacation period geologic field trips to selected areas in North America with pertinent conferences, readings, and accepted reports. Prereq., 15 hrs., and permission.

391,392. SEMINAR IN GEOLOGY (1,1) Staff

Selected topics. Required of all majors and graduate students. Prereq., 15 hrs., and permission. (Yearly.)

415. REGIONAL STRATIGRAPHY— EASTERN NORTH AMERICA (3) Sturgeon Detailed consideration of stratigraphy east of the Great Plains. 2 lee, 2 lab. Prereq., 12 hrs. above 100 including 112 and 314. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

228 Ohio University

416. REGIONAL STRATIGRAPHY— WESTERN NORTH AMERICA

(3) Phelps, Sturgeon Treatment similar to 415 but covering the Great Plains and cor- dilleran regions. 2 lee, 2 lab. Prereq., 12 hrs. above 100 including 112 and 314. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

425. REGIONAL PHYSIOGRAPHY— EASTERN NORTH AMERICA (3) Aukland Study of surface features and related significant geologic data of

North America east of the Great Plains. 2 lee, 2 lab., and field trips. Prereq., 223, 314, 362. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

426. REGIONAL PHYSIOGRAPHY— WESTERN NORTH AMERICA (3) Phelps Similar to 425 but covering the Great Plains and cordilleran

regions. 2 lee, 2 lab. Prereq., 223, 314, 362. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

493. RESEARCH IN GEOLOGY (lto4) Staff

Maximum credit in course 6 hrs. Prereq., 18 hrs., and permission. (Yearly.)

495. THESIS (lto6) Staff

Maximum credit in course 6 hrs. Prereq., permission.

GEOLOGY See Geography and Geology

GERMAN Associafe Professors Krauss, Lederer

Assisfant Professor Benson (chairman) Instructor Johnson

The major requirement for the A.B. degree is a minimum of 20 hours above courses 1-2, including 209-210.

1-2. BEGINNING GERMAN (4-4) Staff

Instruction in the fundamental grammatical principles, drill in pronunciation, conversation, and the reading of prose. (Yearly.)

101-102. ITERMEDIATE GERMAN (4-4) Staff

Reading of modern German literature with emphasis on conversa- tion, translation, drill in idioms, and some grammar review. Prereq., 2 or 2 yrs. high school German. (Yearly.)

103. GERMAN FOR CHEMISTS (2) Johnson

A course designed to familiarize chemistry students with the tech- nical expressions found in a German textbook in chemistry. Prereq,, 101. (2nd sem., yearly.)

108. GERMAN CONVERSATION (3) Krauss

Practice in pronunciation, conversation, idioms. The materials used deal with everyday German life and customs. Prereq., 101 or 3 yrs. high school German. (2nd sem., yearly.)

209-210. GERMAN GRAMMAR AND COMPOSITION (2-2) Lederer

Review of German grammar, drill in formal and free composition, and practice in German conversation. Required of all German majors and those students planning to teach German. Prereq., 102 or 4 yrs. high school German. (Yearly.)

301,302. SURVEY OF GERMAN LITERATURE (3,3) Lederer

Prereq., 102, or 4 yrs. high school German. (1959-60.)

German 229

303.304. READINGS FROM GERMAN LITERATURE (l+o4, 1to4) Staff

Selected readings adapted to the needs of the class or the student. Maximum credit in each course, 8 hrs. Prereq., 102 or 4 yrs. high school German. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

311.312. NINETEENTH CENTURY GERMAN DRAMA (3,3) Lederer

A study of the German drama of the Nineteenth Century and the reading of the more important plays connected with the various move- ments. Prereq., 102 or 4 yrs. high school German. (1958-59.)

313. CLASSICAL GERMAN DRAMA (3) Krauss Plays of Lessing, Goethe, and Schiller are studied. Prereq., 102

or 4 yrs. high school German. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

314. GOETHE'S FAUST (3) Krauss A detailed study of Goethe's greatest contribution to modern thought

and life. Prereq., 313. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

319. THE GERMAN SHORT STORY. 1800-1850 (2) Krauss

Reading of representative short stories from Romanticism to Poetic Realism with discussion of the literary movements. Prereq., 102 or 4 yrs. high school German. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

320. THE GERMAN SHORT STORY, 1850-1900 (2) Krauss Reading of representative short stories of Poetic Realism with dis- cussion of this literary movement. Prereq., 102 or 4 yrs. high school German. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

321. CONTEMPORARY GERMAN SHORT STORY (2) Krauss

Reading of representative stories from Naturalism to the present time with discussion of the various literary movements. Prereq., 102 or 4 yrs. high school German. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

322. WAGNER'S POETICAL WORKS (2) Krauss

Richard Wagner's principal music dramas will be read and dis- cussed for their literary content. Prereq., 102 or 4 yrs. high school German. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

323. GERMAN LYRICS AND BALLADS (2) Krauss Reading and discussion of the German lyi-ics and ballads since

Goethe. Prereq., 102 or 4 yrs. high school German. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

351. ADVANCED GERMAN GRAMMAR AND STYLE (2) Lederer

Grammatical analysis. Free composition and translation into Ger- man. Prereq., 210. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

371. ADVANCED GERMAN (l+o4) Krauss, Lederer

Reading and research in German language and literature for ad- vanced students. Maximum credit in course, 8 hrs. Prereq., 6 hrs. beyond 102,

421-422. INTRODUCTION TO MIDDLE HIGH GERMAN (2-2) Lederer

Selected readings from medieval German lyrics and epics. Prereq., 12 hrs. beyond 102. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

495. THESIS {lto6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

230 Ohio UNivEaisiTY

GOVERNMENT Associate Professors Collins,

Gusteson (chairman) Elsbree

Assistant Professors Everett, Fairfield

Instructor Habachy

The Department of Government seeks to meet the needs of those who desire to understand the organization and functions of government, to promote active participation in the duties of citizenship, to prepare students to enter government service, to provide background for pre- law students, and to train teachers of government.

The major requirement for the A.B. degree is 24 hours, including Govt. 1 and 2. Recommended electives include Economics 11-12 or 101- 102; and History 101-102. Prelaw students should elect Accounting 75-76.

1,2. AMERICAN GOVERNMENT (3.3) Collins, Gusteson, Elsbree, Everett

Govt. 1 includes the political and constitutional development, the organization and the functioning of the national government. Govt. 2 is concerned with the organization and functioning of state and local governments. Not open to juniors and seniors. (Yearly.)

101,102. COMPARATIVE GOVERNMENT (3,3) Elsbree

A comparison of the American, European, and Oriental systems of

government, including organization, procedure, popular representation,

and the effect upon the social and economic life of the people. (Yearly.)

106. CURRENT POLITICAL AND SOCIAL PROBLEMS

(2) Collins, Elsbree, Fairfield A consideration of current problems of a political, social, and economic nature, with particular emphasis on problems in the field of government. (Yearly.)

203. MUNICIPAL GOVERNMENT AND ADMINISTRATION (3) Collins

The creation and legal powers of cities; municipal elections and political bosses; an analysis of the administrative functions and prob- lems of city government: personnel, finance, police, public utility regu- lation and ov/nership. Prereq., 6 hrs. (Yearly.)

216. INTERNATIONAL RELATIONS (3) Everett Basic factors involved in world politics, including the modem state

system, nationalism, militarism; the evolution of international relations, forces and conditions affecting international relations, and the foraiu- lation of national foreign policies. Prereq., Govt. 1 and Hist. 2; or Hist. 1 and 2. (1st sem., yearly.)

217. CURRENT INTERNATIONAL PROBLEMS (3) Elsbree

The non-historical study of international problems arising from the conflict of national foreign policies, programs for national security, efforts toward world political and economic order, and contemporary policies of the Great Powers. Prereq., 6 hrs. government or history. (Yearly.)

301,302. AMERICAN CONSTITUTIONAL LAW (2,2) Gusteson

Principles underlying American constitutional government as seen in leading cases, with special reference to interpretation of the Con- stitution of the United States. Prereq., 9 hrs. govt, or history. (Yearly.)

305. AMERICAN POLITICAL PARTIES (3) Gusteson

The origin and growth, the organization and methods of parties, the influence of economic and social conditions on party policy, the position and functions of the party system in democracies. Prereq., 9 hrs. (Yearly.)

Government 231

308. LEGISLATURES AND LEGISLATIVE PROCESSES (3) Gus+eson

Major problems of representative government with respect to legislative assemblies. Analysis of structure, organization, and proce- dures; problems of representation; relationships between the legislature, the executive, the courts, and the people. Prereq., 9 hrs. (Yearly.)

309. LAW ENFORCEMENT (3) Gus+eson Survey and analysis of the problems of the American policing,

prosecutory, judicial, and correctional systems. Emphasis on both policy making and administration. Prereq., 9 hrs. (Yearly.)

323. INTERNATIONAL LAW AND ORGANIZATION (3) Everett

Development and analysis of the principles of public law govern- ing the relations of states, emphasizing current problems and develop- ments. Analysis of the role of international organizations in the re- lations of states, maintaining international peace, developing inter- national law. Prereq., Govt. 216 or 217. (2nd sem., yearly.)

331. FAR EASTERN GOVERNMENTS AND POLITICS (3) Elsbree

A study of the governmental organization, political parties and foreign policies of China, Japan and selected countries of Southeast Asia. Political developments since 1945 -will be emphasized. Prereq., 9 hrs. (Yearly.)

341. AMERICAN FOREIGN POLICY (3) Collins

A consideration of the problems involved in the formulation and execution of foreign policy. Particular emphasis is given to the current problems of American policy. Prereq., 9 hrs. govt, or hist. (2nd sem,, yearly.)

343. AMERICAN POLITICAL THOUGHT (2) Fairfield The origin and development of political ideas in the United States,

growth of democratic principles from the colonial times to 1865, and an analysis of recent trends in American political thought. Prereq., 9 hrs. govt, or hist. (Yearly.)

344. RECENT POLITICAL THOUGHT (3) Elsbree Eecent political theories basic to political and social institutions:

individualism, collectivism, fascism, and democracy; emphasis on the European version of democracy, totalitarianism of the communist and fascist states. Prereq., 9 hrs. or 3 hrs. govt, and 6 hrs. European histoi*y. (Yearly.)

348. PUBLIC ADMINISTRATION (3) Collins The theory and practice of administrative organization, and control

of administrative action, with emphasis on financial and public personnel administration. Basic course for preparation for civil service examin- ations. Prereq., 9 hrs. (Yearly.)

349. ADMINISTRATIVE LAW (3) Collins

Organization, functions, procedures, and administrative problems of selected national regulatory agencies; principles affecting administra- tive discretion; administrative power over private rights; enforcement and judicial control of administrative action. Prereq., 9 hrs. (Yearly.)

370. STUDIES IN GOVERNMENT (1fo3) Staff

Intensive study of special topics in the field of government and political science. Areas of study include comparative government, inter- national affairs, political parties, political theory, public administration, public law. Maximum credit in course, 12 hrs. Prereq., 12 hrs., per- mission. (Each semester.)

232 Ohio University

391. SEMINAR IN GOVERNMENT {1to3) Staff

Maximum credit in course, 6 lirs. Prereq., 15 hrs.

393. PROBLEMS IN GOVERNMENT (lto3) Siaff

Research or directed reading based upon the student's special in- terest. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 15 hrs. and permission.

401. RESEARCH IN GOVERNMENT {lto3) Staff

Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 15 hrs. and permission.

495. THESIS (1to6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

GREEK See Classicai Languages

HEALTH See Physical EducaHon and Athletics

HISTORY Professors Cady (chairman), Gustavson

Associate Professors Morrison, C. H. Roberts, Stevens

Assistant Professors Mayes, Lobdell, Daniel

Instructors Thompson, Habachy

The major requirenient for the A.B. degree consists of a minimum, of 24 hours, including Hist. 1, 2, 101, 102 (unless excused as the result of taking a placement test), and at least two courses above 300 selected from more than one field of history. Hist. 1, 2 should be taken during the freshman year. Government, economics, geography, and sociology are suggested as electives, v/ith specific courses to be selected in consul- tation with the adviser.

1,2. V/ESTERN CIVILIZATION IN MODERN TIMES (3.3) Staff

Hist. 1 covers the period from 1450 to 1815 and stresses the Renais- sance, the Protestant Reformation, the agricultural and commercial revo- lutions, European expansion, the French Revolution and Napoleonic Era. Hist. 2 places emphasis on the industrial revolution, the unification of Italy and Germany, modern imperialism in Africa and Asia, the rise of Japan, the United States as a world power, World War I, the rise of totalitarian states. World War II, and efforts toward world organization. Not open to juniors and seniors. (Each semester.)

101,102. HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES (3,3) Staff

A survey course covering the political, diplomatic, social, and eco- nomic development of American history. Hist. 101 covers the period to 1865; Hist. 102, the period from 1865 to the present. (Each semester.)

105. HISTORY OF OHIO (3) Morrison

A survey from earliest times to the present: social, economic, and political. (Each semester.)

110. THE OLD SOUTH (3) Morrison A study of the plantation regime in the ante bellum South, with

emphasis on the daily life on the various types of plantations. (Each sem.ester.)

111. THE NEW SOUTH (3) Morrison Social, economic, and political life since 1865, rural conditions, in- dustrial development, labor conditions, the problem of white and black, educational progress, the solid South in politics, the South today. (Each semester.)

History 233

115. ANCIENT HISTORY (3) Cody, Mayes

A survey of the origins of Western Civilization from prehistoric man to the disintegration of the Roman Empire, embracing a general study of the early civilizations of the Fertile Crescent and the Greco- Roman world. (2nd sem., yearly.)

120, MEDIEVAL HISTORY (3) Mayes

A study of social, economic, and cultural forces of the Middle Ages with emphasis on the institutional and cultural life from the fall of Rome to the Renaissance. (2nd sem., yearly.)

125,126. ENGLISH HISTORY (3,3) Cady, Mayes

Designed for English majors and prelegal students as well as for the general student of history. The first semester covers the period to 1688 and stresses institutional aspects of medieval England and the social, political, and constitutional developments in the Tudor and Stuart periods. The second semester emphasizes cultural and economic develop- ments, the British empire, constitutional and social reforms, and the im- pact of World Wars I and II. (Yearly.)

145. LATIN AMERICAN HISTORY (3) Thompson

Emphasis will be placed on the national rather than the colonial period. (2nd sem., yearly.)

240. HISTORY OF CANADA (2) Morrison

An introduction to Canada for Americans: a study of its resources, its founding and development under France and England, and its emer- gence as an important modern state. (Each semester.)

250. THE FAR EAST (3) Cody

Geographical factors; political and cultural traditions of historic China and -Japan; attempted adjustments to the impact of the West in the nineteenth century; collapse of Manchu China; Japanese imperialism culminating in World War II; the postwar Far Eastern scene. (1st sem., yearly.)

269. TEACHING OF THE SOCIAL STUDIES IN JUNIOR

AND SENIOR HIGH SCHOOLS (2) Roberts

The nature, development, purpose, and value of the social studies, with emphasis on methods and techniques of instruction in this field. Problems of curriculum reorganization, unit planning, materials of instruction, and evaluation. Prereq., 12 hrs. social sciences. (Each semester.)

301. COLONIAL AMERICA (3) Lobdell The discovery and colonization of America, relation of the colonies

to England, and the daily life of colonial Americans. Prereq., 6 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

302. THE REVOLUTIONARY ERA (3) Daniel An intensive study of the causes of the Revolution, the struggle for

independence, the movement for a new government, and the framing of the Constitution. Prereq., 6 hrs. (2nd sem., yearly.)

310. SECTIONAL CONTROVERSY, 1820-1850 (2) Stevens

Slavery and political controversy, rise of the common man, rural conditions, transportation, immigration, education, the factory sj^stem, reform agitation, territorial annexations, growth of nationality. Prereq., 6 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

234 Ohio University

312. THE CIVIL WAR AND RECONSTRUCTION (3) Stevens

The sections of the United States in 1850, forces leading to war, the great conflict; Reconstruction, its background and development; restor- ation of home rule in the South, general cultural and economic develop- ment. Prereq., 6 hrs. (2nd sem., yearly.)

316. HISTORY OF THE INDUSTRIAL REVOLUTION IN THE

UNITED STATES, 1850-1941 (3) Daniel

Origins of the factory system in America, the impact of the Civil War, rise of heavy industry, problems of financing and control, influence of the progressive era, resurgence of big business during wartime and the twenties, industrial problems of the depression period. Prereq., 6 hrs., including 102. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

321. THE UNITED STATES IN RECENT TIMES, 1898-1928 (3) Lobdell

American imperialism, the Progressive Era, World War I, retreat from world responsibility, and the post-war prosperity period. Prereq., 6 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

322. THE UNITED STATES IN RECENT TIMES, SINCE 1928 (3) Lobdell The great depression, the New Deal, abandonment of isolation,

World War II, post-war crises and problems. Prereq., 6 hrs. (2nd sem., yearly.)

324. HISTORY OF AMERICAN DIPLOMACY (3) Thompson A survey of the development of the foreign policy of the United

States, emphasizing relations with Latin America, the Far East, and Europe to World War II. Prereq., 6 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

325. THE WESTWARD MOVEMENT (3) Daniel, Stevens

Expansion from the Atlantic to the Pacific. Explorations, Indian trade, land policies, pioneer life, territorial acquistions and state mak- ing, trails and railroads to the Far West, rise of cowboy land, types of later frontiers, and influence of the West upon American ideals and in- stitutions. Prereq., 6 hrs. (2nd sem., yearly.)

331. SOCIAL HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES (3) Daniel The story of immigration, race, the family, class structure, religion,

leisure and "the American way of life"; problems of disease, poverty, crime, and urbanization. Prereq., 6 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

332. CULTURAL HISTORY OF THE UNITED STATES (3) Daniel The development of American art, architecture, music, forms of

literary expression, science, and educational means for the dissemination of culture. Prereq., 6 hrs. (2nd sem., yearly.)

352. INDIA AND SOUTHEAST ASIA IN MODERN TIMES (3) Cady

Historic civilizations of India and Southeast Asia; the impact of Western colonial rule on the peoples of the area; readjustment following the gradual liquidation of colonial empires. Prereq., 6 hrs. (2nd sem., yearly.)

361. THE RENAISSANCE AND THE REFORMATION (3) Mayes

A study of Europe in transition from the 14th to the 16th cen- turies, with special emphasis on Italy. The course will examine the rise of the national states, the commercial revolution, humanism, art and architecture, the later medieval church, the rise of Protestantism, and the Catholic Reformation. Prereq., 6 hrs. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

History 235

363. TUDOR AND STUART ENGLAND (3) Mayes

England in the 16th and 17th centuries: a study of Tudor absolu- tism, the English Reformation, the constitutional crisis (parliament versus the Crown) of the Stuart period, the republican experiment un- der Cromwell, the beginnings of empire, and the major cultural and economic developments. Prereq., 6 hrs. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

365. FRENCH REVOLUTION (3) Gostavson

An intensive study of such historical factors as causation, influence of ideology, institutional organization, and the role of the individual in a gi-eat social upheaval. Px-ereq., 9 hrs. (2nd sem., yearly.)

370. EUROPE BETWEEN WORLD WARS (3) Gustavson

Fascism, communism, and the twenty-year armistice between 1919 and 1939. Prereq., 6 hrs. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

372. CONTEMPORARY EUROPE (3) Gusfavson

Problems of peace and war in Europe since 1939. Prereq., 6 hrs. (2nd sem., yearly.)

375. HISTORY OF RUSSIA (3) Gustavson

A survey from the earliest times to the present. The Russian back- ground of communist ideas, organization, and practices is stressed. Pre- req., 6 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

378. THE HISTORY OF MODERN GERMANY (3) Gustavson

A survey of Germany and central Europe since the Age of Napoleon. Prereq., 6 hrs. (2nd sem., yearly.)

385. IMPERIALISM AND WORLD POLITICS (3) Cody

Types of imperialism; empire building during the nineteenth and twentieth centuries by Russia, Japan, United States, Great Britain, France, Germany, and Italy. Prereq., 6 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

390. REPRESENTATIVE HISTORIANS AND THEIR WRITINGS

(2 or 3 as scheduled) Staff

Typical historians from the time of Herodotus and readings from

their masterpieces to illustrate schools of interpretation, philosophies of

history and the development of historical writing. Prereq., 12 hrs. (2nd

sem., 1959-60.)

392. PROBLEMS IN HISTORY (lto3) Sfaff

Intensive individual work either in research or in systematic reading along the lines of the student's special interest under the supervision of a member of the staff. Prereq., 15 hrs. and permission. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. (Each semester.)

395. HISTORIOGRAPHY AND METHODOLOGY (3) Staff

An introduction to the technique of historical investigation with practice in historical criticism and writing. Prereq., 15 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

398. SEMINAR IN HISTORY (1to3) Staff

Reports based upon original research with gi'oup discussion and criticism. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 15 hrs, and per- mission. (2nd sem., yearly.)

495. THESIS (l+o6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

236 Ohio University

HOME ECONOMICS Professor V. M. Roberts (director)

Associate Professor, Bane

Assistant Professors Macauley, Davis, Lewis,

Nehls, Cowan, Sellers

Instructors Makroczy, Lowe, Price, Rogers

Part-Time Instructor Murray

The School of Home Economics offers work in the following fields: (i) Child Development and Family Life, (2) Foods and Nutrition, (3) Home Economics Education, (4) Housing and Home Management, (5) Institution Administration and (6) Textiles and Clothing.

Basic courses in each area of home economics are set up with em- phasis directed toward home and family living. Students who are major- ing in other departments, but desire training directed toward home and family living may elect any of the basic courses (see "Core Courses," page 91).

Students majoring in home economics take the basic courses in home economics and courses in general education during the first two years and follow a professional curriculum during the junior and senior years. Requirements for a Bachelor of Science in Home Economics degree are indicated on page 91.

HOME ECONOMICS

51. ORIENTATION IN HOME ECONOMICS

(2) Roberts assisted by specialists in each field

The value of home economics for home and family life; the oppor- tunities for careers in the various fields of home economics. Vocational testing, g:uidance, and counseling.

161. HOME NURSING AND FAMILY HEALTH (2) Murray

Training in simple procedures in the care of the sick and minor accidents in the home. A study of disease prevention and health pro- motion for the family.

360. WORKSHOPS IN HOME ECONOMICS (1-2) Staff

Special workshops to aid the home economics teacher will be sche- duled during summer sessions. Maximum credit toward graduate degree 6 hours. Prereq., 268 or equivalent, teaching experience or quali- fied for certification to teach Home Economics. The areas of study in- clude :

a. Home Economics Education

b. Clothing and Textiles

c. Foods and Nutrition

d. Child Development and Family Life

e. Consumer Education

f. Home Furnishings

g. Home Management

h. Household Equipment

i. School Lunch Management

381. RESEARCH IN HOME ECONOMICS {lfo3) Staff

A project course in which the student carries on independent in- vestigations or problems under the guidance of the instructor. Maxi- mum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 20 hrs. and permission.

Home Economics 237

390a, b, c. d. e. FIELD WORK IN HOME ECONOMICS (2 to 4) Staff

(a) Home Economics Extension

(b) Home Service Work With Public Utilities

(c) Institution Management

(d) Retail Merchandising

(e) Radio-TV

Through cooperation with business organizations, department stores, radio-TV stations, and the Home Economics Extension Depart- ment opportunities are given for on-the-job training and practical ex- perience. The faculty adviser serves as coordinator of the work establish- ed with these outside agencies. Prereq., 18 hrs., permission, and senior rank.

391. SEMINAR IN HOME ECONOMICS (1 or2) Sioff

Prereq., 18 hrs., and permission.

495. THESIS (1to6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

CHILD DEVELOPMENT AND FAMILY LIFE

5.6. CHILD DEVELOPMENT AND FAMILY LIVING (3,3) Nehls. Price

H. Ec. 5 deals with the physical, emotional, social, and intellectual development of the child from conception through adolesence. The home environment, the care, and the guidance which foster the total develop- ment of the child will be stressed.

H. Ec. 6 stresses the problems confronting young people in estab- lishing a family. Attention is given to the reinforcement the family may secure through interactions with the church, the school, and the com- munity. Not open to those who have had H. R. 301 or Soc. 260.

172. ADVANCED CHILD DEVELOPMENT (2) Nehls

Emphasis on the development of the preschool child as approached through the cooperation of the parents, the teachers, and the children in the Nursery School. 1 lee. 3 hrs. participation in Nurseiy School. Prereq., 5, or 6 hrs. psychology.

375a, b. READINGS IN CHILD DEVELOPMENT AND FAMILY LIVING

(2 or 3) Nehls, Price

a. Child Development

b. Family Living

An intensive study through library research of a phase of child development or a problem in family living. Weekly conferences. Maxi- mum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 6 and 172, or 9 hrs. psychology and/or sociology, permission.

377. TECHNIQUES WITH YOUNG CHILDREN (3) Nehls. Price Techniques of guidance of nursery school children, with emphasis

on emotional and social development of the child and the effect of family attitudes on behavior. 2 lee, and 3 hrs. at Nursery School. Prereq., 6 and 172.

378. ADMINISTRATION OF GROUP CARE OF YOUNG CHILDREN

(Not offered in 1959-60) (3) Price The organization and administration of Nursery School. Prereq., 6 and 172,

238 Ohio University

379a, b. GUIDANCE OF NURSERY SCHOOL CHILDREN

(2 to 6) Nehls, Price

(a) Teaching and Guidance in the Nursery School. (4 hrs.)

(b) Techniques in Child Feeding. (2 hrs.)

Teaching and guidance in the Nursery School with participation in all phases of the Nursery School program. Prereq., 377 or 6 hrs. psy- chology and permission, or Education 272.

477a, b. SPECIAL STUDIES IN FAMILY RELATIONSHIPS OR CHILD

DEVELOPMENT (2 to 6) Nehls

(a) Family Eelationships. (2 or 3 hrs.)

(b) Child Development. (2 or 3 hrs.)

An intensive study of a problem in family relationships or child de- velopment. Prereq., 6 and 172 or 12 hrs. psychology, sociology and/or human relations.

FOODS AND NUTRITION

1-2. FOODS, NUTRITION AND MEAL PLANNING (3-3) Lewis, Lowe

Selection, storage, preparation, and serving of food. Nutrition and all aspects of food management in the home are considered. 1 lee, 1 discussion, 4 lab.

125. FAMILY NUTRITION (3) Lowe

The relation of nutrition to growth, development, and maintenance of health in all age groups. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 2.

320. CREATIVE COOKERY AND MEAL MANAGEMENT

(Summer sessions only) (2 to 4) Roberts

An advanced course emphasizing the creative, scientific, and artistic phases of food preparation and meal management. Prereq., 9 hrs. foods and nutrition and permission.

322. EXPERIMENTAL COOKERY (Not offered In 1959-60) (3) Lewis Group and individual experiments on selected problems of food prep- aration. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 2 and Chem. 113.

323. FOOD PRESERVATION (Not offered in 1958-59) (2) Lewis

Methods of home food preservation and factors affecting palatability and retention of nutrients in processed food. 1 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 2.

326. ADVANCED NUTRITION (3) Lowe, Roberts

Principles of nutrition as applied to the feeding of individuals and families under varying conditions. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 125, Chem. 113 and Zool. 235.

328. RECENT DEVELOPMENTS IN FOODS AND NUTRITION

(Summer sessions only) (3) Roberts

Reports, discussions, and reviews of scientific literature. Some lab- oratory projects may be included. Prereq., 2, and 125 or equivalent.

329. NUTRITION IN DISEASE (2) Macauley, Lowe Application of principles of nutrition to the feeding of individuals

and the use of diet in prevention and treatment of disease. Problems in planning and preparing therapeutic diets. 1 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., 125, 326.

340. PROBLEMS IN FOODS AND NUTRITION (2 or 3) Macauley, Lewis, Lowe A comprehensive study of nutrition, experimental foods, food or nutrition analysis, or institution management. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 9 hrs. foods and nutrition and permission.

Home Economics 239

433. SPECIAL PROBLEMS IN CHEMISTRY OF FOODS AND NUTRITION

(2 or 3) Lewis An intensive study of a phase of food chemistry or nutrition. Max- imum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 326.

HOME ECONOMICS EDUCATION

155. HOME ECONOMICS FOR THE ELEMENTARY SCHOOL (2) Sellers

Problems related to home economics at the elementary level. Em- phasis on the development of good food habits and nutritional status of children. Three hours each week for class discussion, and laboratory work.

268. TEACHING OF HOME ECONOMICS (3) Sellers Organization, methods, classroom procedures, evaluation, and teach- ing aids in family life education for secondary schools. Prereq., concur- rently with Ed, 281, permission.

269. TEACHING OF FOODS AND NUTRITION (3) Lewis, Lowe Organization of materials and methods of presenting principles of

food preparation and nutrition. For majors in foods and nutrition. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 2, 125.

350. PROBLEMS IN THE TEACHING OF HOME ECONOMICS

{1 to 3) Sellers Opportunity for individual selection of problems. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 18 hrs. and 268.

367. VOCATIONAL HOME ECONOMICS (Summer sessions only) (3) Sellers History and philosophy of vocational homemaking education. Con- temporary trends, methods, sources of materials, and evaluation. Ob- servations arranged. Prereq., 268 or teaching experience in home economics.

368. DEMONSTRATION TECHNIQUES (2) Lewis Practical experience in the demonstration of foods, equipment or

clothing. Planned for those going into secondary education or consum- er service positions. 4 lab. Prereq., 12 hrs.

369. HOME ECONOMICS IN ADULT EDUCATION (3) Sellers Organization procedures, curriculum materials, and methods of con- ducting adult education groups in the field of education for family living. Prereq., 18 hrs. home economics.

450. SPECIAL PROBLEMS IN THE TEACHING OF HOME ECONOMICS

(2 or 3) Sellers Intensive study of some phase of home economics education. Max- imum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., teaching experience in home ec- onomics.

HOUSING AND HOME MANAGEMENT

7. THE HOME AND ITS FURNISHINGS (2) Mokrociy

A practical and aesthetic study in house furnishings including basic art qualities, styles of houses and interiors; analysis of modem floor plans; selection and arrangement of furniture and accessories. 1 lee. and 2 lab.

108. CONSUMER PROBLEMS OF THE FAMILY (2) Rogers

Education of the household buyer by practical application of market devices as aids to the consumer buyer; retailing activities as they affect the role of the consumer. 1 lee. and 2 lab.

240 Ohio University

330. WORKSHOP IN HOME FURNISHINGS (3) Makroczy Laboratory problems in advanced techniques in home furnishings,

including upholstering, slip-covering, refinishing furniture, and making draperies. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 7 and 4; for non-majors, 7 and 4 hrs. art and permission.

331. ECONOMICS OF FURNISHINGS (Offered as needed) (2) Cowan A study of the production, distribution, and qualities of furnish- ings. Problems on china, glass, silver, furniture, bedding, rugs, etc. Prereq., 330; for non-majors, 6 hrs. economics.

334. HOUSEHOLD EQUIPMENT (3) Macauley

Household operating and equipment problems. A critical analysis of the use of equipment to establish standards for effective use. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 2 and 108.

351. HOME MANAGEMENT (2) Rogers

Econcrnic use of time, energy, and money in the successful function- ing of the home from the viewpoint of the satisfaction of members of the family. Prereq., 2 and 108, or 6 hrs. sociology.

353. HOME MANAGEMENT LABORATORY (3) Rogers

Residence in the home management house for one-half semester provides experience in the use of human and material resources of the family for the optimum development of its members. A charge is made to cover room and board. Prereq., 351 or with 351, and permission.

353. PROBLEMS IN FAMILY ECONOMICS (1 to 3) Makroczy

Individual investigation of family income, expenditures, and stand- ards of living. Minimum standards of living are emphasized; planned for majors in social work. Prereq., 351 or 6 hrs. sociology and permis- sion.

452. SPECIAL PROBLEMS IN HOUSEHOLD EQUIPMENT AND

HOME MANAGEMENT (2 or 3) Macauley, Makroczy

An intensive study of the efficient management of time, energy, or money in the home. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 351, 353 and 334.

INSTITUTION ADMINISTRATION

327. QUANTITY COOKERY (3) Macauley

Preparation and serving of foods in large quantities. Use of modem equipment. Laboratory practice in the cafeteria and residence halls of Ohio University. Prereq., 2.

342. INSTITUTION MARKETING AND FOOD COST CONTROL (2) Macauley

Studies in production, distribution and storage of food supplies to serve as a basis for the purchase of such commodities for quantity use. Record keeping involved in food service. 1 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., 327.

343. INSTITUTION EQUIPMENT AND FURNISHINGS (2) Macauley Kitchen planning and selection of equipment including materials,

construction, installation, operation, care, and relative cost; floor plans and specifications. 1 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., 327.

348. INSTITUTION MANAGEMENT (3) Macauley

Principles of organization and administration which apply to food units in school lunch rooms, and public and private institutions. Ad- ministration of labor; standards of work; cost control. Prereq., 327 and Aect. 75,

Home Economics 241

TEXTILES AND CLOTHING

3-4. CLOTHING SELECTION AND CONSTRUCTION

(2-2) Bane, Cowan Makroczy

A basic course in clothing construction with discussions on color.

line, personal attractiveness, fashion, and wardrobe planning. 1 lee. and

3 lab.

110. TEXTILES (2) Cowan

A basic textile course involving the study of textile fibers and the construction, processing, use and care of fabrics. 1 lee. and 3 lab.

212-213. FLAT PATTERN DESIGN (2-2) Bane

Dress pattern making on advanced fitting problems and the execu- tion of original designs. 1 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., 4 and 110 or Art 137 and permission.

300. NEW DEVELOPMENTS IN TEXTILES (Summer sessions only) (2) Cowan New developments in textile fibers with special emphasis on new

fibers, their characteristics, uses and care. Prereq., 9 hrs. clothing and textiles.

301. TECHNIQUES IN TEACHING CLOTHING CONSTRUCTION (Summer sessions only) (1) Bane

Special problems in sizing, alteration, fitting and consti-uction as applied to teaching the high school student. Prereq., 316 or equivalent, teaching experience or certification to teach home economics.

302. TECHNIQUES IN TEACHING CLOTHING SELECTION

(Summer sessions only) (1) Bane

Methods of presenting clothing selection on the high school level with

emphasis on psychological and economic aspects of clothing. Consumer

and market trends to be included. Prereq., 316 or equivalent, teaching

experience or certification to teach home economics.

310. TECHNIQUES IN CLOTHING DESIGN (Summer sessions only) (2) Bane An advanced course in clothing that offers opportunity for creative expression and for an understanding of patterns through the medium of flat pattern design. 1 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., 4 and 110.

313. CLOTHING AND TEXTILES FOR THE CONSUMER

(Not offered in 1958-59) (2) Cowan

Problems presented to the buyer and the consumer in purchasing textile products such as lingerie, home-furnishing fabrics, ready-to-wear, and accessories. Prereq., 9 hrs. clothing and textiles, Ec. 11 or 101.

315. HISTORY OF COSTUME AND TEXTILES

(Not offered in 1959-60) (2) Cowan

Study of costume and textiles through the ages as a basis for the understanding and appreciation of present-day costumes. Prereq., 4 and 110.

316. TAILORING (3) Bane Tailoring of suits or coats. Emphasis placed on professional tech- niques, advanced fitting problems, and construction of high fashion gar- ments. 6 lab. and demonstration. Prereq., 4 and 110.

318. ADVANCED TEXTILES (3) Cowan

Physical and chemical examination of fibers and fabrics. Problems

in the comparison and evaluation of fabrics. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq.,

4 and 110, Chem. 2.

242 Ohio University

319a. b. SPECIAL STUDIES IN TEXTILES OR CLOTHING (3 to 6) Bane, Cowan Intensive study of one of more problems related to textiles or cloth- ing. Maximum credit in each area, 6 hrs.; total in course, 12 hrs. Prereq., 12 hrs. clothing and textiles and permission.

(a) Clothing. (3 hrs.)

(b) Textiles. (3 hrs.)

HUMAN RELATIONS Professors A. C. Anderson, Patrick

Associate Professor B. R. Black (chairnnan) Instructors E. I. Anderson, J. Dickinson

Courses in the department are designed to contribute to the general education of students in any field. Majors in any area who plan to pre- pare for personnel work in business and industry, social work and ad- ministration, government agencies, or education are invited to confer with members of the staff about selection of courses in this and related departments.

291-292. PRACTICUM IN STUDENT PERSONNEL

(3-3) E. I. Anderson, Dickinson A survey of the problems of orientation of freshmen to college. Supervised experience including observation, discussion, and practice in personnel and guidance. 1 lee. and a minimum of 4 lab. Prereq., per- mission. (Yearly)

301. MARRIAGE (3) Patrick and Associates Eggers, McQuate, Organ

Schmidt, Rowles A clinical approach to the problems of dating, courtship, marriage, parenthood, and childhood adjustments in the light of scientific and philosophical thinking of today. Prereq., for undergraduate credit, jun- ior or senior rank; for graduate credit, 12 hrs. social sciences, or 6 hrs. social sciences and 6 hrs. biology. (2nd sem., yearly.)

303-304. HUMAN RELATIONS (3-3) A. C. Anderson, Black

A course taught by the case method, designed for students interested in studying the habits and skills of analysis, judgment, and action im- portant to people in all walks of life. Prereq., junior, senior, or graduate rank. (303, each semester; 304, 2nd sem., yearly.)

325. FIELD WORK OR RESEARCH (1 to 3) StaH

An opportunity for individual work in a specialized area of human relations; field work in human relations; or supervised work for a speci- fied time in the offices of admissions, registrar, O. U. Center, housing, and University College; or research under the direction of the staff. Maximum credit in course, 5 hrs. Prereq., 303 and permission. (Each semester.)

491. SEMINAR IN HUMAN RELATIONS (3) StaH

Prereq., 303 or 304, and permission. (1st sem., yearly.)

493, 494. SEMINAR IN STUDENT PERSONNEL ADMINISTRATION

(3, 3) Black

Designed for those specializing in student personnel work. Empha- sis on philosophy and current trends in student personnel work and ad- ministrative procedures for effective coordination of services within a student personnel program. Prereq., 18 hrs. social sciences and permis- sion. (Yearly.)

495. THESIS (1 to 6) StaH

Prereq., permission.

Industrial Arts 243

HUMANITIES— See General Studies

INDUSTRIAL ARTS Associate Professors Kinison, Paige,

Perry (chairman)

Assistant Professor Calvin

Instructors Adams, Armbruster, Shull, Squibb, Weber

The requirements for an industrial arts major in the program lead- ing to a Bachelor of Science in Education are outlined on page 134. The program outline for the Bachelor of Science in Industrial Technology is described on page 95.

1. GENERAL WOODWORKING I (3) Adams, Paige

A study of the uses of common hard and soft woods hand tools, and machinery, joints and other methods of wood fabrication, glues, finishes, and the planning of projects. 1 lee. and 4 lab.

2. GENERAL WOODWORKING II (3) Paige

A study of the operation of common woodworking machinery, cab- inet consti-uction, decorative processes, veneering and house framing. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 1.

5. DRIVER EDUCATION (1) Weber

A beginning course in driving. Laboratory practice in dual-control car. Study includes the car and current problems of traffic. Credit not counted toward degree. 1 lee. and 1 lab. Fee, $15.

6. WOOD TURNING (2) Paige

A laboratory course in the designing and making of objects on the wood turning lathe. It includes spindle, faceplate, chuck, mandrel turn- ing, and methods of finishing on the wood lathe. 4 lab.

8. ORIENTATION IN INDUSTRIAL ARTS (2) Staff

A course of brief experiences with materials, tools and processes, planning and finishing. Designed to help the student consider teaching industrial arts as a profession. 4 lab.

9. CRAFT AND HOBBY WORK (2) Perry

A laboi'atory course in which any student of the University may learn to work with wood, metal, leather, reed, plastics, textiles or other available materials. 4 lab.

11. DUPLICATING (3) Weber

Study and practice in the areas of block printing, etching, litho- graphy, photography, silk screening, and use of the mimeograph and spirit duplicator. 1 lee. 4 lab.

13. GENERAL COLD METALS (3) Adams, Calvin A study of the materials and the fundamental operations involving

hand and machine work in sheet metal, bench metal and machine shop. 1 lee. and 4 lab.

14. GENERAL HOT METALS (3) Ambruster, Squibb This course includes the basic operations in forge, foundry, and

welding practice. Related infonnation, both technical and general, is in- cluded as part of each phase of laboratory work. 1 lee. and 4 lab.

244 Ohio University

19. AUTOMOTIVE THEORY AND REPAIR (3) Shull

A study of the automobile with emphasis on servicing and overhaul- ing the engine and chassis. 1 lee. and 4 lab.

51. FARM SHOP (3) Shull

A study of woodworking, concrete working and electricity as applied to building and repair work on the farm. 1 lee. and 4 lab.

102. PRACTICAL CARPENTRY (3) Paige

The fundamental processes of carpentry which are involved in house construction, including staking out, concrete forms, framing, flooring, sheathing, insulating, interior finishing, framing of windows and the framing and hanging of doors. Prereq., 1. 6 lab.

104. FURNITURE UPHOLSTERY (2) Paige A study of the tools, equipment, and materials used in the con- struction and repair of spring seats, padded seats, and overstuffed fur- niture. Practice will include both old and new construction. 4 lab.

105. MATERIALS AND FINISHES (3) Paige A study of the different materials and finishes that are generally

used in the industrial arts laboratories: their sources, manufacture, and application.

106. ADVANCED WORK IN CRAFTS (2) Perry Emphasis will be placed upon skill development in some craft area

chosen by the student in consultation with the instructor. Evidence of original design and specialized skill development, as applied to the cho- sen materials, is a requirement for this course. 4 lab. Prereq., 9 or permission.

107. SHEET METAL (2) Adams The laboratory work consists of laying out, cutting, forming, join- ing, decorating and finishing sheet metals. Proper use and maintenance of hand tools and machine tools are emphasized. 4 lab. Prereq., 13 or

permission.

109. CABINETMAKING (3) Paige

The design and construction of various kinds of cabinets. Includes individually-designed projects and production methods. 6 lab. Prereq., 2.

115. INDUSTRIAL ARTS FOR THE ELEMENTARY SCHOOL (1 to 2) Perry The operation and use of common hand tools to form wood, metal

and other materials. Planning and construction of articles commonly associated with elementary school classroom work. 1 lee. and 1 lab. Prereq., elementary teaching majors only.

116. CONSTRUCTIVE DESIGN (2) Paige A study of the principles of design and their application to indus- trial arts projects, and of the identification of the periods of furniture design. 4 lab.

117. SHOP AND MACHINE MAINTENANCE (2 to 4) Shuli Practice in common jobs necessary to maintain tools and machines

in industrial arts school laboratories. This includes sharpening and ad- justment of both hand and power tools, electric motor hook-up and re- pair. 4 to 8 lab. Prereq., permission.

Industrial Arts 245

121. PAHERN MAKING (1) Adams

A laboratory course which includes a study of tools, machinery, pat- tern, layout, joinery, and special types of construction of wood patterns. 2 lab.

124. MACHINE SHOP (2) Calvin

The shaping of metal by the use of the engine lathe, the shaper, the milling machine, and including the care and upkeep of these macliines. 4 lab. Prereq., 13 or permission.

128. ADVANCED METAL WORK (3) Calvin

Continuation of technical operations on metalworking machinery, theory of inspection, product control, gauging and measuring devices. Laboratory work includes operations in both cold and hot metal areas. 6 lab. Prereq., permission.

129. V/ELDING (2) Squibb Application of principles and techniques of oxy-acetylene and arc fu- sion welding of ferrous and nonferrous metals; brazing; selection, care and use of equipment and supplies; welding metallurgy. 4 lab. Prereq., 14 or permission.

131. INTRODUCTION TO CERAMICS (2) Armbruster

A study of the processes of forming pottery, tile and brick; of con- crete work, including the building of forms, and the use of other stone setting materials. 1 lee. and 3 lab. Prereq., 2 or permission.

133. PRACTICAL ELECTRICITY (3) Perry A study of sources, principles, and measurements of electricity.

Planning and construction of devices to illustrate electrical effects. 1 lee. and 4 lab.

134. PRACTICAL POWER AND TRANSPORTATION (3) Shull Experimentation, project construction and study of air, steam, water,

electricity and internal combustion of gases as sources of power, and their effects on industry and transportation. 1 lee. and 4 lab.

141. PRINTING (3) Kinison This course consists of learning the case, composition of straight

matter, pulling and correcting proofs, imposition, distribution, and plat- en presswork. 1 lee. and 4 lab.

142. PRINTING (3) Kinison The course deals with papers and paper making, ink, care of sup- plies, designing and setting display composition, the making of stereo- type mats and castings, and platen presswork. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Pre- req., 141.

144. PHOTOLITHOGRAPHY (3) Kinison

Practice in the making of off-set plates of several kinds and opera- tion of the off-set press. Plate making involves the use of copying cam- ei'a and the whirl er. 6 lab.

147. ADVANCED PRINTING (3) Kinison

Deals with the problems that are encountered in a commercial printing shop. 6 lab. Prereq., 142.

246 Ohio University

199. ADMINISTRATION OF DRIVER EDUCATION (2 or 3) Weber

For prospective driving teachers. Certification by the American Automobile Association upon completion. Certification for teaching in the high schools of Ohio depends upon certification in at least one other high school subject. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., Psych., Psych. 5 or permis- sion.

201. ADVANCED PRINCIPLES OF DRIVER EDUCATION (3) Perry

A course designed to aid teachers in extending their professional development through group study and planning in the area of driver education. Class activity will be guided by problems found in present programs. Emphasis will be upon improvement of time utilization and student motivation. Prereq., 199 or permission.

203. INDUSTRIAL ELECTRONICS (3) Armbroster

Fundamental theory and practice in the use and care of electronic apparatus commonly employed for communication and production con- trol in industry. 1 lee. 4 lab. Prereq., 133.

260. TEACHING OF INDUSTRIAL ARTS (3) Calvin

A study of the techniques used in teaching industrial arts. Em- phasis on organizing and planning, courses of study, methods of pre- senting technical and related information, evaluating student progress and shop management. Prereq., 12 hrs.

299. PROBLEMS IN SAFETY EDUCATION (2) V/eber

A study of current practices in the field of safety education. Special emphasis may be given to applications in the fields of transportation, manufacturing, and driver education.

302. DEVELOPMENT OF TEACHING AIDS FOR INDUSTRIAL EDUCATION

(2) V/eber Emphasis is on analysis of teaching situations to determine which can be enhanced through the use of teaching aids. Laboratory activity consists of development and construction of instructional aids designed for specific purposes. A term paper is required for graduate credit. 4 lab. Prereq., teaching experience or concurrently with practice teach- ing.

309. ADMINISTRATION OF THE GENERAL SHOP (3) Paige

Supervision and administration as related to the general shop. Types of organization, laboratory planning, equipment selection, tool storage, and accounting systems are topics studied. Prereq., 12 hrs.

326. HISTORY OF INDUSTRIAL AND VOCATIONAL ARTS (3) Calvin

A study of the history of industrial arts from its earliest beginnings down to the present, including the Smith-Hughes Law and the George- Deen Act and their administration in Ohio.

328. SPECIAL PROBLEMS IN INDUSTRIAL ARTS (1 fo 3) Staff

A research course where individual problems are selected for inves- tigation, solution, and reporting. Maximum credit in course, 3 hrs. Prereq., senior rank.

399. WORKSHOP IN DRIVER EDUCATION (Summer sessions only) (1) Perry A course designed for teachers of driver education. Class activity will be guided by problems found in present programs. Emphasis will be placed on improvement of time utilization and student motivation. Prereq., certification in driver education.

Journalism 247

450a, b, c, d. ADVANCED WORK IN WOOD, METAL,

PRINTING OR POWER (2) S+aH

Advanced laboratory work in the wood, metal, printing or power areas along with a study of the industrial practices in the field selected. The course may be repeated in different areas for a maximum credit of 6 hrs. 4 lab. Prereq., (a) Wood, 1, 2; (b) Metal, 13, 14; (c) Printing, 11, 141; (d) Power, 133, 134.

457. CURRICULUM BUILDING IN INDUSTRIAL ARTS (3) Staff

A study of the building of a complete industrial arts curriculum and of the construction of the several courses that make up the curriculum. Prereq., 16 hrs.

471. ADMINISTRATION AND SUPERVISION OF INDUSTRIAL EDUCATION

(3) StaH This course is a study of the philosophy of industrial education, of the Federal laws pertaining to vocational education and of the problems and practices of administration and supervision of vocational and non- vocational industrial education in the public schools. Prereq., permis- sion.

481. RESEARCH IN INDUSTRIAL ARTS (1 to 3) Staff

Students are directed in the investigation of selected phases of the theory and practice of industrial education. A written report of this in- vestigation is to be presented by each student to the departmental grad- uate committee. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., Ed. 488.

491. SEMINAR IN INDUSTRIAL ARTS EDUCATION (1 to 3) Staff

Reports on recent books and magazine articles, and reports based upon original research will be given and followed by group discussion and criticism. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 15 hrs.

495. THESIS |1 to 6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

ITALIAN See Romance Languages

JOURNALISM Professor Hortin (director)

Associate Professors Turnbull, Baird, Humphreys

Assistant Professor Baxter

Instructors Nichols, Reamer, Gilbert

1. ORIENTATION IN JOURNALISM (2) Hortin. StaH

Analysis of the forms and purposes of journalistic communciations reporting, editing, management, advertising, radio and television, news, public relations, free lance and feature writing, photo- journalism; opportunities for careers in the various sequences; guidance and coun- seling; survey of facilities.

105. HISTORY OF AMERICAN JOURNALISM (3) Baird

A study of the development of newspaper, magazine, and radio journalism from the colonial period to the present, including political, ec- onomic, and mechanical aspects. Prereq., Eng. 4.

248 Ohio University

107. NEWSPAPER REPORTING (3) Baird, Baxter

Instruction in methods of gathering material and writing news re- ports, interviews, reports of speeches, follow-ups and re-writes, human interest stories, and specialized news. Practice work covering assign- ments and preparing copy. Prereq., Eng. 4, and Sec. St. 15 or the ability to operate a typewriter efficiently.

ni. REPORTING PRACTICE {1 to 6) Reamer

Students are assigned to general reporting on The Athens Mes- senger, which includes the covering of definite news beats as well as special assignments. Prereq., 107 and permission.

140. THE COMMUNITY NEWSPAPER (2) Staff

The course stresses editorial and business phases of weeklies and small dailies. Problems include editing, editorial writing, and rural correspondence; school, church, and business life; circulation, advertis- ing, job printing, and mechanical equipment. Prereq., Eng. 4.

146. TYPOGRAPHY. MECHANICS, AND MAKEUP (3) Baird, Turnbull

Make-up in type of newspaper pages, following introduction to hand composition. Study of principles of good make-up of ads and news, in- cluding correct choice of type. Mechanics of printing reproduction studied.

217. NEWSPAPER AND MAGAZINE EDITING (3) Humphreys

Principles and practices of copyreading, headline writing, illustra- tion, and make-up for newspapers, tabloids, and magazines. Other phases: picture editing, desk problems, wire and syndicate material. Prereq., 107.

221. EDITING PRACTICE (1 to 6) Gilbert

Students are assigned to copyreading on The Athens Messenger, handling local, correspondence, and wire copy, and working out make-up problems. Prereq., 217 or permission.

230. REVIEWING AND CRITICISM (2) Humphreys

A study and analysis of books, art, drama, music, photography, ra- dio, television, and other public presentations. Students write reviews and criticisms after studying outstanding examples in recognized publi- cations. Prereq., 107, Eng. 4.

247. NEWSPAPER ADVERTISING AND LAYOUT (3) Nichols, Turnbull

A study of the operation of the advertising department from the viewpoint of the advertising manager. Prereq., Advt. 155.

251. CONTEMPORARY THOUGHT AND DEVELOPMENTS (3) Humphreys

Contributions in all phases of modern society are discussed by uni- versity faculty members and other authorities. Students are required to do reference reading and to write news reports of the discussions. Prereq., 107 junior or senior rank.

277. NEWSPAPER ADVERTISING PRACTICE |1 to 6) Nichols

Laboratory work in preparing copy for local display advertisers of The Athens Messenger. Other practice problems in the fields of classi- fied, national, and promotion advertising. Prereq., 247.

280. RADIO-TV NEWS WRITING AND EDITING (2) Baxter The study and practice of writing and editing news for broadcast- ing. Students will prepare radio news from local sources and press services. Prereq., 107, Radio 79.

Journalism 249

285. RADIO-TV NEWS PRACTICE (2 or 3) Baxter

A laboratory course in the production of regular newscasts covering both preparation of copy and the actual broadcasts of the script over WOUB and WOUI, AM and FM. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 280.

303. TELEVISION NEWS PRODUCTION (3) Baxter

The preparation and production of television news. Experiments in visual presentation of news and discussion of the organization and policies of the television newsroom. Prereq., 280, Photog. 133, and permission.

306. NEWSPAPER AND COMMUNICATIONS LAW (2) Hortin Principles and case studies of the law of the press with emphasis

on constitutional guarantees, libel, contempt, privacy, copyright, privil- ege, and administrative controls. Some consideration of regulations pertaining to radio and television. Prereq., 217 and senior rank.

307. REPORTING OF PUBLIC AFFAIRS (2) Balrd, Hortin Includes a study of governmental, civic, and business organizations:

courts, legal procedure, city and county government, state and national organizations, banks, political parties, and community activities. Pre- req., Ill, or permission, and senior rank in journalism.

309. RADIO-TV ADVERTISING AND MANAGEMENT (3) Turnbuil

A study of the business principles and practices in the broadcast- ing industry, dealing with problems in radio and TV station operation, with major emphasis on time sales. Prereq., Advt. 155 or permission.

322. FEATURE AND MAGAZINE WRITING (3) Baird. Hortin A study of newspaper, magazine, and pictorial features, followed by

practice in writing and marketing of various types. The course in- cludes finding subjects, securing photographs, writing articles and sur- veying markets. Prereq., 107, or 12 hrs. of English, or permission.

323. ADVANCED FEATURE AND MAGAZINE WRITING (2) Baird, Horttn Students are permitted wide range in selecting feature subjects.

High grade writing is stressed with definite idea of publication. Prereq., 322.

325. THE EDITORIAL PAGE (2) Humphreys

A study of the editorial page as to purpose, style, and effect. Train- ing is given in writing interpretative news articles, columns, and all types of editorials. Prereq., Ill, or 12 hrs. of English, and senior rank, or permission.

327. PUBLIC RELATIONS TECHNIQUES (3) Hortin, Staff Study and practice of fundamental public relations functions. Em- phasis is placed on polling, publicity wi-iting, and preparation of litera- ture of business organizations house organs, reports, pamphlets, ad- vertisements, leaflets, manuals, and letters. Prereq., 107, 146, and junior rank, or permission.

328. PUBLIC RELATIONS (3) Hortin. Staff A study of advanced public relations problems, policies, and prac- tices of various institutions and oragnizations in modem society. Atten- tion is focused on public relations program development. Prereq., 327 or permission.

250 Ohio University

329. BUSINESS AND MAGAZINE JOURNALISM (2) Baird

Study of industrial, business, and institutional publications. Anal- ysis of contents, purposes, and readership of such publications. Practice in copy preparation and make-up. Staff, costs, printing, and circula- tion are considered. Prereq., Ill and 146.

343. NEWSPAPER MANAGEMENT (2) Turnbull

A study of the problems and economics of publishing. Consideration is given to policy making as it affects all departments of the newspaper plant. Prereq., junior or senior rank.

348. ADVERTISING PRODUCTION (2) Turnbull

Study of mechanical, graphic, and creative methods of advertising production; comparative analysis of printing processes; relation of color, art work, type, media, and quality of paper to advertising purpose; study of cost and controls. Prereq., 247 or Advt, 332 or permission.

370. INTERNSHIP (3) StaH

A conference course open only to students who have completed their internship work with an approved organization. Students will submit a comprehensive report involving analysis and problems encountered dur- ing the summer training. Prereq., only by permission; junior rank or above, and completion of summer internship.

375. SPECIALIZED JOURNALISM (3) Baird, Staff A course designed for students desiring training in special fields

science, sports, society, politics, military, home economics, agriculture, religious activities, teaching journalism, music, and other approved ar- eas. Prereq., junior rank or above and permission.

376. GRAPHIC PRODUCTION PROCESSES (3) Turnbull, Staff Advanced study of all processes for reproducing the printed word

and pictures, including photo-engraving, lithography, letterpress, roto- gravTire, mimeographing, duplicating. Emphasis is placed on developing a thorough understanding of latest developments in each field as they affect editing, advertising, public relations, and television news. In- cludes theory and laboratory work in preparation of written and photo- graphic copy for each process. Prereq., 146, senior rank, and permis- sion.

381. RESEARCH IN JOURNALISM (1 to 8) Staff

Special studies in one or more phases of journalism. Prereq., 18 hrs. in journalism and advertising, and permission.

403. SEMINAR IN MASS COMMUNICATIONS (2) Staff

Methods of research in mass communications; the selection, plan- rang, and evaluation of research problems. Study of thesis writing and selection of a thesis problem. Survey of outstanding books and period- ical literature in mass communications. Prereq., permission.

495. THESIS (1 to 6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

LATIN See Classical Languages

Management 251

LIBRARY SCIENCE Assistant Professor Wright (Librarian)

Assistant Librarians Chutter, Linnenbruegge, Dickinson, Devlin

Courses in Library Science under the direction of the University Librarian, in cooperation with the College of Education, provide training for students wishing to qualify as teacher-librarians under the Ohio Department of Education. Library Science 191 is also useful as a gen- eral elective for students interested in training for graduate or research work in any field of study. Students in literature or fine arts may find Library Science 194 helpful as background material.

191. HISTORY OF LIBRARIES AND THE USE OF

LIBRARY RESOURCES (3) Wrighf, Devlin

A survey of the development of book collections serves as an intro- duction to practical training in the effective use of modem library re- sources. Open to all students in any year. Required for a minor in library science, (2nd sem., yearly.)

192. CLASSIFICATION AND CATALOGING OF BOOKS (3) Devlin Training in classifying and cataloging books, with practice in the

preparation of a card catalog for a high school library. Required for a minor in library science. (2nd sem., yearly.)

194. HISTORY OF BOOKS AND PRINTING (3) Wright

A survey of the development of books and printing from early times to the present. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

202. BOOKS FOR HIGH SCHOOL READERS (3) Linnenbruegge

A study of library service for young people serves as an introduc- tion to books and book services for the high school age gi'oup. (2nd sem,, 1959-60.)

291. THE SCHOOL LIBRARY (3) Linnenbruegge

Study of methods and materials used in organizing school library service, and developing library use among school pupils. Practice work and field trips. Required for a minor in library science. (1st sem., year- ly.)

393. ADMINISTRATIVE PROBLEMS IN A SCHOOL LIBRARY (3) Linnenbruegge Study of practical problems in planning adequate library quarters, selection of furniture and equipment, relations with faculty and with purchasing and finance offices. Offered second semester. Prereq., 291. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

MANAGEMENT Professors Beckert, Hellebrandt (chairman),

Associate Professor Splvey

3. INTRODUCTION TO BUSINESS (3) BeclcerJ

A survey of the operations of business, large and small, in our cap- italistic system with observations of the changes taking place in our free enterprise society. An understanding of the technical language of in- dustry and the development of the vocabulary of business and business terms. Not open to upperclassmen pursuing the Bachelor of Science in Commerce degree.

211. INDUSTRIAL MANAGEMENT (3) Hellebrandt, Staff

An examination of the basic fundamentals of management under- lying the solution of problems of organization and operation in all busi- ness enterprise, followed by their application to such specific fields of industrial management as materials, personnel, production, budgets, labor relations, etc, Prereq,, Ec, 12 or 102, junior rank, or permission.

252 Ohio University

301-302. PRODUCTION MANAGEMENT (3) Hellebrandf

An introduction to the more important production procedures and techniques commonly used by progressive manufacturing plants. Deals with methods of supervision used at the lower levels of management in the production field more than with the problems of policy formulation which confront the factory manager. Case and semi-laboratory method used. Prereq., 211, or permission.

302 covers practical training in the more important types of prob- lems encountered by executives at the level of the executive factory manager. The main objective is to develop the ability to analyze and solve problems in management control of production and in the formula- tion of production policies. Case method used. Prereq., 301, or permis- sion.

308. PRODUCTION PLANNING AND CONTROL (2) Hellebrandt

Study of forecasting, planning, authorizing, scheduling, dispatching, and controlling flow of industrial production, from receipt of customer's order to shipment of finished goods. Prereq., 211, or permission.

312, ADMINISTRATION OF PERSONNEL (3) StaH

A comprehensive survey in the principles of management of people in business organizations and institutions. Among the subjects treated are employee selection, training, and rating; labor turnover; job analy- sis; wage and salary administration. Prereq., 211, or permission.

314. PERSONNEL MANAGEMENT PROBLEMS (3) Staff

A detailed study of personnel problems and their relation to various personnel management principles dealing with such subjects as induction and training, transfers and promotions, and morale. Case method used. Prereq., 312, or permission,

321. MOTION AND TIME STUDY (2 or 3 as scfieduled) Hellebrandt

Methods work, work simplification and time study as tools of man- agement to develop methods of determining operating standards, pro- duction control, and wage rate determination. Prereq., 301 or 211 and/or permission.

325. INDUSTRIAL RELATIONS (2 or 3 as scheduled) Hellebrandt

Objectives, establishment and procedures of collective bargaining; administration of collective bargaining agreements; labor-management cooperation; the methods of conciliation, mediation, and arbitration of disputes. Taught by case method. Prereq., 211, or permission.

332. WAGE AND SALARY ADMINISTRATION (2 or 3 as scheduled) Staff

The factors determining industrial wage and salary policies, meth- ods of employee payments, wage relationships, wage rate setting, in- centive wage plans. The techniques and methods of implementing wage and salary policies. Prereq., 302 or 312.

345. ADVANCED PRODUCTION PROBLEMS (2 or 3 as scheduled) Hellebrandt Case studies of production problems in a number of different in- dustries, designed to apply to all phases of the student's training and experience. Prereq., 302, senior rank and/or permission.

381. RESEARCH IN MANAGEMENT (1 to 8) StaH

Special studies in industrial organization and scientific manage- ment. Prereq., 16 hrs. economics and/or commerce including Mgt, 301 or 312, and permission.

Marketing 253

391. SEMINAR IN MANAGEMENT (2 to 4) Staff

Maximum credit in course, 10 hrs. Prereq., 15 hrs. management and /or economics and permission.

495. THESIS (Uo6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

Additional courses: Ec. 335 Labor Economics, Ec. 338 Labor Leg- islation, Stat. 271 Analysis of Statistical Data, Stat. 341 Business Cycles, Stat. 345 Forecasting, and Sec. St. 285 Office Management.

MARKETING Professor Krauskopf

Associate Professors Paynter (chialrman), Raymond

Assistant Professor Richmond

155. MARKETING PRINCIPLES (3) Krauskopf, Paynter, Raymond, Richmond

The principles, methods, and policies of marketing consumers' goods and industrial goods. Prereq., Ec. 12 or 102.

258. MARKETING PROBLEMS (3) Raymond

A consideration by the case method of the problems facing the pro- ducer and the middleman. Prereq., 155.

271. PRINCIPLES OF PERSONAL SELLING (2) Raymond

The fundamentals of personal salesmanship and the problems in- volved in the relationship of the personal salesman to the sales organiza- tion. Prereq., 155.

276. SALES MANAGEMENT (2) Raymond

Problems in the management of the sales organization and in some of the immediately related fields of management. Prereq., 155.

301. RETAIL SELLING POLICIES (3) Paynter The organization and operation of retail institutions. Prereq., 155.

302. RETAIL BUYING AND STOCK CONTROL (3) Paynter A study of buying, receiving, and stock control practices in retail

stores. Prereq., 301.

311. RECENT TRENDS IN MARKETING AND SELLING (3) Krauskopf, Paynter Prereq., 155.

326. INDUSTRIAL PURCHASING AND INDUSTRIAL MARKETING (3) Paynfer The purchasing and selling of industrial goods. Prereq., 155.

341. FOREIGN TRADE (3) Paynter

A study of the theories of foreign trade and of the problems met by concerns engaged in importing and exporting. Prereq., 155.

346. FOREIGN MARKETS (2) Paynter

A study of foreign markets from the point of view of the American exporter. Prereq., 155.

254 Ohio Unive31sity

352. PROBLEMS IN SALES MANAGEMENT (2) Raymond

Problems of sales administration and selling policies by the case method. Prereq., 258 or 271, 276.

381. RESEARCH IN MARKETING (1 to 8) Staff

Research methods, market data, and methods of conducting market surveys. Prereq., 18 hrs. commerce, including 5 hrs. marketing, and permission.

391. SEMINAR IN MARKETING {2 to 4) StaH

Maximum credit in course, 10 hrs. Prereq., 18 hrs. commerce, in- cluding 5 hrs. marketing, and permission.

495. THESIS (lto6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

MATHEMATICS Professors Marquis, Denbow, Goedicke

Associate Professors Butner (chairman), Fishback, Jasper

Assistant Professors Spring, W. E. Baxter, Hood, Sexauer

Instructors M. R. LeBoutillier, Diekhans.Uhl, N.Johnson,

Rodgers, Lauff

The major requirement for the A.B. or B.S. degree is 28 hours including Math. 5, 6, 101, 102 and at least two courses numbered above 300.

1. ELEMENTARY ALGEBRA (3) Staff

A beginning course for students with no high school algebra. (Sum- mer session only.)

2. PLANE GEOMETRY (3) Staff

A course for students with no high school geometry. Prereq., 1, or 1 yr. high school algebra. (Summer session only.)

3. INTERMEDIATE ALGEBRA (3) StaH

Review of high school algebra and some simple topics from college algebra. Any student who takes 3 must earn a "C" or better in order to go on to Math. 5. Prereq., 2, or 1 yr. each in geometry and algebra in high school. (Each semester.)

5. FRESHMAN MATHEMATICS (5) Staff

College algebra and plane trigonometry. Prereq., 2, or 1 yr. each in algebra and plane geometry in high school. (Each semester.)

6. ANALYTIC GEOMETRY AND CALCULUS I (5) Stoff

Topics in analytic geometry, function and limits, differentiation and uitegration of algebraic forms, application of derivatives, integration as a summation process. Prereq., 5. (Each semester.)

9. FUNDAMENTALS OF MATHEMATICS (3) Staff

A critical reanalysis and review of the basic concepts of algebra. Not open to students who have had Math. 5. For premedical and pre- dental students; others by permission. Prereq., 2, or 1 yr. each in algebra and plane geometry in high school. (1st sem. yearly.)

Mathematics 255

!0. FUNDAMENTALS OF MATHEMATICS (3) Staff

An introduction to the basic concepts of statistics, analytic geome- try, and the calculus. Not open to students who have had Math. 6. Prereq., 9. (2nd sem. yearly.)

34. MATHEMATICS OF FINANCE (3) StaH

A study of interest, annuities, sinking funds, valuation of bonds, capitalized cost, life insurance, and life annuities. Prereq., 2, or 1 yr. each in algebra and plane geometry in high school. (Each semester.)

101. ANALYTIC GEOMETRY AND CALCULUS II (4) Staff Conies, differentiation and integration of transcendental functions,

polar coordinates, parametric equations, curvature, integration, indetermi- nate forms. Prereq., 6. (Each semester.)

102. ANALYTIC GEOMETRY AND CALCULUS III (4) StaH Solid analytic geometry, series, expansion of functions, partial

derivatives, multiple integrals, elementary differential equations. Prereq., 101. (Each semester.)

104. COLLEGE GEOMETRY (3) Staff

Review of plane geometry, together with a more advanced treatment of similar and homothetic figures, the triangle, medians, bisectors, alti- tudes, and transversals. Prereq., 6. (2nd sem., yearly.)

107. ELEMENTARY STATISTICS (3) Staff

Basic theory and methods used in widely different fields. Histo- grams, ogives, probability, normal curve, curve fitting, sample theory; simple, correlation; testing statistical hypotheses. Not open to students who have had 207, or who have completed 101. Prereq., 5, or 9, or a "C" in 3. (Each semester.)

207. APPLIED STATISTICS (3) Staff

A course for beginners in statistics, covering the same topics as 107, and including also a study of quality control. Not open to students with 107. Prereq., 101. (Each semester.)

268. TEACHING OF MATHEMATICS IN HIGH SCHOOL

(2 or 3 as scfieduled) Fishbacic, Jasper An analysis of the basic ideas of algebra and geometry. Methods of presenting topics in these subjects to junior and senior high school stu- dents. Prereq., 6 and Psych. 5. (2nd sem., yearly.)

301. THEORY OF EQUATIONS (3) Jasper, Spring

The roots of unity, roots of an equation, isolation of real roots, numerical solutions, determinants, and matrices, systems of linear equa- tions, and symmetric functions. Prereq., 102 (1st sem., yearly.)

303. NUMERICAL ANALYSIS (3) Goedicke, Spring An investigation of numerical methods for approximate solution of

applied problems. Topics will include interpolation theory, curve fitting, approximate integration, and the numerical solution of differential equa- tions. Prereq., 315 or permission. (1st sem,, 1958-59.)

304. 305. ADVANCED CALCULUS (3, 3) Fisfibacic, Jasper Critical treatment of certain topics in calculus. Limits, continuity,

differentiation of functions of one and several variables, series, and defi- nite and multiple integrals, line integrals. Prereq., 102, for 304; 304 for

305. (Yearly.)

256 Ohio University

308. PROJECTIVE GEOMETRY (3) Fishback, Marquis

Elements, primitive forms, duality, protectively related forms, curves and ruled surfaces of the second order, Pascal's and Brianchon's theorems, poles and polars, and the theory of involution. Prereq., 102. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

315. ADVANCED APPLIED MATHEMATICS I (3) Staff An introductory treatment of elementary and series solutions of

differential equations, partial differential equations and boundary value problems, fourier series. Prereq., 102. (Each semester.)

316. ADVANCED APPLIED MATHEMATICS II (3) Staff An introductory treatment of matrices, vector analysis, complex

variables, and Laplace transforms. Prereq., 315. (2nd sem., yearly.)

317. INTRODUCTION TO MODERN ALGEBRA (3) Sexauer, Fishback Development of the postulates of group theory, fields, rings, matrices

and point sets. Prereq., 301 or permission. (1st sem,, 1959-60.)

318. VECTOR ANALYSIS (3) Butner. Goediclce

Algebra of vectors, differential and integral vector calculus, vector spaces, and introductory tensor analysis. Prereq., 102. (1st sem., 1959- 60.)

319. MATRIX THEORY (3) Butner, Denbow Linear transformations; matrices over a field; canonical forms and

invariants. Prereq., 301 or permission. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

326. THEORY OF STATISTICS (3) Butner, Goedicke

Basic concepts of statistics treated theoretically. Distributions of one and several variables, sampling theory, correlation, analysis of vari- ance, testing of statistical hypothesis. Prereq., 102 and 107 or 207 or permission. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

340. STUDIES IN MATHEMATICS (3) Staff

Selected topics in mathematics are studied under the guidance of an instructor particularly interested in the field. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 18 hrs.

351-352. THEORY OF FUNCTIONS OF A COMPLEX VARIABLE

(3-3) Marquis, Jasper

Prereq., 304 for 305; 351 for 352. (1958-59.)

356. THEORY OF FUNCTIONS OF REAL VARIABLES (3) Denbow, Hood

A critical study, from a modern point of view, of topics in real variable theory. Prereq.,, 304. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

399. SEMINAR IN COMPUTING (1) StaH

Topics in programming and theory of digital computing machines. Prereq., 6, and junior standing.

495. THESIS {lto6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

Music 257

MECHANICAL ENGINEERING— See Engineering

MUSIC Professors Ingerham, Ahrendt (director)

Visiting Professor Keleti

Associate Professors Fontaine, P. Peterson, Stephenson

Assistant Professors Kresge, Longstreet, Roach,

Bloyney, Thackrey, Morley, Witzler, Merritt,

Minelli, Jennings, Brophy, hfall, Conkling,

Bergsagel, Reinns

Instructors Szaroleta, R. D. Smith, Comin

Lecturers Malone, Sears

APPLIED MUSIC

Private instructional fee for all applied music (piano, voice, organ, strings, woodwind, brass, percussion), $20 a semester hour.

(Note: A description of the proficiency requirements for applied music may be secured from the School of Music.)

VOICE (1 to 3) Peterson, Roach, Merritt

Prereq., permission.

PIANO (1 to 3) Fontaine, Kresge, Longstreet, Jennings, Szaroleta

Prereq., permission.

ORGAN (1) Kresge

Prereq., permission.

STRINGED INSTRUMENTS: Violin. Viola. Violoncello, Boss

(1 to 3) Ingerham, Conkling

Prereq., permission.

WOODWIND INSTRUMENTS: Flute, Oboe, Clarinet, Bassoon (1 to 3) Witiler Prereq., permission.

BRASS INSTRUMENTS: Trumpet. Baritone. Horn, Trombone. Tuba

(1 to 3) Brophy. Smith Prereq., permission,

PERCUSSION INSTRUMENTS (1 to 3) Minelli

Prereq., permission.

BRASS CHOIR (1) Brophy

Prereq., permission.

UNIVERSITY BANDS (1) Minelli, Brophy

Open to men and women students. Prereq., permission.

UNIVERSITY CHORUS (l) Bergsagel

Open to men and women students. Prereq., permission.

UNIVERSITY SYMPHONY ORCHESTRA (1) Ahrendt

Open to men and women students. Prereq., permission.

MEN'S GLEE CLUB (1) Peterson

Open to men students. Prereq., permission.

WOMEN'S GLEE CLUB (1) Merritt

Open to women students. Prereq., permission.

258 Ohio University

66-67. CLASS PIANO (1-1) Blayney

Prereq., permission.

251-252. CHAMBER MUSIC (1-1) StaH

Participation in the playing of the standard chamber music litera- ture. Prereq., permission. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs.

273. CONDUCTING (2) Ingerham

Fundamentals of conducting, accompained by individual practice in conducting. For music majors only; open to others by permission. Prereq., 104 and 106.

331-332. PIANO ENSEMBLE (1-1) StaH

Participation in the playing of original works or arrangements for two pianos. Prereq., permission.

375. ADVANCED CONDUCTING (1 to 4) StaH

An opportunity for study and practical experience in either choral or instrumental conducting. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 104, 106, 273, and pennission.

431. VOICE (1 to 4) Merrltt, Peterson, Roach

Maximum credit in course, 16 hrs. Prereq., permission.

433. PIANO (1 to 4) Fontaine, Szaroleta, Jennings, Longstreet

Maximum credit in course, 16 hrs. Prereq., permission.

435. ENSEMBLE (1 to 4) StaH

Maximum credit in course, 16 hrs. Prereq., permission.

437. STRINGED INSTRUMENTS {1 to 4) Ingerham, Conkling

Maximum credit in course, 16 hrs, Prereq., permission.

439. V/OODWIND INSTRUMENTS (1 to 4) WItzler

Maximum credit in course, 16 hrs. Prereq., permission.

441. BRASS INSTRUMENTS (1 to 4) Brophy, Smith

Maximum credit in course, 16 hrs. Prereq., permission.

443. PERCUSSION INSTRUMENTS (1 or 2) MInelli

Maximum credit in course, 8 hrs. Prereq., permission.

495. RECITAL (4) Staff

A full-length public recital, a recording of which will be filed in the library, in lieu of a thesis. Prereq., permission. Fee charged by Radio Department based on length and type of program.

MUSIC HISTORY AND LITERATURE

5. MUSIC APPRECIATION (2) Thackrey, Malone

The form and meaning of musical masterpieces. Not open to music majors or those who have received credit for F.A. 123-124.

337. THE LITERATURE OF VOCAL MUSIC (2) Peterson Representative literature from the fields of oratorio, choral music,

and the art song. Prereq., F.A. 124.

338. THE LITERATURE OF ORCHESTRAL MUSIC (2) Ingerham Orchestral literature from the classic through the contemporary.

Prereq., F.A. 124.

Music 259

339. THE EVOLUTION OF THE OPERA (2) Bergsagel

Prereq., F.A. 124.

340. THE LITERATURE OF PIANO MUSIC (2) Fontaine The development of the instrument, the primary forms adapted to

it, and the representative composers. Prereq., F.A. 124.

401-402. MUSIC LITERATURE (3-3) Bergsagel

Prereq., F.A. 124 and permission.

495. THESIS (lto6) StafF

Prereq., permission.

THEORY AND COMPOSITION

3-4 THEORY (3-3) Hall

A beginning study of the melodic, harmonic, and rhythmic principles of music and its notation. 5 hrs. a week.

103-104. DICTATION AND SIGHT SINGING (2-2) Hall

Should be taken concurrently with 105-106. 3 hrs. a week. Prereq., 4 with a minimum grade of C.

105-106. HARMONY (3-3) Hall

Harmonization of melodies and figured basses, both written and at

the keyboard. Improvisation, transposition. 4 hrs. a week. Prereq., 4 with a minimum grade of C.

201-202. ANALYSIS AND FORM (2-2) Fontaine

Harmonic and structural analysis of music composition. Prereq., 106.

233. INSTRUMENTATION (3) Minelli

The various orchestral instruments from the standpoint of their range and orchestral uses. Arranging for small ensembles. 3 hrs. a week and participation in Instrumental Workshop. Prereq., 106.

307-308. ARRANGING AND SCORING FOR BANDS (2-2) Minelli

Scoring and arranging for the modem marching and symphonic band. Prereq., 104, 106, and 233.

313-314. ORCHESTRATION (2-2) Ahrendf

Scoring for small, medium, and full orchestra. Prereq., 104 and 106.

315-316. ADVANCED HARMONY (2-2) Kresge

The evolution of harmony to the present, including the new methods of chord structure in modem harmony. Prereq., 104 and 106.

317-318. COUNTERPOINT (2-2) Fontaine

Single counterpoint in all species in two, three, or four parts. De-

relopment of motive, double counterpoint, free writing on original themes. Prereq., 104 and 106.

319-320. COMPOSITION (2-2) Ahrendt

Original writing in the smaller forms. Prereq., 104 and 106.

357-358. COUNTERPOINT (2-2) Fonfaine

Double and triple counterpoint with and without free parts. Special

attention is given to the Inventions and Partitas of Bach. Prereq., 318.

371-372. COMPOSITION (2-2) Ahrendt

Original writing in the larger forms. Prereq., 320.

260 Ohio University

384. RESEARCH IN MUSIC (1 to 4) Staff

Prereq,, 30 hrs. or the equivalent. Permission,

403. SEMINAR IN MUSIC (1) Staff

Reports on research by students or faculty, for discussion. Required of all graduate students enrolled in the School of Music (yearly). Maximum credit, 2 hrs. Prereq., permission.

407-408. EVOLUTION OF HARMONIC THEORY (2-2) Bergsagel, Hall

A study of the writings of the most important music theorists from the 10th century to the present. Prereq., 106, F.A. 123-124, 1 yr. of Cpt., 201-202, 313-314, 315-316.

409-410. CANON AND FUGUE (2-2) Fontaine

A critical study of the classic canon in all its forms. Complete fa- miliarity with the Well-Tempered Clavichord is expected. A fully devel- oped original fugue in four voices is necessary for credit. Prereq., 358 and permission.

425-426. COMPOSITION (2-2) Ahrendt

Extensive writing in the larger vocal and instrumental forms. Pre- req., 372.

427-428. ADVANCED ORCHESTRATION (2-2) Ahrendt

Problems in scoring original works for the modem symphony or- chestra. Satisfactory scores are performed by the University Symphony Orchestra. Prereq., 314 and 318.

429. SIXTEENTH CENTURY COUNTERPOINT (2) Fontaine

The techniques of the period, particularly as evidenced in the works of Palestrina and Lassus. Original writing in the sixteenth century modal style. Prereq., 318 and permission.

495. THESIS (1 to 6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

MUSIC EDUCATION

72. MUSIC FUNDAMENTALS (2) Thacbey, Malone

A course for elementary teachers only involving theory, ear train- ing, tone production, and sight singing of unison and part songs. 3 hrs. a week.

261. STRING TECHNIQUES AND MATERIALS (2) Conkling

5 hrs. a week.

263. V/IND AND PERCUSSION TECHNIQUES AND MATERIALS

(2) StaH Maximum credit in the course, 6 hrs. 5 labs.

265. VOCAL TECHNIQUES AND MATERIALS (2) Stephenson

266. TEACHING OF MUSIC IN ELEMENTARY GRADES

(2) Morley, Malone, Stephenson

Music material and methods for elementary teachers only. Prereq., 72.

Music 261

267. SUPERVISION OF MUSIC IN THE ELEMENTARY SCHOOL (3) Blayney (For music major only.) Prereq. with Ed. 272.

268. MUSIC IN THE JUNIOR AND SENIOR HIGH SCHOOL (3) Stephenson Prereq., with Ed. 281.

276. MUSIC WORKSHOP (1 fo 3) Staff

Maximum credit in the course, 4 hrs.

a. Elementary Music Workshop (Summer only).

b. Elementary Music Workshop (Extension only).

376a, b, c, d. MUSIC WORKSHOP (1 to 4) StaH

Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs.

a. Music Clinic-Workshop (Summer only).

b. Opera Workshop (Summer only).

c. Elementary Music Workshop (Summer only.)

d. Elementary Music Workshop (Extension only.)

470. CONTEMPORARY TRENDS IN MUSIC EDUCATION (2) Stephenson Prereq., permission.

471. PROBLEMS IN THE SUPERVISION OF VOCAL MUSIC (2) Morley 2 lee, lab as required. Prereq., 265, 267, 268, 2 hrs. observation,

and 4 hrs. student teaching.

472. PROBLEMS IN THE SUPERVISION OF INSTRUMENTAL MUSIC

(3) Minell; 2 lee, lab as required. Prereq., 261, 263, 2 hrs. observation, and 4 hrs. student teaching.

473. EXPERIMENTAL STUDIES IN MUSIC (3) Stephenson Important psychological investigations bearing upon musical compo- sition, performance and appreciation. Prereq., permission.

495. THESIS {1 to 6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

MUSIC THERAPY

374. FOUNDATIONS OF MUSIC (2 to 4) Sears

A lecture-laboratory course applying pertinent findings from the fields of physics, acoustics, electronics, physiology, psychology, and sociology to music education and music therapy. 2 lee, 3 lab, and re- search problem. Prereq., 6 hrs. psychology, general biology, introductory physics, permission.

377. BACKGROUND OF MUSIC THERAPY (3) Sears

The history of the use of music in mental hospitals and clinics; present trends; state and private hospital programs. Prereq., 30 hrs. of music, 9 hrs. of psychology or equivalent; special permission.

379. MUSIC THERAPY (2 to 9) Sears

A workshop course in methods, materials and procedures of con- ducting a music therapy program in hospitals and clinics. Prereq., 377, or by special permission.

PAINTING— See Art

262 Ohio University

PHILOSOPHY Professor Organ (chairman)

Associate Professor Murphree Assistant Professors Wieman, Grean, Hagensick

Instructor Sheridan The major requirement for the A.B. degree consists of a minimum of 24 hours, including 110, 221, 222, and at least three courses in the 300 group.

1. PRINCIPLES OF REASONING (3) Staff

A general course in reasoning which considers the methods by which dependable knowledge is achieved in the natural sciences and social studies, with attention to the common psychological, semantic, and logi- cal errors in human reasoning. Not open to juniors and seniors. (Each semester.)

2. MORAL PHILOSOPHIES (3) Grean, Murpfiree, Sheridan

A study of important moral philosophies in the history of western thought. Discussion of such themes as the good life and the nature of moral obligation. Not open to juniors and seniors. (Each semester.)

103. OLD TESTAMENT THOUGHT (3) Grean, Hood A study of the development of Old Testament thought from the

earliest times. Examination of the philosophical, moral, and religious significance of important passages. The evolution of prophecy and of law, and the rise of post-exilic Judaism will be treated. (1st sem., yearly.)

104. NEW TESTAMENT THOUGHT (3) Grean, Hood A study of the background and development of New Testament

thought. Examination of the philosophical, moral, and religious signifi- cance of the beliefs of Jesus, Paul, and the early Church. (2nd sem., yearly.)

107. WORLD'S GREAT RELIGIONS (3) Organ

A historical and comparative treatment of the origins, literature, beliefs, practices, and values of the living religions of the world, (Each semester.)

110. INTRODUCTION TO PHILOSOPHY (3) S+aH

An analysis of the typical philosophical problems arising in the study of nature, society, religion, and art for the purpose of developing a thoughtful and consistent intellectual perspective, (Each semester,)

117, SOCIAL PHILOSOPHY (2) Murpfiree

An analysis of basic types of social and political philosophies, classi- cal and modem, including the philosophical backgrounds of American democracy. (1st sem., yearly.)

201, ETHICS (3) Wieman

A comparative study of theories of the right and the good which enter into contemporary thought, with attention to the problem of evi- dence and the relation between value standards and experience. (Each semester.)

209. LOGIC (3) Hagensicic

A consideration of the nature of reasoning and argument with special emphasis on the applications of logic in ordinary and scientific activities. (Each semester.)

Philosophy 263

212. AMERICAN PHILOSOPHY (3) Murphree

Chief movements in American thought beginning with transcen- dentalism and including pragmatism, naturalism, and idealism. Prereq., 110. (2nd sem., yearly.)

215. PHILOSOPHY OF RELIGION (3) Grean

A discussion and analysis of representative theories of the nature of religion and religious experience, the existence and nature of God, the problem of evil, human freedom, immortality, and religion and culture. (1st sem., yearly.)

221. HISTORY OF WESTERN PHILOSOPHY: ANCIENT AND MEDIEVAL

(3) Organ A study of significant ideas of representative philosophers in the western world from 600 B.C. to 1600 A.D. (1st sem., yearly.)

222. HISTORY OF WESTERN PHILOSOPHY: MODERN (3) Sheridan A study of significant ideas of representative pliilosophers in the

western world since 1600. (2nd sem., yearly.)

302. AESTHETICS (3) Grean

The nature and function of art and aesthetic experience. Discussion of representative theories of beauty, the creative process, aesthetic appreciation, art and morality, and art and religion. Analysis of parti- cular works of art will be used as illustrations. Prereq., 6 hrs. or 3 hrs. and 12 hrs. humanities. (2nd sem., yearly.)

304. CONTEMPORARY SOCIAL PHILOSOPHY (2) Murphree

Readings in modem social philosophy with attention to theories of action, mass movements, and politics. Prereq., 6 hrs. or 3 hrs. and 6 hrs. of a social science. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

305. THEORY OF KNOWLEDGE (3) Hagensick A critical examination and appraisal of various twentieth century

views of what knowledge is and how it is attained. Prereq., 6 hrs. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

306. PHILOSOPHY OF SCIENCE (3) Hagensick An examination of philosophical problems associated with science.

The character of scientific methods, the relationships between laws and theories are among the topics studied. Prereq., 6 hrs. or 3 hrs. and 12 hrs. natural science. (2nd sem., yearly.)

308. EASTERN PHILOSOPHY (2) Organ

An examination of selected philosophers and systems of philosophy of India and China. Prereq., 6 hrs. including 107. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

310. PRAGMATISM (2) Murphree The background of the pragmatic movement and its development as

represented by Peirce, James, Dewey, and Schiller. Prereq., 6 hrs. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

311. METAPHYSICS (2) Wieman A survey of basic assumptions underlying different conceptions of

the world, with special attention to materialism, formism, idealism, and contextualism. Prereq., 6 hrs. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

321. PLATO (2) Wieman Reading of selected works of Plato in English translation. Prereq.,

6 hrs. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

322. ARISTOTLE (2) Organ Reading of selected works of Aristotle in English translations.

Prereq., 6 hrs. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

264 Ohio University

331. CONTINENTAL IDEALISM |2) Sheridon

Reading and discussion of selections from Kant, Hegel, Schopen- hauer, and Cassirer. This course will present the idealist view of the nature of knowledge, the nature of man, and the problem of value. Prereq., 6 hrs. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

333. EXISTENTIALISM (2) Sheridan

A critical examination of existentialism with emphasis on Sartre, Marcel, Jaspers, and Heidegger. This movement will be treated as a philosophic discipline and in relation to trends in modern life. Prereq., 6 hrs. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

341. SYMBOLIC LOGIC (2) Hagensick

The study and use of symbolic methods and techniques for consider- ing logical problems. Special attention is given to the relations be- tween symbolic logic and our natural and technical languages. Prereq., 6 hrs. including 209. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

391. SEMINAR IN PHILOSOPHY (1-3) StaH

Especially assigned problems are treated or the writings of import- ant philosophers are read and critically examined. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 15 hrs.

495. THESIS (1 to 4) S+aH

Prereq., permission.

PHOTOGRAPHY Lecturers White. Truxell, Allen

A student may not register for more than eight hours in photo- graphy during a single semester without special permission.

77-78. BASIC PHOTOGRAPHY (3-3) Allen

1 lee. and 4 lab.

133. BASIC NEWS PHOTOGRAPHY (3) White Introduction to photographic technique and practice and study of

picture content for news reporting. (Not open to photog. majors.) 1 lee. and 4 lab.

134. ADVANCED NEWS PHOTOGRAPHY (3) Truxell Study and practice in photography for news and feature reporting.

1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 78 or 133 and permission.

143-144. PHOTOGRAPHIC PROCESSES (3-3) White

History of photographic processes, photographic optics, photo- chemistry, sensitometry, photographic printing processes, and mechani- cal reproduction methods. 3 lee. Prereq., 78.

145-146. WORKSHOP IN PHOTOGRAPHY (3-3) Allen

Individual practice in basic problems of photographic design and technique. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. 6 lab. Prereq., 78.

277-278. PORTRAITURE (3-3) Truxell

Formal and informal portraiture as well as problems connected with the photography of people indoors and out-of-doors, individually or in groups, including an approach to fashion. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 146.

379-380. COMMERCIAL AND ILLUSTRATIVE PHOTOGRAPHY (3-3) White

Studio and location work in commercial, advertising, industrial, and architectural photography. Introduction to problems of studio operation and free-lance photography. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 278 or permission.

Physical Education and Athletics 265

38!. PROBLEMS IN PHOTOGRAPHY (3) Staff

Individual study and practice in a specialized phase of photo- graphy under instructor supervision. Maximum credit in any one phase or combination of phases, 12 hrs. 6 lab.

a. Individual selection of approved problems in photographic design, technique or practice. 6 lab. Prereq., 277.

b. Picture stories for publication and magazine free-lance photo- graphy. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 277.

c. 16 mm. motion picture production. 6 lab. Prereq., 277.

d. Special problems in color photography. 6 lab. Prereq., 391.

391-392. COLOR PHOTOGRAPHY (5-5) Wfiite

Theory of color photography, practice with color transparency materials, direct separations, separations from transparencies, masking, and dye transfer printing. 1 lee. and 8 lab. Prereq., 144 and 278 and per- mission.

481. RESEARCH IN PHOTOGRAPHY (1 to 4) Staff

Maximum credit in course, 8 hrs. Prereq., 20 hrs. including 381 and permission.

495. THESIS (1 to 6) StaH

Prereq., permission.

PHYSICAL EDUCATION AND ATHLETICS

Associate Professors Hatcher, Trautwein,

LaTourrette, Trepp, Nessley, Rhoods, Widdoes, Miller

Assistant Professors Blosser, Wren, Snyder,

Ricfiey, Heffelfinger, SchlelcFier, Bartels

Instructors Gillespie, Huntsman, Billingsley,

Jensen, McComb, O'Neal, Sams

WIDDOES, director of the Division; TRAUTWEIN, associate director and business manager of intercollegiate athletics; NESSLEY, assistant director in charge of physical education program; HATCHER, health education; TREPP, chairman, major curriculum for men; LaTOURRETTE, recreation; MILLER, chairman, women's program; RHOADS, intramural athletics, men; GILLESPIE, intramural sports, women; HUNTSMAN, head track coach; BLOSSER, golf coach, assist- ant in football and basketball; WREN, head baseball coach, assistant in football; HEFFELFINGER, head line coach in football; JENSEN, modern dance; SNYDER, head basketball coach, assistant in football; RICHEY, freshman football and baseball; SAMS, aquatics, for women; BARTELS, swimming and tennis coach and aquatics, for men; SCHLEICHER, athletic trainer, wrestling coach; O'NEAL, supervising critic, Putnam school; BILLINGSLEY, aquatics and gymnastics; McCOMB, ice activities and soccer.

SERVICE COURSES

The physical education program is designed for the diversified interests and abilities of men and women in the University. Students may elect freely from those courses which appeal to them yet avoid repetition of one sport or activity for the entire fulfillment of their physical education requirement.

266 Ohio University

The asterisk (*) indicates those courses which may be repeated once. For women this may be done by permission. No student may use more than two credit hours in the same sport or activity toward a degree requirement.

For a detailed statement of the university requirement in physical education refer to page 70.

MEN

I. 2. SEASONAL SPORTS {1, 1) Blosser and Sfaff

Instruction and guidance in sports adaptable to team and league play. Activities change with the seasons and weather conditions. 3 hrs. a week.

II. VOLLEYBALL, HANDBALL, BADMINTON (1) Nessley Students may rotate activities during the semester, 3 hrs. a week.

19. GYMNASTICS (1) Billingslcy

Instruction and practice in tumbling skills, stunts, apparatus, pyra- mids, and trampoline. 3 hrs. a week,

21. WRESTLING* (1) Schleicher

For those who wish to learn wrestling, develop additional skill, or train for the varsity squad. Daily for half a semester.

23. TRACK AND CROSS COUNTRY* (1) Huntsman Coaching and practice in track and field events and training for

varsity track squads. Daily for half a semester.

24. TOUCH FOOTBALL AND SOCCER (1) McComb and Staff Varsity and freshman squads. Daily for half a semester.

25. FOOTBALL* (1) Staff Coaching and practice in skills, strategy, play making and rules.

Two double periods a week for half a semester, Prereq,, permission.

27. BASEBALL* (1) Wren

Instruction and guidance in team and league play. Daily for half a semester,

29. BASKETBALL* (1) Snyder

Coaching and practice in skills, plays, techniques and strategy. Daily for half a semester.

31. SV/IMMING* (1) Bartels and Staff

Coaching and practice in standardized swimming meet events. Daily for half a semester.

33. HANDBALL (1) StaH

Instruction and practice in skills, court strategy, and rules of the four-wall game. 3 hrs. a week,

39. DIVING FUNDAMENTALS (1) Billingsley

Instruction and practice in springboard skills and the basic dives from each of the five diving groups. 3 hrs, a week,

51. ICE HOCKEY* (1) McComb

Daily for half a semester. Prereq., permission.

Physical Education and Athletics 267

MEN— WOMEN

3. BEGINNING SWIMMING (1) Sams, Bartels, StaH

For students who are unable to take care of themselves in deep water; orientation to water, skills, safety, elementary strokes and forms of diving. 3 hrs, a week.

4. INTERMEDIATE SWIMMING* (1) Sams, Bartels, StaH

For students who have passed a beginner's swimming test or can swim; instruction and practice in the basic strokes, plain and surface diving. Prereq., 3 or equivalent. 3 hrs. a week.

5. ADVANCED SWIMMING (1) Sams, Bartels, Sta«

For those who have passed the Red Cross Swimmer's Test or its equivalent. The analysis and skills of diving, the recognized strokes and their variations, and fundamentals of competitive swimming. Prereq., 4 or peiTiiission. 3 hrs. a week.

7. BEGINNING MODERN DANCE (1) Jensen

Fundamentals of movement technique and introduction to the con- cept of movement in relation to time, space, and dynamics. 3 hrs. a week.

8. INTERMEDIATE MODERN DANCE* (1) Jensen

Further studies in technique and dance forms. Prereq., 7 or previous dance training. 3 hrs. a v/eek.

9. 10. ADAPTED ACTIVITIES* (1, 1) Trepp. Miller

Students whose physical activities should be restricted are assigned to those activities adapted to their special needs. 3 hrs. a week. Prereq., medical permission.

15. 16. FOLK AND NATIONAL DANCING (1,1) Hatcher, LaTourrette

American square dances and European dances based on the schot- tische, polka, and waltz. Sixteen is a continuation of 15, using dances which involve more difficult steps. 3 hrs. a week.

17. BEGINNING TENNIS (1) Heffelfinger, Miller For students who wish to learn or improve skills, fundamentals of

play, court strategy and rules. Daily for half a semester.

18. INTERMEDIATE TENNIS* (1) Heffelfinger. Miller A continuation of 17 with emphasis on fundamentals of play and

court strategy. Prereq., 17 or playing experience. Daily for half a se- mester.

37. FENCING (1) Nessley Instruction and practice in foil fencing. 3 hrs. a week.

38. ADVANCED FENCING (1) Nessley A continuation of 37. Emphasis on bouts.

41. BEGINNING GOLF (1) Blosser. Gillespie, Staff Instruction and practice in grips, strokes, stance and other techniques

necessary to start playing golf. Daily for half a semester.

42. INTERMEDIATE GOLF* (1) Blosser. Staff Instruction and practice in playing golf. Prereq., 41 or playing ex- perience. Daily for half a semester.

45. BEGINNING BOWLING (l) Schleicher. Richey

Instruction and practice in skills, etiquette, rules and scoring. Daily for half a semester. Pin fee, $10.50.

268 Ohio University

47. RIDING (]) Stoff

Instruction and practice at the McAfee farm. Fee, $20.

49. BEGINNING SKATING (1) McComb, StaH

50. ADVANCED AND FIGURE SKATING (1) McComb, StaH

115-116. ADVANCED MODERN DANCE* (1-1) Jensen

The more complex coordinations and movement studies. Further study in rhythmic, spatial and dynamic elements of dance. Experimenta- tion in form and composition. 3 hrs. a week. Prereq., permission.

118. LIFE SAVING AND WATER SAFETY (1) Bar+els, Sams, Staff

Techniques included in the test for American Red Cross Senior Life

Saving certificate are covered. 3 hrs. a week. Prereq., 5 or permission.

120. INSTRUCTOR'S LIFE SAVING AND V/ATER SAFETY

(1) Bar+els, Sams, Staff

For those who have been certified as American Red Cross Senior Life Savers and wish to do advanced work in the skills and teaching technique of water activity. 3 hrs. a week. Prereq., 118.

V/OMEN

Course numbers 1 through 131 may be used to satisfy the physical education requirement.

1, 2. SPORTS (1, 1) Staff

Students choose from field hockey, soccer, basketball, volleyball, baseball and badminton according to seasons. This course may be re- peated if a different sport is taken. 3 hours a week.

6. ELEMENTARY TAP DANCING (1) StaH

A course designed for beginners. 3 hrs. a week.

112. SYNCHRONIZED SWIMMING (1) Sams Dealing with fundamental rhythmic patterns and stunts necessary

in creating routines for synchronized swimming. Prereq., 5 or permis- sion. 3 hrs. a week.

113. HIKING (1) LaTourrette Hikes are varied as to distance and places visited. First aid and

rules of the road for hikers and practice in leading hikes are included. 3 hrs. a week.

114. CAMP CRAFT (1) LaTourrette An activity course giving experience in firebuilding, outdoor cooking

and lashing temporary camp equipment. One overnight hike is required.

3 hrs. a week.

131. MASS GAMES (1) Gillespie

Games for primary and intermediate grades, program planning and game leadership. For physical education majors or minors, stu- dents in elementary education and recreational leaders, or by permis- sion. 3 hrs. a week.

137, 138. CHOREOGRAPHY (1 or 2) Jensen

Studies and experimentation in dance composition. Prereq., permis- sion.

PROFESSIONAL COURSES FOR THE MAJOR OR MINOR

Refer to curricula in Health Education, Physical Education and Recreation, pages 169, 170, and 171.

Physical Education and Athletics 269

MEN

65, 66. PROGRAM SKILLS (2, 2) Rhoads, Huntsman, Barfels, Billingsley

P.E. 65: Theory and practice of touch football, soccer, speedball, tumbling, stunts and apparatus, swimming proficiency tests and officiat- ing practice.

P.E. 66: Swimming, marching and conditioning exercises, volley- ball, tennis, softball, secondary school games, and officiating practice.

121. PROGRAM SKILLS (2) Trepp Selected rhythmical activities; archery, handball, badminton, horse

shoes, table tennis; relays and mass games suitable for the elementary school program. Prereq., 65 or 66. 6 hrs. a week.

122. PROGRAM SKILLS (1) Blosser. Nessley, Barfels Wrestling, fencing, golf, outdoor education and methods in aquatics.

Prereq., 65 or 66. 6 hrs. a week.

139. ATHLETIC OFFICIATING (2) Rhoads

A study of the rules, mechanics and procedures for the officiating of football and basketball; State certification upon successful completion of the course.

181. INTRAMURAL SPORTS (2) Rhoads

Current practices, ideas and methods of organizing and administer- ing a program of intramural sports at all age levels.

267. ATHLETIC COACHING (2 to 4) Widdoes, Staff Basketball and baseball. See description under 268. Prereq., junior

or senior rank.

268. ATHLETIC COACHING (2 to 4) Widdoes, Staff Football and track. Instinaction and practice in the gymnasium and

on the field; readings, discussions, reports and moving pictures of actual cases, theories, systems of play, problems relative to athletic coaching and interscholastic and intercollegiate competition. Prereq., junior or senior rank.

MEN— WOMEN

102. PERSONAL AND COMMUNITY HEALTH (3) Hatcher, Trepp

Provides a knowledge of the hygienic practices and an appreciation of the means whereby the health of the individual and of the group may be maintained.

127. FIRST AID (2) LaTourrerte Application of the principles and practice of American Red Cross

First Aid. The Standard Certificate is granted if requirements are met.

128. PHYSICAL THERAPY (2) Schleicher Theory and practice of physical therapy and the treatment of athlet- ic injuries. Prereq., Zool. 133-134,

133-134. ANATOMY, KINESIOLOGY AND PHYSIOLOGY (4-4) Vollowe, Trepp (Same as Zool. 133-134.) For course description, see Zoology.

135. PROGRAM TECHNIQUES (1) Miller, Trepp, Staff

Designed to give majors practical experience in the organization, teaching and management of health education and physical education and recreation programs. Students are supervised by staff members. 3 hrs. a week.

270 Ohio University

150. RECREATION (3) LaTourrette

A review of the theory of play, recreation and group work. Students organize parties and square dances and do handcraft. Programs are planned for community and institutional groups.

153. NATURE AND FUNCTION OF PLAY {2) Rhoads

The historical background, theory, need and administration of play, emphasizing play programs for schools, recreation centers, camps and clubs.

233. THEORY OF ADAPTED ACTIVITIES (2) Trepp, Miller

The organization of reconstructive programs adapted to the needs of physically handicapped individuals. Conditions such as postural de- fects, cardiac defects, post operative cases, etc., are described and therapeutic exercises and suitable sports evaluated. Prereq., Zool. 133.

269. TEACHING OF HEALTH (3) Trepp Instruction, principles and curricula used in presenting health in- formation to pupils in the elementary and secondary schools. Prereq., 102.

270. TEACHING OF PHYSICAL EDUCATION (1) O'Neal Objectives, organization and program suggestions for physical edu- cation in the elementary and secondary school.

271. TEACHING OF SWIMMING (2) Sams, Bartels Methods and practice in the teaching of swimming. Prereq., 118,

304. HISTORY AND PRINCIPLES OF PHYSICAL EDUCATION

(3) Hatcher, Rhoads Systems of physical education from the time of the Greeks and their effects on our present programs; the principles underlying physical edu- cation in the modern program of education. Prereq., Zool. 133, and 134 or with 134, or equivalent.

306. ORGANIZATION AND ADMINISTRATION OF PHYSICAL EDUCATION

(2) Miller, Nessley Headings and discussions about typical methods of organizing and administering physical education, school and community health, recrea- tion and athletics in elementary and secondary schools, private schools and colleges. Prereq., junior or senior rank.

309. TESTS AND MEASUREMENTS (3) Miller, Nessley

Available tests and measurements for health education, physical education and athletics, their place, use and possibilities in the program; practice in handling testing data by elementary statistical methods. Prereq., 10 hrs. and senior or graduate rank.

349. COMMUNITY RECREATION (3) Nessley

For those interested in guiding leisure time programs. Topics in- clude: brief history of the play movement, programs and program building, general administration of playgrounds, community centers, and recreational activities. Prereq., 10 hrs. and senior or graduate rank.

352. PHYSICAL DIAGNOSIS (3) Schmidt and StaH

A study of the fundamental deficiencies and defects characteristic of children that handicap normal physical, mental, and social develop- ment and the techniques in conducting health examinations and clinical service. Prereq., 15 hrs. and senior or graduate rank.

Physical Education and Athletics 275

353. CLINICAL OBSERVATION AND PRACTICE IN PHYSICAL

MEDICINE AND REHABILITATION (3) V.A. Hospital Staff

A concentrated summer school field course at Veterans Administra- tion Hospital, Chillicothe, Ohio. Instruction by hospital corrective therapy staff. Open to senior majors or graduate students in physical education. May be taken alone or in conjunction with one or more courses on the campus at Athens. Prereq., Zool. 133-134, or equivalent.

395. SCHOOL HEALTH PROBLEMS (3) Trepp A study of the principles, problems, organization and administration

of school health programs, including school and community relationships. Prereq., 10 hrs., senior or graduate rank.

396. PROBLEMS OF INTERSCHOOL ATHLETICS (3) WIddoes, Rhoads The organization and administration of interschool athletics from

the point of view of coaches and administrators; the problems pertain- ing to interschool competition at all age levels. Prereq., 10 hrs. and senior or graduate rank.

491. SEMINAR IN PHYSICAL EDUCATION AND ATHLETICS

(3) Nessiey. Miller, Staff For graduate students who wish to do research and investigation in health education, physical education, recreation or athletics. Topics and problems suitable for thesis writing, trends of the program, methods of research, writing practice and critical analysis of outlines for re- search study. Prereq., 24 hrs.

495. THESIS (1 to 6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

WOMEN

121, 122. PROGRAM SKILLS (2. 2) Staff

Theory and practice of individual sports techniques, folk dancing, fundamental gymnastics, tumbling and stunts.

139. ATHLETIC OFFICIATING (1) Hatcher, LaTourrette Theory and practice of officiating field hockey, soccer and basketball.

140. ATHLETIC OFFICIATING (1) LaTourrette Theory and practice of officiating volleyball, baseball, and track.

142. CAMP LEADERSHIP (2) LaTourrette

The responsibilities of counselors and methods of program plan- ning. Assistance with the campcraft class provides practical leadership experiences. (Offered in alternate years.)

272. COACHING METHODS (2) Hatclier, LaTourrette Theory and practice of coaching field hockey, soccer, and basket- ball. Prereq., playing experience in the sports.

273. COACHING METHODS (2) LaTourrette Theory and practice of coaching volleyball, baseball, track and field

activities. Prereq., playing experience in the sports.

274. TEACHING OF RHYTHMIC ACTIVITIES (1) Hatcher, Jensen Methods of teaching folk dancing. Prereq., 15 or 122.

275. TEACHING OF RYHTHMIC ACTIVITIES (1) Hatcher, Jensen Methods of teaching ballroom and modern dancing. Prereq., 8.

PHYSICAL SCIENCE— See General Studies

272 Ohio Univeesity

PHYSICS Professor Edwards

Associate Professors McClure, Pierce,

Randall (cfioirman), T. Smith

Assistant Professors Gallaher, Stumpf, Shipman

The major requirement for the A.B. degree is a minimum of 24 semester hours including 113-114 and at least 6 hours in courses number- ed above 300 and Math. 5, 6, 101, and 102.

The major requirement for the B.S. degree is a minimum of 36 semester hours. This must include 113-114, 201-202, 219-220, and a minimum of 5 semester hours in advanced laboratory courses selected from 325 to 330 inclusive, and at least 15 hours in courses numbered above 300. Mathematics courses through differential equations are also required.

Students preparing for positions in industrial or atomic energy laboratories should register for additional advanced laboratory courses while completing the B.S. degree. A complete curriculum for such stu- dents is given on page 104.

Freshmen students planning to major in physics are advised to take Math. 5, 6 and General Chemistry. Students anticipating graduate study should obtain a reading knowledge of both French and German.

5. 6. INTRODUCTION TO PHYSICS (4, 4) Edwards. Shipman

A beginning course in physics designed for nontechnical and pre- medical students. Phys. 5, mechanics and heat; Phys. 6, electricity, atomic structure, sound and light. 3 lee. and 2 lab. (Yearly.)

113-114. GENERAL PHYSICS (4-4) Gallaher, McCiure, Randall

Shipman, Smith

Fundamental principles of physics. Phys. 113, mechanics, heat, and

sound; Phys. 114, electricity, magnetism, and light. For students in

engineering, mathematics, physics, and chemistry, 3 lee. and 2 lab.

Prereq., Math. 6. (Both courses offered each semester.)

115. MODERN PHYSICS (3) Stumpf

Fundamental principles of atomic, nuclear, and solid state physics for engineering and science students. 3 lee. Prereq., 114 or 6 and Math. 6. (2nd sem., yearly.)

201-202. MECHANICS (3-3) Stumpf

Vector analysis, kinematics, Newton's Laws of motion, momentum and energy, the harmonic oscillator, rigid body motion, Lagrange's equations, elasticity, hydrostatics and hydrodynamics, and wave motion. Prereq., 114 and Math. 102. (Yearly.)

215. SOUND (2) Pierce

Wave motion and equations representing it; vibration of strings, bars, and air columns; musical scales; interference, beats, and combina- tion tones; hearing; architectural acoustics. Prereq., 5 or 113 and Math.

6. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

219-220. ELECTRICITY AND MAGNETISM (3-3) Smith

A.C. and D.C. circuits, electric and magnetic fields, both static and dynamic. Theory of electrical measurements. Maxwell's equations. Prereq., 114 and Math. 102. (Yearly.)

268. TEACHING OF PHYSICAL SCIENCES (2) Pierce

Objectives, materials, methods, evaluation. Prereq., 8 hrs. in physics or chemistry. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

Physics 273

305. LIGHT (3) Randall

Laws of geometric optics, theory of interference, diffraction, polar- imetry, electromagnetic waves, dispersion, double refraction and other selected topics. Experimental basis of concepts is emphasized. Prereq., 114 and Math. 102 (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

308. X-RAYS (2) Gallaher

The history and development of the principles of X-rays in med- icine, chemistry, and physics; production of continuous and character- istic X-ray spectra; detection, absorption, classical and quantum scat- tering, refraction and applications to crystallography. Prereq., 114 and Math. 102. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

310. HBM AND THERMODYNAMICS (3) Smith

Temperature, expansivity, calorimetry, specific heats, thermal con- duction, thermal properties of gases, change of phase, first and second laws of thermodynamics, Carnot cycle, entropy, applications to physical processes. Prereq., 114 and Math. 102. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

314. MODERN SPECTROSCOPY (3) Randall

The structure of atoms, molecules, and nuclei as revealed by emis- sion and absorption spectra, hjrperfine structure, energy levels, electron configurations, and elementary quantum mechanics. Prereq., 114. (1st sem., yearly.)

325. MECHANICS LABORATORY (1 or 2) Pierce Kater's pendulum, impact, moment of inertia, gyroscope, viscosity,

bending of beams, coupled pendulums. Prereq., 113 and Math. 102. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

326. HEAT LABORATORY (1 or 2) Pierce Mechanical equivalent, heat of combustion, determination of gamma,

conductivity, specific heat of carbon, absolute expansion of mercury, flame temperature. Prereq., 114 and Math. 102. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

327. OPTICS LABORATORY (1 to 3) Randall Dispersion, resolving power, Fresnel and Fraunhofer diffraction,

Newton's rings, Michelson interferometer, grating, refractometer, polari- meter, measurement of wave length. Use of precision apparatus and ac- curate results emphasized. Prereq., 114. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

328. SPECTROSCOPY LABORATORY (1 to 3) Randall Qualitative and quantitative analysis by emission and absortion

methods in visible and ultraviolet regions, prism and grating spec- trometers. Experimental techniques in calibration, sources, standards, mountings, spectrophotometry, photographic procedure. Prereq., 114. (2nd sem., yearly.)

329. ELECTRONICS AND ELECTRICAL MEASUREMENTS LABORATORY

(1 to 4) Smith

Charge on the electron, specific charge of electron, thermionic

emission, resonance potentials, discharge through gases, photoelectricity.

Study of ballistic galvanometer, dielectric constants, magnetic hystersis,

transients. Prereq., 114 and Math. 102. (1st sem., yearly.)

330. X-RAYS AND RADIOACTIVITY LABORATORY (1 to 3) Edwards Crystal analysis. X-ray spectral distribution, absorption coefficients

and limits, Moseley's law, curved crystal spectrograph. Geiger counters, pulse heights and coincidence analysis. Radioactive decay and radiation study. Prereq., 114 and Math. 102. (2nd sem., yearly.)

274 Ohio University

349-350. ATOMIC AND NUCLEAR PHYSICS (3-3) Edwards

Phys. 349, introduction to atomic physics; Phys. 350, introduction to nuclear physics. Intended for students in physics, chemistry, mathe- matics or engineering. Topics include elementary particles, quantum theory of radiation, nuclear energy and reactions. Prereq., 114 and Math. 102. (Yearly.)

352. QUANTUM MECHANICS (3) Gallaher

The philosophy and methods of selected topics including Schroeding- er's equation, simple barrier problems, eigenfunctions for the rigid ro- tator and the linear harmonic oscillator. Prereq., 201 and Math, 315. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

361. SPECIAL PROBLEMS IN PHYSICS {Ho3) Sfoff

Supervised minor research problems in experimental or theoretical physics. Prereq., 15 hrs. and permission. (Yearly.)

365. NUCLEAR REACTOR THEORY AND PRACTICE (3) Randall

Nuclear physics and neutron theory used in reactors: declassified applications to reactor engineering practice, operation, design and ma- terials. Intended for scientists and engineers interested in atomic energy. Prereq., 114 and Math. 102. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

405-406. THEORETICAL PHYSICS (4-4) Gallaher

Advanced dynamics, Lagrange's equations. Hamilton's principle,

canonical equations, Hamilton-Jacobi equations, statistical mechanics,

kinetic theory, electromagnetic theory. Prereq., 114, Math. 315 and permission, (1958-59.)

410. HIGH ENERGY PARTICLES (3) Randall

Theoretical and experimental m.ethods of current problems concern- ing photons, electrons, mesons, neutrons, protons and hyperons from cosmic rays and particle accelerators. Prereq., 14 hrs. and Math. 102. (2nd sem. 1959-60.)

451. ELECTROMAGNETIC THEORY (3) Gallaher

Electro-and magneto-statics, Maxwell's equations, vector and scalar potentials, electromagnetic radiation, multipole radiation, retarded po- tentials, Huygen's principle, relativistic electrodynamics and selected topics, Prereq., 406. (1st sem., 1959-60 or on demand.)

461. STATISTICAL MECHANICS AND THERMODYNAMICS (3) Smith

Quantum theory, Maxwell-Boltzmann, Fermi-Dirac, and Bose- Einstein statistics. Development of partition function. Application of the general theories to selected topics in classical and quantum states of gases, chemical equilibrium, specific heats, fluctuations, transport phenomena, electric and magnetic properties of matter. Prereq., 310, 352, 405. (2nd sem., 1958-59 or on demand.)

481. RESEARCH IN PHYSICS (lto3) Staff

Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 15 hrs. and permission.

491.492. SEMINAR IN PHYSICS (1,1) Gallaher

Selected topics. Required of all graduate students in physics each semester in residence. Prereq., 15 hrs.

495. THESIS (lto6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

Psychology 275

PRINTING ADMINISTRATION Associate Professor Kinison

n. HAND COMPOSITION AND TYPOGRAPHY (1to3) Kinison

A laboratory course in hand composition. It includes the basic oper- ations that are used in general printing. Display composition forms a part of the laboratory exercises. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. 1 lee. and 4-10 lab.

21. ELEMENTS OF PRESSWORK (lto3) Kinison

Includes production problems in the operation of presses, adjustment and care of pressroom machinery, selection and handling of paper, and matching and mixing of inks. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. 1 lee. and 4-10 lab.

112. ORGANIZATION OF PRINTING PRODUCTION (4) Kinison

An introduction to the problems involved in commercial printing. It includes, planning, layout, estimating, and scheduling of the complete manufacture of printing projects. 1 lee. and 6 lab. Prereq., 11, 21, or Ind. A. 142.

144. PHOTOLITHOGRAPHY (3) Kinison

Practice in the making of off-set plates of several kinds and oper- ation of the off-set press. Plate making involves the use of the copying camera and the whirler. 6 lab.

PSYCHOLOGY Professors Lefimcn, A. C. Anderson,

Patrick (chairnnan), Scott, Paulsen, Uhrbrock

Associate Professors Pullen, Klore

Assistant Professors Nygaard, Bradshaw,

Stornn, Games, G. Johns

Instructor Bowling

Part-time Instructor M. Jofins

Assistant Instructor Leety

The major requirement for the A.B. degree is 24 semester hours in- cluding 1 or 101, 209, 290, and 6 hours in courses numbered 300 to 399. Not more than 18 hours may be taken in courses numbered 1 to 299, and total hours in psychology courses may not exceed 30. Math. 107 is required at the sophomore level, and undergraduate majors (especial- ly those planning to pursue graduate work in psychology) are advised to prepare themselves in allied fields appropriate to their interests. Especially recommended are language, preferably French and German, and biological sciences, philosophy, and the social sciences, including economics.

1. GENERAL PSYCHOLOGY (3) Staff

An elementary study of the most sigriificant facts and principles of mental life. Lectures, class demonstrations, discussions. Not open to juniors and seniors. (Each semester.)

2. PSYCHOLOGY OF EVERYDAY PROBLEMS (3) Scott

An attempt is made to use the principles of psychology in the solution of the problems and adjustments of everyday life. Prereq., 1. Not open to juniors and seniors. Credit in this course is not allowed toward the major in psychology. (Each semester.)

276 Ohio University

5. EDUCATIONAL PSYCHOLOGY (3) Games, Lehman, Patriclc, Pullen

This course aims to give students preparing to teach the funda- mental psychological facts and principles concerning maturation, moti- vation, emotion, and the learning processes in behavior development. Prereq., 1 or 101. Not open to juniors and seniors. (Each semester.)

9. IMPROVEMENT OF READING AND STUDY METHODS (1) Bradshaw

Improvement of study and reading habits. Credit not counted toward a degree. (Each semester.)

101. GENERAL PSYCHOLOGY (3) Staff

An elementary study of the most significant facts and principles of mental life. Lectures, class demonstrations, discussion. An intensive course not open to freshmen and to students having had Psych. 1. (Each semester.)

103. CHILD PSYCHOLOGY (3) Lehman

A study of behavior in infancy and childhood, including a survey of the social, cultural, and biological factors associated with various kinds of child behavior. Prereq., 1 or 101 (Each semester.)

110. PSYCHOLOGY OF ADJUSTMENT (3) Bradshaw, Pullen

An introductory study of motivational and inter-personal relations, with special emphasis upon frustration, conflict, and adjustment mechan- isms. Prereq., 1 or 101. (1st sem., yearly.)

113. PSYCHOLOGY OF ADOLESCENCE (2) Bradshaw, Pullen

A study of the physical growth, glandular changes, and emotions of adolescents. Interests, religious experience, and social adjustment are considered. Prereq., 1 or 101. (Each semester.)

135. PSYCHOLOGY OF ADVERTISING AND SELLING (3) Anderson

Applications of psychology of attention, human motives, learning and remembering, imagery, individual likenesses and differences to ad- vertising and selling. Prereq., 1 or 101. (Each semester.)

204. PSYCHOLOGY OF EXCEPTIONAL CHILDREN (2) Lehman, Pullen

The growth and development of nontypical children. Speech dis- orders, auditory defects, visual defects, delinquency, psychopathy, special talents and defects are considered. Prereq., 6 hrs. (2nd sem., 1957-58.)

209. EXPERIMENTAL PSYCHOLOGY (3) Klare, Nygaard

Training in the scientific methods and techniques of modern experi- mental psychology. Individual reports of experiments in the following fields: sensory processes, individual differences, learning, memory, etc. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 1 or 101 and a course in statistics. (Each semester.)

231. EMPLOYEE SELECTION AND PLACEMENT (2) Klare, Paulsen

Evaluation of tests and other selective devices for employee se- lection, placement, and promotion in industry. Lecture and laboratory combined. Prereq., 1 or 101 and a course in statistics, or concurrent registration in a course in statistics. (1st sem., yearly.)

Psychology 277

233. INDUSTRIAL PSYCHOLOGY (2) Klare, Scott, Uhrbrocit

Learning, training, fatigue, motivation, and environmental con- ditions as they affect the individual's performance. Lecture and labora- tory combined. Prereq., 6 hrs. (Each semester.)

290. INTRODUCTION TO PSYCHOLOGICAL MEASUREMENTS (3) Games

The nature and purpose of psychological measurements. Introduc- tion to tests of intelligence, achievement, personality and interest and some practice in test construction, administration, and validation. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 1 or 101 and a course in statistics. (2nd sem., yearly.)

301. ADVANCED EXPERIMENTAL PSYCHOLOGY (3) G.Johns, Klare, Nygaard Research on a topic selected by the student. Prereq., 9 hrs., includ- ing 209. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

303. MENTAL MEASUREMENTS (3) Games, Pullen

The theory, methods, practice and results of intelligence tests. 2

lee. and 1 lab. Prereq., 9 hrs. and a course in statistics. (Each semester.)

307. COMPARATIVE AND GENETIC PSYCHOLOGY (3) G. Johns, Nygaard

Behavior of lower and higher organisms leading up to man is con- sidered. A comparative-genetic-psycho-biological approach is maintained. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 9 hrs. or 6 hrs and 6 hrs. zoology. (1st sera., yearly.)

309. MOTIVATION AND EMOTIONS (3) G. Johns, Patrick The dynamics of animals and human behavior; a study of drives,

desires, incentives; a study of emotion in relation to motives. Prereq., 9 hrs. (2nd sem., yearly.)

310. MENTAL HYGIENE (3) Patrick. Pullen The Dynamics of behavior pathology: The integration and appli- cation of motivational, emotional, perceptual, and learning principles to maladjustments including psychoneurosis. Prereq., 9 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

312. ABNORMAL PSYCHOLOGY (3) Pullen, Scott Considers man's mental deviations from the normal; the theory,

application, and limitations of psychoanalysis; methods of studying ab- normal mental processes, especially psychosis. Clinics at hospitals. 2 lee. and 1 lab. Prereq., 9 hrs. or 6 hrs. and 6 hrs. zoology. (2nd sem., yearly.)

313. CURRENT PSYCHOLOGICAL LITERATURE (3) Games, Nygaard The purpose is to give students a critical evaluation of current

experimental and theoretical findings in psychological journals and related fields. Prereq., 12 hours and permission. (1st sem., yearly.)

315. SOCIAL PSYCHOLOGY (3) Paulsen. Storm A study of the behavior of man as influenced by group membership,

with emphasis on the individual's interaction as a basis of change of motives, attitudes and personahty. Prereq., 9 hrs. and Soc. 1 or C hrs. and 3 hrs. sociology. (2nd sem., yearly.)

316. PSYCHOLOGY OF INDIVIDUAL DIFFERENCES (2) Bradshaw, Lehman The extent and the nature of individual differences, and the in- fluence thereupon of such factors as heredity, environment, race, nation- ality, age and sex. Prereq., 9 hrs. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

278 Ohio University

317. EXPERIMENTAL SENSORY PSYCHOLOGY (3) Staff

A systematic study of sensory processes, including vision, audition, gustation, olfaction, and somesthesis. Experimental methods, research findings, and theory are emphasized. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 15 hours, (1st sem., 1958-59.)

319. PSYCHOLOGY OF PERSONALITY (3) Pullen, Storm The nature of personality as revealed in interrelations to biological,

psychological, and cultural concepts. Prereq., 9 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

320. PERSONNEL AND VOCATIONAL COUNSELING (3) Klare, Paulsen Methods and techniques useful in considering personnel and voca- tional problems to be met in industrial, commercial, and school work. Prereq., 9 hrs. including 231. (2nd sem., yearly.)

325. MINOR PROBLEMS IN PSYCHOLOGY {lto3) Staff

Training in the scientific study of some problem of special interest to the student. Relatively independent work emphasized. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 9 hrs. and permission. (Each semester.)

335. HISTORY OF PSYCHOLOGY (2) Scott

The evolution of methods and concepts of psychology with emphasis on more recent trends. Prereq., 9 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

337. COUNSELING AND PSYCHOTHERAPY (3) Patrick. Puilen

Analysis of theory and practice in counseling and psychotherapy. Prereq., 9 hrs. (2nd sem., yearly.)

341. PSYCHOLOGY OF COMMUNICATION (3) Klare

A psychological approach to the process of communication, with applications to problems in the social sciences. Prereq., 12 hrs. and permission. (1st sem., yearly.)

351. SEMINAR IN PSYCHOLOGICAL PROBLEMS IN INDUSTRY (3) Uhrbrock Consideration of problems of selection, placenient, motivation, de- velopment and evaluation of employees; with emphasis on job analysis, interviewing, testing, rating and attitude evaluation as related to work- er satisfaction, fatigue and productivity. Prereq., 6 hrs., statistics, and permission. ( E ach semester. )

353. LEARNING AND MEMORY (3) Anderson, Nygaard

A study of methods and basic data in the areas of conditioning, discrimination learning, problem solving, habit formation, and memory. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 9 lirs. (1st sem., yearly.)

401. SYSTEMS OF PSYCHOLOGY (3) G. Johns, Nygaard

A critical analysis and comparison of modern and contemporary psychological theory. Prereq., 15 hrs, and permission. (2nd sem., 1958- 59.)

402. PERCEPTION (3) Klare, Storm The psychological principles of perception involving the study of

impersonal (time, space, motion) and personal (social) phenomena. Prereq., 15 hrs. (2nd sem. 1958-59.)

406. AN INTRODUCTION TO PSYCHODIAGNOSIS (3) Patrick, Puilen

A survey and practice of methods and techniques in diagnosing and evaluating personality disorders. Prereq., 303 and 310 or 312. (2nd sem., yearly.)

Psychology 279

407. CLINICAL PSYCHOLOGY (3) Patrick, Pullen

The theory and use of clinical methods including interviewing, observation, case documentation, professional problems, and individual testing. Prereq., 337. (1st sem. 1959-60.)

419. THEORIES OF PERSONALITY (3) Storm

A critical consideration of the theories of personality structure and origin. Prereq., 315 and 319. (2nd sem. 1958-59.)

421. PRACTICUM IN PERSONNEL AND VOCATIONAL COUNSELING

(3) Klare, Paulsen A course designed to provide experience in personnel and vocational counseling. The work will include the handling of counseling cases, discussion of cases, and readings. Prereq., 320. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

423. RESEARCH METHODS AND TECHNIQUES (2) Klare, Paulsen

Study of research methods especially suited to handling problems in social sciences. Major emphasis is placed on the application and interpretation of statistical techniques. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 15 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

427. ADVANCED PERSONNEL PSYCHOLOGY (3) Klare, Paulsen

The integration of facts and theories from various areas of psycho- logy as applied to personnel problems in education, business and in- dustry. Prereq., 320. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

432. ADVANCED SOCIAL PSYCHOLOGY (3) Staff

A summary of the main theoretical and substantive trends in con- temporary social psychology, with emphasis upon the role of small group theory and research. Prereq., 315. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

454. LEARNING THEORY (3) Anderson, Nygaard

Lectures and readings covering theoretical works in the field of learning. Prereq., 15 hrs. including 353. (2nd sem. 1958-59.)

471. QUANTITATIVE METHODS I (3) Games General topics of measurements including psychophysics methods,

scaling techniques, correlational and experimental design analyses. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 290 or equivalent. (2nd sem., 1957-58.)

472. QUANTITATIVE METHODS II (3) Games A continuation and extension of Quantitative Methods I. 2 lee. and

2 lab. Prereq., 471. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

481. RESEARCH IN PSYCHOLOGY (Uo6) Staff

Prereq., 15 hrs. and permission.

494. ADVANCED SEMINAR IN PSYCHOLOGY (2 to 4) Staff Trends and methods in psychology are critically reviewed. Coopera- tive investigations, findings of many studies coordinated with the stu- dent's own findings. Prereq., 15 hrs. and permission. (2nd sem., yearly.)

495. THESIS (lto6) Staff Prereq., permission.

280 Ohio University

RADIO-TELEVISION Associate Professors Jukes. Turnbull, Baird

Assistant Professors Baxter, Greer

Instructors F. C. Johnson, Saunders

Station Engineer Tonnpklns

47. RADIO WORKSHOP— ENGINEERING SECTION* (1 or2) Jukes, Tompkins Technical work connected with radio broadcasting. Practice in con- trol room technique, remote pick-up, tape recording, transmission lines and station maintenance. Maximum credit in course, 4 hrs. Prereq., permission.

79. INTRODUCTION TO RADIO-TV (2) Baird, Greer

The development of radio and television. Attention given to Ameri- can and foreign systems, mechanics of broadcasting, FCC rules, net- works, advertising, and public service programs.

105. RADIO BROADCASTING MECHANICS (2) Jukes. Tompkins

Brief study of the apparatus used in radio broadcasting, including microphones, amplifiers, studio acoustics, control room, transmission lines, radio transmitter, and antenna. 1 lee. and 2 lab.

147. RADIO WORKSHOP* (2) Johnson

Rehearsal, performance, and technical work connected with radio broadcasting. Maximum credit in course, 4 hrs. Prereq., 6 hrs. in radio and permission.

180. RADIO SPEECH (3) Greer. Johnson

Microphone technique, pronunciation problems. Practice in reading various types of materials. 1 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., Speech 2.

225-226. RADIO PRODUCTION (3-3) Greer

Radio techniques, sources of radio material, editing and preparation of radio play scripts, use of sound effects. Practice w^ork in the Univer- sity station. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 180.

247. ADVANCED RADIO WORKSHOP* (2) Greer

Rehearsal, performance, and technical work connected with radio broadcasting. Maximum credit in course, 4 hrs. Prereq., 8 hrs. in radio, including 147.

280. RADIO-TV NEWS WRITING AND EDITING (2) Baxter

(Same as Jour. 280) The study and practice of writing and editing news for broadcasting. Students will prepare radio news from local sources and press services. Prereq., Jour. 107.

285. RADIO-TV NEWS PRACTICE (2 or 3) Baxter

(Same as Jour. 285) A laboratory course in the production of regu- lar newscasts covering both preparation of copy and the actual broad- casts of the script over WOUB and WOUI, AM and FM. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 280.

301. PRINCIPLES OF TELEVISION PRODUCTION (3) Johnson History of television, its impact upon society and other media of

communication, production aspects of television, general principles of transmission and reception. Prereq., junior standing, 10 hrs. in radio, and permission.

302. TELEVISION PRODUCTION LABORATORY (2) Johnson Laboratory experience in the production of basic television program

types. The problems of camera, audio pick-up, and floor managing as they relate to the formats of specific television productions. Prereq., 301.

•Credit in the three workshops (47, 147, 247) is limited to a total of 10 hours, with not more than 4 hours in any one.

Radio-Television 281

309. RADIO-TV ADVERTISING AND MANAGEMENT (3) Turnbuli

(Same as Jour. 309) A study of the business principles and prac- tices in the broadcasting industry, dealing with problems in radio and TV station operation, with major emphasis on time sales. Prereq., Advt. 155 or permission.

316. CONTINUITY WRITING (2) Johnson

Writing of scripts including continuity, straight and dramatized commercials, original and short sketches and stories. Prereq., 12 hrs. radio and journalism, or 12 hrs. English, and junior standing.

331. DIRECTING FOR TELEVISION (3) Greer Analysis and application of the theory and techniques of directing

for television with special attention to the problems involved in the basic formats. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 301, 302 or equivalent.

332. DRAMATIC PRODUCTION FOR TELEVISION (3) Johnson Television techniques as they apply to the dramatic form. Rehearsal,

performance, and technical work connected with the production of the dramatic script. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 301, 331, or Dram. A. 299, 350.

375. PROGRAM PLANNING AND BUILDING (3) Greer

A thorough study of all aspects of radio station operation with particular reference to programming, costs, staff, program building and series planning. Case study of a specific situation. Prereq., senior stand- ing, 225-226, 309 or equivalent.

385. RADIO AND TELEVISION IN EDUCATION (3) Johnson

The use of educational radio and television programs in the class- room and in the home. Study of the problems in broadcasting and televising high school and college courses. Practical applications in set- ting up programs. Prereq., 12 hrs. Radio-TV or 12 hrs. Education and permission.

483. SEMINAR IN RADIO AND TELEVISION (3) Jukes Individual projects and advanced research in production problems,

music, directing, writing, announcing and the evaluation of radio and television programs. Special emphasis on the problems and the poten- tialities of educational television. Prereq., 12 hrs., permission.

484. SEMINAR IN TELEVISION PRODUCTION (3) Jukes

Current literature and advanced research in television production problems. Individual reading projects and use of laboratory facilities for research of an exploratory or experimental nature. Class discussions and reports. Prereq., 301, 302, and permission.

494. RESEARCH (1-12) Staff Individual, guided research on special problems. Projects must be

approved prior to registration. Prereq., 8 hrs., permission.

495. THESIS (lto6) Staff Prereq., permission.

Suggested courses: Dramatic Art (see page 188), Speech and Speech Correction (see page 279), E.E. 103-104— Basic Electrical Engi- neering, E.E. 325 Acoustics, Mus. 5 Music Appreciation, Jour. 375 Specialized Journalism.

282 Ohio University

RESERVE OFFICERS' TRAINING CORPS

Professor James R. Patrick, Coordinator

AIR SCIENCE

Professor of Air Science: Lieutenant Colonel Moberly Assistant Professors: Captains Falkner, Irvin, Hopkins, Wooa,

Lieutenants Wiegand, Zimnnerman

Instructors and Administrative Assistants:

Master Sergeants Word, Corgill

Technical Sergeants Scarmock, Feagin, Cornele

Airman First Class Lindsay

1.2. BASIC COURSE (2,2) Staff

Introduction to the eight-semester AFROTC Program and the ad- vantages of flight training. Introduction to aviation. Fundamentals of global geography. International tensions and security structures. In- struments of national military security. Basic military and leadership training (lat)oratory). Three hours a week. Prereq., permission.

101,102. BASIC COURSE (2,2) Staff

Introduction to Air Science 101 curriculum. Elements of aerial war- fare: introduction to aerial warfare; targets, weapons, delivery aircraft. Elements of aerial warfare: the air ocean, bases, forces. Careers in the Air Force. Leadership training (laboratory). Three hours a week. Pre- req ; Basic Air Force 1, 2.

221,222. ADVANCED COURSE (3,3) Staff

Introduction to Advanced AFROTC. The Air Force commander and his staff. Problem solving techniques. Communicating in the Air Force. Instructing in the Air Force. The military justice system. Applied air science, aerodynamics and propulsion, navigation, weather. Air Force base functions. Leadership training (laboratory). Five hours a week. Prereq., completion of basic Air Force courses and selection for the Ad- vanced Air Force course.

AFROTC SUMMER CAMP (3) Camp and Air Base Staff

A four-week training program conducted on an Air Force base be- tween the junior and senior years, consisting primarily of orientation to base facilities with some classroom work to make practical application of courses covered in the freshman, sophomore and junior years and also to provide opportunity for life under military conditions.

Instruction includes physical training, familiarization flying, USAF base activity and equipment, individual weapons, drill, field exercises, air base problems. Prereq., Advanced Air Force 221, 222.

251,252. ADVANCED COURSE (3,3) Staff

Critique of summer camp. Introduction to the Advanced Course, leadership seminar. Career guidance. Military aspects of world political geography. Military aviation and the art of war. Briefing for com- missioned service. Leadership training (laboratory). Five hours a week. Prereq., 221, 222, 251.

Romance Languages 283

MILITARY SCIENCE AND TACTICS

Professor of Military Science and Tactics: Lieutenant Colonel Andrews

Assistont Professors: Major Catlin; Captains Roberts, Bellonno, Shernnan

Instructors: Sergeants Crondall, Canter, Allen, Saffle, Clem,

Eintracht, Robeysek

1,2. BASIC MILITARY SCIENCE I (2,2) Staff

Organization of the Army and ROTC, individual weapons and

marksmanship. American military history, school of the soldier and exercise of command. Three hours a week.

101,102. BASIC MILITARY SCIENCE II (2,2) Staff

Map and aerial photograph reading to include application of the basic principles; functioning and tactical use of infantry crew-served weapons; school of the soldier and exercise of command. Three hours a week. Prereq., MS 1, 2.

221,222. ADVANCED MILITARY SCIENCE III (3,3) Staff

Leadership, military teaching methods; organization, functions, and missions of the arms and services, small unit tactics and communica- tions, school of the soldier and exercise of command. Five hours a week. Prereq., two years of basic course or one year of active duty and by per- mission of the P. M. S. T.

SUMMER ROTC CAMP (3) Camp Staff

A six-week training program to be conducted at an Army post, camp or base. Summer training will supplement instruction given in Military Science courses 221, 222, 251, and 252 with practical work in weapons and marksmanship, interior guard, maps and photographs, tactical exercises, signal communications, operation under field condi- tions and specialized training. Particular emphasis is placed on the development of leadership, character and the student's capability to function effectively in small unit combat operations, as may be re- quired of any officer regardless of branch. Prereq., Advanced Military Science 221 and 222.

251,252. ADVANCED MILITARY SCIENCE IV (3,3) Staff

Command and staff, military intelligence, training management, logistics, military administration, personnel management, military jus- tice, role of the United States in world affairs, exercise of command. Prereq., Advanced Military Science 221, 222 and by permission of the P. M. S. T.

ROMANCE LANGUAGES Professors Wilkinson, Ondis

Associate Professors Renkenberger, Rice (cFiairnnan)

Assistant Professor Cameron

Instructor Bolen

Acting Instructor Kreps

The major requirement in French, Italian, or Spanish for the A.B. degree is 20 hours above course 1-2 in the language. A major in Ro- mance languages or Romance philology consists of 20 hours above course 1-2 in one language and at least one year in each of two other Romance languages.

FRENCH

1-2. BEGINNING FRENCH (4-4) Staff

Pronunciation, essentials of grammar, oral practice, and reading. (Yearly.)

284 Ohio University

101-102. INTERMEDIATE FRENCH (4-4) StafF

Conversation, composition, grammar review, and varied readings. Prereq., 2 or 2 yrs. high school French. (Yearly.)

213.214. FRENCH CONVERSATION (3.3) Bolen

Prereq., 102 or 4 yrs. high school French. (Yearly.)

243-244. FRENCH COMPOSITION (2-2) Wilkinson

Prereq., 102. (1958-59.)

301,302. SURVEY OF FRENCH LITERATURE (3,3) Renlcenberger

A general view of French literature from the beginning. Special topics for investigation by advanced students. Collateral readings and reports. Prereq., 102, or 4 yrs. high school French. (1959-60.)

303, 304. READINGS FROM FRENCH LITERATURE (3, 3) Staff

Selections vary with the needs of the class or the student. Prereq., 102. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

328. SIXTEENTH CENTURY FRENCH LITERATURE (3) Rice

Development of French thought during the Renaissance. Prereq., 6 hrs. beyond 102. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

331,332. SEVENTEENTH CENTURY FRENCH LITERATURE (3,3) Rice

Prereq., 102, or 4 yrs. high school French. (1958-59.)

335. 336. EIGHTEENTH CENTURY FRENCH LITERATURE (3, 3) Renlcenberger Prereq., 102. (1958-59.)

381. RESEARCH IN FRENCH LANGUAGE AND LITERATURE (1to4) Staff A course designed to promote independent work in the study of special linguistic and literary problems. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 12 hrs. beyond 102 and permission. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

495. THESIS {lto6) Staff

Prereq., Premission.

ITALIAN

1-2. BEGINNING ITALIAN (4-4) Staff

Pronunciation, grammar, and practice in the language.

101-102. INTERMEDIATE ITALIAN (4-4) Staff

Review of grammar and reading in modem Italian. Prereq., 2 or 2 yrs. high school Italian.

301.302. SURVEY OF ITALIAN LITERATURE (3,3) Staff

Prereq., 102. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

303,304. READINGS FROM ITALIAN LITERATURE (3,3) Staff

Selections may vary with the needs of the class. Prereq., 102. (Giveii upon sufficient demand.)

371. ADVANCED ITALIAN (lto4) Staff

Advanced work in language and literature. Maximum credit in

course, 8 hrs. Prereq., 6 hrs. beyond 102. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

495. THESIS (lto6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

Romance Languages 285

ROMANCE PHILOLOGY

325-326. GENERAL ROMANCE LINGUISTICS (2-2) Wilkinson

Introduction to graduate courses in philology. Prereq., Fr., It., Lat., or Sp. 102. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

421-422. ROMANCE PHILOLOGY (OLD FRENCH) (2.2) Ondis

Prereq., 16 hrs. in French and 16 hrs. in another Romance language or Latin. R. Philol. 326 is advised but not required. (Given upon suffi- cient demand.)

441-442. ROMANCE PHILOLOGY (OLD SPANISH) (2-2) Ondis

Prereq., 16 hrs. in Spanish and 16 hrs. in another Romance language or Latin. R. Philol. 326 is advised but not required. (Given upon suffi- cient demand.)

495. THESIS (Uo6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

SPANISH

1-2. BEGINNING SPANISH (4-4) Staff

Pronunciation, oral practice, essentials of grammar, and reading. (Yearly.)

101-102. INTERMEDIATE SPANISH (4-4) Staff

Conversation, composition, grammar review, and varied readings, Prereq., 2 or 2 yrs. high school Spanish. (Yearly.)

213,214. SPANISH CONVERSATION (3.3) Cameron

Prereq., 102.

301.302. SURVEY OF SPANISH LITERATURE (3,3) Staff

Historic and literary study of Spain from the Middle Ages to the present time. Prereq., 102. (1959-60.)

303.304. READINGS FROM SPANISH LITERATURE (3.3) Staff

Selections vary with the needs of the class and the student. Pre- req., 102. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

305.306. THE SPANISH DRAMA (3.3) Ondii

Sp. 305 traces the drama in Spain from its origins to 1700; Sp. 306, from 1700 to the present. Prereq., 102 or 4 yrs. high school Spanish. (1959-60.)

315.316. THE SPANISH NOVEL (3,3) Ondis

Sp. 315 covers the evolution of the novel in Spain from the earliest times to 1700; Sp. 316, the Spanish novel from 1700 to the present. Prereq., 102, or 4 yrs. high school Spanish. (1958-59.)

351,352. ADVANCED SPANISH GRAMMAR (3,3) Ondis

Peculiarities of Spanish grammar and syntax. Analysis of difficult texts. Free composition and oral reports. Prereq., 102, or 4 yrs. high school Spanish. (1959-60.)

381. RESEARCH IN SPANISH LANGUAGE AND LITERATURE (1 to4) Staff Prereq., 12 hrs. beyond 102 and permission. Maximum credit in courses, 6 hrs.

495. THESIS (lto6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

ROMANCE PHILOLOGY— See Romance Languages

286 Ohio University

RUSSIAN Assistant Professor Benson

1-2. BEGINNING RUSSIAN (4-4) Benson

Pronunciation, the writing system, grammar, and conversation. Simple prose. (Yearly.)

101-102. INTERMEDIATE RUSSIAN (4-4) Benson

Prose readings. Grammar review and conversation. Prereq., 2. (Yearly.)

201-202. ADVANCED RUSSIAN (2-2) Benson

Literary prose and drama. Advanced conversation, Prereq., 102. (Yearly.)

271. SPECIAL READINGS IN RUSSIAN (lto3) Benson

Assigned readings, adapted to the individual needs of the student.

Maximum credit in course, 6 hours. Prereq., 202 and permission. (Yearly.)

SCULPTURE— See Art

SECRETARIAL STUDIES Associate Professor Sponseller (chairman)

Assistant Professors Via, Appel, Weaver Instructor Murrell

15. BEGINNING TYPEWRITING (2) Via, Weaver

Development of basic skill on the typewriter and application of this skill to the more common typing practices. Achievement standard 30 words per minute. 5 hours a week; 1 hour arranged. Prereq., not open to those who have had high school typewriting.

16. INTERMEDIATE TYPEWRITING (2) Appel Development of further basic skill in the operation of the type- writer and quantity production of business forms. Achievement standard 45 words per minute. 5 hours a week; 1 hour arranged. Prereq., 15 with a scholastic average of 2.0 or one year high school typewriting.

31. BEGINNING SHORTHAND (3) Appel, Via. Weaver Theory of Gregg Simplified shorthand. Development of ability to

take dictation. Achievement standard 60 words per minute on new material. 4 hours a week. Prereq., 15 or with 15; not open to those who have had high school shorthand.

32. INTERMEDIATE SHORTHAND (3) Appel, Via, Weaver Increasing the student's ability to take dictation. Achievement

standard 80 words per minute on new material. 4 hours a week. Prereq., 31 with a scholastic average of 2.0 or one year high school shorthand; 16 or with 16.

111. ADVANCED TYPEWRITING (2) Staff

Development of speed and accuracy in the production of related typewriting office problems. Achievement standard 60 words per min- ute, 5 hours a week; 1 hour arranged. Prereq., 16 with a scholastic average of 2.0 or two years high school typewriting.

151. BEGINNING DICTATION AND TRANSCRIPTION (3) Appel, Via, Weaver Increasing dictation rates and developing transcription techniques. Achievement standards 100 words per minute on new material; 25- word-per-minute transcription rate. 5 hrs. a week. Prereq., Ill and 32 with scholastic average of 2.0 or two years high school shorthand.

Secretarial Studies 287

152. ADVANCED DICTATION AND TRANSCRIPTION (3) Appel Achievement standards 120 words per minute on new material;

35-word-per-minute transcription rate. 5 hours a week. Prereq., 151 with a scholastic average of 2.0.

153. SPECIALIZED DICTATION AND TRANSCRIPTION (3) Via Development of greater speeds and of vocabulary other than that re- quired by an ordinary business office. 5 hours a week. Prereq., 152 with a scholastic average of 2.0.

172. FILING SYSTEMS AND PROCEDURES (1) Staff

Various filing procedures and their applications. 2 hours lee. and

1 hour lab. a week. Prereq., 16.

173. MACHINE TRANSCRIPTION (1) Staff Development of skill in the use of machine transcribers. 1 hour lee.

and 2 hours lab. a week. Prereq., 16.

180. OFFICE MACHINES (2) Staff Training in the solution of the more common mathematical business

office problems on key-driven and crank-driven calculators. Instruction on accounting, dictating, and duplicating machines. 5 hours a week.

181. OFFICE PROCEDURES (2) Via Application of skills to solution of typical office problems and pro- cedures. 5 hours a week, Prereq., 180, 16, and Acct. 75.

220. BUSINESS COMMUNICATIONS (3) Sponseller

Application of English in the writing of effective business letters and reports for typical business situations. Prereq., Eng. 4, junior or senior rank.

261. TEACHING OF BUSINESS SUBJECTS (3) Appel

Principles and procedures of teaching business subjects at the secondary level with emphasis in the areas of general business education and vocational business education. Prereq., junior rank, major or minor in Business Education.

275. SECRETARIAL PRACTICE (3) Sponseller

Students spend 5 hours a week working in offices on the campus and

2 hours a week in conference. Prereq., 151, 172, 173, 181.

285. OFFICE MANAGEMENT (3) Weaver

Application of the principles of scientific management to office work and a study of the organization and work for which the office manager is responsible. Prereq., Ec. 12, junior rank, or permission.

335. COMMERCIAL CURRICULUM CONSTRUCTION (2) Appel

Principles and factors necessary in the construction of a curriculum of commercial courses in the high schools of varied communities. Pre- req., 20 hrs. commerce.

387. RESEARCH IN BUSINESS TEACHING PROBLEMS [[UoB] Weaver

Prereq., 20 hrs. commerce, senior rank, and permission.

391. SEMINAR IN BUSINESS TEACHING PROBLEMS (2-4) Weaver

Maximum credit in course, 10 hrs. Prereq., 20 hrs. commerce and permission.

437. ADMINISTRATION IN BUSINESS EDUCATION (3 to 6) Sponseller

_ Problems involved in planning, administering, and supervising a business education program in the high school. Prereq., 20 hrs. com- merce and permission.

288 Ohio University

SOCIAL SCIENCE— See General Studies

SOCIOLOGY Associafe Professors Jeddeloh, Harlan (chairman)

Assistant Professors Worstell, Eggers, Park

The courses in the Department of Sociology represent the following areas of teaching and research interest: social institutions and social change; social psychology and collective behavior; population and ecol- ogy; cultural anthropology; criminology and juvenile delinquency; and pre-professional social work.

The major requirement for the A.B. degree is a minimum of 28 semester hours, which must include the following courses: 1-2 or 101; 201-202; 301 or 303; 330; 375. In criminology and juvenile delinquency and in pre-professional social work the requirement is 34 semester hours, which must include the above courses plus 133 and 339. (See pages 111 and 113 for descriptions of these curricula.)

In fulfilling the degree requirements of the College of Arts and Sciences, it is recommended that m.ajor students register for the follow- ing courses: in the natural sciences. Zoology 3-4 and Mathematics 107; in the humanities, English 293.

SOCIOLOGY

1-2. GENERAL SOCIOLOGY (3-3) Staff

Basic introduction to the major fields of sociology. Soc. 1 deals with the nature of culture and cultural behavior, and with the characteristics of communities in primitive and modern societies. Soc. 2 deals with per- sonality development and the social conduct of the individual, and with social institutions and social change. Should be taken in sequence. Not open to juniors and seniors. (Each sem.)

101. PRINCIPLES OF SOCIOLOGY (3) Staff

A one-semester basic course for students unable to take 1 and 2, covering the same fields at a more rapid pace, with greater emphasis upon individual reading. No credit for students who have taken 1 or 2. Not open to freshmen. (Each sem.)

103. READINGS IN SOCIOLOGY (1) Staff Independent reading of selected major treatises and research mono- graphs in a specific field of sociology chosen by the student, under the guidance of a staff member. Prereq., 1 and 2, or 101. (Each sem.)

104. URBAN COMMUNITIES (3) Jeddeloh

Development of modern cities; demographic, economic, and social characteristics; ecological processes and social organization; the nature of urbanism; city planning. Prereq., 3 hrs. (2nd sem., yearly.)

105. SOCIAL ANTHROPOLOGY (3) Park Human origins, prehistoric cultures, early civilizations; contempor- ary primitive societies; major culture areas. Methods of anthropological research. Prereq., 3 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

201. ELEMENTARY RESEARCH TECHNIQUES (2) Staff

A laboratory course in the skills and procedures of scientific method in the study of society. Study design, schedule and scale construction, interview methods; graphic representation; analysis and organization of data. May be taken concurrently with 101 by upperclassmen. (1st sem., yearly.)

Sociology 289

202. FIELD STUDIES IN SOCIOLOGY (2) Staff

Planning and execution of an empirical study of interest to the stu- dent, utilizing the knowledge and skills developed in 201. Limited class meetings; conferences with instructor; formal report of study. Prereq., 201. (Yearly.)

207. EDUCATIONAL SOCIOLOGY (3) Jeddeloh

Sociological study of the school as a social institution; its relation to the community; development of the child; sociological aspects of learn- ing and teaching. Prereq., 3 hrs. or permission. (2nd sem., yearly.)

209. INTRODUCTION TO THE STUDY OF POPULATION (3) Staff Growth and distribution of population; birth and death rates; mi- gration; the labor force; control of population; demographic methods. Prereq., 6 hrs. in social sciences. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

210. SOCIAL BEHAVIOR (3) Eggers, Harlan Social-psychological development of the individual; the emergence

of role-taking abilities and self-concepts in social interaction; the func- tion of language in conduct. Prereq., 6 hrs. sociology or psychology, or H. Ec. 5 and 6. (1st sem., yearly.)

211. RACE AND CULTURE CONTACTS (3) Parle The conflict, accommodation, and assimilation of racial and ethnic

groups; individual and collective status and experience arising in the contacts of peoples of diverse cultures. Prereq., 3 hrs. sociology or 9 hrs. social sciences. (2nd sem., yearly.)

220. SOCIAL PROBLEMS (3) Jeddeloh

Intensive study of a limited number of major social problems as they affect the person, family, community, and nation. Group projects and discussions. Prereq., 6 hrs. in social sciences. (1st sem., yearly.)

229. CROWD, MASS, AND PUBLIC (3) Harlan

Individual and group behavior under conditions of social unrest and suggestibility; characteristics of these groups, their stages of develop- ment and types of action. Prereq., 6 hrs. in social sciences. (1st sem., 1958-59.)

260. MARRIAGE AND THE FAMILY (3) Eggers

The family as a basic institution in various cultures; courtship, marriage, and family relationships in American society; family disor- ganization; the development of marriage counseling. Prereq., 6 hrs. in social sciences. (1st sem., yearly.)

301. SOCIAL RESEARCH METHODS (2) Staff

Principles of scientific method; theoretical and practical problems of research design; statistical and other methods of data analysis. Should precede or be taken in conjunction with 381 or 495. Prereq., 8 hrs., and Math. 107, Stat. 155, or Educ. 381. (1st sem., 1959-60.)

303. SOCIOLOGICAL THEORY (2) Staff

Origins and development of sociology; major European and Ameri- can contributors; current trends and the status of specialized fields of interest. Prereq., 6 hrs. (2nd sem., yearly.)

307. VOLUNTARY ASSOCIATIONS (3) Harlan

The origins, social composition, and functions of informal and quasi-institutional groups such as lodges, veterans' organizations, service clubs, and sports and hobby clubs, as typical forms of association in contemporary society. Prereq., 6 hrs. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

290 Ohio Unh^ersity

311. CRIMINOLOGY AND PENOLOGY (3) Jeddeloh

An introduction to modern criminology and the correctional treat- ment of offenders. Field visits to courts and correctional institutions. Prereq., 6 hrs. (1st sem., yearly.)

315. FOLK COMMUNITIES (3) Park Comparative study of primary village communities in various so- cieties; the impact of Western technology and institutions; the dis- organization of folk cultures. Prereq., 10 hrs. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

316. CULTURE AND CIVILIZATION (3) Park Anthropological and sociological analysis of the concept "civiliza- tion" and of the transformation of social life which it represents. Con- sideration of selected civilizations outside the main course of Western history, with emphasis on their characteristic ethos and social institu- tions. Prereq., 10 hrs. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

320. INDUSTRIAL SOCIOLOGY (3) Staff Work groups and large business firms as social systems: worker- union-management relations; leadership; decision-making. Review of research in human relations in industry. Prereq., 9 hrs. in social sciences. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

321. CONTEMPORARY SOCIAL MOVEMENTS (3) Harlan Characteristics and objectives of various types of social movements;

reform and revolution; leaders, ideologies, tactics; case studies of typical movements. Prereq., 9 hrs. in social sciences. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

322. JUVENILE DELINQUENCY (3) Jeddeloh Factors associated with delinquency; characteristics of delinquents;

juvenile courts and clinics; probation, correctional training; delinquency prevention. Field visits. Prereq., 9 hrs. sociology or psychology. (2nd sem., yearly.)

325. PERSONALITY AND SOCIETY (3) Harlan Survey of current systematic knowledge of child-rearing practices

and parent-child relationships in various cultures and social classes, and of their consequences for the personality development of the child. Pre- req., 12 hrs. sociology or psychology. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

326. DYNAMICS OF INTERPERSONAL RELATIONS (2) Eggers

Analysis of epsiodes of group interaction; role-playing as an experi- mental device in the study of interpersonal relations; theories concerning the development of competence in interpersonal relations. Prereq., 210, or 9 hrs. psychology. (2nd sem., yearly.)

330. CURRENT SOCIOLOGICAL LITERATURE (1) Staff

Familiarization with the scope and types of professional literature of sociology and related fields. Professional organizations and activities; advanced training and emplojmaent requirements. Prereq., 9 hrs. (Each sem.)

336. PUBLIC OPINION AND MASS COMMUNICATIONS (3) Harlan

The processes of opinion formation; relation to public policy decisions; public opinion polls; organization and control of mass media; nature and effects of propaganda. Prereq., 9 hrs. social sciences. (2nd sem., yearly.)

Sociology 291

350. SPECIAL STUDIES IN SOCIOLOGY (1-4) Staff

Guided readings in special topics in sociology not included in the current departmental curriculum, in one or more of the following areas: a. Social Organization, b. Social Psychology, c. Collective Behavior, d. Physical Anthropology, e. Cultural Anthropology, f. Demography and Ecology, g. Criminology and Delinquency, h. Social Work. Abstracts of readings, discussions with instructor, final essay. Maximum credit in course, 4 hrs. ; in any one area, 2 hrs. Prereq., 12 hrs., permission. (Each sem.)

370. IN-SERVICE TRAINING (lto3) Staff

Individually-arranged work experience under responsibile super- vision; advance planning and departmental approval; periodic reports. Prereq., 12 hrs.; junior and senior majors. (Summer only.)

375. SENIOR SEMINAR (2) Staff

Required of all senior majors in last semester of residence. Includes comprehensive examination covering required courses and electives sub- mitted for major. Prereq., 28 hrs. completed or in progress. (2nd sem., yearly.)

381. RESEARCH PROBLEMS IN SOCIOLOGY (lto3) Staff

Individual research; may be coordinated with other student or staff research. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Prereq., 12 hrs. and per- mission. (Each sem.)

470. INTERNSHIP (3 to 6) Staff

Full-time placement for research and training in positions in juven- ile courts, business and industrial firms, governmental agencies, etc. 3-6 months. Prereq., candidacy for M.A. degree. (Yearly.)

491. SEMINAR (3) Staff

Topic announced each term. Maximum credit in course, 6 hrs. Pre- req., 15 hrs.

495. THESIS (lto6) Staff

Prereq., permission.

SOCIAL WORK

102. THE SOCIAL SECURITY SYSTEM (2) Worstell and others

Historical development and current provisions of the Social Security Act and other income security programs as established by law, and their significance in contemporary American life; comparisons with the social security systems of other nations. (Each sem.)

133. SOCIAL WORK IN THE AMERICAN COMMUNITY (3) Worstell

A survey of the social services as they are administered through public and voluntary agencies, including historical and philosophical growth and development. Field trips and individual projects arranged. Prereq., 3 hrs. (Each sem.)

234. CHILD WELFARE (3) Worstell

Legislation regarding child care and protection; services for chil- dren in their own homes, foster homes, and institutions. Case materials illustrating services and resources. Prereq., 133, or 6 hrs. psychology, home economics, or education. (Each sem.)

248. SOCIAL GROUP WORK (2) Worstell

Principles, methods, and types of group work; agencies sponsoring group work programs. Student responsible for participation or leadei*- ship in a group work project. Prereq., 133. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

292 Ohio University

250. COMMUNITY PLANNING FOR SOCIAL WELFARE (2) Worstell

The planning, organization, and development of welfare services in the community; operation and functions of community chests, councils of social agencies, and similar organizations. Prereq., 133. (2nd sem., 1959-60.)

339. INTRODUCTION TO SOCIAL CASE WORK (3) Worstell

The development of social case work; analysis of basic principles; problems and methods as seen in theoretical and case material. Prereq., 133, 234, and specific consent of the instructor. (Each sem.)

341. FIELD SERVICES (2) Worstell

In-service observation of agency functions and methods; assignment to specific work responsibilities; conferences with training supervisor. Two afternoons each week. Maximum credit in course, 4 hrs. Prereq., 339 and specific consent of the instructor. (Each sem.)

SPANISH See Romance Languages

SPEECH AND SPEECH AND HEARING THERAPY

Professors Stoats, Kontner, Andersch, A. C. LoFollette

Associate Professor Jukes

Assistant Professors C. Lane, Wiseman, Hohne, Penson,

Ludlunn, Catolono, Wotkins, Ham, Greer

Instructors Trisolini, Reyes, F. C. Johnson,

Boros, Feidner, Saunders

Part-time Instructor C. L. Lane

SPEECH

1. FUNDAMENTALS OF SPEECH (1) Andersch, Staff

Study and practice of basic techniques for eifective participation in everyday speaking situations. 1 lee. and 1 lab.

2. VOICE AND ARTICULATION (2) La Foliette, Staff

Designed to help each student discover and remedy his vocal and articulatory problems. Group drills and individual instruction. Special attention given to pronunciation problems.

3. PUBLIC SPEAKING (2) Stoats, Staff

Principles of public speaking. Practice in presenting short informa- tive, entertaining, and persuasive speeches with emphasis upon intellec- tual and emotional adjustments to speaking situations. Prereq., 1 or pro- ficiency test.

25. PRINCIPLES OF ARGUMENTATION (2) Stoats, Wiseman, Ludium, Wotkins Analysis of the debate proposition, preparation of the brief, study of evidence, and class debates.

34. ORAL INTERPRETATION OF LITERATURE

(3) Hahne, Cotalono, Trisolini, Reyes Techniques in interpretation, development of adequate intellectual and emotional responsiveness to the meaning of literature; study of literature adapted to oral interpretation; drill in reading aloud; prepa- ration of programs. Prereq., 2 or 3.

Speech and Speech and Hearing Therapy 293

104. BASES OF SPEECH (3) Kantner

Scope, purposes and interrelationships of the component areas in the general field of speech. The physiological, phonetic, psychological and semantic bases of speech. Prereq., Sophomore standing; major in Dramatic Art and Speech.

110. PARLIAMENTARY PROCEDURE (1) Stoats, Ludlum

Prereq., 1 or proficiency test.

112. ADVANCED PUBLIC SPEAKING (2) Wiseman, Ludlum

Extended study and application of the principles of public speaking

with emphasis on content and organization. Preparation and delivery of

various types of speeches of substantial length. Prereq., 3 or permission.

147. WORKSHOP IN SPEECH (1 or2) Staff

A. Public Address. Preparation and delivery of speeches and read- ings for local, state and national contests and/or intercollegiate debate. Maximum credit in course, 6 hours. Prereq., permission.

B. Choric Interpretation. Application of the principles of oral in- terpretation to group presentation. Laboratory experience. Maximum credit in course, 2 hours. Prereq., 34.

205. DYNAMICS OF GROUP DISCUSSION (3) Wiseman

Study and practice of the principles and techniques of group dis- cussion as an integral part of the democratic pattern of living. Empha- sis on the functions of discussion in public relations and as a method of instruction.

260. TEACHING OF HIGH SCHOOL DRAMATICS AND SPEECH (3) Andersch Organization of curricular and co-curricular speech and dramatic activities; analysis of available materials; methods of casting, staging, and producing plays; problems in the coaching of debate and oratory. Prereq., junior standing, major or minor in dramatic art and speech.

303. ADVANCED ORAL INTERPRETATION (3) Trisolini, Hahne

A study of the principles of types of literature from the standpoint of the oral interpreter. Emphasis on the development of skill in the interpretation of various forms of poetry, prose, and dramatic literature. Prereq., 34.

305. PROBLEM SOLVING THROUGH GROUP DISCUSSION (3) Wiseman

Social responsibility, ethical problems and standards; application of the principles of general semantics and group dynamics; purposes, types, and methods of discussion; frequent class practice. Prereq., junior standing.

309. CLASSICAL RHETORICAL THEORY (3) Staats

The principles of rhetoric based upon the theories of Aristotle, Cicero, Quintilian, and Adams. Speeches of eminent orators are analyzed. Prereq., F. A. 203-204 or permission.

325. DIRECTION OF FORENSIC PROGRAMS (3) Wiseman, Ludlum

Organization of forensic programs in high schools and colleges, management of inter-school contests and tournaments, coaching of de- bate, discussion and individual events, and principles of judging. Prac- tical application in the university forensic program. Prereq., 25, 305 or equivalent.

294 Ohio University

333. ORAL INTERPRETATION OF DRAMATIC LITERATURE (3) Trisolini

A study of the principles of drama from the standpoint of the oral interpreter. Special emphasis on the modern period from Ibsen and Chekov to the present. Prereq., Speech 34, 303, or Dram. Art 339.

349. RHETORICAL CRITICISM (3) Watkins

Theories and critical methods of Plutarch, Cicero, Goodrich, Brougham and selected modern writers. Application through original critiques of selected speeches. Prereq., 12 hrs., including 309, or equival- ent.

401. INTRODUCTION TO GRADUATE WORK (3) Kan+ner

Men, movements, and professional literature in the field of speech. Conduct of research and selection of a thesis problem.

412. ADVANCED SPEECH COMPOSITION AND DELIVERY (3) Staafs

Advanced study of content, organization, composition and delivery of lecture-length speeches. Prereq., 112, 309, or equivalent.

440. APPLICATIONS OF GENERAL SEMANTICS TO SPEECH (3) V\^iseman

The chief formulations from general semantics which underlie the synthesis of communication methodologies and personal integration through com.munication will be presented. Special emphasis on the ap- plication of these principles to the field of speech. Prereq., 10 hours of speech or permission.

462. SPEECH AND HIGHER EDUCATION (3) Andersch

Philosophy and function of speech as an academic discipline, re- lationships to other areas of study, inter-relationships of various areas within the field, problems in the teaching of speech at the college level. Required of all graduate students in speech. Prereq., 18 hrs.

471. AMERICAN PUBLIC ADDRESS (3) Stoats The history of public address in America from colonial times to

the present. Analysis of selected speeches. Practice in the organization, composition and delivery of speeches of substantial length. Prereq., 112, F. A. 203-204 or equivalent.

472. BRITISH AND FRENCH PUBLIC ADDRESS (3) Watkins

A study of the pulpit and political orators of the French revolution- ary period and the British parliamentary orators of the 18th and early 19th centuries. Prereq., 309 or equivalent.

475. GREEK, ROMAN AND PATRISTIC PUBLIC ADDRESS (3) Stoats

Historical and cultural aspects of public address in the Greek, Ro- man and Patristic periods. Outstanding speakers and speeches of each period analyzed in terms of the issues of the time. Prereq., A knowledge of the history of the periods studied is essential. F. A. 203-204, speech 309, Hist. 115 or 120 or equivalent.

485. CONTEMPORARY STUDIES IN PUBLIC ADDRESS (3) Ludlum

Review of selected studies in public address and communication emphasizing the experimental and descriptive methods and the more significant findings of comtemporary research. Prereq., 12 hrs., 401.

490. SEMINAR IN PUBLIC ADDRESS (3) Stoots, Wiseman

Advanced study in the history of public address, rhetorical theory, or rhetorical criticism and speech analysis. Class discussions and re- ports. Prereq., 309 or 471, or equivalent.

Speech and Speech and Hearing Therapy 295

491. SEMINAR IN SPEECH EDUCATION (2 or 3) Andersch

Problems in the teaching of basic speech courses at the college level,

evolution of the speech curriculum. Assigned problems. Prereq., 15 hrs.

494. RESEARCH (1-12) Staff Individual, guided research on special problems. Projects must be

approved prior to registration. Pi'ereq., 8 hrs., permission.

495. THESIS (lto6) Staff Prereq., permission.

Additional course: F.A. 203-204 History of Oratory. See also courses listed under Dramatic Art on page 196 and Radio- TV on page 280.

SPEECH AND HEARING THERAPY

4. REMEDIAL SPEECH (lto2) La Follette. Staff

The Speech and Hearing Clinic is equipped and staffed to aid stu- dents in overcoming special speech problems. Instruction and supervised remedial practice are offered for individuals and small groups. Enroll- ment with permission at any time up to four weeks prior to the end of the semester. Not to be counted in hours for graduation.

194. SPEECH CORRECTION FOR THE CLASSROOM TEACHER (3) Boros Nature, causes, and treatment of defective speech in the public

schools with special reference to the role of the regular classroom teacher. Open to majors in elementary education; others by permission. Not open to majors in dramatic art and speech.

195. PRINCIPLES OF SPEECH CORRECTION (3) Ham The nature, symptoms, causes, etiology, and diagnosis of disorders

of speech and voice. Emphasis on methods and techniques in the correc- tion of common speech defects. Prereq., 6 hrs.. Psych. 1 or 5, or per- mission.

247. CLINICAL PRACTICE IN SPEECH CORRECTION

(1 or 2) LaFollette, Penson, Ham Supervised clinical practice with children or adults in the University Speech and Hearing Clinic. Maximum credit in course, 4 hrs. Prereq., 307, 310, 320, permission.

262. SPEECH AND HEARING THERAPY IN PUBLIC SCHOOLS (2) Ham, Boros Methods, organization, and implementation of speech and hearing programs in the public schools. Must be taken concurrently with Student Teaching. Prereq., 307.

307. CLINICAL METHODS (3) Ham

Basic orientation to speech therapy. Observation of children with normal and defective speech. Clinical work in the school situation and in the Children's Speech Clinic. Prereq., 6 hrs., including 195.

310. SPEECH PATHOLOGY (3) LaFollette

Anatomy of the vocal mechanism and study of organic speech dis- orders, such as stuttering, aphasia, cleft, palate speech, spastic speech, and speech of the hard of hearing. Prereq., 195.

312. PHONETICS (3) Kantner

The study of speech sounds from a sociological, physiological, and acoustical point of view. Mastery of the international phonetic alphabet. Training in phonetic transcription. Prereq., 6 hrs. or permission.

296 Ohio University

319. AUDIOMETRY AND SPEECH AND HEARING PROBLEMS (3) LaFollette Techniques of audiometric testing with clinical practice; interpre- tation of audiograms, criteria for educational placement and referral; principles of hearing aid selection; public school hearing conservation programs. Prereq., 6 hrs., or equivalent of 6 hrs., and permission.

320. ADVANCED CLINICAL METHODS (3) LaFollette Methods in speech correction for adults; survey of current litera- ture; clinical experience with adults in such problems as articulatory disorders, stuttering, aphasia, cerebral palsy, cleft palate and loss of hearing. Prereq., 10 hrs., including 310.

323. LIP READING (3) LaFollette

The basic principles of understanding language by observing the speaker's lips and facial expression. Emphasis on both theory and prac- tice of speech reading. Special attention given to teaching methods Prereq., 6 hrs.

335. DIAGNOSTIC PROCEDURES IN SPEECH AND HEARING THERAPY

(3) Ham The role of diagnosis in speech and hearing therapy; conducting the speech examination; the nature, purpose, administration and interpre- tation of the more important diagnostic tests and procedures related to the speech problem. Preparation of the case history. Prereq., 320 or with 320.

345. STUHERING AND PSYCHOGENETIC DISORDERS OF SPEECH

(3) Penson

A detailed study of literature in the field with emphasis on the

nature, causes, development, and treatment of stuttering and other

speech defects with psychogenic implications. Extensive case studies.

Prereq., senior majors, 310, 320 or with 320.

392. SPEECH SCIENCE (3) Penson

Structure and function of the mechanism for speech and hearing. Anatomical, physiological and neurological considerations. Laboratory projects. Prereq., senior majors or graduate students.

405. CLINICAL PROGRAMS IN SPEECH AND HEARING THERAPY

(3) LaFollette Organization and administration of clinical programs in speech and hearing therapy. Administrative structures, services, professional stan- dards and underlying philosophies in speech and hearing clinics, both public and private. Prereq., 310, 319, 320.

455. LANGUAGE FOR THE DEAF AND HARD OF HEARING (3) LaFollette

Stage by stage instruction for the teaching of speech to deaf and hard of hearing children of all ages. Consideration of basic problems, specific techniques and special equipment. Students with severe hearing losses may audit this course by special permission without the pre- requisites. Prereq., 307, 319 323 or equivalent.

465. LANGUAGE PROBLEMS OF THE BRAIN INJURED (3) Ham

Consideration of the neurological basis, pathological causes and speech and psychological implications of cerebral palsy, aphasia, and other types of brain injury, together with methods of therapy. Prereq., 310, 320, 392, or with 392.

Statistics 297

476. RESEARCH DESIGN IN SPEECH SCIENCE (3) Penson

Scope and philosophy of speech science. Instrumentation, research designs, areas of research and significant findings in selected contemp- orary studies. Group or individual research projects in speech pathology, audiology and phonetics. Prereq., 392.

492. SEMINAR IN SPEECH CORRECTION (3) Penson, LaFollette

Current literature and advanced research in the field of speech cor- rection. Individual reading projects. Class reports and discussions. Pre- req., 12 hrs., including 195.

494. RESEARCH (1-12) Staff Individual, guided research on special problems. Projects must be

approved prior to registration. Prereq., permission, 8 hrs.

495. THESIS OR DISSERTATION (1 to 6 for thesis) Staff Prereq., permission.

See also courses listed under Dramatic Art on page 196 and Radio- TV on page 280.

STATISTICS Associate Professor Solfow (chairman)

155. BUSINESS STATISTICS (4) Soltow

Elementary statistical methods used in business. 3 lee, and 3-hour lab. Prereq., Ec. 12 or 102 and Math. 3 and 34 or Math. 5 and 6.

271. ANALYSIS OF STATISTICAL DATA (3) Soltow

Study of reports and forecasts of business firms, bureaus, and agencies. Application of statistical methods of specific problems. Pre- req., 155.

303. VARIABLES (3) Staff

The application of sampling theory to industrial operations. A course in industrial statistics especially recommended for students in- terested in production control. Prereq., 155.

341. BUSINESS CYCLES (3) Staff

A study of the nature, causes, and theory of the business cycle to- gether with a survey of techniques of description and control. Prereq., 155 or with 155.

345. FORECASTING (3) Staff

The theory of predicition of social data and the theory of business forecasting with special reference to economic conditions and the busi- ness cycle. Prereq., 155 or with 155.

381. RESEARCH IN BUSINESS STATISTICS (1to8) Staff

Prereq., 18 hrs. commerce including 155 and permission.

391. SEMINAR IN BUSINESS STATISTICS (2to4) Staff

Maximum credit in course, 10 hrs. Prereq., 18 hrs. commerce in- cluding 155 and permission.

Additional course: Math. 326 Theory of Statistics.

298 Ohio University

ZOOLOGY Professors Elliotf, Frey (chairman), Stehr

Associate Professors Rowles, Seibert, Lawrence Assistant Professors McQuate, Southwick, W. Peterson, Vallowe

Instructor Tullis

The major requirement for the A.B. degree is a minimum of 24 hours in approved departmental courses; for the B.S. degree, a mini- mum of 24 to 30 hours. These courses must include Zool. 3-4, 107, 120 or 121, 235 or 305. In addition, the following extra-departmental courses are required : Chem. 1-2 or 3-4, Math. 5 or 9, or 107 (medical technology majors have no requirement in mathematics), Phil. 110 or 209 or other approved course in philosophy. Premedical students are urged to elect Math. 9 and 10 (see page 107) and to include these courses as part of the freshman program. Students who substitute a year in medical or dental school for the senior year are credited with 8 hours on the major for the A.B. degree and 10 hours on the B.S. degree. Those who complete the affiliated training in medical technology at Mount Carmel Hospital are credited with 32 hours toward the B.S. degree.

Curricula are outlined by the College of Arts and Sciences for stu- dents preparing for medicine, dentistry, physical therapy, and medical technology (see pages 107, 104, 111 and 106). Students who wish to teach and to complete requirements for the A.B. or B.S. degrees v/ith a major in zoology, may meet requirements for certification for teaching.

3. PRINCIPLES OF ZOOLOGY (3) Staff

Elementary physiology and anatomy of a living organism to illus- trate principles of life: metabolism, growth, reproduction, and heredity. 2 lee. and 2 lab. (Each semester). No credit if student has had Biol. 1, 2.

4. PRINCIPLES OF ZOOLOGY (3) Staff

A survey of the important animal phyla to illustrate major biologi- cal principles; the relationships of animals and their environment; the doctrine of evolution as the underlying principle. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Pre- req., 3. (Each semester.) No credit if student has had Biol. 1, 2.

103. READINGS IN BIOLOGY (1) Stehr

A course for students interested in advances in biological fact and thought, especially as applied to the field of human affairs. Prereq., 4, or Biol. 2, or high school biology. (Each semester.)

107. PRINCIPLES OF HEREDITY (3) McQuate, Tullis An introduction to the fimdamental principles of heredity and var- iation. Practical applications to animal and plant breeding, human heredity, and race betterment. Prereq., 4, or Biol. 2, or 6 hrs. botany (1st S6m., yearly.)

108. ELEMENTARY LABORATORY GENETICS (2) McQuate, Tullis

Breeding experiments primarily with Drosophila designed to illus- trate the principles of heredity. 4 lab. Prereq., 107. (2nd sem., yearly.)

113. BIOLOGY OF VERTEBRATES (4) Seibert

A study of vertebrate animals, other than birds, including classifi- cation, life histories, and other pertinent topics. Identification of mu- seum collection with emphasis on Ohio specimens; collecting and pre- serving techniques; field work. 2 lee, 4 lab., and field v^^ork. Prereq., 4. (1st sem., yearly.)

Zoology 299

H8. ORNITHOLOGY (3) Seibert

A study of birds and bird biology, including classification, migra- tion, general anatomy and physiology, life histories, and economic values. Emphasis on field identification. 2 lee. and 2 lab., or field work. Prereq., 4, or Biol. 2. (2nd sem., yearly.)

120. COMPARATIVE VERTEBRATE ANATOMY (4) Elliott A comparative study of body systems of vertebrates, with labor- atory work covering various type forms. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 4. (2nd sem., yearly.)

121. ELEMENTS OF ANATOMY (3) Southwick Course for majors in zoology other than premedical and predental

students. Particular emphasis is given to a study and dissection of the head, thorax, and abdomen of the mammal. Illustrated by dissection of a cat. 2 lee. and 2 lab. Prereq., 4. (1st sem., yearly.)

133-134. ANATOMY, KINESIOLOGY, AND PHYSIOLOGY

(4-4) Rowles, Vallowe, Trepp

(Same as P.E. 133-134) Course for majors in physical education

and athletics. All body systems are studied with particular emphasis on

the skeleton, joints, and muscles, including physiology of exercise and

muscular movements of body. Prereq., 3. (Yearly.)

216. ANIMAL COMMUNITIES (4) Seibert

A study of animals in relation to their surroundings. Discussion of the general principles governing animal distribution and animal com- munities. 2 lee. and 4 lab. or field work. Prereq., 4. (2nd sem., yearly.)

219. GENERAL ENTOMOLOGY (4) Stehr

A study of the structure, habits, and life histories of insects, with

practice in collecting, mounting, and identification. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 4. (1st sem., yearly.)

225. ANIMAL MICROTECHNIC (1 or 2) Peterson

The principles and methods of preparing animal material for micro- scopic study. Practice in fixing, embedding, sectioning, staining, and mounting tissues. Principles of the microscope and its accessories. 1 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 4, junior or senior rank. (1st sem., yearly.)

235. ELEMENTS OF PHYSIOLOGY (4) Rowles

Functions of various tissues and organs of mammals as applied particularly to the human organism. Recommended for home economics majors and zoology majors other than premedical and predental stu- dents. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 4, or 3 and 6 hrs. home economics. (2nd sem., yearly.)

241. ELEMENTARY BACTERIOLOGY (4) Lawrence

Morphology and physiology of bacteria, staining reactions, prepara- tion of media and the biochemical reactions resulting from bacterial activity. Bacteriology majors are referred to Zool. 311. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 4 or Biol. 2, or 6 hrs. botany or 8 hrs. chemistry. (Each se- mester.)

245. CLINICAL TECHNIC (2) Frey

The theoi'y and practice of making various tests used in laboratories of clinical pathology with emphasis on hematology. Prei-eq., 311 and per- mission. (Each semester.)

301. MAMMALIAN ANATOMY (4) Elliott

The anatomy of mammals with particular emphasis on the cat. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 120. (1st sem., yearly.)

300 Ohio University

302. VERTEBRATE EMBRYOLOGY (4) Peterson

All phases of vertebrate development are considered, and particular emphasis in laboratory is given to the chick and pig. 2 lee. and 6 lab. Prereq., 120. (2nd sem., yearly.)

304. HISTOLOGY (4) Southwick A study of the fundamental body tissues of vertebrates followed by

a study of the histology of the various body systems. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 120 or 121. (2nd sem., yearly.)

305. PRINCIPLES OF PHYSIOLOGY (4) Rowles Physio-chemical composition of living material; properties of solu- tions, membranes and enzymes; physiology of various body systems. Not open for graduate credit to students majoring in physiology. 2 lee. and 6 lab. Prereq., 120 or 121, Chem. 2 or 4. (Organic chemistry valuable. (1st sem., yearly.)

308. PHYSIOLOGY OF EXERCISE (2) Rowles An analysis of the manner in which the various organs of the body

meet the requirements of physical activity as related to oxygen debt, fatigue, efficiency, diet, age, sex, body type, race, altitude, and environ- mental temperature. Course designed for majors and graduate students in physiology, physical education and athletics. Prereq., Zool. 134, or 120 or 121 and 235 or 305. (2nd sem., yearly.)

309. BIOLOGICAL CHEMISTRY (4) Rowles Introduction to physical chemistry of true and colloidal solutions;

principles of enzyme action; chemistry of and tests for: carbohydrates, proteins, fats; digestion and metabolism; chemical analysis of: blood, bile, milk, urine. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 4 hrs. physiology, Chem. 113 and 117. (1st sem., yearly.)

311. GENERAL BACTERIOLOGY (4) Frey A study of the structure, classification, and relationships of bac- teria; preparation of cultures, staining, and biochemical reactions. Not open for graduate credit to majors in bacteriology. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Pre- req., 4 and Chem. 113 or 201. (Each semester.)

312. PATHOGENIC BACTERIOLOGY (4) Lawrence Microorganisms in relation to diseases. A study of disease manifes- tations, methods of transmission, means of protection and immunity. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 311. (1st sem., yearly.)

314. MICROBIOLOGICAL TECHNICS (2) Frey, Lawrence

A practical course designed to give the student extensive experience in the use of bacteriological technics and equipment. 4 lab. Prereq., 311 or 241 and organic chemistry. (1st sem., yearly.)

316. ANIMAL PARASITES (4) Lawrence

A study of parasites in relation to human disease. Parasites infest- ing man, their life histories, the diseases they produce, and means of prevention. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 10 hrs. and permission. (2nd sem., yearly.)

317. ADVANCED GENERAL BACTERIOLOGY (4) Lawrence A study of bacteria as living systems. Subjects considered will in- clude: growth requirements, enzyme systems, intermediary and end products formed, influence of environmental factors and bacterial tax- onomy. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 311 or 241 and organic chemistry. (2nd sem., yearly.)

Zoology 301

320. ADVANCED ENTOMOLOGY (4) Stehr

Study of insect morphology and the principles of insect classification and identification, with emphasis on the more extensive orders. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 219. (2nd sem., 1958-59.)

325-326. INVERTEBRATE ZOOLOGY (4-4) Stehr

A study of the structure, relationships, and life histories of repre- sentative members of the various invertebrate phyla, together vdth re- lated general principles. 2 lee. and 4 lab. Prereq., 10 hrs. and permission. (1959-60.)

327. ANIMAL ECOLOGY (4) Seiberf

A study of the effect of environment on animals; the role of temper- ature, moisture, gases, photoperiod, metabolism, osmotic regulation on ecological distribution; physiological and structural adaptations. Experi- mental methods in field and laboratory. 2 lee. and 4 lab. or field work. Prereq., 216. (1st sem. 1959-60.)

343. BIOLOGICAL STUDIES ( Uo 4 a semester in any of the following areas)

Semi-independent studies under the guidance of the instructor. Max- imum credit in any one area, 8 hrs. Prereq., 10 hrs. and permission.

a. Bacteriology studies in water, dairy, and pathogenic bacteri- ology; serology and advanced technic. Frey, Lawrence.

b. Ecology field and laboratory studies of the relation between animals and their surroundings. Seibert, Southwick, Stehr.

c. Entomology classification, structure, life histories, and economic aspects of insects. Stehr.

d. Genetics breeding experiments, pedigree analysis and library work in the field of heredity. McQuate, Tullis.

e. Invertebrate Zoology classification, structure, embryology, and life history of invertebrates. Peterson, Stehr.

f. Parasitology animal parasites. Lawrence, Peterson.

g. Physiological Zoology physiological and related experimental studies. Vallowe, Rowles.

h. Readings in Biology readings dealing with biological history, theory, and advances. Stehr.

i. Technician's Methods technic and theory of blood, urine, gas- tric analysis, fecal examination, and serological methods. Frey.

j. Vertebrate Anatomy gross and microscopic anatomy, embryol- ogy, histological technic. Elliott, Peterson.

k. Vertebrate Zoology classification, life history studies. Seibert, Vallowe.

413. BACTERIOLOGICAL REVIEW (2) Frey

An advanced theoretical course in bacteriology. Special reference is made to dissociation, bacterial growth curves, anaerobiasis, oxidation and reduction, and bacterial metabolism. Prereq., 12 hrs. bactei'iology and permission. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

415. PHYSIOLOGICAL REVIEWS (2) Rowles

An advanced lecture and conference course, involving literature re- view in various specialized phases of physiology and biological chem- istry. Prereq., 8 hours of physiology and biological chemistry and per- mission. (Given upon sufficient demand.)

302 Ohio University

485. RESEARCH IN BIOLOGY (lto4) Staff

Research work in all areas listed under 343. This course fulfills

the thesis requirement. Maximum credit in course, 4 hrs. Prereq., 20

hrs. and permission.

MEDICAL TECHNOLOGY

Mount Carmei Hospital Staff: H. B. Davidson, M. D. Director The following courses are offered at Mount Carmei Hospital, Col- umbus, Ohio. See curriculum on page 106.

291. URINALYSIS Four weeks (3) The physical, chemical, and microscopic study of urine.

292. HEMATOLOGY Eight weeks (5) Total red and white blood counts, hemoglobin determinations, differ- ential counts of white blood cells, sedimentation rates, blood typing, and blood cross-matching.

293. BACTERIOLOGY. SEROLOGY, AND PARASITOLOGY Eight weeks (11) Review of medical bacteriology with particular emphasis upon and

reference to methods of recognition and detection of types of bacteria; methods in which blood serum can be used in recognition and diagnosis of disease; review of parasites pathogenic to man; methods of examin- ing feces; microscopic and bacteriologic study of sputum.

294. CHEMISTRY Thirteen weeks (8) A study of the methods of blood chemistry determinations; methods

of gastric analysis and the more complicated chemical procedures for urine and other body products.

295. HISTOLOGIC TECHNIC Six weeks (4) Review of fundamental procedures in the preparation of tissue for

microscopic examination; study of special stains commonly used in microscopic examination of human tissue; experience in handling, on a routine basis, large amounts of human tissue for microscopic study.

296. BASAL METABOLISM AND ELECTROCARDIOGRAPHY Two weeks (1) Study of the methods of determining the basal metabolic rate, a

study of the electrocardiograph and methods of taking electrocardio- graphic tracings.

OFFICERS OF THE UNIVERSITY

(As of December 1, 1957)

Board of Trustees

General Administrative

In the Colleges

Administrative Assistants

Committees

Emeriti

Instruction

Staff

OFFICERS OF THE UNIVERSITY

BOARD OF TRUSTEES

Term Expires

H. E. Frederick, Marysville 1958

Harvey B. Jordan, Pittsburgh 1959

John W, Galbreath, Columbus 1960

Fred H. Johnson, Columbus 1961

Gordon K. Bush, Athens 1962

Joseph B. Hall, Cincinnati 1963

C. Don McVay, Athens 1964

OFFICERS OF THE BOARD OF TRUSTEES

John W. Galbreath Chairman

Fred H. Johnson Vice Chairman

Paul R. O'Brien Secretary

COMMIHEES OF THE BOARD OF TRUSTEES*

Athletics and Public Relations McVay, Frederick, Bush

Executive Johnson, Bush, Jordan, Hall

Faculty Relations Hall, Frederick, McVay

Finance Jordan, Johnson, McVay

Inter-University Relations Bush, Hall, Johnson, Frederick

Library Frederick, Hall, Jordan

Planning, Building, and Land Purchase Bush, Johnson, McVay, Jordan

•The President of the University and the Secretary of the Board are ex-officio members of all committees. The first person listed is Chairman.

304

General Administrative Officers 305

GENERAL ADMINISTRATIVE OFFICERS

John Calhoun Baker, M.B.A., D.C.S., LL.D, President of the

University Cutler Hall

Erma Irene Anderson, M.S.Ed. Assistant Dean of Women

McGuffey Hall

Burton Staley Andrews, B.S.Ed., Lieutenant Colonel, Infantry

Professor of Military Science and Tactics Carnegie Hall

Richard Lowell Bitters, B.S.J Director of Press Relatione

Cutler Hall

Janice Battin Bexler, B.S.Ed. Director of the Ohio University Center

Ohio University Center

Bernard Ralph Black, Ed.D. Assistant Dean of the University

College Cutler Hall

Martha Essman Cleveland, B.S.S.S Executive Assistant in the

Office of the President Cutler Hall

Gilford White Crowell, Ed.D. Director of the Center for Educational

Services, and Acting Director of the Slimmer Session and University Extension Wilson Hall

Joseph Harrison Dando, A.B. Director of Men's Residence Halls

Jefferson Hall

Margaret Keehne Davis, A.M. Director of Residence Services

McGuffey Hall

Margaret Mary Deppen, M.S. Dean of Women

McGuffey Hall

Brandon Tad Grover, B.S.Ed. Assistant to the President

Cutler Hall

Albert Carl Gubitz, A.M. Dean of the Ohio University Branches and

Director of the Bureau of Appointments Cutler Hall

James Robert Heady, B.S.C. Director of Non-Academic Personnel

Ewing Hall

306 Ohio Univeiesity

Martin Luther Hecht, Jr., B.S.C. Alumni Secretary

Cutler Hall

William Henry Herbert, A.M. Purchasing Agent

Service and Storage Building

Arthur Maurel Hunkins, A.M Dean of Men

McGuffey Hall

Myron Albert Hutcheson, B.S.J Director of Student Financial Aids

McGuffey Hall

Robert Hanna Jones Superintendent of Buildings and Grounds

Ewing Hall

Vincent Joseph Jukes, A.M Director of Radio, Television,

and Audio-Visual Services, and Coordinator of Veterans Affairs 29 South College

David Neal EIeller, B.S.J., M.S. Editor of "The Ohio Alumnus"

Cutler Hall

Luverne Frederick Lausche, B.S. Business Manager

Ewing Hall

James Henry Lochary, M.Ed Assistant Dean of Men

McGuffey Hall

Robert Ernst Mahn, A.M. Registrar and University Editor

Ewing Hall

Robert Edward Matson, M.Ed Assistant Dean of Men

McGuffey Hall

Frederick Hotchkiss McKelvey, Ed.D Director of the Summer

Session and University Extension (on leave) Wilson Hall

Caleb Powers Moberly, M.L., Lieutenant Colonel, Air Force Professor

of Air Science Carnegie Hall

Paul Raymond O'Brien, A.B.C. Treasurer

Ewing Hall

James Ruey Patrick, Ph.D. R.O.T.C. Coordinator

Carnegie Hall

Anthony Martin Reis, B.S.C. Director of Housing

McGuffey Hall

Bertram Allison Renkenberger, Ph.D. Adviser to Foreign Students

29 South College

Administrative Officers in the Colleges 307

Edward Eugene Rhine, B.F.A., Assistant to the Dean of the

Ohio University Branches Cutler Hall

Eleonora Louise Schmidt, M.D. Director of the Health Service

Health Center

Edward Alex Sudnick, M.S.Ed. Assistant to the Director of

Admissions and University Examiner Cutler Hall

Carroll Curtis Widdoes, A.B. Director of the Division of

Physical Education and Athletics Men's Gymnasium

Clark Emerson Williams, A.B. Director of Admissions, and

University Examiner Cutler Hall

Walter Woodman Wright, S.B., B.S.L.S. Librarian

Edwin Watts Chubb Library

ADMINISTRATIVE OFFICERS IN THE COLLEGES

Donald Roop Clippinger, Ph.D., LL.D. Dean of the Graduate College

Cutler Hall

Rush Elliott, Ph.D. Dean of the College of Arts and Sciences

Cutler Hall

Francis Newell Hamblin, Ed.D. Dean of the College of Education

Cutler Hall

Karl H. Krauskopf, Ph.D. Acting Dean of the College of Comanerce

Copeland Hall

Gaige Brue Paulsen, Ph.D. Dean of the University College

Cutler Hall

Earl Covert Seigfred, Ph.D. Dean of the College of Fine Arts

Cutler Hall

Edwin James Taylor, Jr., M.S. Dean of the College of Applied

Science Engineering Building

Karl Ahrendt, Ph.D. Director of the School of Music

Music Hall

Loren Joseph Hortin, A.M., Litt.D. Director of the School of

Journalism Copeland Hall

Claude Edgar Kantner, Ph.D. Director of the Scliool of Dramatic

Art and Speech Speech Building

308 Ohio University

Frederick Darwin Leach, Ph.D. Director of the School of Painting

and Allied Arts EUis Hall

VrviAN Mae Roberts, Ph.D. Director of the School of Home

Economics Agriculture and Household Arts Building

ADMINISTRATIVE ASSISTANTS

Mildred Leona Barber Assistant to the Treasurer

Ann Freeman Christian Resident Counselor, Center Dormitory

LUELLA L. Cliffton, B.S.Ed. Secretary of the Graduate College

Mary Carolyn Clutter, M.Ed. Secretary to the Dean,

University College

Rowland Congdon, B.S.J. Assistant in the News Bureau

Mary Kellar Forman, A.B Resident Counselor, Voigt Hall

Lois Pauline Fri, B.S.Ed. Secretary to the Librarian

Omah Olena Gaston, B.S.Ed. Assistant to the Dean, College of

Arts and Sciences

Gladys Howell Gill Auditor of the Students' General Fund

Nellie Brooks Griswold Assistant to the University Recorder

Margaret Christy Harper, A.M. Resident Counselor, Scott Quadrangle

Amelia Power Hays Resident Counselor, Hoivard Hail

Theresa Marie Heiser, B.S.Ed Secretary of the College of Commerce

Myrle King, B.S.Ed. University Recorder

Mildred Knowles Koehn Assistant Resident Counselor,

Scott Quadrangle

Marion Wilfreda Mair, A.M. Resident Counselor, Lindley Hall

Ethel Hammann Moll Resident Counselor, Jefferson Hall

Ann Elizabeth Mumma, A.M. Secretary of the College of Education

Helena Lenore Palmer, B.S.Ed. Assistant Registrar

Joanne Dove Prisley, A.M Resident Counselor, Bryan Hall

Mary Gertrude Pbitchard Assistant to the Treasurer

John William Roberson, B.S.Ed. Cashier

Paul William Whaley Assistant Purchasing Agent

LuciLE Pierce Wild Resident Counselor, Boyd Hall

University Committees 309

UNIVERSITY COMMITTEES

First person listed is Chairman of Committee

Administrative Seigfred, Andrews, Baker, Clippinger, Crowell, Deppen, Elliott, Gubitz, Hamblin, Hunkins, Jukes, Krauskopf, Mahn, Moberly, Paulsen, Renkenberger, Schmidt, Taylor, Widdoes, Williams, Wright, and the Chairman of the Faculty Advisory Council

Advisory Council Crewson, Beckert, Cooper, Fishback, Goedicke, Gus- tavson, Gusteson, Krantz, LaTourrette, Morton, Murphree, Paige, Penson, Perry, Picard, Pullen, Quisenberry, W. Roberts, C. Smith, E. Thompson, Trepp, Whan, Wieman, Wiseman

Campus Affairs Deppen, Hunkins, Merritt, Murphree, C. Smith, Starks; student representatives: president. Student Council; two vice presi- dents, Student Council; president, Men's Union Governing Board; president, Women's League

Correspondence, Extension, and Adult Education Crowell, Collins, La- Follette, Mahn, Morton, Nessley, Paynter, Perry

Executive Baker, Clippinger, Crowell, Elliott, Gubitz, Hamblin, Kraus- kopf, Mahn, Paulsen, Seigfred, Taylor, Widdoes, Williams, and the Chairman of the Faculty Advisory Council

Faculty Lectures Wray, Beckert, Cady, Gustavson, T, Smith

Fraternity Affairs Council Lochary, A. Anderson, Fenzel, Hecht, Mur- phy, P. Peterson, Reamer, the President of Inter-Fraternity Coun- cil, and one I.F.C. elected student member

Graduate Council Clippinger, Cady, Cooper, Gambill, Krantz, LaFol- lette, Levinson, Murphy, Pullen, Randall, Stephenson

Honors Work Organ, Curry, Fichthorn, Humphreys, Krantz, Mayes, Quisenberry, Stone, Watkins

Inter-Collegiate Athletics Hellebrandt, Blickle, Butner, DeVeau, LaFol- lette, Picard, Wiseman

Library Wright, Bergsagel, Cherrington, Hicks, Klare, Kline, Lewis, Murphree, Olpp, Shuster, Wray, and two student representatives

Research T. Smith, A. Anderson, Chase, Clippinger, Culbert, Harlan, W, Huntsman, O'Brien, Penson, Soltow, Southwick

Scholarship Encouragement Collins, Badger, Bane, Brooks, Curry, Leach, Randall, Reininga, E. Thompson, Wiseman, and three student representatives

Student Financial Aids Policy Hutcheson, B. Black, Crowell, Deppen, Gusteson, Ludlum, Marquis, Matson, O'Brien, Renkenberger, Spon- seller, Sudnick, and two student representatives

University College Paulsen, W. E. Baxter, Benz, B. Black, Bradshaw, Gambill, Jasper, Weaver, Wiseman, and five student representatives

Ways and Means O'Brien, Bixler, Dando, Davis, Deppen, Grover, Hunldns, Lausche, Reis

310 Ohio University

OFFICERS OF INSTRUCTION

John Calhoun Baker, M.B.A., LL.D., D.C.S. President of the Univer- sity

DEANS AND PROFESSORS EMERITI

Edith E. Beechel, Ph.D., Professor Emerita of Education

Edwin Watts Chubb, Litt.D., LL.D., Dean Emeritus of the College of Arts and Sciences

Frank Brown Dilley, Ph.D., Professor Emeritus of Education

Howard Leroy Dunlap, Ph.D., Professor Emeritus of Chemistry

Walter Sylvester Gamertsfelder, Ph.D., L.H.D., LL.D., Trustee Pro- fessor Emeritus of Philosophy and Ethics

John Robert Gentry, Ph.D., Professor Emeritus of Psychology

Frank Barnhart Gullum, M.S., Associate Professor Emeritus of Chemistry

John Ambrose Hess, Ph.D., Professor Emeritus of German

Victor Dwight Hill, Ph.D., Professor Emeritus of Classical Languages

Horace Thomas Houf, A.M., B.D. L.H.D., Professor Emeritus of Phi- losophy

Ellis Herndon Hudson, M.D., Professor Emeritus of Hygiene

Frederick Hartzler Krecker, Ph.D., Professor Emeritus of Zoology

George Starr Lasher, A.M., Professor Emeritus of Journalism

Constance Grosvenor Leete, A.M., Assistant Professor Emerita of Romance Languages

Thomas Cooke McCracken, Ph.D., Dean Emeritus of the College of Education

Mariam Sarah Morse, A.M., Associate Professor Emerita of Home Economics

Mary Theodora Noss, Docteur d'Universite', Professor Emerita of French

George Crawford Parks, Ph.B., Business Manager Emeritus

Ida Mae Patterson, M.S., Associate Professor Emerita of Home Eco- nomics

Harry Houston Peckham, A.M., Professor Emeritus of English

Clarence Cramer Robinson, Mus.M., Professor Emeritus of Music

AzARiAH BooDY SiAS, Ph.D., Professor Emeritus of School Administration

Edwin Bert Smith, Ph.D., Professor Emeritus of Government

Hiram Roy Wilson, Litt.D., Professor Emeritus of English

0FFICE21S OF Instruction 311

PROFESSORS Karl Ahrendt, Ph.D., Professor of Music

Elizabeth Genevieve Andersch, Ph.D., Professor of Dramatic Art and

Speech

Amos Carey Anderson, Ph.D., Professor of Psychology

Burton Staley Andrews, B.S.Ed., Lieutenant Colonel, Infantry, Pro- fessor of Military Science and Tactics

Ralph Ferdinand Beckert, A.M., Professor of Accounting

Harry Edward Benz, Ph.D., Professor of Education

Paul Howard Black, M.S., P/rofessor of Mechanical Engineering

John Frank Cady, Ph.D., Professor of History

Homer Virgil Cherrington, Ph.D., Professor of Finance

Donald Hoop Clippinger, Ph.D., LL.D., Professor of Chemistry

Carl Herbert Denbow, Ph.D., Professor of Mathematics

LAvmENCE Powell Eblin, Ph.D., Professor of Chemistry

John Elza Edwards, Ph.D., Professor of Physics

Rush Elliott, Ph.D., Professor of Anatomy

Richard Allen Foster, Ph.D., Professor of English

Carl Adam Frey, Ph.D., Professor of Bacteriology

Victor Alfred Goedicke, Ph.D., Professor of Mathematics and Astron- omy

Darrell Bennett Green, Ph.D., Professor of Electrical Engineering

Albert Carl Gubitz, A.M., Professor of Economics

Carl Gustav Gustavson, Ph.D., Professor of History

Francis Newell Hamblin, Ed.D., Professor of Education

EiNAR August Hansen, Ph.D., Professor of Elementary Education

Edwin Theodore Hellebrandt, Ph.D., Professor of Economics and

Management

George Edward Hill, Ph.D., Professor of Education

Loren Joseph Hortin, A.M., Litt.D., Professor of Journalism

Deforest Wilbur Ingerham, Mus.B., Professor of Violin

Claude Edgar Kantner, Ph.D., Professor of Dramatic Art and Speech

Paul Murray Kendall, Ph.!)., Professor of English (on leave 1957-1958)

Karl Hort Krauskopf, Ph.D., Professor of Advertising

Arthur C. LaFollette, Ph.D., Professor of Dramatic Art and Speech

Frederick Darwin Leach, Ph.D., Professor of Painting

Harvey Christian Lehman, Ph.D., Professor of Psychology

312 Ohio University

Robert Houghton Marquis, Ph.D., Professor of Mathematics

Lawrence Carl Mitchell, A.M., Professor of Painting

Caleb Powers Mobebly, M.L., Lieutenant Colonel, Air Force, Professor of Air Science

Robert Lee Morton, Ph.D., Professor of Education

Paul Robert Murphy, Ph.D., Professor of Classical Languages

Lewis Amedeus Ondis, Ph.D., Professor of Romance Philology

Troy Organ, Ph.D., Professor of Philosophy

James Ruey Patrick, Ph.D., Professor of Psychology

Gaige Brue Paulsen, Ph.D., Professor of Psychology

Frederick Quentin Picard, Ph.D., Professor of Economics

Ernest Eugene Ray, M.B.A., C.P.A., Professor of Accounting

Vivian Mae Roberts, Ph.D., Professor of Home Economics

Thurman Carlisle Scott, Ph.D., Professor of Psychology^

Earl Covert Seigfred, Ph.D., Professor of Fine Arts

Forest Leroy Shoemaker, Ph.D., Professor of Education

LORIN COOVER Staats, Ph.D., Professor of Dramatic Art and Speech

William Carl Stehr, Ph.D., Professor of Entomology

Myron Thomas Sturgeon, Ph.D., Professor of Geology

Richard Stephen Uhrbrock, Ph.D., Professor of Psychology

Edna Martha Way, A.M., Professor of Space Arts

Gerald Thomas Wilkinson, Ph.D., Professor of Romance Languages

Edith Armstrong Wray, Ph.D., Professor of English

ASSOCIATE PROFESSORS

Ibvin Poston Badger, M.S.C.E., Associate Professor of Civil Engineer- ing

Russell Norman Baird, A.M., Associate Professor of Journalism

Allyne Bane, A.M., Associate Professor of Home Economics

Bernard Ralph Black, Ed.D., Associate Professor of Human Relations

Arthur Harry Blickle, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Botany and Curator of the Museum

Robert Keith Butner, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Mathematics

Ernest Monroe Collins, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Government

Harry Bernarr Crewson, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Economics

Gilford White Crowell, Ed.D., Associate Professor of Education

Officers of Instruction 313

Thomas Harvey Curry, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Chemical Engi- neering

Jesse Harold Day, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Chemistry

Archibald Campbell Denison, A.B., B.Ar., Associate Professor of

Architecture

Burton William Deveau, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Agriculture

WiLLARD Hubbard Elsbrbe, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Government

John James Evans, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Education

Margaret Josephine Felsinger, Ed.D., Associate Professor of Education

William Henry Fenzel, B.C.S., A.B., Associate Professor of Account- ing

William Harrison Fichthorn, D.C.S., Associate Professor of Finance

WILLLA.M Thompson Fishback, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Mathe- matics

Paul Hendricks Fontaine, Mus.B., Associate Professor of Piano and Counterpoint

William Gray Gambill, Jr., Ph.D., Associate Professor of Botany

Raymond Harris Gusteson, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Government

William Harrell Harlan, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Sociology

Sarah Hatcher, A.M., Associate Professor of Physical Education and Athletics

William Henry Herbert, A.M., Associate Professor of Commerce

Lewis Franklin Hicks, M.S.M.E., Associate Professor of Mechanical Engineering

Sbxson Eckels Humphreys, Litt.D., Associate Professor of Journalism

William Duane Huntsman, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Chemistry

Robert Kelly Ingham, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Chemistry

Samuel Jacob Jasper, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Mathematics

Henry John Jeddeloh, A.M., Associate Professor of Sociology

Vincent Joseph Jukes, A.M., Associate Professor of Dramatic Art and Speech

Charles Richard Kinison, M.S., Associate Professor of Industrial Arts

William Harry Kirchner, Jr., Ph.D., Associate Professor of English

George Roger Klare, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Psychology

Robert Joseph Kline, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Chemistry

Lavern Laurell Krantz, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Education

314 Ohio University

Paul Gerhardt Krauss, Ph.D., Associate Professor of German

Greta Alecia Lash, A.M., Associate Professor of English

Charlotte Ellen LaTourrettb, A.M., Associate Professor of Physical Education and Athletics

Luverne Frederick Lausche, B.S., Associate Professor of Mechanical Engineering

James Vantine Lawrence, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Bacteriology

Herbert Lederer, Ph.D., Associate Professor of German

David Levinson, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Economics

Edward Perrin Lynn, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Education

Oscar Earle McClure, A.M., Associate Professor of Electrical Engi- neering and Physics

Frederick Hotchkiss McKelvey, Ed.D., Associate Professor of Edu- cation (on leave 1957-1958)

Raymer McQuiston, A.M., Associate Professor of English

Wilma Katherine Miller, Pe.D., Associate Professor of Physical Edu- cation and Athletics

Olin Dee Morrison, A.M., Associate Professor of History

Idus Laviga Murphree, Jr., Ph.D., Associate Professor of Social Science and Philosophy

Allen Alexander Nellis, Jr., A.M., Associate Professor of Engineer- ing Drawing

Carl Tussing Nessley, Ed.M., Associate Professor of Physical Educa- cation and Athletics, and Assistant Director of Physical Education and Athletics

Frank Theodore Paige, A.M., Associate Professor of Industrial Arts

Roy Hoyt Paynter, M.B.A., Associate Professor of Marketing

Donald Edwin Perry, Ed.D., Associate Professor of Industrial Arts

Philip Lawrence Peterson, Mus.M., Associate Professor of Voice

William Marion Pierce, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Physics

Maxwell Spencer Pullen, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Psychology

Marie Acomb Quick, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Education

Roger Christian Quisenberry, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Electrical Engineering

Charles Addison Randall, Jr., Ph.D., Associate Professor of Physics

Robert Scott Raymond, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Marketing

Officers of Instruction 315

Warren Henry Reininga, M.C.S., C.P.A., Associate Professor of Ac- counting

Bertram Allison Renkenberger, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Ro- mance Languages

Arthur Henry Rhoads, A.M., Associate Professor of Physical Educa- tion and Athletics

James Van Nostran Rice, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Romance Languages

Carl Henry Roberts, Ed.D., Associate Professor of Education

Emmett Rowles, A.m., Associate Professor of Physiology

Henri Cleret Seibert, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Zoology

Richard Royal Selleck, M.S., Associate Professor of Electrical Engi- neering.

GusTAVUS Edward Smith, M.S.E.E., Associate Professor of Electrical Engineering

Thomas Stevenson Smith, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Physics

Le33 Carl Soltow, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Statistics

Charles Clinton Spivey, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Management

Doris Mae Sponseller, A.M., Associate Professor of Secretarial Studies

Gilbert Arthur Stephenson, Mus.M., Ed.D., Associate Professor of Music Education

Harry Rorert Stevens, Ph.D., Associate Professor of History

Edward Stone, Ph.D., Associate Professor of English

Neil Duncan Thomas, B.S.C.E., Associate Professor of Engineering Drawing

Eric Thompson, Ph.D., Associate Professor of English

William John Trautwein, A.B., Associate Professor of Physical Edu- cation and Athletics, and Associate Director of Athletics

Joseph Peter Trepp, A.M., Associate Professor of Physical Education

and Athletics

Arthur Thomas Turnbull, Jr., M.S., Associate Professor of Journalism Atwell Milton Wallace, Ph.D., Associate Professor of Botany

Carroll Curtis Widdoes, A.B., Associate Professor of Physical Educa- tion and' Athletics

Hazel Mae Willis, A.M., Associate Professor of Design Isabelle McCoy Work, A.M., Associate Professor of Space Arts

316 Ohio University

ASSISTANT PROFESSORS Edith Trelease Aney, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of English

Marguerite Elizabeth Appel, A.M., Assistant Professor of Secretarial

Studies

Merrill Forrest Aukland, M.S., Assistant Professor of Geography and

Geology

Alan Albert Barnhill, M.S.Ed., Assistant Professor of Engineering Drawing

Robert Lewis Bartels, A.M., Assistant Professor of Physical Educa- tion and Athletics, and Swimming and Tennis Coach

Willard Ellis Baxter, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Mathematics

William Spiers Baxter, A.M., Assistant Professor of Journalism

Frank Dawson Bean, A.M., Assistant Professor of Education

Jack Bruno Bellomo, B.S., Captain, QvM/rtermaster Corps, Assistant Professor of Military Science and Tactics

Morton Benson, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of German and Russian

John Dagfinn Bergsagel, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Musicology

Mary Dee Blayney, A.M., Assistant Professor of Music Education

Kermit Allen Blosser, A.M., Assistant Professor of Physical Educa- tion and Athletics, Assistant in Football and Basketball, and Golf Coach

Homer Leslie Bradshaw, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Psychology

Wendell Victor Flagg Brooks, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Chemistry

William Reuben Brophy, Mus.M., Assistant Professor of Brass Instru- ments, and Assistant Director of Bands

LuRENE Brown, A.M., Assistant Professor of English

Harrison Butterworth, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of English

Laurence Vivla.n Calvin, A.M., Assistant Professor of Industrial Arts

Wallace John Cameron, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Romance Lan- guages

Cosmo Anthony Catalano, M.F.A., Assistant Professor of Dramatic Art and Speech

Virgil George Catlin, B.S. Major, Artillery, Assistant Professor of Military Science and Tactics

William Weymouth Chase, Ed.D., Assistant Professor of Education

Paul Leighton Conkling, Mus.M., Assistant Professor of Violoncello

Willlam Hickerson Cooper, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Education

Officers of Instruction 317

Mary Letitia Cowan, A.M., Assistant Professor of Home Economics

Taylor Culbert, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of English

Robert Leslie Daniel, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of History

Margaret Keehne Davis, A.M., Assistant Professor of Home Economics

Ray Edward Dawson, Ph.D., C.P.A,, Assistant Professor of Finance

Clara Hockridge DeLand, A.M., Assistant Professor of Education

Esther Mae Dunham, A.M., Assistant Professor of Education

Oscar Raymond Eggers, A.M., Assistant Professor of Sociology

Agnes Lydia Eisen, A.M., Assistant Professor of Education

John Thomas Everett, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Government

Roy Phillip Fairfield, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Government

Robert Dittrick Falkner, A.B., Captain, Air Force, Assistant Profes- sor of Air Science

Lawrence Joseph Gallaher, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Physics

Paul Allen Games, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Psychology

Stanley Grean, A.B., B.D., Assistant Professor of Philosophy

Archie McIntosh Greer, M.F.A., Assistant Professor of Dramatic Art and Speech

Paul Wandell Hagensick, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Philosophy Virginia Hahne, A.M., Assistant Professor of Dramatic Art and Speech

Sherwood Eastabrook Hall, Mus.M., Assistant Professor of Music Theory

Richard Errol Ham, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Dramatic Art and Speech

Esther Jane Hand, A.M., Assistant Professor of English

Clifford Charles Heffelfinger, A.M., Assistant Professor of Physical Education and Athletics, and Assistant Football Coach

Harry Lee Hoffee, M.S.E.E., Assistant Professor of Electrical Engi- neering

Rodney Taber Hood, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Mathematics

Julian Pelham Hopkins, B.S., Captain, Air Force, Assistant Professor of Air Science

David Lee Hostetler, M.F.A., Assistant Professor of Ceramics

Lowell B. Howard, LL.B., A.M., Assistant Professor of Biisiness Law

Reginald Terrell Irvin, A.M., Captain, Air Force, Assistant Professor of Air Science

318 Ohio University

Laurence Eugene Jennings, Mus.M., Assistant Professor of Piano

Gilbert Roland Johns, A.B., Assistant Professor of Psychology

Virginia Knecht, A.M., Assistant Professor of English

Allen Raymond Kresge, Assistant Professor of Organ and Harmony

Christopher Charles Lane, A.M., Assistant Professor of Dramatic Art and Speech (on leave, first semester 1957-58)

Mary Katherine Leonard, A.M., Assistant Professor of School Design

Mary Ann Lewis, M.S., Assistant Professor of Hom,e Economics

John Francis Lindley, M.S.C.E., Assistant Professor of Civil Engi- neering

George Henry Lobdell, Jr., Ph.D., Assistant Professor of History

William Ransom Longstreet, A.M., Mus.B., Assistant Professor of Piano

Thomas Spencer Ludlum, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Dramatic Art and Speech

Rubye Mitchell Macaulby, M.S., Assistant Professor of Home Eco- nomics

Charles Ray Mayes, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of History

John Truman McQuate, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Zoology (on leave 1957-58)

Evangeline Merritt, Mus.M., Assistant Professor of Voice

Charles Minelli, M.Mus.Ed., Assistant Professor of Music and Direc- tor of Bands

Grace MacGregor Morley, A.M., Assistant Professor of Music Educa- tion

Julia Jane Nehls, M.S., Assistant Professor of Home Economics

Margaret Viola Nelson, A.M., Assistant Professor of Education

Donald Henry Niesse, M.S.M.E., Assistant Professor of Mechanical Engineering

John Emil Nygaard, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Psychology

William Henry Olpp, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Fine Arts

Ronald Ramon Olsen, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Economics

Mabel Beryl Olson, A.M., Assistant Professor of Education

George Kerlin Park, A.M., Assistant Professor of Sociology

Edward Martin Penson, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Dramatic Art and Speech

Officers of Instruction 319

Wesley John Peterson, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Zoology

WiLLARD Brooks Phelps, A.M., Assistant Professor of Geology

Leona Mabel Pickard, A.M., Assistant Professor of English

Milton Ernest Ploghoft, Ed.D., Assistant Professor of Education, and Principal, Unive/rsity Elementa/ry School

Clifford Waldemer Reims, Mus.M., Assistant Professor of Voice

Frank Brough Rickey, M.S., Assistant Professor of Physical Education and Athletics, Freshman Football Coach, and Assistant in Baseball

David Richmond, M.S., Assistant Professor of Advertising

Helen Hedden Roach, A.B., Assistant Professor of Voice

Donald Owen Roberts, M.F.A., Assistant Professor of Design

William Samuel Roberts, Jr., Captain, Infantry, Assistant Professor of Military Science and Tactics

Edward Gerhard Russ, M.S.C.E., Assistant Professor of Civil Engi- neering

Fred Schleicher, Jr., B.S.Ed., Assistant Professor of Physical Educa- tion and Athletics, Head Athletic Trainer, and Varsity Wrestling Coach

Beulah Elizabeth Sellers, A.M., Assistant Professor of Home Eco- nom.ics

Norman Emil Sexauer, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Mathematics

Lee Martin Sherman, B.S., Captain, Infantry, Assistant Professor of Military Science and Tactics

James Trusler Shipman, M.S., Assistant Professor of Physics

Albert Henry Shuster, Jr., Ed.D., Assistant Professor of Education

Joseph Richard Sligo, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Education

Charles Logan Smith, M.F.A., Assistant Professor of Design

Ralppi Dorrance Smith, M.S.M.E., Assistant Professor of Mechanical Engineering.

William Burton Smith, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Chemistry

James Edgar Snyder, B.S.Ed., Assistant Professor of Physical Educa- tion and Athletics, and Head Basketball Coach

Charles Henry Southwick, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Zoology Ray Frederick Spring, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Mathematics Esther Bell Starks, A.M., Assistant Professor of Education Thomas Franklin Storm, M.S., Assistant Professor of Psychology

320 Ohio University

FoLDEN Burt Stumpf, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Physics

Harold Roland Swardson, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of English

Robert Frederick Sympson, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Chemistry

Joseph Eugene Thackrey, A.M., Assistant Professor of Music Educa- tion

James Ying-Peh Tong, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Chemistry

Florence Elizabeth Ullmann, M.S.Ed., Assistant Professor of Educa- tion

Henry Howard Vallowe, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Zoology

Monroe Thomas Vermillion, M.S., Assistant Professor of Botany

Dorotha Macil Via, A.M., Assistant Professor of Secreta/rial Studies

Mary Ward, A.M., Assistant Professor of Education

Lloyd Irion Watkins, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Dramatic Art and

Speech

Betty Maria Weaver, M.B.A., C.P.S., Assistant Professor of Secretarial

Studies

Edgar William Whan, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of English, and Di- rector of English Composition

Robert Colyer Wickham, M.S., Assistant Professor of Engineering Drawing

Karl Leo Wiegand, A.M., First Lieutenant, Air Force, Assistant Pro- fessor of Air Science

Robert Morgan Wieman, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Philosophy

Janet Purser Wilson, A.M., Assistant Professor of Education

Gordon Wiseman, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Dramatic Art and

Speech

Warren Arthur Wistendahl, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Botany

James Gardnehi Witte, Ph.D., Assistant Professor of Economics

Karl Escott Witzler, Mus.M., Assistant Professor of Woodwind In- struments

David Edward Wood, B.S., Captain, Air Force, Assistant Professor of

Air Science

Helen Wisgerhof Worstell, M.S., Assistant Professor of Sociology

Robert Michael Wren, B.S.Ed., Assistant Professor of Physical Edu- cation and Athletics, Head Baseball Coach, and Assistant in Foot- ball

Walter Woodman Wright, S.B., B.S.L.S., Assistant Professor of Library Science

Thomas Bard Zimmerman, A.B., First Lieutenant, Air Force, Assistant Professor of Air Science

Officers of Instruction 321

INSTRUCTORS

John Harry Adams, M.S., Instructor in Industrial Arts

Ivan Charles Allen, Master Sergeant, Instructor in Military Science and Tactics

James Joseph Armbruster, M.Ed., Instructor in Industrial Arts

Richard Alden Beale, M.F.A., Instructor in Design

HoBEaiT Shejrwood Billingsley, M.S., Instructor in Physical Education and Athletics

Poul Bjerre, M.S.E.E., Instructor in Electrical Engineering

Jacqueline Bolen, B.S.Ed., Instructor in French

Vilma Boros, A.m., Instructor in Dramatic Art and Speech

Robert Curtis Brown, A.M., Instructor in English

William Vernon Canter, Sergeant First Class, Instructor in Military Science and Tactics

Levoyd Cargill, Master Sergeant, Air Force, Instructor in Air Science

Mildred Carolyn Chutter, A.B., B.S.L.S., Assistant Librarian in Charge of Cataloguing

John Tapley Clem, Sergeant, Instructor in Military Science and Tactics

Sally Joan Comin, A.M., Instructor in Music Theory

Donald Eugene Cornele, Technical Sergeant, Air Force, Instructor in Air Science

Lyle Rodric Crandall, Sergeant First Class, Instructor in Military Science and Tactics

Eileen Mary Curran, Ph.D., Instructor in English

Loren Kenneth Davidson, A.M., Instructor in English

Eleanor Ruth Devlin, A.M., Assistant Librarian in Charge of Refer- ence

Dorothy Margaret Dickinson, B.S.Ed., B.S.L.S., Assistant Librarian in Charge of Circulation

James Charles Dickinson, A.M., Instructor in Human Relations

Herbert Henry Diekhans, M.S., Instructor in Mathematics

Frank Russell Eaton, M.S.L.S., Assistant Reference Librarian

Ira Stern Eintracht, Master Sergeant, Instructor in Military Science and Tactics

Joseph Edward Essman, B.S., Acting Instructor in Electrical Engi- neering

Alfred Berlin Feagin, Technical Sergeant, Air Force, Instructor in Air Science

322 Ohio University

Edward Joseph Feidner, M.F.A., Instructor in Dramatic Art and Speech

Joseph Albert Fletcher, B.S.C.E., Acting Instructor in Civil Engi- neering

Robert M. Freimark, M.F.A., Instructor in Drawing

Jack Gilbert, B.S.J., Instructor in Journalism

Mary Ellen Gillespie, B.S.Ed., Instructor in Physical Education and Athletics

Joseph Allen Greene, A.M., Instructor in English

Edward Burke Groff, Ph.D., Instructor in English

Suzan S. S. Habachy, A.M., Instructor in Government and History

William Dean Hinkle, Part-time Acting Instructor in Mechanical Engineering

Robert Goode Hogan, Ph.D., Instructor in English

Donald George Horvath, B.S.E.E., Acting Instructor in Electrical Engineering

Harry Adolph Hultgren, A.M., Instructor in Classical Languages

Stanley Houser Huntsman, M.S., Instructor in Physical Education and Athletics, Head Track Coach, and Assistant in Football

Joyce Ilene Jensen, M.S., Instructor in Physical Education and Ath- letics

Marcia D. Johns, A.B., Part-time Instructor in Psychology

Frank Craig Johnson, M.S., Instructor in Dramatic Art and Speech

Kathryn Ann Johnson, A.M., Instructor in German

Neva Duff Johnson, A.B., Instructor in Mathematics

Margaret Cotton Kasten, A.M., Instructor in English

Marion Elizabeth Kirk, B.S., Assistant Cataloguer

Albert Joseph Korsok, A.M., Instructor in Geography

Shirley Ruth Kreps, B.S.Ed., Acting Instructor in Spanish

Irma Green LaFollette, A.B., B.S.Ed., Instructor in English

Charlotte Lewis Lane, B.S., Part-time Instructor in Dramatic Art and Speech

Rita Josephine Lauff, M.Ed., Instructor in Mathematics

Miriam Randall LeBoutillier, A.B., Instructor in Mathematics

Wilma Brammell Leety, B.S., Assistant Instructor in Psychology

Paul Lindner Lehrer, A.M., Instructor in Geography

Officers of Instruction 323

Richard Lincoln Lettis, Ph.D., Instructor in English

Alton Fred Lindsay, Airman First Class, Air Force, Instructor in Air Science

Gertrude Rosalie Ida Linnenbruegge, A.M., Assistant Librarian in Charge of Work with Children and Young People (on leave, first semester 1957-58)

Margaret Joyce Lowe, M.S., Instructor in Home Economics

Alexander Duncan MacGibbon, A.M., Instructor in English

Judith Emma Makroczy, M.S., Instructor in Home Economics

John Alexander McComb, B.S.Ed., Instructor in Physical Education and Athletics

Robert Francis McDonnell, A.M., Instructor in English

John Francis McLaren, B.B.A., C.P.S., Instructor in Accounting

Milan Mihal, M.S.Ed., Instructor in School Design

Dorothy Elizabeth Caroline Mintzlaff, A.M., Instructor in English

SVEN Eric Molin, Ph.D., Instructor in English

William Edgar Morris, Ph.D., Instructor in English

Jean Ann Murray, R.N., Part-time Instructor in Home Economics

Avis Lorene Murrell, M.B.A., Instructor in Secretarial Studies

Catherine Nelson, A.B., B.S.L.S., Assistant Librarian in Charge of Book Selection

P. Outhwaite Nichols, Instructor in Journalism

John Raymond O'Neal, M.Ed., Instructor in Physical Education and Athletics

William Elihu Palmer, A.M., Instructor in English

Joan Elizabeth Price, M.S., Instructor in Home Economics

Richard John Purdum, Ph.D., Instructor in English

Elizabeth Raymond Raymond, A.M., Instructor in English

Charles William Reamer, A.B., Instructor in Journalism

Raul Reyes, A.M., Instructor in Dramatic Art and Speech

June C. Roberts, Part-time Instructor in Art Education and Draiving

James William Robeysek, Sergeant, Instructor in Military Science and

Tactics Richard Walter Rodgers, M.S., Instructor in Mathematics

Ann Nancy Roe, A.B., Instructor in English

324 Ohio University

Robert Thomas Roe, A.B., Instructor in English

Hugh Francis Rogers, A.M., Instructor in Engineering Drawing

Mary-Lyell Rogers, M.S., Instructor in Home Economics

Charles David Rose, Acting Instructor in Engineering Drawing

Kenneth Milton Saffle, Master Sergeant, Instructor in Military Sci- ence and Tactics

Marjorie Sams, M.S., Instructor in Physical Education and Athletics

Thomas Cecil Sarchet, M.S., Instructor in Engineering Drawing

James Gray Saunders, M.F.A., Instructor in Dramatic Art and Speech

Vincent Paul Scarmack, Technical Sergeant, Air Force, Instructor in Air Science

James Francis Sheridan, Ph.D., Instructor in Philosophy

Robert Leroy Shrigley, M.Ed., Instructor in Education

Howard Isaac Shull, A.M., Instructor in Industrial Arts

Robert Dean Smith, Mus.M., Instructor in Brass Instruments

June Corrine Southworth, A.B., B.S.L.S., Assistant Librarian in Charge of Acquisitions

Albert Rea Squibb, M.Ed., Instructor in Industrial Arts

Daniel Halbert Stright, M.S., Instructor in Agriculture, and Farm Superintendent

Gertrude Anne Szaroleta, Mus.M., Instructor in Piano (on leave 1957-1958)

Barbara Elizabeth Thompson, B.S.Ed., Instructor in Education

Richard Austin Thompson, Ph.D., Instructor in History

Ernest Toth, M.F.A., Instructor in Industrial Design

Anthony George Trisolini, A.M., Instructor in Dramatic Art and

Speech

James Earl Tullis, M.S., Instructor in Zoology

Erika Ottolea Uhl, M.S., Instoructor in Mathematics

John Malcolm Violette, A.M., Instructor in English

Thomas Archibald Ward, Master Sergeant, Air Force, Instructor in Air Science

Earl Mervin Weber, A.M., Instructor in Industrial Arts

Arvin Robert Wells, A.M., Instructor in English

Mary Ellen Williams, A.M., Instructor in English

William Franklin Willier, J.D., Instructor in Business Law

The University Branches 325

LECTURERS AND OTHERS

Walter Albert Allen, A.B., Lecturer in Photography

Fred William Cartland, M.S.E.E., Lecturer in Electrical Engineering

Horace B. Davidson, M.D., Director of Internes in Medical Technology

Lily Keleti, Visiting Professor of Piano

Gene Dovglas Kelly, B.S., Lecturer in Ceraviics and Design

Harry Larson, M.S.E., Lecturer in Civil Engineering

George Tyrell LeBoutillier, Lecturer in Architecture

Margaret Liggett, M.S., Itinerant Teacher in Home Economics

Frances Fleda Malone, M.Ed., Lecturer in Music Education

Dwight Mutchler, Lecturer in Drawing

William Wesley Sears, M.M.E., Lecturer in Music Education

Elizabeth Brownson Stanton, Ph.D., Visiting Assistant Professor of English

HOLLis Spurgeon Summers, Ph.D., Visiting McGuffey Professor of Cre- ative Writing

Sidney H. Tompkins, Lecturer in Radio and Television, and Chief Engi- neer of the Broadcasting Services

Betty Truxell, B.F.A., Lecturer in Photography

Clarence Hudson White, Lecturer in Photography

Thomas McKinley Wolfe, M.B.A., Lecturer in Commerce (on leave 1957-1958)

THE UNIVERSITY BRANCHES

Albert Carl Gubitz, A.M., Dean

David William Wilson, A.M., Director, Chillicothe Branch

James John Mains, Jr., M.A., Director, Ironton Branch

H0V7ARD Ernest Kirk, M.A., Director, Lancaster Branch

Eldred Richard Bovenizer, M.Ed., Director, Martins Ferry Branch

Maurice Ralph Elliott, B.S.Ed., Director, Portsmouth Branch

Ellis Bradford Miracle, A.M., Director, Zanesville Branch

326 Ohio University

HEALTH SERVICE

Eleonora Louise Schmidt, M.D., Director

Burt Held, M.D., Associate Physician

Ruth Eileen Matthewson, M.D., Associate Physician

ROARY Adlai Murchison, M.D., Associate Physician

UNIVERSITY TESTING AND VOCATIONAL COUNSELING

Gaige Brue Paulsen, Ph.D., Director

Ardyce Saul Bowling, M.S.Ed., Vocational Counselor

George Roger Klare, Ph.D., Vocational Counselor

INDEX

A

Absences 20, 67

Accounting, Courses in 1V9

Accreditation 14

Activities, Student 41

Administrative Assistants 308

Administrative Officers 305

Admission :

Application for 52

Extension Division 175

Graduate College 160

Subjects in High School 52

Advanced Standing Examinations 57

Advertising, Courses in 180

Advisers, Student 21, 78, 161

Agriculture :

Courses in 181

Curriculum 117

Degree with major in 117

Airport, University 16

Air Science, Courses in 282

Alumni Office 23

Apartments 18

Applications:

Admission 52

Advanced Standing Examination 57

Auditors 60

Board and Room 17

Change of College 61

Extension Division 175

Foreign Student 55

Graduate College 160

Graduation 68

Graduation in Absentia 71, 108

Honors Work 72

Loan Funds 29

Scholarships 24

Applied Music, Courses in 257

Applied Science, College of 82

Appointments, Bureau of 22

Archaeology, Courses in 182

Architectural Engineering 85

Architecture 156

Architecture, Courses in 183

Art, Courses in 184

Art History, Courses in 184

Arts and Sciences, College of 98

Assistantships, Graduate 163, 164

Associate in Arts Diploma 78

Astronomy, Courses in 188

Athletics :

Coaching Staff 265

Fields 16

Intercollegiate 40, 168

Intramural 39, 168

Atomic Energy and Industrial Physics,

Curriculum 104

Auditing Privilege 60

Automobiles, Registration of 62

Awards and Prizes 32

B

Bands, University 45

Biology, Courses in 188, 223

Board and Room 17

Botany, Courses in 189

Branches, University 166, 325

Buildings and Grounds 14

Bureau of Appointments 22

Business Law, Courses in 191

Business Teacher Training 122

0

Cadet Program, Teacher 129

Calendar, University 4

Campus Affairs Committee 41

Cent«r for Educational Service 140

Center, Ohio University 39

Ceramics, Courses in 185

Certificates, Teaching 141

Change of Address 61

Change of College 61

Change Orders, Course 61

Chemical Engineering :

Courses in 209

Degree in 85

Chemistry, Courses in 192

Chorus, University 45

Civil Engineering:

Courses in 210

Degree in 86

Classical Languages, Courses in 194

Clinics:

Health 19

Hearing 21, 145

Speech 21, 145

Clothing and Textiles 92, 241

Colleges 12

Applied Science 82

Arts and Sciences 98

Commerce 116

Education 128

Fine Arts 144

Graduate 160

University 76

Commencement 73

Commerce :

College of 116

Curriculum 119

Degree in 118

Correspondence Study 174

Counseling 21, 326

Courses of Instruction 178

Credit :

Course 178

Extension and Correspondence 174

Grades 68

Graduate 162

Hours 68

827

328

Ohio University

Military Service 57

Residence 71« 162

Curricula 12

Agriculture H'^

Architectural Engineering 85

Architecture 156

Art 154

Art Education 157

Atomic Energy & Industrial

Physics 104

Cadet Program 129

Chemical Engineering 85

iCivil Engineering 86

Commerce 11°

Design 153

Dramatic Art and Speech 146

Electrical Engineering 87

Elementary Education 129

Home Economics 90

Industrial Engineering Option 89, 120

Industrial Technology 95

Journalism 123

Mechanical Engineering 88

Medical Technology 106

Music 147

Nursing 109

Occupational Therapy 110

Painting and Drawing 154

Photography 157

Physical Education and Athletics 168

Predental 104

Preforestry 105

Prelaw 106

Premedical 107

Prepharmacy HO

Prephysical Therapy HI

Preprof essional 104

Preveterinary Medicine 112

Secondary Education 130

Secretarial Studies 121

Special Subjects, Education 133

Speech 146

Speech and Hearing Therapy 146

Technical Engineering Option 88

D

Dean's List 65

Debate 44

Degrees 12

Bachelor of Arts 99

Bachelor of Fine Arts 144

Bachelor of Science 102

Bachelor of Science with a Major in

Agriculture 117

Bachelor of Science in Architectural

Engineering . 85

Bachelor of Science in Chemical Engi- neering 85

Bachelor of Science in Civil Engineer- ing 86

Bachelor of Science in Commerce 118

Bachelor of Science in Education 128

Bachelor of Science in Electrical

Engineering 87

Bachelor of Science in Home

Economics 90

Bachelor of Science in Industrial

Technology 95

Bachelor of Science in Journalism 122

Bachelor of Science in Mechanical

Engineering ; 88

Bachelor of Science in Secretarial

Studies 120

Doctor of Philosophy 160

Master of Arts 13, 160

Master of Business Administra- tion 13, 160

Master of Education 18, 160

Master of Fine Arts 13, 160

Master of Science 13, 160

Degree, Second Bachelor's 73

Design, Courses in 155, 184

Diploma, Associate in Arts 78

Divisions: 13

Branches 166

Physical Education and Athletics 166

Resei-ve Officers' Training Corps 171

University Extension 174

Dormitories 17

Dramatic Art and Speech, School of 145

Dramatic Art, Courses in 196

Dramatic Organizations 43

Drawing, Courses in 155, 184

E

Economics, Courses in 198

Education, College of 128

Education, Courses in :

Elementary Education 201

Guidance and Counseling 204

History and Philosophy 205

Professional Laboratory Experiences _204

Research and Scientific Techniques 205

School Administration and Super- vision 206

Secondary Education 203

Special Education, Elementary 202

Teaching Techniques 207

Education, Degrees in 128, 160

Education, Graduate Work 140, 160

Electrical Engineering :

Courses in 212

Degree in 87

Elementary Education :

Courses in 201

Curriculum 129

Emeriti Deans and Professors 310

Employment Opportunities 31

Engineering 82

Admission to 83

Architectural 85

Chemical 85. 210

Civil 86, 210

Courses in 208

Curricula 84

Index

829

Drawing 208

Electrical 87. 212

Industrial Option 89, 120

Mechanical 88, 214

Technical Option 88

English, Courses in 216

English, Proficiency in 69

Entrance Requirements 52

Examinations :

Advanced Standing 57

Graduate Students 160

Medical 20, 52

Testing 21. 53

Expense Estimate 59

Extension Division, University 174

F

Faculty Roster 310

Farm, University 16

Fees and Deposits 58

Fees:

Auditors 58

Board 17

Comprehensive 58

Correspondence Study 58

Extension Class 58

Miscellaneous 59

Private Instruction 58

Refund of 18, 59

Registration 58

Room 17

Summer Session 58

Fellowships, Graduate 163

Finance, Courses in 221

P'inancial Aids, Student 24

Fine Arts :

College of 144

Courses in 222

Degrees in 144, 160

Food Service 17

Foods and Nutrition 92, 238

Foreign Language Requirements

77, 100, 102

Foreign Students 22, 55

Foreign Study Programs 36

Forensic Organizations 43

Fraternities 18, 49

French, Courses in 283

Freshman Year 76

Fund, Ohio University, Inc. 23

G

General Studies, Courses in 223

Geography, Courses in 224

Geology, Courses in 225

German, Courses in 228

Glee Clubs 45

Golf Course, University 16

Government :

Courses in 230

Grades :

Admission 54

Graduation 64

Honors Work 72

Minimum Standard 68, 162

Point Deficiency 65

Probation 66

Reports 64

Transcripts 66

Grading System 63

Graduate College :

Admission 160

Admission to Candidacy 163

Appointments 163

Assistantships and Fellowships 163

Credit 162

Degrees 160

Examinations 163

Program of Study 162

Record Examination 160

Requirements for the Degree 163

Standards of Work 162

Thesis 162

Time Limit 163

Graduation Regulations :

Application 68

Commencement 73

Honors Work 72

In Absentia 71, 108

Major Areas of Study 69

Physical Education 70

Proficiency in English 69

Residence 71

R.O.T.C. 70

Scholastic Average 64, 68

Second Bachelor's Degree 73

Time Limit 72, 163

With Honor 72

Grants-in-Aid 28

Greek, Courses in 195

Guest Artists & Speakers 37

Guidance and Counseling, Courses in 204

Guidance Program 21, 78

«

Health Service, Student 19, 31, 326

History, Courses in 232

History and Philosophy, Education,

Courses in 205

History of the University 12

Home Economics :

Core Courses 91

Courses in 236

Curricula 90

Degree in 90

School of 90

Honors :

Day 65

Dean's List 65

Graduation 65

Work Program 72

Honor Societies 47

Housing 17

Human Relations, Courses in 242

Humanities, Courses in 228

330

Ohio University

I

In Absentia, Graduation 71, 108

Independent Groups 50

Industrial Arts, Courses in 243

Industrial Engineering Option 89, 120

Industrial Technology :

Curriculum 95

Degree in 95

Intercollegiate Athletics 40, 168

Interfratemity Council 49

Intramural Athletics 40, 168

Italian, Courses in 284

Music History and Literature,

Courses in 258

Music Therapy, Courses in 261

N

Natatorium 39

News Bureau 22

Non-Residents of Ohio 53

Non-Thesis Program 162

Nursing Curriculum 109

Journalism :

Courses in 247

Curricula 123

Degree in 122

School of 122

Kindergarten-Primary, Courses in 201

O

Observation and Participation,

Student Teaching 137

Office Management 120

Officers of the University 304

Ohio, Applicants from 54

Ohio, Non-Residents of 53

Ohio, Residents of 53

Ohio University Fund, Inc. 23

Orchestra, University Symphony 45

Out-of-State Applicants 55

Latin, Courses in 195

Law, Preparation for 106, 119

Library Science, Courses in 251

Library, University 37

Living Accommodations 17

Load, Student 60

Loan Funds 29, 31

Location of the University 13

M

Major Areas of Study 69

Management, Courses in 251

Management, Industrial 120

Map of Campus (See front of Catalog)

Marketing, Courses in 253

Married Students, Housing for 18

Mathematics, Courses in 254

Mechanical Engineering :

Courses in 214

Degree in 88

Medical Examination 20, 52

Medical Technology :

Courses in 302

Curriculum 106

Men's Union 43

Military Science, Courses in 283

Military Service, Credit 57

Musevmi, University 38

Music :

Courses in 257

Organizations 45

School of 147

Music Education, Courses in 260

Painting and Allied Arts, School of 154

Painting, Courses in 184

Panhellenic Association 49

Personnel Management 120

Personnel Work, Appointments in 164

Personnel Work, Preparation for 120

Philosophy, Courses in 262

Photography 157

Photography, Courses in 264

Physical Education and Athletics :

Courses in 265

■Curricula 169

Division of 166

Requirement 70

Physical Science, Courses in 223

Physics, Courses in 272

Playshop, University 44

Point-Hour Ratio 63

Predental Curriculum 104

Preforestry Curriculum 105

Premedical Curriculum 107

Preparation for :

Government Foreign Service 106

Juvenile Delinquency & Criminology,

Work in 113

Law 106, 119

Personnel Management 120

Secretarial Work 122

Social Work 111, 291

Teaching 82, 112, 122, 128

Theology 112

Preprofessional Curricula : Atomic Energy and Industrial

Physics 104

Dental 104

Index

331

Forestry 105

Medical 107

Medical Technology 106

Nursing 109

Optometry 110

Pharmacy 110

Physical Therapy 111

Veterinary Medicine 112

Printing Administration, Courses in 275

Prizes and Awards 32

Probation Regulations 65

Proficiency in English 69

Psychology, Ck)urses in 275

Public Relations Office 22

Publications, Student 43

R

Radio-Television, Courses in 280

Radio Stations 45

Recreation 39

Refund of Fees 18, 59

Registration 58, 60, 78, 161

Regulations, University 52

Religion, Courses in 262

Religious Organizations 46

Repeating a Course 64

Research and Scientific Techniques,

Education, Courses in 205

Reserve Officers' Training Corps :

Air Science, Courses in 282

Division 171

Military Science and Tactics, Courses

in 283

Requirement 70

Residence Halls 17

Residence Requirement 71, 162

Residents of Ohio 53

Romance Languages, Courses in 283

Romance Philology, Courses in 285

Room and Board 17

Russian, Courses in 286

(S

Scholarship Regulations 63

Scholarships 24, 28, 164

Scholastic Average 64

Scholastic Organizations 47

School Administration and Supervision,

Courses in 206

School of :

Dramatic Art and Speech 145

Home Economics 90

Journalism 122

Music 147

Painting and Allied Arts 154

Sculpture, Courses in 185

Secondary Education :

Courses in 203

Curriculum 130

Degree in 128

Sessions, The 14

Social Organizations 49

Social Policy, Student 41

Social Science, Courses in 223

Social Work, Preparation for 111, 291

Sociology, Courses in 288

Sororities 18, 49

Spanish, Courses in 285

Special Education, Courses in 202

Special Education, Curriculum 133

Special Students 56, 60, 161

Speech, Courses in 292

Speech, Requirement 76

Speech and Hearing Therapy, Courses

in 295

Statistics, Courses in 297

Student :

Activities 41

Advisers 21, 78, 161

Center 39

Council 42

Employment 31

Financial Aids 24

Government Associations 42, 50

Health Service 19

Load 60, 79, 162

Publicationa 43

Teaching 137

Students :

Auditors 60

Classification of 60

Foreign 22, 55

Freshmen 76

Graduate 160

Part-time 56

Special 56, 60, 161

Transfer 55, 56, 162

Summer Session, The 175

Summer Theatre 44

Teaching Certificates 141

Teaching, Preparation for_82, 112, 122, 128

Teaching Techniques, Courses in 207

Technical Engineering Option 88

Television 44

Terminal Programs 78

Testing and Vocational Counseling_21, 326

Testing Program ; 53

Theatre, Summer 44

Theatre, University 43

Theory and Composition, Music,

Courses in 259

Thesis 163

Time Limit for Graduation 72, 163

Trailer Park 19

Training Schools 137, 139

Transfer Student 55, 56, 162

Transcripts 66

Travel-Study Programs 36

Trustees. Board of 304

332

Ohio University

Union, Men's 43

University College, The 76

W

Withdrawal from Course 61

Withdrawal from University 62

Women's League 42

Vacations 4

Vaccination 20, 52

Veterans 21, 57

Vocational and Counseling Service 21

Y.M.CJ^. and Y.W.C-A. 46

Z

Zoology, Courses in

-298

■i

I